xref: /dragonfly/contrib/gcc-4.7/gcc/doc/invoke.texi (revision 0dace59e)
1@c Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999,
2@c 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012
3@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4@c This is part of the GCC manual.
5@c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
6
7@ignore
8@c man begin INCLUDE
9@include gcc-vers.texi
10@c man end
11
12@c man begin COPYRIGHT
13Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998,
141999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011,
152012
16Free Software Foundation, Inc.
17
18Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
19under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
20any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
21Invariant Sections being ``GNU General Public License'' and ``Funding
22Free Software'', the Front-Cover texts being (a) (see below), and with
23the Back-Cover Texts being (b) (see below).  A copy of the license is
24included in the gfdl(7) man page.
25
26(a) The FSF's Front-Cover Text is:
27
28     A GNU Manual
29
30(b) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is:
31
32     You have freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU
33     software.  Copies published by the Free Software Foundation raise
34     funds for GNU development.
35@c man end
36@c Set file name and title for the man page.
37@setfilename gcc
38@settitle GNU project C and C++ compiler
39@c man begin SYNOPSIS
40gcc [@option{-c}|@option{-S}|@option{-E}] [@option{-std=}@var{standard}]
41    [@option{-g}] [@option{-pg}] [@option{-O}@var{level}]
42    [@option{-W}@var{warn}@dots{}] [@option{-pedantic}]
43    [@option{-I}@var{dir}@dots{}] [@option{-L}@var{dir}@dots{}]
44    [@option{-D}@var{macro}[=@var{defn}]@dots{}] [@option{-U}@var{macro}]
45    [@option{-f}@var{option}@dots{}] [@option{-m}@var{machine-option}@dots{}]
46    [@option{-o} @var{outfile}] [@@@var{file}] @var{infile}@dots{}
47
48Only the most useful options are listed here; see below for the
49remainder.  @samp{g++} accepts mostly the same options as @samp{gcc}.
50@c man end
51@c man begin SEEALSO
52gpl(7), gfdl(7), fsf-funding(7),
53cpp(1), gcov(1), as(1), ld(1), gdb(1), adb(1), dbx(1), sdb(1)
54and the Info entries for @file{gcc}, @file{cpp}, @file{as},
55@file{ld}, @file{binutils} and @file{gdb}.
56@c man end
57@c man begin BUGS
58For instructions on reporting bugs, see
59@w{@value{BUGURL}}.
60@c man end
61@c man begin AUTHOR
62See the Info entry for @command{gcc}, or
63@w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/onlinedocs/gcc/Contributors.html}},
64for contributors to GCC@.
65@c man end
66@end ignore
67
68@node Invoking GCC
69@chapter GCC Command Options
70@cindex GCC command options
71@cindex command options
72@cindex options, GCC command
73
74@c man begin DESCRIPTION
75When you invoke GCC, it normally does preprocessing, compilation,
76assembly and linking.  The ``overall options'' allow you to stop this
77process at an intermediate stage.  For example, the @option{-c} option
78says not to run the linker.  Then the output consists of object files
79output by the assembler.
80
81Other options are passed on to one stage of processing.  Some options
82control the preprocessor and others the compiler itself.  Yet other
83options control the assembler and linker; most of these are not
84documented here, since you rarely need to use any of them.
85
86@cindex C compilation options
87Most of the command-line options that you can use with GCC are useful
88for C programs; when an option is only useful with another language
89(usually C++), the explanation says so explicitly.  If the description
90for a particular option does not mention a source language, you can use
91that option with all supported languages.
92
93@cindex C++ compilation options
94@xref{Invoking G++,,Compiling C++ Programs}, for a summary of special
95options for compiling C++ programs.
96
97@cindex grouping options
98@cindex options, grouping
99The @command{gcc} program accepts options and file names as operands.  Many
100options have multi-letter names; therefore multiple single-letter options
101may @emph{not} be grouped: @option{-dv} is very different from @w{@samp{-d
102-v}}.
103
104@cindex order of options
105@cindex options, order
106You can mix options and other arguments.  For the most part, the order
107you use doesn't matter.  Order does matter when you use several
108options of the same kind; for example, if you specify @option{-L} more
109than once, the directories are searched in the order specified.  Also,
110the placement of the @option{-l} option is significant.
111
112Many options have long names starting with @samp{-f} or with
113@samp{-W}---for example,
114@option{-fmove-loop-invariants}, @option{-Wformat} and so on.  Most of
115these have both positive and negative forms; the negative form of
116@option{-ffoo} would be @option{-fno-foo}.  This manual documents
117only one of these two forms, whichever one is not the default.
118
119@c man end
120
121@xref{Option Index}, for an index to GCC's options.
122
123@menu
124* Option Summary::      Brief list of all options, without explanations.
125* Overall Options::     Controlling the kind of output:
126                        an executable, object files, assembler files,
127                        or preprocessed source.
128* Invoking G++::        Compiling C++ programs.
129* C Dialect Options::   Controlling the variant of C language compiled.
130* C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on C++.
131* Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on Objective-C
132                        and Objective-C++.
133* Language Independent Options:: Controlling how diagnostics should be
134                        formatted.
135* Warning Options::     How picky should the compiler be?
136* Debugging Options::   Symbol tables, measurements, and debugging dumps.
137* Optimize Options::    How much optimization?
138* Preprocessor Options:: Controlling header files and macro definitions.
139                         Also, getting dependency information for Make.
140* Assembler Options::   Passing options to the assembler.
141* Link Options::        Specifying libraries and so on.
142* Directory Options::   Where to find header files and libraries.
143                        Where to find the compiler executable files.
144* Spec Files::          How to pass switches to sub-processes.
145* Target Options::      Running a cross-compiler, or an old version of GCC.
146* Submodel Options::    Specifying minor hardware or convention variations,
147                        such as 68010 vs 68020.
148* Code Gen Options::    Specifying conventions for function calls, data layout
149                        and register usage.
150* Environment Variables:: Env vars that affect GCC.
151* Precompiled Headers:: Compiling a header once, and using it many times.
152@end menu
153
154@c man begin OPTIONS
155
156@node Option Summary
157@section Option Summary
158
159Here is a summary of all the options, grouped by type.  Explanations are
160in the following sections.
161
162@table @emph
163@item Overall Options
164@xref{Overall Options,,Options Controlling the Kind of Output}.
165@gccoptlist{-c  -S  -E  -o @var{file}  -no-canonical-prefixes  @gol
166-pipe  -pass-exit-codes  @gol
167-x @var{language}  -v  -###  --help@r{[}=@var{class}@r{[},@dots{}@r{]]}  --target-help  @gol
168--version -wrapper @@@var{file} -fplugin=@var{file} -fplugin-arg-@var{name}=@var{arg}  @gol
169-fdump-ada-spec@r{[}-slim@r{]} -fdump-go-spec=@var{file}}
170
171@item C Language Options
172@xref{C Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}.
173@gccoptlist{-ansi  -std=@var{standard}  -fgnu89-inline @gol
174-aux-info @var{filename} -fallow-parameterless-variadic-functions @gol
175-fno-asm  -fno-builtin  -fno-builtin-@var{function} @gol
176-fhosted  -ffreestanding -fopenmp -fms-extensions -fplan9-extensions @gol
177-trigraphs  -no-integrated-cpp  -traditional  -traditional-cpp @gol
178-fallow-single-precision  -fcond-mismatch -flax-vector-conversions @gol
179-fsigned-bitfields  -fsigned-char @gol
180-funsigned-bitfields  -funsigned-char}
181
182@item C++ Language Options
183@xref{C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C++ Dialect}.
184@gccoptlist{-fabi-version=@var{n}  -fno-access-control  -fcheck-new @gol
185-fconserve-space  -fconstexpr-depth=@var{n}  -ffriend-injection @gol
186-fno-elide-constructors @gol
187-fno-enforce-eh-specs @gol
188-ffor-scope  -fno-for-scope  -fno-gnu-keywords @gol
189-fno-implicit-templates @gol
190-fno-implicit-inline-templates @gol
191-fno-implement-inlines  -fms-extensions @gol
192-fno-nonansi-builtins  -fnothrow-opt  -fno-operator-names @gol
193-fno-optional-diags  -fpermissive @gol
194-fno-pretty-templates @gol
195-frepo  -fno-rtti  -fstats  -ftemplate-depth=@var{n} @gol
196-fno-threadsafe-statics -fuse-cxa-atexit  -fno-weak  -nostdinc++ @gol
197-fno-default-inline  -fvisibility-inlines-hidden @gol
198-fvisibility-ms-compat @gol
199-Wabi  -Wconversion-null  -Wctor-dtor-privacy @gol
200-Wdelete-non-virtual-dtor -Wnarrowing -Wnoexcept @gol
201-Wnon-virtual-dtor  -Wreorder @gol
202-Weffc++  -Wstrict-null-sentinel @gol
203-Wno-non-template-friend  -Wold-style-cast @gol
204-Woverloaded-virtual  -Wno-pmf-conversions @gol
205-Wsign-promo}
206
207@item Objective-C and Objective-C++ Language Options
208@xref{Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling
209Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialects}.
210@gccoptlist{-fconstant-string-class=@var{class-name} @gol
211-fgnu-runtime  -fnext-runtime @gol
212-fno-nil-receivers @gol
213-fobjc-abi-version=@var{n} @gol
214-fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors @gol
215-fobjc-direct-dispatch @gol
216-fobjc-exceptions @gol
217-fobjc-gc @gol
218-fobjc-nilcheck @gol
219-fobjc-std=objc1 @gol
220-freplace-objc-classes @gol
221-fzero-link @gol
222-gen-decls @gol
223-Wassign-intercept @gol
224-Wno-protocol  -Wselector @gol
225-Wstrict-selector-match @gol
226-Wundeclared-selector}
227
228@item Language Independent Options
229@xref{Language Independent Options,,Options to Control Diagnostic Messages Formatting}.
230@gccoptlist{-fmessage-length=@var{n}  @gol
231-fdiagnostics-show-location=@r{[}once@r{|}every-line@r{]}  @gol
232-fno-diagnostics-show-option}
233
234@item Warning Options
235@xref{Warning Options,,Options to Request or Suppress Warnings}.
236@gccoptlist{-fsyntax-only  -fmax-errors=@var{n}  -pedantic @gol
237-pedantic-errors @gol
238-w  -Wextra  -Wall  -Waddress  -Waggregate-return  -Warray-bounds @gol
239-Wno-attributes -Wno-builtin-macro-redefined @gol
240-Wc++-compat -Wc++11-compat -Wcast-align  -Wcast-qual  @gol
241-Wchar-subscripts -Wclobbered  -Wcomment @gol
242-Wconversion  -Wcoverage-mismatch  -Wno-cpp  -Wno-deprecated  @gol
243-Wno-deprecated-declarations -Wdisabled-optimization  @gol
244-Wno-div-by-zero -Wdouble-promotion -Wempty-body  -Wenum-compare @gol
245-Wno-endif-labels -Werror  -Werror=* @gol
246-Wfatal-errors  -Wfloat-equal  -Wformat  -Wformat=2 @gol
247-Wno-format-contains-nul -Wno-format-extra-args -Wformat-nonliteral @gol
248-Wformat-security  -Wformat-y2k @gol
249-Wframe-larger-than=@var{len} -Wno-free-nonheap-object -Wjump-misses-init @gol
250-Wignored-qualifiers @gol
251-Wimplicit  -Wimplicit-function-declaration  -Wimplicit-int @gol
252-Winit-self  -Winline -Wmaybe-uninitialized @gol
253-Wno-int-to-pointer-cast -Wno-invalid-offsetof @gol
254-Winvalid-pch -Wlarger-than=@var{len}  -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations @gol
255-Wlogical-op -Wlong-long @gol
256-Wmain -Wmaybe-uninitialized -Wmissing-braces  -Wmissing-field-initializers @gol
257-Wmissing-format-attribute  -Wmissing-include-dirs @gol
258-Wno-mudflap @gol
259-Wno-multichar  -Wnonnull  -Wno-overflow @gol
260-Woverlength-strings  -Wpacked  -Wpacked-bitfield-compat  -Wpadded @gol
261-Wparentheses  -Wpedantic-ms-format -Wno-pedantic-ms-format @gol
262-Wpointer-arith  -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast @gol
263-Wredundant-decls @gol
264-Wreturn-type  -Wsequence-point  -Wshadow @gol
265-Wsign-compare  -Wsign-conversion  -Wstack-protector @gol
266-Wstack-usage=@var{len} -Wstrict-aliasing -Wstrict-aliasing=n @gol
267-Wstrict-overflow -Wstrict-overflow=@var{n} @gol
268-Wsuggest-attribute=@r{[}pure@r{|}const@r{|}noreturn@r{]} @gol
269-Wswitch  -Wswitch-default  -Wswitch-enum -Wsync-nand @gol
270-Wsystem-headers  -Wtrampolines  -Wtrigraphs  -Wtype-limits  -Wundef @gol
271-Wuninitialized  -Wunknown-pragmas  -Wno-pragmas @gol
272-Wunsuffixed-float-constants  -Wunused  -Wunused-function @gol
273-Wunused-label  -Wunused-local-typedefs -Wunused-parameter @gol
274-Wno-unused-result -Wunused-value @gol -Wunused-variable @gol
275-Wunused-but-set-parameter -Wunused-but-set-variable @gol
276-Wvariadic-macros -Wvector-operation-performance -Wvla
277-Wvolatile-register-var  -Wwrite-strings -Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant}
278
279@item C and Objective-C-only Warning Options
280@gccoptlist{-Wbad-function-cast  -Wmissing-declarations @gol
281-Wmissing-parameter-type  -Wmissing-prototypes  -Wnested-externs @gol
282-Wold-style-declaration  -Wold-style-definition @gol
283-Wstrict-prototypes  -Wtraditional  -Wtraditional-conversion @gol
284-Wdeclaration-after-statement -Wpointer-sign}
285
286@item Debugging Options
287@xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC}.
288@gccoptlist{-d@var{letters}  -dumpspecs  -dumpmachine  -dumpversion @gol
289-fdbg-cnt-list -fdbg-cnt=@var{counter-value-list} @gol
290-fdisable-ipa-@var{pass_name} @gol
291-fdisable-rtl-@var{pass_name} @gol
292-fdisable-rtl-@var{pass-name}=@var{range-list} @gol
293-fdisable-tree-@var{pass_name} @gol
294-fdisable-tree-@var{pass-name}=@var{range-list} @gol
295-fdump-noaddr -fdump-unnumbered -fdump-unnumbered-links @gol
296-fdump-translation-unit@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
297-fdump-class-hierarchy@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
298-fdump-ipa-all -fdump-ipa-cgraph -fdump-ipa-inline @gol
299-fdump-passes @gol
300-fdump-statistics @gol
301-fdump-tree-all @gol
302-fdump-tree-original@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]}  @gol
303-fdump-tree-optimized@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
304-fdump-tree-cfg -fdump-tree-vcg -fdump-tree-alias @gol
305-fdump-tree-ch @gol
306-fdump-tree-ssa@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} -fdump-tree-pre@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
307-fdump-tree-ccp@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} -fdump-tree-dce@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
308-fdump-tree-gimple@r{[}-raw@r{]} -fdump-tree-mudflap@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
309-fdump-tree-dom@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
310-fdump-tree-dse@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
311-fdump-tree-phiprop@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
312-fdump-tree-phiopt@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
313-fdump-tree-forwprop@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
314-fdump-tree-copyrename@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
315-fdump-tree-nrv -fdump-tree-vect @gol
316-fdump-tree-sink @gol
317-fdump-tree-sra@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
318-fdump-tree-forwprop@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
319-fdump-tree-fre@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
320-fdump-tree-vrp@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
321-ftree-vectorizer-verbose=@var{n} @gol
322-fdump-tree-storeccp@r{[}-@var{n}@r{]} @gol
323-fdump-final-insns=@var{file} @gol
324-fcompare-debug@r{[}=@var{opts}@r{]}  -fcompare-debug-second @gol
325-feliminate-dwarf2-dups -feliminate-unused-debug-types @gol
326-feliminate-unused-debug-symbols -femit-class-debug-always @gol
327-fenable-@var{kind}-@var{pass} @gol
328-fenable-@var{kind}-@var{pass}=@var{range-list} @gol
329-fdebug-types-section @gol
330-fmem-report -fpre-ipa-mem-report -fpost-ipa-mem-report -fprofile-arcs @gol
331-frandom-seed=@var{string} -fsched-verbose=@var{n} @gol
332-fsel-sched-verbose -fsel-sched-dump-cfg -fsel-sched-pipelining-verbose @gol
333-fstack-usage  -ftest-coverage  -ftime-report -fvar-tracking @gol
334-fvar-tracking-assignments  -fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle @gol
335-g  -g@var{level}  -gtoggle  -gcoff  -gdwarf-@var{version} @gol
336-ggdb  -grecord-gcc-switches  -gno-record-gcc-switches @gol
337-gstabs  -gstabs+  -gstrict-dwarf  -gno-strict-dwarf @gol
338-gvms  -gxcoff  -gxcoff+ @gol
339-fno-merge-debug-strings -fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm @gol
340-fdebug-prefix-map=@var{old}=@var{new} @gol
341-femit-struct-debug-baseonly -femit-struct-debug-reduced @gol
342-femit-struct-debug-detailed@r{[}=@var{spec-list}@r{]} @gol
343-p  -pg  -print-file-name=@var{library}  -print-libgcc-file-name @gol
344-print-multi-directory  -print-multi-lib  -print-multi-os-directory @gol
345-print-prog-name=@var{program}  -print-search-dirs  -Q @gol
346-print-sysroot -print-sysroot-headers-suffix @gol
347-save-temps -save-temps=cwd -save-temps=obj -time@r{[}=@var{file}@r{]}}
348
349@item Optimization Options
350@xref{Optimize Options,,Options that Control Optimization}.
351@gccoptlist{-falign-functions[=@var{n}] -falign-jumps[=@var{n}] @gol
352-falign-labels[=@var{n}] -falign-loops[=@var{n}] -fassociative-math @gol
353-fauto-inc-dec -fbranch-probabilities -fbranch-target-load-optimize @gol
354-fbranch-target-load-optimize2 -fbtr-bb-exclusive -fcaller-saves @gol
355-fcheck-data-deps -fcombine-stack-adjustments -fconserve-stack @gol
356-fcompare-elim -fcprop-registers -fcrossjumping @gol
357-fcse-follow-jumps -fcse-skip-blocks -fcx-fortran-rules @gol
358-fcx-limited-range @gol
359-fdata-sections -fdce -fdelayed-branch @gol
360-fdelete-null-pointer-checks -fdevirtualize -fdse @gol
361-fearly-inlining -fipa-sra -fexpensive-optimizations -ffat-lto-objects @gol
362-ffast-math -ffinite-math-only -ffloat-store -fexcess-precision=@var{style} @gol
363-fforward-propagate -ffp-contract=@var{style} -ffunction-sections @gol
364-fgcse -fgcse-after-reload -fgcse-las -fgcse-lm -fgraphite-identity @gol
365-fgcse-sm -fif-conversion -fif-conversion2 -findirect-inlining @gol
366-finline-functions -finline-functions-called-once -finline-limit=@var{n} @gol
367-finline-small-functions -fipa-cp -fipa-cp-clone -fipa-matrix-reorg @gol
368-fipa-pta -fipa-profile -fipa-pure-const -fipa-reference @gol
369-fira-algorithm=@var{algorithm} @gol
370-fira-region=@var{region} @gol
371-fira-loop-pressure -fno-ira-share-save-slots @gol
372-fno-ira-share-spill-slots -fira-verbose=@var{n} @gol
373-fivopts -fkeep-inline-functions -fkeep-static-consts @gol
374-floop-block -floop-flatten -floop-interchange -floop-strip-mine @gol
375-floop-parallelize-all -flto -flto-compression-level @gol
376-flto-partition=@var{alg} -flto-report -fmerge-all-constants @gol
377-fmerge-constants -fmodulo-sched -fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves @gol
378-fmove-loop-invariants fmudflap -fmudflapir -fmudflapth -fno-branch-count-reg @gol
379-fno-default-inline @gol
380-fno-defer-pop -fno-function-cse -fno-guess-branch-probability @gol
381-fno-inline -fno-math-errno -fno-peephole -fno-peephole2 @gol
382-fno-sched-interblock -fno-sched-spec -fno-signed-zeros @gol
383-fno-toplevel-reorder -fno-trapping-math -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss @gol
384-fomit-frame-pointer -foptimize-register-move -foptimize-sibling-calls @gol
385-fpartial-inlining -fpeel-loops -fpredictive-commoning @gol
386-fprefetch-loop-arrays @gol
387-fprofile-correction -fprofile-dir=@var{path} -fprofile-generate @gol
388-fprofile-generate=@var{path} @gol
389-fprofile-use -fprofile-use=@var{path} -fprofile-values @gol
390-freciprocal-math -free -fregmove -frename-registers -freorder-blocks @gol
391-freorder-blocks-and-partition -freorder-functions @gol
392-frerun-cse-after-loop -freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops @gol
393-frounding-math -fsched2-use-superblocks -fsched-pressure @gol
394-fsched-spec-load -fsched-spec-load-dangerous @gol
395-fsched-stalled-insns-dep[=@var{n}] -fsched-stalled-insns[=@var{n}] @gol
396-fsched-group-heuristic -fsched-critical-path-heuristic @gol
397-fsched-spec-insn-heuristic -fsched-rank-heuristic @gol
398-fsched-last-insn-heuristic -fsched-dep-count-heuristic @gol
399-fschedule-insns -fschedule-insns2 -fsection-anchors @gol
400-fselective-scheduling -fselective-scheduling2 @gol
401-fsel-sched-pipelining -fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops @gol
402-fshrink-wrap -fsignaling-nans -fsingle-precision-constant @gol
403-fsplit-ivs-in-unroller -fsplit-wide-types -fstack-protector @gol
404-fstack-protector-all -fstrict-aliasing -fstrict-overflow @gol
405-fthread-jumps -ftracer -ftree-bit-ccp @gol
406-ftree-builtin-call-dce -ftree-ccp -ftree-ch -ftree-copy-prop @gol
407-ftree-copyrename -ftree-dce -ftree-dominator-opts -ftree-dse @gol
408-ftree-forwprop -ftree-fre -ftree-loop-if-convert @gol
409-ftree-loop-if-convert-stores -ftree-loop-im @gol
410-ftree-phiprop -ftree-loop-distribution -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns @gol
411-ftree-loop-ivcanon -ftree-loop-linear -ftree-loop-optimize @gol
412-ftree-parallelize-loops=@var{n} -ftree-pre -ftree-pta -ftree-reassoc @gol
413-ftree-sink -ftree-sra -ftree-switch-conversion -ftree-tail-merge @gol
414-ftree-ter -ftree-vect-loop-version -ftree-vectorize -ftree-vrp @gol
415-funit-at-a-time -funroll-all-loops -funroll-loops @gol
416-funsafe-loop-optimizations -funsafe-math-optimizations -funswitch-loops @gol
417-fvariable-expansion-in-unroller -fvect-cost-model -fvpt -fweb @gol
418-fwhole-program -fwpa -fuse-linker-plugin @gol
419--param @var{name}=@var{value}
420-O  -O0  -O1  -O2  -O3  -Os -Ofast}
421
422@item Preprocessor Options
423@xref{Preprocessor Options,,Options Controlling the Preprocessor}.
424@gccoptlist{-A@var{question}=@var{answer} @gol
425-A-@var{question}@r{[}=@var{answer}@r{]} @gol
426-C  -dD  -dI  -dM  -dN @gol
427-D@var{macro}@r{[}=@var{defn}@r{]}  -E  -H @gol
428-idirafter @var{dir} @gol
429-include @var{file}  -imacros @var{file} @gol
430-iprefix @var{file}  -iwithprefix @var{dir} @gol
431-iwithprefixbefore @var{dir}  -isystem @var{dir} @gol
432-imultilib @var{dir} -isysroot @var{dir} @gol
433-M  -MM  -MF  -MG  -MP  -MQ  -MT  -nostdinc  @gol
434-P  -fdebug-cpp -ftrack-macro-expansion -fworking-directory @gol
435-remap -trigraphs  -undef  -U@var{macro}  @gol
436-Wp,@var{option} -Xpreprocessor @var{option}}
437
438@item Assembler Option
439@xref{Assembler Options,,Passing Options to the Assembler}.
440@gccoptlist{-Wa,@var{option}  -Xassembler @var{option}}
441
442@item Linker Options
443@xref{Link Options,,Options for Linking}.
444@gccoptlist{@var{object-file-name}  -l@var{library} @gol
445-nostartfiles  -nodefaultlibs  -nostdlib -pie -rdynamic @gol
446-s  -static  -static-libgcc  -static-libstdc++ -shared  @gol
447-shared-libgcc  -symbolic @gol
448-T @var{script}  -Wl,@var{option}  -Xlinker @var{option} @gol
449-u @var{symbol}}
450
451@item Directory Options
452@xref{Directory Options,,Options for Directory Search}.
453@gccoptlist{-B@var{prefix} -I@var{dir} -iplugindir=@var{dir} @gol
454-iquote@var{dir} -L@var{dir} -specs=@var{file} -I- @gol
455--sysroot=@var{dir}}
456
457@item Machine Dependent Options
458@xref{Submodel Options,,Hardware Models and Configurations}.
459@c This list is ordered alphanumerically by subsection name.
460@c Try and put the significant identifier (CPU or system) first,
461@c so users have a clue at guessing where the ones they want will be.
462
463@emph{Adapteva Epiphany Options}
464@gccoptlist{-mhalf-reg-file -mprefer-short-insn-regs @gol
465-mbranch-cost=@var{num} -mcmove -mnops=@var{num} -msoft-cmpsf @gol
466-msplit-lohi -mpost-inc -mpost-modify -mstack-offset=@var{num} @gol
467-mround-nearest -mlong-calls -mshort-calls -msmall16 @gol
468-mfp-mode=@var{mode} -mvect-double -max-vect-align=@var{num} @gol
469-msplit-vecmove-early -m1reg-@var{reg}}
470
471@emph{ARM Options}
472@gccoptlist{-mapcs-frame  -mno-apcs-frame @gol
473-mabi=@var{name} @gol
474-mapcs-stack-check  -mno-apcs-stack-check @gol
475-mapcs-float  -mno-apcs-float @gol
476-mapcs-reentrant  -mno-apcs-reentrant @gol
477-msched-prolog  -mno-sched-prolog @gol
478-mlittle-endian  -mbig-endian  -mwords-little-endian @gol
479-mfloat-abi=@var{name}  -mfpe @gol
480-mfp16-format=@var{name}
481-mthumb-interwork  -mno-thumb-interwork @gol
482-mcpu=@var{name}  -march=@var{name}  -mfpu=@var{name}  @gol
483-mstructure-size-boundary=@var{n} @gol
484-mabort-on-noreturn @gol
485-mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls @gol
486-msingle-pic-base  -mno-single-pic-base @gol
487-mpic-register=@var{reg} @gol
488-mnop-fun-dllimport @gol
489-mcirrus-fix-invalid-insns -mno-cirrus-fix-invalid-insns @gol
490-mpoke-function-name @gol
491-mthumb  -marm @gol
492-mtpcs-frame  -mtpcs-leaf-frame @gol
493-mcaller-super-interworking  -mcallee-super-interworking @gol
494-mtp=@var{name} -mtls-dialect=@var{dialect} @gol
495-mword-relocations @gol
496-mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd @gol
497-munaligned-access}
498
499@emph{AVR Options}
500@gccoptlist{-mmcu=@var{mcu} -maccumulate-args -mbranch-cost=@var{cost} @gol
501-mcall-prologues -mint8 -mno-interrupts -mrelax -mshort-calls @gol
502-mstrict-X -mtiny-stack}
503
504@emph{Blackfin Options}
505@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu}@r{[}-@var{sirevision}@r{]} @gol
506-msim -momit-leaf-frame-pointer  -mno-omit-leaf-frame-pointer @gol
507-mspecld-anomaly  -mno-specld-anomaly  -mcsync-anomaly  -mno-csync-anomaly @gol
508-mlow-64k -mno-low64k  -mstack-check-l1  -mid-shared-library @gol
509-mno-id-shared-library  -mshared-library-id=@var{n} @gol
510-mleaf-id-shared-library  -mno-leaf-id-shared-library @gol
511-msep-data  -mno-sep-data  -mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls @gol
512-mfast-fp -minline-plt -mmulticore  -mcorea  -mcoreb  -msdram @gol
513-micplb}
514
515@emph{C6X Options}
516@gccoptlist{-mbig-endian  -mlittle-endian -march=@var{cpu} @gol
517-msim -msdata=@var{sdata-type}}
518
519@emph{CRIS Options}
520@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu}  -march=@var{cpu}  -mtune=@var{cpu} @gol
521-mmax-stack-frame=@var{n}  -melinux-stacksize=@var{n} @gol
522-metrax4  -metrax100  -mpdebug  -mcc-init  -mno-side-effects @gol
523-mstack-align  -mdata-align  -mconst-align @gol
524-m32-bit  -m16-bit  -m8-bit  -mno-prologue-epilogue  -mno-gotplt @gol
525-melf  -maout  -melinux  -mlinux  -sim  -sim2 @gol
526-mmul-bug-workaround  -mno-mul-bug-workaround}
527
528@emph{CR16 Options}
529@gccoptlist{-mmac @gol
530-mcr16cplus -mcr16c @gol
531-msim -mint32 -mbit-ops
532-mdata-model=@var{model}}
533
534@emph{Darwin Options}
535@gccoptlist{-all_load  -allowable_client  -arch  -arch_errors_fatal @gol
536-arch_only  -bind_at_load  -bundle  -bundle_loader @gol
537-client_name  -compatibility_version  -current_version @gol
538-dead_strip @gol
539-dependency-file  -dylib_file  -dylinker_install_name @gol
540-dynamic  -dynamiclib  -exported_symbols_list @gol
541-filelist  -flat_namespace  -force_cpusubtype_ALL @gol
542-force_flat_namespace  -headerpad_max_install_names @gol
543-iframework @gol
544-image_base  -init  -install_name  -keep_private_externs @gol
545-multi_module  -multiply_defined  -multiply_defined_unused @gol
546-noall_load   -no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms @gol
547-nofixprebinding -nomultidefs  -noprebind  -noseglinkedit @gol
548-pagezero_size  -prebind  -prebind_all_twolevel_modules @gol
549-private_bundle  -read_only_relocs  -sectalign @gol
550-sectobjectsymbols  -whyload  -seg1addr @gol
551-sectcreate  -sectobjectsymbols  -sectorder @gol
552-segaddr -segs_read_only_addr -segs_read_write_addr @gol
553-seg_addr_table  -seg_addr_table_filename  -seglinkedit @gol
554-segprot  -segs_read_only_addr  -segs_read_write_addr @gol
555-single_module  -static  -sub_library  -sub_umbrella @gol
556-twolevel_namespace  -umbrella  -undefined @gol
557-unexported_symbols_list  -weak_reference_mismatches @gol
558-whatsloaded -F -gused -gfull -mmacosx-version-min=@var{version} @gol
559-mkernel -mone-byte-bool}
560
561@emph{DEC Alpha Options}
562@gccoptlist{-mno-fp-regs  -msoft-float  -malpha-as  -mgas @gol
563-mieee  -mieee-with-inexact  -mieee-conformant @gol
564-mfp-trap-mode=@var{mode}  -mfp-rounding-mode=@var{mode} @gol
565-mtrap-precision=@var{mode}  -mbuild-constants @gol
566-mcpu=@var{cpu-type}  -mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
567-mbwx  -mmax  -mfix  -mcix @gol
568-mfloat-vax  -mfloat-ieee @gol
569-mexplicit-relocs  -msmall-data  -mlarge-data @gol
570-msmall-text  -mlarge-text @gol
571-mmemory-latency=@var{time}}
572
573@emph{DEC Alpha/VMS Options}
574@gccoptlist{-mvms-return-codes -mdebug-main=@var{prefix} -mmalloc64}
575
576@emph{FR30 Options}
577@gccoptlist{-msmall-model -mno-lsim}
578
579@emph{FRV Options}
580@gccoptlist{-mgpr-32  -mgpr-64  -mfpr-32  -mfpr-64 @gol
581-mhard-float  -msoft-float @gol
582-malloc-cc  -mfixed-cc  -mdword  -mno-dword @gol
583-mdouble  -mno-double @gol
584-mmedia  -mno-media  -mmuladd  -mno-muladd @gol
585-mfdpic  -minline-plt -mgprel-ro  -multilib-library-pic @gol
586-mlinked-fp  -mlong-calls  -malign-labels @gol
587-mlibrary-pic  -macc-4  -macc-8 @gol
588-mpack  -mno-pack  -mno-eflags  -mcond-move  -mno-cond-move @gol
589-moptimize-membar -mno-optimize-membar @gol
590-mscc  -mno-scc  -mcond-exec  -mno-cond-exec @gol
591-mvliw-branch  -mno-vliw-branch @gol
592-mmulti-cond-exec  -mno-multi-cond-exec  -mnested-cond-exec @gol
593-mno-nested-cond-exec  -mtomcat-stats @gol
594-mTLS -mtls @gol
595-mcpu=@var{cpu}}
596
597@emph{GNU/Linux Options}
598@gccoptlist{-mglibc -muclibc -mbionic -mandroid @gol
599-tno-android-cc -tno-android-ld}
600
601@emph{H8/300 Options}
602@gccoptlist{-mrelax  -mh  -ms  -mn  -mint32  -malign-300}
603
604@emph{HPPA Options}
605@gccoptlist{-march=@var{architecture-type} @gol
606-mbig-switch  -mdisable-fpregs  -mdisable-indexing @gol
607-mfast-indirect-calls  -mgas  -mgnu-ld   -mhp-ld @gol
608-mfixed-range=@var{register-range} @gol
609-mjump-in-delay -mlinker-opt -mlong-calls @gol
610-mlong-load-store  -mno-big-switch  -mno-disable-fpregs @gol
611-mno-disable-indexing  -mno-fast-indirect-calls  -mno-gas @gol
612-mno-jump-in-delay  -mno-long-load-store @gol
613-mno-portable-runtime  -mno-soft-float @gol
614-mno-space-regs  -msoft-float  -mpa-risc-1-0 @gol
615-mpa-risc-1-1  -mpa-risc-2-0  -mportable-runtime @gol
616-mschedule=@var{cpu-type}  -mspace-regs  -msio  -mwsio @gol
617-munix=@var{unix-std}  -nolibdld  -static  -threads}
618
619@emph{i386 and x86-64 Options}
620@gccoptlist{-mtune=@var{cpu-type}  -march=@var{cpu-type} @gol
621-mfpmath=@var{unit} @gol
622-masm=@var{dialect}  -mno-fancy-math-387 @gol
623-mno-fp-ret-in-387  -msoft-float @gol
624-mno-wide-multiply  -mrtd  -malign-double @gol
625-mpreferred-stack-boundary=@var{num} @gol
626-mincoming-stack-boundary=@var{num} @gol
627-mcld -mcx16 -msahf -mmovbe -mcrc32 @gol
628-mrecip -mrecip=@var{opt} @gol
629-mvzeroupper -mprefer-avx128 @gol
630-mmmx  -msse  -msse2 -msse3 -mssse3 -msse4.1 -msse4.2 -msse4 -mavx @gol
631-mavx2 -maes -mpclmul -mfsgsbase -mrdrnd -mf16c -mfma @gol
632-msse4a -m3dnow -mpopcnt -mabm -mbmi -mtbm -mfma4 -mxop -mlzcnt @gol
633-mbmi2 -mlwp -mthreads  -mno-align-stringops  -minline-all-stringops @gol
634-minline-stringops-dynamically -mstringop-strategy=@var{alg} @gol
635-mpush-args  -maccumulate-outgoing-args  -m128bit-long-double @gol
636-m96bit-long-double  -mregparm=@var{num}  -msseregparm @gol
637-mveclibabi=@var{type} -mvect8-ret-in-mem @gol
638-mpc32 -mpc64 -mpc80 -mstackrealign @gol
639-momit-leaf-frame-pointer  -mno-red-zone -mno-tls-direct-seg-refs @gol
640-mcmodel=@var{code-model} -mabi=@var{name} @gol
641-m32 -m64 -mx32 -mlarge-data-threshold=@var{num} @gol
642-msse2avx -mfentry -m8bit-idiv @gol
643-mavx256-split-unaligned-load -mavx256-split-unaligned-store}
644
645@emph{i386 and x86-64 Windows Options}
646@gccoptlist{-mconsole -mcygwin -mno-cygwin -mdll @gol
647-mnop-fun-dllimport -mthread @gol
648-municode -mwin32 -mwindows -fno-set-stack-executable}
649
650@emph{IA-64 Options}
651@gccoptlist{-mbig-endian  -mlittle-endian  -mgnu-as  -mgnu-ld  -mno-pic @gol
652-mvolatile-asm-stop  -mregister-names  -msdata -mno-sdata @gol
653-mconstant-gp  -mauto-pic  -mfused-madd @gol
654-minline-float-divide-min-latency @gol
655-minline-float-divide-max-throughput @gol
656-mno-inline-float-divide @gol
657-minline-int-divide-min-latency @gol
658-minline-int-divide-max-throughput  @gol
659-mno-inline-int-divide @gol
660-minline-sqrt-min-latency -minline-sqrt-max-throughput @gol
661-mno-inline-sqrt @gol
662-mdwarf2-asm -mearly-stop-bits @gol
663-mfixed-range=@var{register-range} -mtls-size=@var{tls-size} @gol
664-mtune=@var{cpu-type} -milp32 -mlp64 @gol
665-msched-br-data-spec -msched-ar-data-spec -msched-control-spec @gol
666-msched-br-in-data-spec -msched-ar-in-data-spec -msched-in-control-spec @gol
667-msched-spec-ldc -msched-spec-control-ldc @gol
668-msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns -msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns @gol
669-msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle -msched-count-spec-in-critical-path @gol
670-msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec -msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost @gol
671-msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit -msched-max-memory-insns=@var{max-insns}}
672
673@emph{IA-64/VMS Options}
674@gccoptlist{-mvms-return-codes -mdebug-main=@var{prefix} -mmalloc64}
675
676@emph{LM32 Options}
677@gccoptlist{-mbarrel-shift-enabled -mdivide-enabled -mmultiply-enabled @gol
678-msign-extend-enabled -muser-enabled}
679
680@emph{M32R/D Options}
681@gccoptlist{-m32r2 -m32rx -m32r @gol
682-mdebug @gol
683-malign-loops -mno-align-loops @gol
684-missue-rate=@var{number} @gol
685-mbranch-cost=@var{number} @gol
686-mmodel=@var{code-size-model-type} @gol
687-msdata=@var{sdata-type} @gol
688-mno-flush-func -mflush-func=@var{name} @gol
689-mno-flush-trap -mflush-trap=@var{number} @gol
690-G @var{num}}
691
692@emph{M32C Options}
693@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu} -msim -memregs=@var{number}}
694
695@emph{M680x0 Options}
696@gccoptlist{-march=@var{arch}  -mcpu=@var{cpu}  -mtune=@var{tune}
697-m68000  -m68020  -m68020-40  -m68020-60  -m68030  -m68040 @gol
698-m68060  -mcpu32  -m5200  -m5206e  -m528x  -m5307  -m5407 @gol
699-mcfv4e  -mbitfield  -mno-bitfield  -mc68000  -mc68020 @gol
700-mnobitfield  -mrtd  -mno-rtd  -mdiv  -mno-div  -mshort @gol
701-mno-short  -mhard-float  -m68881  -msoft-float  -mpcrel @gol
702-malign-int  -mstrict-align  -msep-data  -mno-sep-data @gol
703-mshared-library-id=n  -mid-shared-library  -mno-id-shared-library @gol
704-mxgot -mno-xgot}
705
706@emph{MCore Options}
707@gccoptlist{-mhardlit  -mno-hardlit  -mdiv  -mno-div  -mrelax-immediates @gol
708-mno-relax-immediates  -mwide-bitfields  -mno-wide-bitfields @gol
709-m4byte-functions  -mno-4byte-functions  -mcallgraph-data @gol
710-mno-callgraph-data  -mslow-bytes  -mno-slow-bytes  -mno-lsim @gol
711-mlittle-endian  -mbig-endian  -m210  -m340  -mstack-increment}
712
713@emph{MeP Options}
714@gccoptlist{-mabsdiff -mall-opts -maverage -mbased=@var{n} -mbitops @gol
715-mc=@var{n} -mclip -mconfig=@var{name} -mcop -mcop32 -mcop64 -mivc2 @gol
716-mdc -mdiv -meb -mel -mio-volatile -ml -mleadz -mm -mminmax @gol
717-mmult -mno-opts -mrepeat -ms -msatur -msdram -msim -msimnovec -mtf @gol
718-mtiny=@var{n}}
719
720@emph{MicroBlaze Options}
721@gccoptlist{-msoft-float -mhard-float -msmall-divides -mcpu=@var{cpu} @gol
722-mmemcpy -mxl-soft-mul -mxl-soft-div -mxl-barrel-shift @gol
723-mxl-pattern-compare -mxl-stack-check -mxl-gp-opt -mno-clearbss @gol
724-mxl-multiply-high -mxl-float-convert -mxl-float-sqrt @gol
725-mxl-mode-@var{app-model}}
726
727@emph{MIPS Options}
728@gccoptlist{-EL  -EB  -march=@var{arch}  -mtune=@var{arch} @gol
729-mips1  -mips2  -mips3  -mips4  -mips32  -mips32r2 @gol
730-mips64  -mips64r2 @gol
731-mips16  -mno-mips16  -mflip-mips16 @gol
732-minterlink-mips16  -mno-interlink-mips16 @gol
733-mabi=@var{abi}  -mabicalls  -mno-abicalls @gol
734-mshared  -mno-shared  -mplt  -mno-plt  -mxgot  -mno-xgot @gol
735-mgp32  -mgp64  -mfp32  -mfp64  -mhard-float  -msoft-float @gol
736-msingle-float  -mdouble-float  -mdsp  -mno-dsp  -mdspr2  -mno-dspr2 @gol
737-mfpu=@var{fpu-type} @gol
738-msmartmips  -mno-smartmips @gol
739-mpaired-single  -mno-paired-single  -mdmx  -mno-mdmx @gol
740-mips3d  -mno-mips3d  -mmt  -mno-mt  -mllsc  -mno-llsc @gol
741-mlong64  -mlong32  -msym32  -mno-sym32 @gol
742-G@var{num}  -mlocal-sdata  -mno-local-sdata @gol
743-mextern-sdata  -mno-extern-sdata  -mgpopt  -mno-gopt @gol
744-membedded-data  -mno-embedded-data @gol
745-muninit-const-in-rodata  -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata @gol
746-mcode-readable=@var{setting} @gol
747-msplit-addresses  -mno-split-addresses @gol
748-mexplicit-relocs  -mno-explicit-relocs @gol
749-mcheck-zero-division  -mno-check-zero-division @gol
750-mdivide-traps  -mdivide-breaks @gol
751-mmemcpy  -mno-memcpy  -mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls @gol
752-mmad  -mno-mad  -mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd  -nocpp @gol
753-mfix-24k -mno-fix-24k @gol
754-mfix-r4000  -mno-fix-r4000  -mfix-r4400  -mno-fix-r4400 @gol
755-mfix-r10000 -mno-fix-r10000  -mfix-vr4120  -mno-fix-vr4120 @gol
756-mfix-vr4130  -mno-fix-vr4130  -mfix-sb1  -mno-fix-sb1 @gol
757-mflush-func=@var{func}  -mno-flush-func @gol
758-mbranch-cost=@var{num}  -mbranch-likely  -mno-branch-likely @gol
759-mfp-exceptions -mno-fp-exceptions @gol
760-mvr4130-align -mno-vr4130-align -msynci -mno-synci @gol
761-mrelax-pic-calls -mno-relax-pic-calls -mmcount-ra-address}
762
763@emph{MMIX Options}
764@gccoptlist{-mlibfuncs  -mno-libfuncs  -mepsilon  -mno-epsilon  -mabi=gnu @gol
765-mabi=mmixware  -mzero-extend  -mknuthdiv  -mtoplevel-symbols @gol
766-melf  -mbranch-predict  -mno-branch-predict  -mbase-addresses @gol
767-mno-base-addresses  -msingle-exit  -mno-single-exit}
768
769@emph{MN10300 Options}
770@gccoptlist{-mmult-bug  -mno-mult-bug @gol
771-mno-am33 -mam33 -mam33-2 -mam34 @gol
772-mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
773-mreturn-pointer-on-d0 @gol
774-mno-crt0  -mrelax -mliw -msetlb}
775
776@emph{PDP-11 Options}
777@gccoptlist{-mfpu  -msoft-float  -mac0  -mno-ac0  -m40  -m45  -m10 @gol
778-mbcopy  -mbcopy-builtin  -mint32  -mno-int16 @gol
779-mint16  -mno-int32  -mfloat32  -mno-float64 @gol
780-mfloat64  -mno-float32  -mabshi  -mno-abshi @gol
781-mbranch-expensive  -mbranch-cheap @gol
782-munix-asm  -mdec-asm}
783
784@emph{picoChip Options}
785@gccoptlist{-mae=@var{ae_type} -mvliw-lookahead=@var{N} @gol
786-msymbol-as-address -mno-inefficient-warnings}
787
788@emph{PowerPC Options}
789See RS/6000 and PowerPC Options.
790
791@emph{RL78 Options}
792@gccoptlist{-msim -mmul=none -mmul=g13 -mmul=rl78}
793
794@emph{RS/6000 and PowerPC Options}
795@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu-type} @gol
796-mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
797-mcmodel=@var{code-model} @gol
798-mpower  -mno-power  -mpower2  -mno-power2 @gol
799-mpowerpc  -mpowerpc64  -mno-powerpc @gol
800-maltivec  -mno-altivec @gol
801-mpowerpc-gpopt  -mno-powerpc-gpopt @gol
802-mpowerpc-gfxopt  -mno-powerpc-gfxopt @gol
803-mmfcrf  -mno-mfcrf  -mpopcntb  -mno-popcntb -mpopcntd -mno-popcntd @gol
804-mfprnd  -mno-fprnd @gol
805-mcmpb -mno-cmpb -mmfpgpr -mno-mfpgpr -mhard-dfp -mno-hard-dfp @gol
806-mnew-mnemonics  -mold-mnemonics @gol
807-mfull-toc   -mminimal-toc  -mno-fp-in-toc  -mno-sum-in-toc @gol
808-m64  -m32  -mxl-compat  -mno-xl-compat  -mpe @gol
809-malign-power  -malign-natural @gol
810-msoft-float  -mhard-float  -mmultiple  -mno-multiple @gol
811-msingle-float -mdouble-float -msimple-fpu @gol
812-mstring  -mno-string  -mupdate  -mno-update @gol
813-mavoid-indexed-addresses  -mno-avoid-indexed-addresses @gol
814-mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd  -mbit-align  -mno-bit-align @gol
815-mstrict-align  -mno-strict-align  -mrelocatable @gol
816-mno-relocatable  -mrelocatable-lib  -mno-relocatable-lib @gol
817-mtoc  -mno-toc  -mlittle  -mlittle-endian  -mbig  -mbig-endian @gol
818-mdynamic-no-pic  -maltivec -mswdiv  -msingle-pic-base @gol
819-mprioritize-restricted-insns=@var{priority} @gol
820-msched-costly-dep=@var{dependence_type} @gol
821-minsert-sched-nops=@var{scheme} @gol
822-mcall-sysv  -mcall-netbsd @gol
823-maix-struct-return  -msvr4-struct-return @gol
824-mabi=@var{abi-type} -msecure-plt -mbss-plt @gol
825-mblock-move-inline-limit=@var{num} @gol
826-misel -mno-isel @gol
827-misel=yes  -misel=no @gol
828-mspe -mno-spe @gol
829-mspe=yes  -mspe=no @gol
830-mpaired @gol
831-mgen-cell-microcode -mwarn-cell-microcode @gol
832-mvrsave -mno-vrsave @gol
833-mmulhw -mno-mulhw @gol
834-mdlmzb -mno-dlmzb @gol
835-mfloat-gprs=yes  -mfloat-gprs=no -mfloat-gprs=single -mfloat-gprs=double @gol
836-mprototype  -mno-prototype @gol
837-msim  -mmvme  -mads  -myellowknife  -memb  -msdata @gol
838-msdata=@var{opt}  -mvxworks  -G @var{num}  -pthread @gol
839-mrecip -mrecip=@var{opt} -mno-recip -mrecip-precision @gol
840-mno-recip-precision @gol
841-mveclibabi=@var{type} -mfriz -mno-friz @gol
842-mpointers-to-nested-functions -mno-pointers-to-nested-functions @gol
843-msave-toc-indirect -mno-save-toc-indirect}
844
845@emph{RX Options}
846@gccoptlist{-m64bit-doubles  -m32bit-doubles  -fpu  -nofpu@gol
847-mcpu=@gol
848-mbig-endian-data -mlittle-endian-data @gol
849-msmall-data @gol
850-msim  -mno-sim@gol
851-mas100-syntax -mno-as100-syntax@gol
852-mrelax@gol
853-mmax-constant-size=@gol
854-mint-register=@gol
855-mpid@gol
856-msave-acc-in-interrupts}
857
858@emph{S/390 and zSeries Options}
859@gccoptlist{-mtune=@var{cpu-type}  -march=@var{cpu-type} @gol
860-mhard-float  -msoft-float  -mhard-dfp -mno-hard-dfp @gol
861-mlong-double-64 -mlong-double-128 @gol
862-mbackchain  -mno-backchain -mpacked-stack  -mno-packed-stack @gol
863-msmall-exec  -mno-small-exec  -mmvcle -mno-mvcle @gol
864-m64  -m31  -mdebug  -mno-debug  -mesa  -mzarch @gol
865-mtpf-trace -mno-tpf-trace  -mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd @gol
866-mwarn-framesize  -mwarn-dynamicstack  -mstack-size -mstack-guard}
867
868@emph{Score Options}
869@gccoptlist{-meb -mel @gol
870-mnhwloop @gol
871-muls @gol
872-mmac @gol
873-mscore5 -mscore5u -mscore7 -mscore7d}
874
875@emph{SH Options}
876@gccoptlist{-m1  -m2  -m2e @gol
877-m2a-nofpu -m2a-single-only -m2a-single -m2a @gol
878-m3  -m3e @gol
879-m4-nofpu  -m4-single-only  -m4-single  -m4 @gol
880-m4a-nofpu -m4a-single-only -m4a-single -m4a -m4al @gol
881-m5-64media  -m5-64media-nofpu @gol
882-m5-32media  -m5-32media-nofpu @gol
883-m5-compact  -m5-compact-nofpu @gol
884-mb  -ml  -mdalign  -mrelax @gol
885-mbigtable -mfmovd -mhitachi -mrenesas -mno-renesas -mnomacsave @gol
886-mieee -mno-ieee -mbitops  -misize  -minline-ic_invalidate -mpadstruct @gol
887-mspace -mprefergot  -musermode -multcost=@var{number} -mdiv=@var{strategy} @gol
888-mdivsi3_libfunc=@var{name} -mfixed-range=@var{register-range} @gol
889-madjust-unroll -mindexed-addressing -mgettrcost=@var{number} -mpt-fixed @gol
890-maccumulate-outgoing-args -minvalid-symbols -msoft-atomic @gol
891-mbranch-cost=@var{num} -mcbranchdi -mcmpeqdi -mfused-madd -mpretend-cmove}
892
893@emph{Solaris 2 Options}
894@gccoptlist{-mimpure-text  -mno-impure-text @gol
895-pthreads -pthread}
896
897@emph{SPARC Options}
898@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu-type} @gol
899-mtune=@var{cpu-type} @gol
900-mcmodel=@var{code-model} @gol
901-mmemory-model=@var{mem-model} @gol
902-m32  -m64  -mapp-regs  -mno-app-regs @gol
903-mfaster-structs  -mno-faster-structs  -mflat  -mno-flat @gol
904-mfpu  -mno-fpu  -mhard-float  -msoft-float @gol
905-mhard-quad-float  -msoft-quad-float @gol
906-mstack-bias  -mno-stack-bias @gol
907-munaligned-doubles  -mno-unaligned-doubles @gol
908-mv8plus  -mno-v8plus  -mvis  -mno-vis @gol
909-mvis2  -mno-vis2  -mvis3  -mno-vis3 @gol
910-mfmaf  -mno-fmaf  -mpopc  -mno-popc @gol
911-mfix-at697f}
912
913@emph{SPU Options}
914@gccoptlist{-mwarn-reloc -merror-reloc @gol
915-msafe-dma -munsafe-dma @gol
916-mbranch-hints @gol
917-msmall-mem -mlarge-mem -mstdmain @gol
918-mfixed-range=@var{register-range} @gol
919-mea32 -mea64 @gol
920-maddress-space-conversion -mno-address-space-conversion @gol
921-mcache-size=@var{cache-size} @gol
922-matomic-updates -mno-atomic-updates}
923
924@emph{System V Options}
925@gccoptlist{-Qy  -Qn  -YP,@var{paths}  -Ym,@var{dir}}
926
927@emph{TILE-Gx Options}
928@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu} -m32 -m64}
929
930@emph{TILEPro Options}
931@gccoptlist{-mcpu=@var{cpu} -m32}
932
933@emph{V850 Options}
934@gccoptlist{-mlong-calls  -mno-long-calls  -mep  -mno-ep @gol
935-mprolog-function  -mno-prolog-function  -mspace @gol
936-mtda=@var{n}  -msda=@var{n}  -mzda=@var{n} @gol
937-mapp-regs  -mno-app-regs @gol
938-mdisable-callt  -mno-disable-callt @gol
939-mv850e2v3 @gol
940-mv850e2 @gol
941-mv850e1 -mv850es @gol
942-mv850e @gol
943-mv850  -mbig-switch}
944
945@emph{VAX Options}
946@gccoptlist{-mg  -mgnu  -munix}
947
948@emph{VxWorks Options}
949@gccoptlist{-mrtp  -non-static  -Bstatic  -Bdynamic @gol
950-Xbind-lazy  -Xbind-now}
951
952@emph{x86-64 Options}
953See i386 and x86-64 Options.
954
955@emph{Xstormy16 Options}
956@gccoptlist{-msim}
957
958@emph{Xtensa Options}
959@gccoptlist{-mconst16 -mno-const16 @gol
960-mfused-madd  -mno-fused-madd @gol
961-mforce-no-pic @gol
962-mserialize-volatile  -mno-serialize-volatile @gol
963-mtext-section-literals  -mno-text-section-literals @gol
964-mtarget-align  -mno-target-align @gol
965-mlongcalls  -mno-longcalls}
966
967@emph{zSeries Options}
968See S/390 and zSeries Options.
969
970@item Code Generation Options
971@xref{Code Gen Options,,Options for Code Generation Conventions}.
972@gccoptlist{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}  -fcall-used-@var{reg} @gol
973-ffixed-@var{reg}  -fexceptions @gol
974-fnon-call-exceptions  -funwind-tables @gol
975-fasynchronous-unwind-tables @gol
976-finhibit-size-directive  -finstrument-functions @gol
977-finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list=@var{sym},@var{sym},@dots{} @gol
978-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=@var{file},@var{file},@dots{} @gol
979-fno-common  -fno-ident @gol
980-fpcc-struct-return  -fpic  -fPIC -fpie -fPIE @gol
981-fno-jump-tables @gol
982-frecord-gcc-switches @gol
983-freg-struct-return  -fshort-enums @gol
984-fshort-double  -fshort-wchar @gol
985-fverbose-asm  -fpack-struct[=@var{n}]  -fstack-check @gol
986-fstack-limit-register=@var{reg}  -fstack-limit-symbol=@var{sym} @gol
987-fno-stack-limit -fsplit-stack @gol
988-fleading-underscore  -ftls-model=@var{model} @gol
989-ftrapv  -fwrapv  -fbounds-check @gol
990-fvisibility -fstrict-volatile-bitfields}
991@end table
992
993@menu
994* Overall Options::     Controlling the kind of output:
995                        an executable, object files, assembler files,
996                        or preprocessed source.
997* C Dialect Options::   Controlling the variant of C language compiled.
998* C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on C++.
999* Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options:: Variations on Objective-C
1000                        and Objective-C++.
1001* Language Independent Options:: Controlling how diagnostics should be
1002                        formatted.
1003* Warning Options::     How picky should the compiler be?
1004* Debugging Options::   Symbol tables, measurements, and debugging dumps.
1005* Optimize Options::    How much optimization?
1006* Preprocessor Options:: Controlling header files and macro definitions.
1007                         Also, getting dependency information for Make.
1008* Assembler Options::   Passing options to the assembler.
1009* Link Options::        Specifying libraries and so on.
1010* Directory Options::   Where to find header files and libraries.
1011                        Where to find the compiler executable files.
1012* Spec Files::          How to pass switches to sub-processes.
1013* Target Options::      Running a cross-compiler, or an old version of GCC.
1014@end menu
1015
1016@node Overall Options
1017@section Options Controlling the Kind of Output
1018
1019Compilation can involve up to four stages: preprocessing, compilation
1020proper, assembly and linking, always in that order.  GCC is capable of
1021preprocessing and compiling several files either into several
1022assembler input files, or into one assembler input file; then each
1023assembler input file produces an object file, and linking combines all
1024the object files (those newly compiled, and those specified as input)
1025into an executable file.
1026
1027@cindex file name suffix
1028For any given input file, the file name suffix determines what kind of
1029compilation is done:
1030
1031@table @gcctabopt
1032@item @var{file}.c
1033C source code that must be preprocessed.
1034
1035@item @var{file}.i
1036C source code that should not be preprocessed.
1037
1038@item @var{file}.ii
1039C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.
1040
1041@item @var{file}.m
1042Objective-C source code.  Note that you must link with the @file{libobjc}
1043library to make an Objective-C program work.
1044
1045@item @var{file}.mi
1046Objective-C source code that should not be preprocessed.
1047
1048@item @var{file}.mm
1049@itemx @var{file}.M
1050Objective-C++ source code.  Note that you must link with the @file{libobjc}
1051library to make an Objective-C++ program work.  Note that @samp{.M} refers
1052to a literal capital M@.
1053
1054@item @var{file}.mii
1055Objective-C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.
1056
1057@item @var{file}.h
1058C, C++, Objective-C or Objective-C++ header file to be turned into a
1059precompiled header (default), or C, C++ header file to be turned into an
1060Ada spec (via the @option{-fdump-ada-spec} switch).
1061
1062@item @var{file}.cc
1063@itemx @var{file}.cp
1064@itemx @var{file}.cxx
1065@itemx @var{file}.cpp
1066@itemx @var{file}.CPP
1067@itemx @var{file}.c++
1068@itemx @var{file}.C
1069C++ source code that must be preprocessed.  Note that in @samp{.cxx},
1070the last two letters must both be literally @samp{x}.  Likewise,
1071@samp{.C} refers to a literal capital C@.
1072
1073@item @var{file}.mm
1074@itemx @var{file}.M
1075Objective-C++ source code that must be preprocessed.
1076
1077@item @var{file}.mii
1078Objective-C++ source code that should not be preprocessed.
1079
1080@item @var{file}.hh
1081@itemx @var{file}.H
1082@itemx @var{file}.hp
1083@itemx @var{file}.hxx
1084@itemx @var{file}.hpp
1085@itemx @var{file}.HPP
1086@itemx @var{file}.h++
1087@itemx @var{file}.tcc
1088C++ header file to be turned into a precompiled header or Ada spec.
1089
1090@item @var{file}.f
1091@itemx @var{file}.for
1092@itemx @var{file}.ftn
1093Fixed form Fortran source code that should not be preprocessed.
1094
1095@item @var{file}.F
1096@itemx @var{file}.FOR
1097@itemx @var{file}.fpp
1098@itemx @var{file}.FPP
1099@itemx @var{file}.FTN
1100Fixed form Fortran source code that must be preprocessed (with the traditional
1101preprocessor).
1102
1103@item @var{file}.f90
1104@itemx @var{file}.f95
1105@itemx @var{file}.f03
1106@itemx @var{file}.f08
1107Free form Fortran source code that should not be preprocessed.
1108
1109@item @var{file}.F90
1110@itemx @var{file}.F95
1111@itemx @var{file}.F03
1112@itemx @var{file}.F08
1113Free form Fortran source code that must be preprocessed (with the
1114traditional preprocessor).
1115
1116@item @var{file}.go
1117Go source code.
1118
1119@c FIXME: Descriptions of Java file types.
1120@c @var{file}.java
1121@c @var{file}.class
1122@c @var{file}.zip
1123@c @var{file}.jar
1124
1125@item @var{file}.ads
1126Ada source code file that contains a library unit declaration (a
1127declaration of a package, subprogram, or generic, or a generic
1128instantiation), or a library unit renaming declaration (a package,
1129generic, or subprogram renaming declaration).  Such files are also
1130called @dfn{specs}.
1131
1132@item @var{file}.adb
1133Ada source code file containing a library unit body (a subprogram or
1134package body).  Such files are also called @dfn{bodies}.
1135
1136@c GCC also knows about some suffixes for languages not yet included:
1137@c Pascal:
1138@c @var{file}.p
1139@c @var{file}.pas
1140@c Ratfor:
1141@c @var{file}.r
1142
1143@item @var{file}.s
1144Assembler code.
1145
1146@item @var{file}.S
1147@itemx @var{file}.sx
1148Assembler code that must be preprocessed.
1149
1150@item @var{other}
1151An object file to be fed straight into linking.
1152Any file name with no recognized suffix is treated this way.
1153@end table
1154
1155@opindex x
1156You can specify the input language explicitly with the @option{-x} option:
1157
1158@table @gcctabopt
1159@item -x @var{language}
1160Specify explicitly the @var{language} for the following input files
1161(rather than letting the compiler choose a default based on the file
1162name suffix).  This option applies to all following input files until
1163the next @option{-x} option.  Possible values for @var{language} are:
1164@smallexample
1165c  c-header  cpp-output
1166c++  c++-header  c++-cpp-output
1167objective-c  objective-c-header  objective-c-cpp-output
1168objective-c++ objective-c++-header objective-c++-cpp-output
1169assembler  assembler-with-cpp
1170ada
1171f77  f77-cpp-input f95  f95-cpp-input
1172go
1173java
1174@end smallexample
1175
1176@item -x none
1177Turn off any specification of a language, so that subsequent files are
1178handled according to their file name suffixes (as they are if @option{-x}
1179has not been used at all).
1180
1181@item -pass-exit-codes
1182@opindex pass-exit-codes
1183Normally the @command{gcc} program will exit with the code of 1 if any
1184phase of the compiler returns a non-success return code.  If you specify
1185@option{-pass-exit-codes}, the @command{gcc} program will instead return with
1186numerically highest error produced by any phase that returned an error
1187indication.  The C, C++, and Fortran frontends return 4, if an internal
1188compiler error is encountered.
1189@end table
1190
1191If you only want some of the stages of compilation, you can use
1192@option{-x} (or filename suffixes) to tell @command{gcc} where to start, and
1193one of the options @option{-c}, @option{-S}, or @option{-E} to say where
1194@command{gcc} is to stop.  Note that some combinations (for example,
1195@samp{-x cpp-output -E}) instruct @command{gcc} to do nothing at all.
1196
1197@table @gcctabopt
1198@item -c
1199@opindex c
1200Compile or assemble the source files, but do not link.  The linking
1201stage simply is not done.  The ultimate output is in the form of an
1202object file for each source file.
1203
1204By default, the object file name for a source file is made by replacing
1205the suffix @samp{.c}, @samp{.i}, @samp{.s}, etc., with @samp{.o}.
1206
1207Unrecognized input files, not requiring compilation or assembly, are
1208ignored.
1209
1210@item -S
1211@opindex S
1212Stop after the stage of compilation proper; do not assemble.  The output
1213is in the form of an assembler code file for each non-assembler input
1214file specified.
1215
1216By default, the assembler file name for a source file is made by
1217replacing the suffix @samp{.c}, @samp{.i}, etc., with @samp{.s}.
1218
1219Input files that don't require compilation are ignored.
1220
1221@item -E
1222@opindex E
1223Stop after the preprocessing stage; do not run the compiler proper.  The
1224output is in the form of preprocessed source code, which is sent to the
1225standard output.
1226
1227Input files that don't require preprocessing are ignored.
1228
1229@cindex output file option
1230@item -o @var{file}
1231@opindex o
1232Place output in file @var{file}.  This applies regardless to whatever
1233sort of output is being produced, whether it be an executable file,
1234an object file, an assembler file or preprocessed C code.
1235
1236If @option{-o} is not specified, the default is to put an executable
1237file in @file{a.out}, the object file for
1238@file{@var{source}.@var{suffix}} in @file{@var{source}.o}, its
1239assembler file in @file{@var{source}.s}, a precompiled header file in
1240@file{@var{source}.@var{suffix}.gch}, and all preprocessed C source on
1241standard output.
1242
1243@item -v
1244@opindex v
1245Print (on standard error output) the commands executed to run the stages
1246of compilation.  Also print the version number of the compiler driver
1247program and of the preprocessor and the compiler proper.
1248
1249@item -###
1250@opindex ###
1251Like @option{-v} except the commands are not executed and arguments
1252are quoted unless they contain only alphanumeric characters or @code{./-_}.
1253This is useful for shell scripts to capture the driver-generated command lines.
1254
1255@item -pipe
1256@opindex pipe
1257Use pipes rather than temporary files for communication between the
1258various stages of compilation.  This fails to work on some systems where
1259the assembler is unable to read from a pipe; but the GNU assembler has
1260no trouble.
1261
1262@item --help
1263@opindex help
1264Print (on the standard output) a description of the command-line options
1265understood by @command{gcc}.  If the @option{-v} option is also specified
1266then @option{--help} will also be passed on to the various processes
1267invoked by @command{gcc}, so that they can display the command-line options
1268they accept.  If the @option{-Wextra} option has also been specified
1269(prior to the @option{--help} option), then command-line options that
1270have no documentation associated with them will also be displayed.
1271
1272@item --target-help
1273@opindex target-help
1274Print (on the standard output) a description of target-specific command-line
1275options for each tool.  For some targets extra target-specific
1276information may also be printed.
1277
1278@item --help=@{@var{class}@r{|[}^@r{]}@var{qualifier}@}@r{[},@dots{}@r{]}
1279Print (on the standard output) a description of the command-line
1280options understood by the compiler that fit into all specified classes
1281and qualifiers.  These are the supported classes:
1282
1283@table @asis
1284@item @samp{optimizers}
1285This will display all of the optimization options supported by the
1286compiler.
1287
1288@item @samp{warnings}
1289This will display all of the options controlling warning messages
1290produced by the compiler.
1291
1292@item @samp{target}
1293This will display target-specific options.  Unlike the
1294@option{--target-help} option however, target-specific options of the
1295linker and assembler will not be displayed.  This is because those
1296tools do not currently support the extended @option{--help=} syntax.
1297
1298@item @samp{params}
1299This will display the values recognized by the @option{--param}
1300option.
1301
1302@item @var{language}
1303This will display the options supported for @var{language}, where
1304@var{language} is the name of one of the languages supported in this
1305version of GCC.
1306
1307@item @samp{common}
1308This will display the options that are common to all languages.
1309@end table
1310
1311These are the supported qualifiers:
1312
1313@table @asis
1314@item @samp{undocumented}
1315Display only those options that are undocumented.
1316
1317@item @samp{joined}
1318Display options taking an argument that appears after an equal
1319sign in the same continuous piece of text, such as:
1320@samp{--help=target}.
1321
1322@item @samp{separate}
1323Display options taking an argument that appears as a separate word
1324following the original option, such as: @samp{-o output-file}.
1325@end table
1326
1327Thus for example to display all the undocumented target-specific
1328switches supported by the compiler the following can be used:
1329
1330@smallexample
1331--help=target,undocumented
1332@end smallexample
1333
1334The sense of a qualifier can be inverted by prefixing it with the
1335@samp{^} character, so for example to display all binary warning
1336options (i.e., ones that are either on or off and that do not take an
1337argument) that have a description, use:
1338
1339@smallexample
1340--help=warnings,^joined,^undocumented
1341@end smallexample
1342
1343The argument to @option{--help=} should not consist solely of inverted
1344qualifiers.
1345
1346Combining several classes is possible, although this usually
1347restricts the output by so much that there is nothing to display.  One
1348case where it does work however is when one of the classes is
1349@var{target}.  So for example to display all the target-specific
1350optimization options the following can be used:
1351
1352@smallexample
1353--help=target,optimizers
1354@end smallexample
1355
1356The @option{--help=} option can be repeated on the command line.  Each
1357successive use will display its requested class of options, skipping
1358those that have already been displayed.
1359
1360If the @option{-Q} option appears on the command line before the
1361@option{--help=} option, then the descriptive text displayed by
1362@option{--help=} is changed.  Instead of describing the displayed
1363options, an indication is given as to whether the option is enabled,
1364disabled or set to a specific value (assuming that the compiler
1365knows this at the point where the @option{--help=} option is used).
1366
1367Here is a truncated example from the ARM port of @command{gcc}:
1368
1369@smallexample
1370  % gcc -Q -mabi=2 --help=target -c
1371  The following options are target specific:
1372  -mabi=                                2
1373  -mabort-on-noreturn                   [disabled]
1374  -mapcs                                [disabled]
1375@end smallexample
1376
1377The output is sensitive to the effects of previous command-line
1378options, so for example it is possible to find out which optimizations
1379are enabled at @option{-O2} by using:
1380
1381@smallexample
1382-Q -O2 --help=optimizers
1383@end smallexample
1384
1385Alternatively you can discover which binary optimizations are enabled
1386by @option{-O3} by using:
1387
1388@smallexample
1389gcc -c -Q -O3 --help=optimizers > /tmp/O3-opts
1390gcc -c -Q -O2 --help=optimizers > /tmp/O2-opts
1391diff /tmp/O2-opts /tmp/O3-opts | grep enabled
1392@end smallexample
1393
1394@item -no-canonical-prefixes
1395@opindex no-canonical-prefixes
1396Do not expand any symbolic links, resolve references to @samp{/../}
1397or @samp{/./}, or make the path absolute when generating a relative
1398prefix.
1399
1400@item --version
1401@opindex version
1402Display the version number and copyrights of the invoked GCC@.
1403
1404@item -wrapper
1405@opindex wrapper
1406Invoke all subcommands under a wrapper program.  The name of the
1407wrapper program and its parameters are passed as a comma separated
1408list.
1409
1410@smallexample
1411gcc -c t.c -wrapper gdb,--args
1412@end smallexample
1413
1414This will invoke all subprograms of @command{gcc} under
1415@samp{gdb --args}, thus the invocation of @command{cc1} will be
1416@samp{gdb --args cc1 @dots{}}.
1417
1418@item -fplugin=@var{name}.so
1419Load the plugin code in file @var{name}.so, assumed to be a
1420shared object to be dlopen'd by the compiler.  The base name of
1421the shared object file is used to identify the plugin for the
1422purposes of argument parsing (See
1423@option{-fplugin-arg-@var{name}-@var{key}=@var{value}} below).
1424Each plugin should define the callback functions specified in the
1425Plugins API.
1426
1427@item -fplugin-arg-@var{name}-@var{key}=@var{value}
1428Define an argument called @var{key} with a value of @var{value}
1429for the plugin called @var{name}.
1430
1431@item -fdump-ada-spec@r{[}-slim@r{]}
1432For C and C++ source and include files, generate corresponding Ada
1433specs. @xref{Generating Ada Bindings for C and C++ headers,,, gnat_ugn,
1434GNAT User's Guide}, which provides detailed documentation on this feature.
1435
1436@item -fdump-go-spec=@var{file}
1437For input files in any language, generate corresponding Go
1438declarations in @var{file}.  This generates Go @code{const},
1439@code{type}, @code{var}, and @code{func} declarations which may be a
1440useful way to start writing a Go interface to code written in some
1441other language.
1442
1443@include @value{srcdir}/../libiberty/at-file.texi
1444@end table
1445
1446@node Invoking G++
1447@section Compiling C++ Programs
1448
1449@cindex suffixes for C++ source
1450@cindex C++ source file suffixes
1451C++ source files conventionally use one of the suffixes @samp{.C},
1452@samp{.cc}, @samp{.cpp}, @samp{.CPP}, @samp{.c++}, @samp{.cp}, or
1453@samp{.cxx}; C++ header files often use @samp{.hh}, @samp{.hpp},
1454@samp{.H}, or (for shared template code) @samp{.tcc}; and
1455preprocessed C++ files use the suffix @samp{.ii}.  GCC recognizes
1456files with these names and compiles them as C++ programs even if you
1457call the compiler the same way as for compiling C programs (usually
1458with the name @command{gcc}).
1459
1460@findex g++
1461@findex c++
1462However, the use of @command{gcc} does not add the C++ library.
1463@command{g++} is a program that calls GCC and treats @samp{.c},
1464@samp{.h} and @samp{.i} files as C++ source files instead of C source
1465files unless @option{-x} is used, and automatically specifies linking
1466against the C++ library.  This program is also useful when
1467precompiling a C header file with a @samp{.h} extension for use in C++
1468compilations.  On many systems, @command{g++} is also installed with
1469the name @command{c++}.
1470
1471@cindex invoking @command{g++}
1472When you compile C++ programs, you may specify many of the same
1473command-line options that you use for compiling programs in any
1474language; or command-line options meaningful for C and related
1475languages; or options that are meaningful only for C++ programs.
1476@xref{C Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}, for
1477explanations of options for languages related to C@.
1478@xref{C++ Dialect Options,,Options Controlling C++ Dialect}, for
1479explanations of options that are meaningful only for C++ programs.
1480
1481@node C Dialect Options
1482@section Options Controlling C Dialect
1483@cindex dialect options
1484@cindex language dialect options
1485@cindex options, dialect
1486
1487The following options control the dialect of C (or languages derived
1488from C, such as C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++) that the compiler
1489accepts:
1490
1491@table @gcctabopt
1492@cindex ANSI support
1493@cindex ISO support
1494@item -ansi
1495@opindex ansi
1496In C mode, this is equivalent to @samp{-std=c90}. In C++ mode, it is
1497equivalent to @samp{-std=c++98}.
1498
1499This turns off certain features of GCC that are incompatible with ISO
1500C90 (when compiling C code), or of standard C++ (when compiling C++ code),
1501such as the @code{asm} and @code{typeof} keywords, and
1502predefined macros such as @code{unix} and @code{vax} that identify the
1503type of system you are using.  It also enables the undesirable and
1504rarely used ISO trigraph feature.  For the C compiler,
1505it disables recognition of C++ style @samp{//} comments as well as
1506the @code{inline} keyword.
1507
1508The alternate keywords @code{__asm__}, @code{__extension__},
1509@code{__inline__} and @code{__typeof__} continue to work despite
1510@option{-ansi}.  You would not want to use them in an ISO C program, of
1511course, but it is useful to put them in header files that might be included
1512in compilations done with @option{-ansi}.  Alternate predefined macros
1513such as @code{__unix__} and @code{__vax__} are also available, with or
1514without @option{-ansi}.
1515
1516The @option{-ansi} option does not cause non-ISO programs to be
1517rejected gratuitously.  For that, @option{-pedantic} is required in
1518addition to @option{-ansi}.  @xref{Warning Options}.
1519
1520The macro @code{__STRICT_ANSI__} is predefined when the @option{-ansi}
1521option is used.  Some header files may notice this macro and refrain
1522from declaring certain functions or defining certain macros that the
1523ISO standard doesn't call for; this is to avoid interfering with any
1524programs that might use these names for other things.
1525
1526Functions that would normally be built in but do not have semantics
1527defined by ISO C (such as @code{alloca} and @code{ffs}) are not built-in
1528functions when @option{-ansi} is used.  @xref{Other Builtins,,Other
1529built-in functions provided by GCC}, for details of the functions
1530affected.
1531
1532@item -std=
1533@opindex std
1534Determine the language standard. @xref{Standards,,Language Standards
1535Supported by GCC}, for details of these standard versions.  This option
1536is currently only supported when compiling C or C++.
1537
1538The compiler can accept several base standards, such as @samp{c90} or
1539@samp{c++98}, and GNU dialects of those standards, such as
1540@samp{gnu90} or @samp{gnu++98}.  By specifying a base standard, the
1541compiler will accept all programs following that standard and those
1542using GNU extensions that do not contradict it.  For example,
1543@samp{-std=c90} turns off certain features of GCC that are
1544incompatible with ISO C90, such as the @code{asm} and @code{typeof}
1545keywords, but not other GNU extensions that do not have a meaning in
1546ISO C90, such as omitting the middle term of a @code{?:}
1547expression. On the other hand, by specifying a GNU dialect of a
1548standard, all features the compiler support are enabled, even when
1549those features change the meaning of the base standard and some
1550strict-conforming programs may be rejected.  The particular standard
1551is used by @option{-pedantic} to identify which features are GNU
1552extensions given that version of the standard. For example
1553@samp{-std=gnu90 -pedantic} would warn about C++ style @samp{//}
1554comments, while @samp{-std=gnu99 -pedantic} would not.
1555
1556A value for this option must be provided; possible values are
1557
1558@table @samp
1559@item c90
1560@itemx c89
1561@itemx iso9899:1990
1562Support all ISO C90 programs (certain GNU extensions that conflict
1563with ISO C90 are disabled). Same as @option{-ansi} for C code.
1564
1565@item iso9899:199409
1566ISO C90 as modified in amendment 1.
1567
1568@item c99
1569@itemx c9x
1570@itemx iso9899:1999
1571@itemx iso9899:199x
1572ISO C99.  Note that this standard is not yet fully supported; see
1573@w{@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/gcc-4.7/c99status.html}} for more information.  The
1574names @samp{c9x} and @samp{iso9899:199x} are deprecated.
1575
1576@item c11
1577@itemx c1x
1578@itemx iso9899:2011
1579ISO C11, the 2011 revision of the ISO C standard.
1580Support is incomplete and experimental.  The name @samp{c1x} is
1581deprecated.
1582
1583@item gnu90
1584@itemx gnu89
1585GNU dialect of ISO C90 (including some C99 features). This
1586is the default for C code.
1587
1588@item gnu99
1589@itemx gnu9x
1590GNU dialect of ISO C99.  When ISO C99 is fully implemented in GCC,
1591this will become the default.  The name @samp{gnu9x} is deprecated.
1592
1593@item gnu11
1594@item gnu1x
1595GNU dialect of ISO C11.  Support is incomplete and experimental.  The
1596name @samp{gnu1x} is deprecated.
1597
1598@item c++98
1599The 1998 ISO C++ standard plus amendments. Same as @option{-ansi} for
1600C++ code.
1601
1602@item gnu++98
1603GNU dialect of @option{-std=c++98}.  This is the default for
1604C++ code.
1605
1606@item c++11
1607The 2011 ISO C++ standard plus amendments.  Support for C++11 is still
1608experimental, and may change in incompatible ways in future releases.
1609
1610@item gnu++11
1611GNU dialect of @option{-std=c++11}. Support for C++11 is still
1612experimental, and may change in incompatible ways in future releases.
1613@end table
1614
1615@item -fgnu89-inline
1616@opindex fgnu89-inline
1617The option @option{-fgnu89-inline} tells GCC to use the traditional
1618GNU semantics for @code{inline} functions when in C99 mode.
1619@xref{Inline,,An Inline Function is As Fast As a Macro}.  This option
1620is accepted and ignored by GCC versions 4.1.3 up to but not including
16214.3.  In GCC versions 4.3 and later it changes the behavior of GCC in
1622C99 mode.  Using this option is roughly equivalent to adding the
1623@code{gnu_inline} function attribute to all inline functions
1624(@pxref{Function Attributes}).
1625
1626The option @option{-fno-gnu89-inline} explicitly tells GCC to use the
1627C99 semantics for @code{inline} when in C99 or gnu99 mode (i.e., it
1628specifies the default behavior).  This option was first supported in
1629GCC 4.3.  This option is not supported in @option{-std=c90} or
1630@option{-std=gnu90} mode.
1631
1632The preprocessor macros @code{__GNUC_GNU_INLINE__} and
1633@code{__GNUC_STDC_INLINE__} may be used to check which semantics are
1634in effect for @code{inline} functions.  @xref{Common Predefined
1635Macros,,,cpp,The C Preprocessor}.
1636
1637@item -aux-info @var{filename}
1638@opindex aux-info
1639Output to the given filename prototyped declarations for all functions
1640declared and/or defined in a translation unit, including those in header
1641files.  This option is silently ignored in any language other than C@.
1642
1643Besides declarations, the file indicates, in comments, the origin of
1644each declaration (source file and line), whether the declaration was
1645implicit, prototyped or unprototyped (@samp{I}, @samp{N} for new or
1646@samp{O} for old, respectively, in the first character after the line
1647number and the colon), and whether it came from a declaration or a
1648definition (@samp{C} or @samp{F}, respectively, in the following
1649character).  In the case of function definitions, a K&R-style list of
1650arguments followed by their declarations is also provided, inside
1651comments, after the declaration.
1652
1653@item -fallow-parameterless-variadic-functions
1654Accept variadic functions without named parameters.
1655
1656Although it is possible to define such a function, this is not very
1657useful as it is not possible to read the arguments.  This is only
1658supported for C as this construct is allowed by C++.
1659
1660@item -fno-asm
1661@opindex fno-asm
1662Do not recognize @code{asm}, @code{inline} or @code{typeof} as a
1663keyword, so that code can use these words as identifiers.  You can use
1664the keywords @code{__asm__}, @code{__inline__} and @code{__typeof__}
1665instead.  @option{-ansi} implies @option{-fno-asm}.
1666
1667In C++, this switch only affects the @code{typeof} keyword, since
1668@code{asm} and @code{inline} are standard keywords.  You may want to
1669use the @option{-fno-gnu-keywords} flag instead, which has the same
1670effect.  In C99 mode (@option{-std=c99} or @option{-std=gnu99}), this
1671switch only affects the @code{asm} and @code{typeof} keywords, since
1672@code{inline} is a standard keyword in ISO C99.
1673
1674@item -fno-builtin
1675@itemx -fno-builtin-@var{function}
1676@opindex fno-builtin
1677@cindex built-in functions
1678Don't recognize built-in functions that do not begin with
1679@samp{__builtin_} as prefix.  @xref{Other Builtins,,Other built-in
1680functions provided by GCC}, for details of the functions affected,
1681including those which are not built-in functions when @option{-ansi} or
1682@option{-std} options for strict ISO C conformance are used because they
1683do not have an ISO standard meaning.
1684
1685GCC normally generates special code to handle certain built-in functions
1686more efficiently; for instance, calls to @code{alloca} may become single
1687instructions which adjust the stack directly, and calls to @code{memcpy}
1688may become inline copy loops.  The resulting code is often both smaller
1689and faster, but since the function calls no longer appear as such, you
1690cannot set a breakpoint on those calls, nor can you change the behavior
1691of the functions by linking with a different library.  In addition,
1692when a function is recognized as a built-in function, GCC may use
1693information about that function to warn about problems with calls to
1694that function, or to generate more efficient code, even if the
1695resulting code still contains calls to that function.  For example,
1696warnings are given with @option{-Wformat} for bad calls to
1697@code{printf}, when @code{printf} is built in, and @code{strlen} is
1698known not to modify global memory.
1699
1700With the @option{-fno-builtin-@var{function}} option
1701only the built-in function @var{function} is
1702disabled.  @var{function} must not begin with @samp{__builtin_}.  If a
1703function is named that is not built-in in this version of GCC, this
1704option is ignored.  There is no corresponding
1705@option{-fbuiltin-@var{function}} option; if you wish to enable
1706built-in functions selectively when using @option{-fno-builtin} or
1707@option{-ffreestanding}, you may define macros such as:
1708
1709@smallexample
1710#define abs(n)          __builtin_abs ((n))
1711#define strcpy(d, s)    __builtin_strcpy ((d), (s))
1712@end smallexample
1713
1714@item -fhosted
1715@opindex fhosted
1716@cindex hosted environment
1717
1718Assert that compilation takes place in a hosted environment.  This implies
1719@option{-fbuiltin}.  A hosted environment is one in which the
1720entire standard library is available, and in which @code{main} has a return
1721type of @code{int}.  Examples are nearly everything except a kernel.
1722This is equivalent to @option{-fno-freestanding}.
1723
1724@item -ffreestanding
1725@opindex ffreestanding
1726@cindex hosted environment
1727
1728Assert that compilation takes place in a freestanding environment.  This
1729implies @option{-fno-builtin}.  A freestanding environment
1730is one in which the standard library may not exist, and program startup may
1731not necessarily be at @code{main}.  The most obvious example is an OS kernel.
1732This is equivalent to @option{-fno-hosted}.
1733
1734@xref{Standards,,Language Standards Supported by GCC}, for details of
1735freestanding and hosted environments.
1736
1737@item -fopenmp
1738@opindex fopenmp
1739@cindex OpenMP parallel
1740Enable handling of OpenMP directives @code{#pragma omp} in C/C++ and
1741@code{!$omp} in Fortran.  When @option{-fopenmp} is specified, the
1742compiler generates parallel code according to the OpenMP Application
1743Program Interface v3.0 @w{@uref{http://www.openmp.org/}}.  This option
1744implies @option{-pthread}, and thus is only supported on targets that
1745have support for @option{-pthread}.
1746
1747@item -fgnu-tm
1748@opindex fgnu-tm
1749When the option @option{-fgnu-tm} is specified, the compiler will
1750generate code for the Linux variant of Intel's current Transactional
1751Memory ABI specification document (Revision 1.1, May 6 2009).  This is
1752an experimental feature whose interface may change in future versions
1753of GCC, as the official specification changes.  Please note that not
1754all architectures are supported for this feature.
1755
1756For more information on GCC's support for transactional memory,
1757@xref{Enabling libitm,,The GNU Transactional Memory Library,libitm,GNU
1758Transactional Memory Library}.
1759
1760Note that the transactional memory feature is not supported with
1761non-call exceptions (@option{-fnon-call-exceptions}).
1762
1763@item -fms-extensions
1764@opindex fms-extensions
1765Accept some non-standard constructs used in Microsoft header files.
1766
1767In C++ code, this allows member names in structures to be similar
1768to previous types declarations.
1769
1770@smallexample
1771typedef int UOW;
1772struct ABC @{
1773  UOW UOW;
1774@};
1775@end smallexample
1776
1777Some cases of unnamed fields in structures and unions are only
1778accepted with this option.  @xref{Unnamed Fields,,Unnamed struct/union
1779fields within structs/unions}, for details.
1780
1781@item -fplan9-extensions
1782Accept some non-standard constructs used in Plan 9 code.
1783
1784This enables @option{-fms-extensions}, permits passing pointers to
1785structures with anonymous fields to functions that expect pointers to
1786elements of the type of the field, and permits referring to anonymous
1787fields declared using a typedef.  @xref{Unnamed Fields,,Unnamed
1788struct/union fields within structs/unions}, for details.  This is only
1789supported for C, not C++.
1790
1791@item -trigraphs
1792@opindex trigraphs
1793Support ISO C trigraphs.  The @option{-ansi} option (and @option{-std}
1794options for strict ISO C conformance) implies @option{-trigraphs}.
1795
1796@item -no-integrated-cpp
1797@opindex no-integrated-cpp
1798Performs a compilation in two passes: preprocessing and compiling.  This
1799option allows a user supplied "cc1", "cc1plus", or "cc1obj" via the
1800@option{-B} option.  The user supplied compilation step can then add in
1801an additional preprocessing step after normal preprocessing but before
1802compiling.  The default is to use the integrated cpp (internal cpp)
1803
1804The semantics of this option will change if "cc1", "cc1plus", and
1805"cc1obj" are merged.
1806
1807@cindex traditional C language
1808@cindex C language, traditional
1809@item -traditional
1810@itemx -traditional-cpp
1811@opindex traditional-cpp
1812@opindex traditional
1813Formerly, these options caused GCC to attempt to emulate a pre-standard
1814C compiler.  They are now only supported with the @option{-E} switch.
1815The preprocessor continues to support a pre-standard mode.  See the GNU
1816CPP manual for details.
1817
1818@item -fcond-mismatch
1819@opindex fcond-mismatch
1820Allow conditional expressions with mismatched types in the second and
1821third arguments.  The value of such an expression is void.  This option
1822is not supported for C++.
1823
1824@item -flax-vector-conversions
1825@opindex flax-vector-conversions
1826Allow implicit conversions between vectors with differing numbers of
1827elements and/or incompatible element types.  This option should not be
1828used for new code.
1829
1830@item -funsigned-char
1831@opindex funsigned-char
1832Let the type @code{char} be unsigned, like @code{unsigned char}.
1833
1834Each kind of machine has a default for what @code{char} should
1835be.  It is either like @code{unsigned char} by default or like
1836@code{signed char} by default.
1837
1838Ideally, a portable program should always use @code{signed char} or
1839@code{unsigned char} when it depends on the signedness of an object.
1840But many programs have been written to use plain @code{char} and
1841expect it to be signed, or expect it to be unsigned, depending on the
1842machines they were written for.  This option, and its inverse, let you
1843make such a program work with the opposite default.
1844
1845The type @code{char} is always a distinct type from each of
1846@code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char}, even though its behavior
1847is always just like one of those two.
1848
1849@item -fsigned-char
1850@opindex fsigned-char
1851Let the type @code{char} be signed, like @code{signed char}.
1852
1853Note that this is equivalent to @option{-fno-unsigned-char}, which is
1854the negative form of @option{-funsigned-char}.  Likewise, the option
1855@option{-fno-signed-char} is equivalent to @option{-funsigned-char}.
1856
1857@item -fsigned-bitfields
1858@itemx -funsigned-bitfields
1859@itemx -fno-signed-bitfields
1860@itemx -fno-unsigned-bitfields
1861@opindex fsigned-bitfields
1862@opindex funsigned-bitfields
1863@opindex fno-signed-bitfields
1864@opindex fno-unsigned-bitfields
1865These options control whether a bit-field is signed or unsigned, when the
1866declaration does not use either @code{signed} or @code{unsigned}.  By
1867default, such a bit-field is signed, because this is consistent: the
1868basic integer types such as @code{int} are signed types.
1869@end table
1870
1871@node C++ Dialect Options
1872@section Options Controlling C++ Dialect
1873
1874@cindex compiler options, C++
1875@cindex C++ options, command-line
1876@cindex options, C++
1877This section describes the command-line options that are only meaningful
1878for C++ programs; but you can also use most of the GNU compiler options
1879regardless of what language your program is in.  For example, you
1880might compile a file @code{firstClass.C} like this:
1881
1882@smallexample
1883g++ -g -frepo -O -c firstClass.C
1884@end smallexample
1885
1886@noindent
1887In this example, only @option{-frepo} is an option meant
1888only for C++ programs; you can use the other options with any
1889language supported by GCC@.
1890
1891Here is a list of options that are @emph{only} for compiling C++ programs:
1892
1893@table @gcctabopt
1894
1895@item -fabi-version=@var{n}
1896@opindex fabi-version
1897Use version @var{n} of the C++ ABI@.  Version 2 is the version of the
1898C++ ABI that first appeared in G++ 3.4.  Version 1 is the version of
1899the C++ ABI that first appeared in G++ 3.2.  Version 0 will always be
1900the version that conforms most closely to the C++ ABI specification.
1901Therefore, the ABI obtained using version 0 will change as ABI bugs
1902are fixed.
1903
1904The default is version 2.
1905
1906Version 3 corrects an error in mangling a constant address as a
1907template argument.
1908
1909Version 4, which first appeared in G++ 4.5, implements a standard
1910mangling for vector types.
1911
1912Version 5, which first appeared in G++ 4.6, corrects the mangling of
1913attribute const/volatile on function pointer types, decltype of a
1914plain decl, and use of a function parameter in the declaration of
1915another parameter.
1916
1917Version 6, which first appeared in G++ 4.7, corrects the promotion
1918behavior of C++11 scoped enums and the mangling of template argument
1919packs, const/static_cast, prefix ++ and --, and a class scope function
1920used as a template argument.
1921
1922See also @option{-Wabi}.
1923
1924@item -fno-access-control
1925@opindex fno-access-control
1926Turn off all access checking.  This switch is mainly useful for working
1927around bugs in the access control code.
1928
1929@item -fcheck-new
1930@opindex fcheck-new
1931Check that the pointer returned by @code{operator new} is non-null
1932before attempting to modify the storage allocated.  This check is
1933normally unnecessary because the C++ standard specifies that
1934@code{operator new} will only return @code{0} if it is declared
1935@samp{throw()}, in which case the compiler will always check the
1936return value even without this option.  In all other cases, when
1937@code{operator new} has a non-empty exception specification, memory
1938exhaustion is signalled by throwing @code{std::bad_alloc}.  See also
1939@samp{new (nothrow)}.
1940
1941@item -fconserve-space
1942@opindex fconserve-space
1943Put uninitialized or run-time-initialized global variables into the
1944common segment, as C does.  This saves space in the executable at the
1945cost of not diagnosing duplicate definitions.  If you compile with this
1946flag and your program mysteriously crashes after @code{main()} has
1947completed, you may have an object that is being destroyed twice because
1948two definitions were merged.
1949
1950This option is no longer useful on most targets, now that support has
1951been added for putting variables into BSS without making them common.
1952
1953@item -fconstexpr-depth=@var{n}
1954@opindex fconstexpr-depth
1955Set the maximum nested evaluation depth for C++11 constexpr functions
1956to @var{n}.  A limit is needed to detect endless recursion during
1957constant expression evaluation.  The minimum specified by the standard
1958is 512.
1959
1960@item -fdeduce-init-list
1961@opindex fdeduce-init-list
1962Enable deduction of a template type parameter as
1963std::initializer_list from a brace-enclosed initializer list, i.e.
1964
1965@smallexample
1966template <class T> auto forward(T t) -> decltype (realfn (t))
1967@{
1968  return realfn (t);
1969@}
1970
1971void f()
1972@{
1973  forward(@{1,2@}); // call forward<std::initializer_list<int>>
1974@}
1975@end smallexample
1976
1977This deduction was implemented as a possible extension to the
1978originally proposed semantics for the C++11 standard, but was not part
1979of the final standard, so it is disabled by default.  This option is
1980deprecated, and may be removed in a future version of G++.
1981
1982@item -ffriend-injection
1983@opindex ffriend-injection
1984Inject friend functions into the enclosing namespace, so that they are
1985visible outside the scope of the class in which they are declared.
1986Friend functions were documented to work this way in the old Annotated
1987C++ Reference Manual, and versions of G++ before 4.1 always worked
1988that way.  However, in ISO C++ a friend function that is not declared
1989in an enclosing scope can only be found using argument dependent
1990lookup.  This option causes friends to be injected as they were in
1991earlier releases.
1992
1993This option is for compatibility, and may be removed in a future
1994release of G++.
1995
1996@item -fno-elide-constructors
1997@opindex fno-elide-constructors
1998The C++ standard allows an implementation to omit creating a temporary
1999that is only used to initialize another object of the same type.
2000Specifying this option disables that optimization, and forces G++ to
2001call the copy constructor in all cases.
2002
2003@item -fno-enforce-eh-specs
2004@opindex fno-enforce-eh-specs
2005Don't generate code to check for violation of exception specifications
2006at run time.  This option violates the C++ standard, but may be useful
2007for reducing code size in production builds, much like defining
2008@samp{NDEBUG}.  This does not give user code permission to throw
2009exceptions in violation of the exception specifications; the compiler
2010will still optimize based on the specifications, so throwing an
2011unexpected exception will result in undefined behavior.
2012
2013@item -ffor-scope
2014@itemx -fno-for-scope
2015@opindex ffor-scope
2016@opindex fno-for-scope
2017If @option{-ffor-scope} is specified, the scope of variables declared in
2018a @i{for-init-statement} is limited to the @samp{for} loop itself,
2019as specified by the C++ standard.
2020If @option{-fno-for-scope} is specified, the scope of variables declared in
2021a @i{for-init-statement} extends to the end of the enclosing scope,
2022as was the case in old versions of G++, and other (traditional)
2023implementations of C++.
2024
2025The default if neither flag is given to follow the standard,
2026but to allow and give a warning for old-style code that would
2027otherwise be invalid, or have different behavior.
2028
2029@item -fno-gnu-keywords
2030@opindex fno-gnu-keywords
2031Do not recognize @code{typeof} as a keyword, so that code can use this
2032word as an identifier.  You can use the keyword @code{__typeof__} instead.
2033@option{-ansi} implies @option{-fno-gnu-keywords}.
2034
2035@item -fno-implicit-templates
2036@opindex fno-implicit-templates
2037Never emit code for non-inline templates that are instantiated
2038implicitly (i.e.@: by use); only emit code for explicit instantiations.
2039@xref{Template Instantiation}, for more information.
2040
2041@item -fno-implicit-inline-templates
2042@opindex fno-implicit-inline-templates
2043Don't emit code for implicit instantiations of inline templates, either.
2044The default is to handle inlines differently so that compiles with and
2045without optimization will need the same set of explicit instantiations.
2046
2047@item -fno-implement-inlines
2048@opindex fno-implement-inlines
2049To save space, do not emit out-of-line copies of inline functions
2050controlled by @samp{#pragma implementation}.  This will cause linker
2051errors if these functions are not inlined everywhere they are called.
2052
2053@item -fms-extensions
2054@opindex fms-extensions
2055Disable pedantic warnings about constructs used in MFC, such as implicit
2056int and getting a pointer to member function via non-standard syntax.
2057
2058@item -fno-nonansi-builtins
2059@opindex fno-nonansi-builtins
2060Disable built-in declarations of functions that are not mandated by
2061ANSI/ISO C@.  These include @code{ffs}, @code{alloca}, @code{_exit},
2062@code{index}, @code{bzero}, @code{conjf}, and other related functions.
2063
2064@item -fnothrow-opt
2065@opindex fnothrow-opt
2066Treat a @code{throw()} exception specification as though it were a
2067@code{noexcept} specification to reduce or eliminate the text size
2068overhead relative to a function with no exception specification.  If
2069the function has local variables of types with non-trivial
2070destructors, the exception specification will actually make the
2071function smaller because the EH cleanups for those variables can be
2072optimized away.  The semantic effect is that an exception thrown out of
2073a function with such an exception specification will result in a call
2074to @code{terminate} rather than @code{unexpected}.
2075
2076@item -fno-operator-names
2077@opindex fno-operator-names
2078Do not treat the operator name keywords @code{and}, @code{bitand},
2079@code{bitor}, @code{compl}, @code{not}, @code{or} and @code{xor} as
2080synonyms as keywords.
2081
2082@item -fno-optional-diags
2083@opindex fno-optional-diags
2084Disable diagnostics that the standard says a compiler does not need to
2085issue.  Currently, the only such diagnostic issued by G++ is the one for
2086a name having multiple meanings within a class.
2087
2088@item -fpermissive
2089@opindex fpermissive
2090Downgrade some diagnostics about nonconformant code from errors to
2091warnings.  Thus, using @option{-fpermissive} will allow some
2092nonconforming code to compile.
2093
2094@item -fno-pretty-templates
2095@opindex fno-pretty-templates
2096When an error message refers to a specialization of a function
2097template, the compiler will normally print the signature of the
2098template followed by the template arguments and any typedefs or
2099typenames in the signature (e.g. @code{void f(T) [with T = int]}
2100rather than @code{void f(int)}) so that it's clear which template is
2101involved.  When an error message refers to a specialization of a class
2102template, the compiler will omit any template arguments that match
2103the default template arguments for that template.  If either of these
2104behaviors make it harder to understand the error message rather than
2105easier, using @option{-fno-pretty-templates} will disable them.
2106
2107@item -frepo
2108@opindex frepo
2109Enable automatic template instantiation at link time.  This option also
2110implies @option{-fno-implicit-templates}.  @xref{Template
2111Instantiation}, for more information.
2112
2113@item -fno-rtti
2114@opindex fno-rtti
2115Disable generation of information about every class with virtual
2116functions for use by the C++ run-time type identification features
2117(@samp{dynamic_cast} and @samp{typeid}).  If you don't use those parts
2118of the language, you can save some space by using this flag.  Note that
2119exception handling uses the same information, but it will generate it as
2120needed. The @samp{dynamic_cast} operator can still be used for casts that
2121do not require run-time type information, i.e.@: casts to @code{void *} or to
2122unambiguous base classes.
2123
2124@item -fstats
2125@opindex fstats
2126Emit statistics about front-end processing at the end of the compilation.
2127This information is generally only useful to the G++ development team.
2128
2129@item -fstrict-enums
2130@opindex fstrict-enums
2131Allow the compiler to optimize using the assumption that a value of
2132enumerated type can only be one of the values of the enumeration (as
2133defined in the C++ standard; basically, a value that can be
2134represented in the minimum number of bits needed to represent all the
2135enumerators).  This assumption may not be valid if the program uses a
2136cast to convert an arbitrary integer value to the enumerated type.
2137
2138@item -ftemplate-depth=@var{n}
2139@opindex ftemplate-depth
2140Set the maximum instantiation depth for template classes to @var{n}.
2141A limit on the template instantiation depth is needed to detect
2142endless recursions during template class instantiation.  ANSI/ISO C++
2143conforming programs must not rely on a maximum depth greater than 17
2144(changed to 1024 in C++11).  The default value is 900, as the compiler
2145can run out of stack space before hitting 1024 in some situations.
2146
2147@item -fno-threadsafe-statics
2148@opindex fno-threadsafe-statics
2149Do not emit the extra code to use the routines specified in the C++
2150ABI for thread-safe initialization of local statics.  You can use this
2151option to reduce code size slightly in code that doesn't need to be
2152thread-safe.
2153
2154@item -fuse-cxa-atexit
2155@opindex fuse-cxa-atexit
2156Register destructors for objects with static storage duration with the
2157@code{__cxa_atexit} function rather than the @code{atexit} function.
2158This option is required for fully standards-compliant handling of static
2159destructors, but will only work if your C library supports
2160@code{__cxa_atexit}.
2161
2162@item -fno-use-cxa-get-exception-ptr
2163@opindex fno-use-cxa-get-exception-ptr
2164Don't use the @code{__cxa_get_exception_ptr} runtime routine.  This
2165will cause @code{std::uncaught_exception} to be incorrect, but is necessary
2166if the runtime routine is not available.
2167
2168@item -fvisibility-inlines-hidden
2169@opindex fvisibility-inlines-hidden
2170This switch declares that the user does not attempt to compare
2171pointers to inline functions or methods where the addresses of the two functions
2172were taken in different shared objects.
2173
2174The effect of this is that GCC may, effectively, mark inline methods with
2175@code{__attribute__ ((visibility ("hidden")))} so that they do not
2176appear in the export table of a DSO and do not require a PLT indirection
2177when used within the DSO@.  Enabling this option can have a dramatic effect
2178on load and link times of a DSO as it massively reduces the size of the
2179dynamic export table when the library makes heavy use of templates.
2180
2181The behavior of this switch is not quite the same as marking the
2182methods as hidden directly, because it does not affect static variables
2183local to the function or cause the compiler to deduce that
2184the function is defined in only one shared object.
2185
2186You may mark a method as having a visibility explicitly to negate the
2187effect of the switch for that method.  For example, if you do want to
2188compare pointers to a particular inline method, you might mark it as
2189having default visibility.  Marking the enclosing class with explicit
2190visibility will have no effect.
2191
2192Explicitly instantiated inline methods are unaffected by this option
2193as their linkage might otherwise cross a shared library boundary.
2194@xref{Template Instantiation}.
2195
2196@item -fvisibility-ms-compat
2197@opindex fvisibility-ms-compat
2198This flag attempts to use visibility settings to make GCC's C++
2199linkage model compatible with that of Microsoft Visual Studio.
2200
2201The flag makes these changes to GCC's linkage model:
2202
2203@enumerate
2204@item
2205It sets the default visibility to @code{hidden}, like
2206@option{-fvisibility=hidden}.
2207
2208@item
2209Types, but not their members, are not hidden by default.
2210
2211@item
2212The One Definition Rule is relaxed for types without explicit
2213visibility specifications that are defined in more than one different
2214shared object: those declarations are permitted if they would have
2215been permitted when this option was not used.
2216@end enumerate
2217
2218In new code it is better to use @option{-fvisibility=hidden} and
2219export those classes that are intended to be externally visible.
2220Unfortunately it is possible for code to rely, perhaps accidentally,
2221on the Visual Studio behavior.
2222
2223Among the consequences of these changes are that static data members
2224of the same type with the same name but defined in different shared
2225objects will be different, so changing one will not change the other;
2226and that pointers to function members defined in different shared
2227objects may not compare equal.  When this flag is given, it is a
2228violation of the ODR to define types with the same name differently.
2229
2230@item -fno-weak
2231@opindex fno-weak
2232Do not use weak symbol support, even if it is provided by the linker.
2233By default, G++ will use weak symbols if they are available.  This
2234option exists only for testing, and should not be used by end-users;
2235it will result in inferior code and has no benefits.  This option may
2236be removed in a future release of G++.
2237
2238@item -nostdinc++
2239@opindex nostdinc++
2240Do not search for header files in the standard directories specific to
2241C++, but do still search the other standard directories.  (This option
2242is used when building the C++ library.)
2243@end table
2244
2245In addition, these optimization, warning, and code generation options
2246have meanings only for C++ programs:
2247
2248@table @gcctabopt
2249@item -fno-default-inline
2250@opindex fno-default-inline
2251Do not assume @samp{inline} for functions defined inside a class scope.
2252@xref{Optimize Options,,Options That Control Optimization}.  Note that these
2253functions will have linkage like inline functions; they just won't be
2254inlined by default.
2255
2256@item -Wabi @r{(C, Objective-C, C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2257@opindex Wabi
2258@opindex Wno-abi
2259Warn when G++ generates code that is probably not compatible with the
2260vendor-neutral C++ ABI@.  Although an effort has been made to warn about
2261all such cases, there are probably some cases that are not warned about,
2262even though G++ is generating incompatible code.  There may also be
2263cases where warnings are emitted even though the code that is generated
2264will be compatible.
2265
2266You should rewrite your code to avoid these warnings if you are
2267concerned about the fact that code generated by G++ may not be binary
2268compatible with code generated by other compilers.
2269
2270The known incompatibilities in @option{-fabi-version=2} (the default) include:
2271
2272@itemize @bullet
2273
2274@item
2275A template with a non-type template parameter of reference type is
2276mangled incorrectly:
2277@smallexample
2278extern int N;
2279template <int &> struct S @{@};
2280void n (S<N>) @{2@}
2281@end smallexample
2282
2283This is fixed in @option{-fabi-version=3}.
2284
2285@item
2286SIMD vector types declared using @code{__attribute ((vector_size))} are
2287mangled in a non-standard way that does not allow for overloading of
2288functions taking vectors of different sizes.
2289
2290The mangling is changed in @option{-fabi-version=4}.
2291@end itemize
2292
2293The known incompatibilities in @option{-fabi-version=1} include:
2294
2295@itemize @bullet
2296
2297@item
2298Incorrect handling of tail-padding for bit-fields.  G++ may attempt to
2299pack data into the same byte as a base class.  For example:
2300
2301@smallexample
2302struct A @{ virtual void f(); int f1 : 1; @};
2303struct B : public A @{ int f2 : 1; @};
2304@end smallexample
2305
2306@noindent
2307In this case, G++ will place @code{B::f2} into the same byte
2308as@code{A::f1}; other compilers will not.  You can avoid this problem
2309by explicitly padding @code{A} so that its size is a multiple of the
2310byte size on your platform; that will cause G++ and other compilers to
2311layout @code{B} identically.
2312
2313@item
2314Incorrect handling of tail-padding for virtual bases.  G++ does not use
2315tail padding when laying out virtual bases.  For example:
2316
2317@smallexample
2318struct A @{ virtual void f(); char c1; @};
2319struct B @{ B(); char c2; @};
2320struct C : public A, public virtual B @{@};
2321@end smallexample
2322
2323@noindent
2324In this case, G++ will not place @code{B} into the tail-padding for
2325@code{A}; other compilers will.  You can avoid this problem by
2326explicitly padding @code{A} so that its size is a multiple of its
2327alignment (ignoring virtual base classes); that will cause G++ and other
2328compilers to layout @code{C} identically.
2329
2330@item
2331Incorrect handling of bit-fields with declared widths greater than that
2332of their underlying types, when the bit-fields appear in a union.  For
2333example:
2334
2335@smallexample
2336union U @{ int i : 4096; @};
2337@end smallexample
2338
2339@noindent
2340Assuming that an @code{int} does not have 4096 bits, G++ will make the
2341union too small by the number of bits in an @code{int}.
2342
2343@item
2344Empty classes can be placed at incorrect offsets.  For example:
2345
2346@smallexample
2347struct A @{@};
2348
2349struct B @{
2350  A a;
2351  virtual void f ();
2352@};
2353
2354struct C : public B, public A @{@};
2355@end smallexample
2356
2357@noindent
2358G++ will place the @code{A} base class of @code{C} at a nonzero offset;
2359it should be placed at offset zero.  G++ mistakenly believes that the
2360@code{A} data member of @code{B} is already at offset zero.
2361
2362@item
2363Names of template functions whose types involve @code{typename} or
2364template template parameters can be mangled incorrectly.
2365
2366@smallexample
2367template <typename Q>
2368void f(typename Q::X) @{@}
2369
2370template <template <typename> class Q>
2371void f(typename Q<int>::X) @{@}
2372@end smallexample
2373
2374@noindent
2375Instantiations of these templates may be mangled incorrectly.
2376
2377@end itemize
2378
2379It also warns psABI related changes.  The known psABI changes at this
2380point include:
2381
2382@itemize @bullet
2383
2384@item
2385For SYSV/x86-64, when passing union with long double, it is changed to
2386pass in memory as specified in psABI.  For example:
2387
2388@smallexample
2389union U @{
2390  long double ld;
2391  int i;
2392@};
2393@end smallexample
2394
2395@noindent
2396@code{union U} will always be passed in memory.
2397
2398@end itemize
2399
2400@item -Wctor-dtor-privacy @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2401@opindex Wctor-dtor-privacy
2402@opindex Wno-ctor-dtor-privacy
2403Warn when a class seems unusable because all the constructors or
2404destructors in that class are private, and it has neither friends nor
2405public static member functions.
2406
2407@item -Wdelete-non-virtual-dtor @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2408@opindex Wdelete-non-virtual-dtor
2409@opindex Wno-delete-non-virtual-dtor
2410Warn when @samp{delete} is used to destroy an instance of a class that
2411has virtual functions and non-virtual destructor. It is unsafe to delete
2412an instance of a derived class through a pointer to a base class if the
2413base class does not have a virtual destructor.  This warning is enabled
2414by @option{-Wall}.
2415
2416@item -Wnarrowing @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2417@opindex Wnarrowing
2418@opindex Wno-narrowing
2419Warn when a narrowing conversion prohibited by C++11 occurs within
2420@samp{@{ @}}, e.g.
2421
2422@smallexample
2423int i = @{ 2.2 @}; // error: narrowing from double to int
2424@end smallexample
2425
2426This flag is included in @option{-Wall} and @option{-Wc++11-compat}.
2427
2428With -std=c++11, @option{-Wno-narrowing} suppresses the diagnostic
2429required by the standard.  Note that this does not affect the meaning
2430of well-formed code; narrowing conversions are still considered
2431ill-formed in SFINAE context.
2432
2433@item -Wnoexcept @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2434@opindex Wnoexcept
2435@opindex Wno-noexcept
2436Warn when a noexcept-expression evaluates to false because of a call
2437to a function that does not have a non-throwing exception
2438specification (i.e. @samp{throw()} or @samp{noexcept}) but is known by
2439the compiler to never throw an exception.
2440
2441@item -Wnon-virtual-dtor @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2442@opindex Wnon-virtual-dtor
2443@opindex Wno-non-virtual-dtor
2444Warn when a class has virtual functions and accessible non-virtual
2445destructor, in which case it would be possible but unsafe to delete
2446an instance of a derived class through a pointer to the base class.
2447This warning is also enabled if @option{-Weffc++} is specified.
2448
2449@item -Wreorder @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2450@opindex Wreorder
2451@opindex Wno-reorder
2452@cindex reordering, warning
2453@cindex warning for reordering of member initializers
2454Warn when the order of member initializers given in the code does not
2455match the order in which they must be executed.  For instance:
2456
2457@smallexample
2458struct A @{
2459  int i;
2460  int j;
2461  A(): j (0), i (1) @{ @}
2462@};
2463@end smallexample
2464
2465The compiler will rearrange the member initializers for @samp{i}
2466and @samp{j} to match the declaration order of the members, emitting
2467a warning to that effect.  This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
2468@end table
2469
2470The following @option{-W@dots{}} options are not affected by @option{-Wall}.
2471
2472@table @gcctabopt
2473@item -Weffc++ @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2474@opindex Weffc++
2475@opindex Wno-effc++
2476Warn about violations of the following style guidelines from Scott Meyers'
2477@cite{Effective C++, Second Edition} book:
2478
2479@itemize @bullet
2480@item
2481Item 11:  Define a copy constructor and an assignment operator for classes
2482with dynamically allocated memory.
2483
2484@item
2485Item 12:  Prefer initialization to assignment in constructors.
2486
2487@item
2488Item 14:  Make destructors virtual in base classes.
2489
2490@item
2491Item 15:  Have @code{operator=} return a reference to @code{*this}.
2492
2493@item
2494Item 23:  Don't try to return a reference when you must return an object.
2495
2496@end itemize
2497
2498Also warn about violations of the following style guidelines from
2499Scott Meyers' @cite{More Effective C++} book:
2500
2501@itemize @bullet
2502@item
2503Item 6:  Distinguish between prefix and postfix forms of increment and
2504decrement operators.
2505
2506@item
2507Item 7:  Never overload @code{&&}, @code{||}, or @code{,}.
2508
2509@end itemize
2510
2511When selecting this option, be aware that the standard library
2512headers do not obey all of these guidelines; use @samp{grep -v}
2513to filter out those warnings.
2514
2515@item -Wstrict-null-sentinel @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2516@opindex Wstrict-null-sentinel
2517@opindex Wno-strict-null-sentinel
2518Warn also about the use of an uncasted @code{NULL} as sentinel.  When
2519compiling only with GCC this is a valid sentinel, as @code{NULL} is defined
2520to @code{__null}.  Although it is a null pointer constant not a null pointer,
2521it is guaranteed to be of the same size as a pointer.  But this use is
2522not portable across different compilers.
2523
2524@item -Wno-non-template-friend @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2525@opindex Wno-non-template-friend
2526@opindex Wnon-template-friend
2527Disable warnings when non-templatized friend functions are declared
2528within a template.  Since the advent of explicit template specification
2529support in G++, if the name of the friend is an unqualified-id (i.e.,
2530@samp{friend foo(int)}), the C++ language specification demands that the
2531friend declare or define an ordinary, nontemplate function.  (Section
253214.5.3).  Before G++ implemented explicit specification, unqualified-ids
2533could be interpreted as a particular specialization of a templatized
2534function.  Because this non-conforming behavior is no longer the default
2535behavior for G++, @option{-Wnon-template-friend} allows the compiler to
2536check existing code for potential trouble spots and is on by default.
2537This new compiler behavior can be turned off with
2538@option{-Wno-non-template-friend}, which keeps the conformant compiler code
2539but disables the helpful warning.
2540
2541@item -Wold-style-cast @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2542@opindex Wold-style-cast
2543@opindex Wno-old-style-cast
2544Warn if an old-style (C-style) cast to a non-void type is used within
2545a C++ program.  The new-style casts (@samp{dynamic_cast},
2546@samp{static_cast}, @samp{reinterpret_cast}, and @samp{const_cast}) are
2547less vulnerable to unintended effects and much easier to search for.
2548
2549@item -Woverloaded-virtual @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2550@opindex Woverloaded-virtual
2551@opindex Wno-overloaded-virtual
2552@cindex overloaded virtual function, warning
2553@cindex warning for overloaded virtual function
2554Warn when a function declaration hides virtual functions from a
2555base class.  For example, in:
2556
2557@smallexample
2558struct A @{
2559  virtual void f();
2560@};
2561
2562struct B: public A @{
2563  void f(int);
2564@};
2565@end smallexample
2566
2567the @code{A} class version of @code{f} is hidden in @code{B}, and code
2568like:
2569
2570@smallexample
2571B* b;
2572b->f();
2573@end smallexample
2574
2575will fail to compile.
2576
2577@item -Wno-pmf-conversions @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2578@opindex Wno-pmf-conversions
2579@opindex Wpmf-conversions
2580Disable the diagnostic for converting a bound pointer to member function
2581to a plain pointer.
2582
2583@item -Wsign-promo @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
2584@opindex Wsign-promo
2585@opindex Wno-sign-promo
2586Warn when overload resolution chooses a promotion from unsigned or
2587enumerated type to a signed type, over a conversion to an unsigned type of
2588the same size.  Previous versions of G++ would try to preserve
2589unsignedness, but the standard mandates the current behavior.
2590
2591@smallexample
2592struct A @{
2593  operator int ();
2594  A& operator = (int);
2595@};
2596
2597main ()
2598@{
2599  A a,b;
2600  a = b;
2601@}
2602@end smallexample
2603
2604In this example, G++ will synthesize a default @samp{A& operator =
2605(const A&);}, while cfront will use the user-defined @samp{operator =}.
2606@end table
2607
2608@node Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options
2609@section Options Controlling Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialects
2610
2611@cindex compiler options, Objective-C and Objective-C++
2612@cindex Objective-C and Objective-C++ options, command-line
2613@cindex options, Objective-C and Objective-C++
2614(NOTE: This manual does not describe the Objective-C and Objective-C++
2615languages themselves.  @xref{Standards,,Language Standards
2616Supported by GCC}, for references.)
2617
2618This section describes the command-line options that are only meaningful
2619for Objective-C and Objective-C++ programs, but you can also use most of
2620the language-independent GNU compiler options.
2621For example, you might compile a file @code{some_class.m} like this:
2622
2623@smallexample
2624gcc -g -fgnu-runtime -O -c some_class.m
2625@end smallexample
2626
2627@noindent
2628In this example, @option{-fgnu-runtime} is an option meant only for
2629Objective-C and Objective-C++ programs; you can use the other options with
2630any language supported by GCC@.
2631
2632Note that since Objective-C is an extension of the C language, Objective-C
2633compilations may also use options specific to the C front-end (e.g.,
2634@option{-Wtraditional}).  Similarly, Objective-C++ compilations may use
2635C++-specific options (e.g., @option{-Wabi}).
2636
2637Here is a list of options that are @emph{only} for compiling Objective-C
2638and Objective-C++ programs:
2639
2640@table @gcctabopt
2641@item -fconstant-string-class=@var{class-name}
2642@opindex fconstant-string-class
2643Use @var{class-name} as the name of the class to instantiate for each
2644literal string specified with the syntax @code{@@"@dots{}"}.  The default
2645class name is @code{NXConstantString} if the GNU runtime is being used, and
2646@code{NSConstantString} if the NeXT runtime is being used (see below).  The
2647@option{-fconstant-cfstrings} option, if also present, will override the
2648@option{-fconstant-string-class} setting and cause @code{@@"@dots{}"} literals
2649to be laid out as constant CoreFoundation strings.
2650
2651@item -fgnu-runtime
2652@opindex fgnu-runtime
2653Generate object code compatible with the standard GNU Objective-C
2654runtime.  This is the default for most types of systems.
2655
2656@item -fnext-runtime
2657@opindex fnext-runtime
2658Generate output compatible with the NeXT runtime.  This is the default
2659for NeXT-based systems, including Darwin and Mac OS X@.  The macro
2660@code{__NEXT_RUNTIME__} is predefined if (and only if) this option is
2661used.
2662
2663@item -fno-nil-receivers
2664@opindex fno-nil-receivers
2665Assume that all Objective-C message dispatches (@code{[receiver
2666message:arg]}) in this translation unit ensure that the receiver is
2667not @code{nil}.  This allows for more efficient entry points in the
2668runtime to be used.  This option is only available in conjunction with
2669the NeXT runtime and ABI version 0 or 1.
2670
2671@item -fobjc-abi-version=@var{n}
2672@opindex fobjc-abi-version
2673Use version @var{n} of the Objective-C ABI for the selected runtime.
2674This option is currently supported only for the NeXT runtime.  In that
2675case, Version 0 is the traditional (32-bit) ABI without support for
2676properties and other Objective-C 2.0 additions.  Version 1 is the
2677traditional (32-bit) ABI with support for properties and other
2678Objective-C 2.0 additions.  Version 2 is the modern (64-bit) ABI.  If
2679nothing is specified, the default is Version 0 on 32-bit target
2680machines, and Version 2 on 64-bit target machines.
2681
2682@item -fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors
2683@opindex fobjc-call-cxx-cdtors
2684For each Objective-C class, check if any of its instance variables is a
2685C++ object with a non-trivial default constructor.  If so, synthesize a
2686special @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} instance method which will run
2687non-trivial default constructors on any such instance variables, in order,
2688and then return @code{self}.  Similarly, check if any instance variable
2689is a C++ object with a non-trivial destructor, and if so, synthesize a
2690special @code{- (void) .cxx_destruct} method which will run
2691all such default destructors, in reverse order.
2692
2693The @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} and @code{- (void) .cxx_destruct}
2694methods thusly generated will only operate on instance variables
2695declared in the current Objective-C class, and not those inherited
2696from superclasses.  It is the responsibility of the Objective-C
2697runtime to invoke all such methods in an object's inheritance
2698hierarchy.  The @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} methods will be invoked
2699by the runtime immediately after a new object instance is allocated;
2700the @code{- (void) .cxx_destruct} methods will be invoked immediately
2701before the runtime deallocates an object instance.
2702
2703As of this writing, only the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.4 and later has
2704support for invoking the @code{- (id) .cxx_construct} and
2705@code{- (void) .cxx_destruct} methods.
2706
2707@item -fobjc-direct-dispatch
2708@opindex fobjc-direct-dispatch
2709Allow fast jumps to the message dispatcher.  On Darwin this is
2710accomplished via the comm page.
2711
2712@item -fobjc-exceptions
2713@opindex fobjc-exceptions
2714Enable syntactic support for structured exception handling in
2715Objective-C, similar to what is offered by C++ and Java.  This option
2716is required to use the Objective-C keywords @code{@@try},
2717@code{@@throw}, @code{@@catch}, @code{@@finally} and
2718@code{@@synchronized}.  This option is available with both the GNU
2719runtime and the NeXT runtime (but not available in conjunction with
2720the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.2 and earlier).
2721
2722@item -fobjc-gc
2723@opindex fobjc-gc
2724Enable garbage collection (GC) in Objective-C and Objective-C++
2725programs.  This option is only available with the NeXT runtime; the
2726GNU runtime has a different garbage collection implementation that
2727does not require special compiler flags.
2728
2729@item -fobjc-nilcheck
2730@opindex fobjc-nilcheck
2731For the NeXT runtime with version 2 of the ABI, check for a nil
2732receiver in method invocations before doing the actual method call.
2733This is the default and can be disabled using
2734@option{-fno-objc-nilcheck}.  Class methods and super calls are never
2735checked for nil in this way no matter what this flag is set to.
2736Currently this flag does nothing when the GNU runtime, or an older
2737version of the NeXT runtime ABI, is used.
2738
2739@item -fobjc-std=objc1
2740@opindex fobjc-std
2741Conform to the language syntax of Objective-C 1.0, the language
2742recognized by GCC 4.0.  This only affects the Objective-C additions to
2743the C/C++ language; it does not affect conformance to C/C++ standards,
2744which is controlled by the separate C/C++ dialect option flags.  When
2745this option is used with the Objective-C or Objective-C++ compiler,
2746any Objective-C syntax that is not recognized by GCC 4.0 is rejected.
2747This is useful if you need to make sure that your Objective-C code can
2748be compiled with older versions of GCC.
2749
2750@item -freplace-objc-classes
2751@opindex freplace-objc-classes
2752Emit a special marker instructing @command{ld(1)} not to statically link in
2753the resulting object file, and allow @command{dyld(1)} to load it in at
2754run time instead.  This is used in conjunction with the Fix-and-Continue
2755debugging mode, where the object file in question may be recompiled and
2756dynamically reloaded in the course of program execution, without the need
2757to restart the program itself.  Currently, Fix-and-Continue functionality
2758is only available in conjunction with the NeXT runtime on Mac OS X 10.3
2759and later.
2760
2761@item -fzero-link
2762@opindex fzero-link
2763When compiling for the NeXT runtime, the compiler ordinarily replaces calls
2764to @code{objc_getClass("@dots{}")} (when the name of the class is known at
2765compile time) with static class references that get initialized at load time,
2766which improves run-time performance.  Specifying the @option{-fzero-link} flag
2767suppresses this behavior and causes calls to @code{objc_getClass("@dots{}")}
2768to be retained.  This is useful in Zero-Link debugging mode, since it allows
2769for individual class implementations to be modified during program execution.
2770The GNU runtime currently always retains calls to @code{objc_get_class("@dots{}")}
2771regardless of command-line options.
2772
2773@item -gen-decls
2774@opindex gen-decls
2775Dump interface declarations for all classes seen in the source file to a
2776file named @file{@var{sourcename}.decl}.
2777
2778@item -Wassign-intercept @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2779@opindex Wassign-intercept
2780@opindex Wno-assign-intercept
2781Warn whenever an Objective-C assignment is being intercepted by the
2782garbage collector.
2783
2784@item -Wno-protocol @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2785@opindex Wno-protocol
2786@opindex Wprotocol
2787If a class is declared to implement a protocol, a warning is issued for
2788every method in the protocol that is not implemented by the class.  The
2789default behavior is to issue a warning for every method not explicitly
2790implemented in the class, even if a method implementation is inherited
2791from the superclass.  If you use the @option{-Wno-protocol} option, then
2792methods inherited from the superclass are considered to be implemented,
2793and no warning is issued for them.
2794
2795@item -Wselector @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2796@opindex Wselector
2797@opindex Wno-selector
2798Warn if multiple methods of different types for the same selector are
2799found during compilation.  The check is performed on the list of methods
2800in the final stage of compilation.  Additionally, a check is performed
2801for each selector appearing in a @code{@@selector(@dots{})}
2802expression, and a corresponding method for that selector has been found
2803during compilation.  Because these checks scan the method table only at
2804the end of compilation, these warnings are not produced if the final
2805stage of compilation is not reached, for example because an error is
2806found during compilation, or because the @option{-fsyntax-only} option is
2807being used.
2808
2809@item -Wstrict-selector-match @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2810@opindex Wstrict-selector-match
2811@opindex Wno-strict-selector-match
2812Warn if multiple methods with differing argument and/or return types are
2813found for a given selector when attempting to send a message using this
2814selector to a receiver of type @code{id} or @code{Class}.  When this flag
2815is off (which is the default behavior), the compiler will omit such warnings
2816if any differences found are confined to types that share the same size
2817and alignment.
2818
2819@item -Wundeclared-selector @r{(Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
2820@opindex Wundeclared-selector
2821@opindex Wno-undeclared-selector
2822Warn if a @code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression referring to an
2823undeclared selector is found.  A selector is considered undeclared if no
2824method with that name has been declared before the
2825@code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression, either explicitly in an
2826@code{@@interface} or @code{@@protocol} declaration, or implicitly in
2827an @code{@@implementation} section.  This option always performs its
2828checks as soon as a @code{@@selector(@dots{})} expression is found,
2829while @option{-Wselector} only performs its checks in the final stage of
2830compilation.  This also enforces the coding style convention
2831that methods and selectors must be declared before being used.
2832
2833@item -print-objc-runtime-info
2834@opindex print-objc-runtime-info
2835Generate C header describing the largest structure that is passed by
2836value, if any.
2837
2838@end table
2839
2840@node Language Independent Options
2841@section Options to Control Diagnostic Messages Formatting
2842@cindex options to control diagnostics formatting
2843@cindex diagnostic messages
2844@cindex message formatting
2845
2846Traditionally, diagnostic messages have been formatted irrespective of
2847the output device's aspect (e.g.@: its width, @dots{}).  The options described
2848below can be used to control the diagnostic messages formatting
2849algorithm, e.g.@: how many characters per line, how often source location
2850information should be reported.  Right now, only the C++ front end can
2851honor these options.  However it is expected, in the near future, that
2852the remaining front ends would be able to digest them correctly.
2853
2854@table @gcctabopt
2855@item -fmessage-length=@var{n}
2856@opindex fmessage-length
2857Try to format error messages so that they fit on lines of about @var{n}
2858characters.  The default is 72 characters for @command{g++} and 0 for the rest of
2859the front ends supported by GCC@.  If @var{n} is zero, then no
2860line-wrapping will be done; each error message will appear on a single
2861line.
2862
2863@opindex fdiagnostics-show-location
2864@item -fdiagnostics-show-location=once
2865Only meaningful in line-wrapping mode.  Instructs the diagnostic messages
2866reporter to emit @emph{once} source location information; that is, in
2867case the message is too long to fit on a single physical line and has to
2868be wrapped, the source location won't be emitted (as prefix) again,
2869over and over, in subsequent continuation lines.  This is the default
2870behavior.
2871
2872@item -fdiagnostics-show-location=every-line
2873Only meaningful in line-wrapping mode.  Instructs the diagnostic
2874messages reporter to emit the same source location information (as
2875prefix) for physical lines that result from the process of breaking
2876a message which is too long to fit on a single line.
2877
2878@item -fno-diagnostics-show-option
2879@opindex fno-diagnostics-show-option
2880@opindex fdiagnostics-show-option
2881By default, each diagnostic emitted includes text indicating the
2882command-line option that directly controls the diagnostic (if such an
2883option is known to the diagnostic machinery).  Specifying the
2884@option{-fno-diagnostics-show-option} flag suppresses that behavior.
2885
2886@end table
2887
2888@node Warning Options
2889@section Options to Request or Suppress Warnings
2890@cindex options to control warnings
2891@cindex warning messages
2892@cindex messages, warning
2893@cindex suppressing warnings
2894
2895Warnings are diagnostic messages that report constructions that
2896are not inherently erroneous but that are risky or suggest there
2897may have been an error.
2898
2899The following language-independent options do not enable specific
2900warnings but control the kinds of diagnostics produced by GCC.
2901
2902@table @gcctabopt
2903@cindex syntax checking
2904@item -fsyntax-only
2905@opindex fsyntax-only
2906Check the code for syntax errors, but don't do anything beyond that.
2907
2908@item -fmax-errors=@var{n}
2909@opindex fmax-errors
2910Limits the maximum number of error messages to @var{n}, at which point
2911GCC bails out rather than attempting to continue processing the source
2912code.  If @var{n} is 0 (the default), there is no limit on the number
2913of error messages produced.  If @option{-Wfatal-errors} is also
2914specified, then @option{-Wfatal-errors} takes precedence over this
2915option.
2916
2917@item -w
2918@opindex w
2919Inhibit all warning messages.
2920
2921@item -Werror
2922@opindex Werror
2923@opindex Wno-error
2924Make all warnings into errors.
2925
2926@item -Werror=
2927@opindex Werror=
2928@opindex Wno-error=
2929Make the specified warning into an error.  The specifier for a warning
2930is appended, for example @option{-Werror=switch} turns the warnings
2931controlled by @option{-Wswitch} into errors.  This switch takes a
2932negative form, to be used to negate @option{-Werror} for specific
2933warnings, for example @option{-Wno-error=switch} makes
2934@option{-Wswitch} warnings not be errors, even when @option{-Werror}
2935is in effect.
2936
2937The warning message for each controllable warning includes the
2938option that controls the warning.  That option can then be used with
2939@option{-Werror=} and @option{-Wno-error=} as described above.
2940(Printing of the option in the warning message can be disabled using the
2941@option{-fno-diagnostics-show-option} flag.)
2942
2943Note that specifying @option{-Werror=}@var{foo} automatically implies
2944@option{-W}@var{foo}.  However, @option{-Wno-error=}@var{foo} does not
2945imply anything.
2946
2947@item -Wfatal-errors
2948@opindex Wfatal-errors
2949@opindex Wno-fatal-errors
2950This option causes the compiler to abort compilation on the first error
2951occurred rather than trying to keep going and printing further error
2952messages.
2953
2954@end table
2955
2956You can request many specific warnings with options beginning
2957@samp{-W}, for example @option{-Wimplicit} to request warnings on
2958implicit declarations.  Each of these specific warning options also
2959has a negative form beginning @samp{-Wno-} to turn off warnings; for
2960example, @option{-Wno-implicit}.  This manual lists only one of the
2961two forms, whichever is not the default.  For further,
2962language-specific options also refer to @ref{C++ Dialect Options} and
2963@ref{Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options}.
2964
2965When an unrecognized warning option is requested (e.g.,
2966@option{-Wunknown-warning}), GCC will emit a diagnostic stating
2967that the option is not recognized.  However, if the @option{-Wno-} form
2968is used, the behavior is slightly different: No diagnostic will be
2969produced for @option{-Wno-unknown-warning} unless other diagnostics
2970are being produced.  This allows the use of new @option{-Wno-} options
2971with old compilers, but if something goes wrong, the compiler will
2972warn that an unrecognized option was used.
2973
2974@table @gcctabopt
2975@item -pedantic
2976@opindex pedantic
2977Issue all the warnings demanded by strict ISO C and ISO C++;
2978reject all programs that use forbidden extensions, and some other
2979programs that do not follow ISO C and ISO C++.  For ISO C, follows the
2980version of the ISO C standard specified by any @option{-std} option used.
2981
2982Valid ISO C and ISO C++ programs should compile properly with or without
2983this option (though a rare few will require @option{-ansi} or a
2984@option{-std} option specifying the required version of ISO C)@.  However,
2985without this option, certain GNU extensions and traditional C and C++
2986features are supported as well.  With this option, they are rejected.
2987
2988@option{-pedantic} does not cause warning messages for use of the
2989alternate keywords whose names begin and end with @samp{__}.  Pedantic
2990warnings are also disabled in the expression that follows
2991@code{__extension__}.  However, only system header files should use
2992these escape routes; application programs should avoid them.
2993@xref{Alternate Keywords}.
2994
2995Some users try to use @option{-pedantic} to check programs for strict ISO
2996C conformance.  They soon find that it does not do quite what they want:
2997it finds some non-ISO practices, but not all---only those for which
2998ISO C @emph{requires} a diagnostic, and some others for which
2999diagnostics have been added.
3000
3001A feature to report any failure to conform to ISO C might be useful in
3002some instances, but would require considerable additional work and would
3003be quite different from @option{-pedantic}.  We don't have plans to
3004support such a feature in the near future.
3005
3006Where the standard specified with @option{-std} represents a GNU
3007extended dialect of C, such as @samp{gnu90} or @samp{gnu99}, there is a
3008corresponding @dfn{base standard}, the version of ISO C on which the GNU
3009extended dialect is based.  Warnings from @option{-pedantic} are given
3010where they are required by the base standard.  (It would not make sense
3011for such warnings to be given only for features not in the specified GNU
3012C dialect, since by definition the GNU dialects of C include all
3013features the compiler supports with the given option, and there would be
3014nothing to warn about.)
3015
3016@item -pedantic-errors
3017@opindex pedantic-errors
3018Like @option{-pedantic}, except that errors are produced rather than
3019warnings.
3020
3021@item -Wall
3022@opindex Wall
3023@opindex Wno-all
3024This enables all the warnings about constructions that some users
3025consider questionable, and that are easy to avoid (or modify to
3026prevent the warning), even in conjunction with macros.  This also
3027enables some language-specific warnings described in @ref{C++ Dialect
3028Options} and @ref{Objective-C and Objective-C++ Dialect Options}.
3029
3030@option{-Wall} turns on the following warning flags:
3031
3032@gccoptlist{-Waddress   @gol
3033-Warray-bounds @r{(only with} @option{-O2}@r{)}  @gol
3034-Wc++11-compat  @gol
3035-Wchar-subscripts  @gol
3036-Wenum-compare @r{(in C/Objc; this is on by default in C++)} @gol
3037-Wimplicit-int @r{(C and Objective-C only)} @gol
3038-Wimplicit-function-declaration @r{(C and Objective-C only)} @gol
3039-Wcomment  @gol
3040-Wformat   @gol
3041-Wmain @r{(only for C/ObjC and unless} @option{-ffreestanding}@r{)}  @gol
3042-Wmaybe-uninitialized @gol
3043-Wmissing-braces  @gol
3044-Wnonnull  @gol
3045-Wparentheses  @gol
3046-Wpointer-sign  @gol
3047-Wreorder   @gol
3048-Wreturn-type  @gol
3049-Wsequence-point  @gol
3050-Wsign-compare @r{(only in C++)}  @gol
3051-Wstrict-aliasing  @gol
3052-Wstrict-overflow=1  @gol
3053-Wswitch  @gol
3054-Wtrigraphs  @gol
3055-Wuninitialized  @gol
3056-Wunknown-pragmas  @gol
3057-Wunused-function  @gol
3058-Wunused-label     @gol
3059-Wunused-value     @gol
3060-Wunused-variable  @gol
3061-Wvolatile-register-var @gol
3062}
3063
3064Note that some warning flags are not implied by @option{-Wall}.  Some of
3065them warn about constructions that users generally do not consider
3066questionable, but which occasionally you might wish to check for;
3067others warn about constructions that are necessary or hard to avoid in
3068some cases, and there is no simple way to modify the code to suppress
3069the warning. Some of them are enabled by @option{-Wextra} but many of
3070them must be enabled individually.
3071
3072@item -Wextra
3073@opindex W
3074@opindex Wextra
3075@opindex Wno-extra
3076This enables some extra warning flags that are not enabled by
3077@option{-Wall}. (This option used to be called @option{-W}.  The older
3078name is still supported, but the newer name is more descriptive.)
3079
3080@gccoptlist{-Wclobbered  @gol
3081-Wempty-body  @gol
3082-Wignored-qualifiers @gol
3083-Wmissing-field-initializers  @gol
3084-Wmissing-parameter-type @r{(C only)}  @gol
3085-Wold-style-declaration @r{(C only)}  @gol
3086-Woverride-init  @gol
3087-Wsign-compare  @gol
3088-Wtype-limits  @gol
3089-Wuninitialized  @gol
3090-Wunused-parameter @r{(only with} @option{-Wunused} @r{or} @option{-Wall}@r{)} @gol
3091-Wunused-but-set-parameter @r{(only with} @option{-Wunused} @r{or} @option{-Wall}@r{)}  @gol
3092}
3093
3094The option @option{-Wextra} also prints warning messages for the
3095following cases:
3096
3097@itemize @bullet
3098
3099@item
3100A pointer is compared against integer zero with @samp{<}, @samp{<=},
3101@samp{>}, or @samp{>=}.
3102
3103@item
3104(C++ only) An enumerator and a non-enumerator both appear in a
3105conditional expression.
3106
3107@item
3108(C++ only) Ambiguous virtual bases.
3109
3110@item
3111(C++ only) Subscripting an array that has been declared @samp{register}.
3112
3113@item
3114(C++ only) Taking the address of a variable that has been declared
3115@samp{register}.
3116
3117@item
3118(C++ only) A base class is not initialized in a derived class' copy
3119constructor.
3120
3121@end itemize
3122
3123@item -Wchar-subscripts
3124@opindex Wchar-subscripts
3125@opindex Wno-char-subscripts
3126Warn if an array subscript has type @code{char}.  This is a common cause
3127of error, as programmers often forget that this type is signed on some
3128machines.
3129This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3130
3131@item -Wcomment
3132@opindex Wcomment
3133@opindex Wno-comment
3134Warn whenever a comment-start sequence @samp{/*} appears in a @samp{/*}
3135comment, or whenever a Backslash-Newline appears in a @samp{//} comment.
3136This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3137
3138@item -Wno-coverage-mismatch
3139@opindex Wno-coverage-mismatch
3140Warn if feedback profiles do not match when using the
3141@option{-fprofile-use} option.
3142If a source file was changed between @option{-fprofile-gen} and
3143@option{-fprofile-use}, the files with the profile feedback can fail
3144to match the source file and GCC cannot use the profile feedback
3145information.  By default, this warning is enabled and is treated as an
3146error.  @option{-Wno-coverage-mismatch} can be used to disable the
3147warning or @option{-Wno-error=coverage-mismatch} can be used to
3148disable the error.  Disabling the error for this warning can result in
3149poorly optimized code and is useful only in the
3150case of very minor changes such as bug fixes to an existing code-base.
3151Completely disabling the warning is not recommended.
3152
3153@item -Wno-cpp
3154@r{(C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++ and Fortran only)}
3155
3156Suppress warning messages emitted by @code{#warning} directives.
3157
3158@item -Wdouble-promotion @r{(C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
3159@opindex Wdouble-promotion
3160@opindex Wno-double-promotion
3161Give a warning when a value of type @code{float} is implicitly
3162promoted to @code{double}.  CPUs with a 32-bit ``single-precision''
3163floating-point unit implement @code{float} in hardware, but emulate
3164@code{double} in software.  On such a machine, doing computations
3165using @code{double} values is much more expensive because of the
3166overhead required for software emulation.
3167
3168It is easy to accidentally do computations with @code{double} because
3169floating-point literals are implicitly of type @code{double}.  For
3170example, in:
3171@smallexample
3172@group
3173float area(float radius)
3174@{
3175   return 3.14159 * radius * radius;
3176@}
3177@end group
3178@end smallexample
3179the compiler will perform the entire computation with @code{double}
3180because the floating-point literal is a @code{double}.
3181
3182@item -Wformat
3183@opindex Wformat
3184@opindex Wno-format
3185@opindex ffreestanding
3186@opindex fno-builtin
3187Check calls to @code{printf} and @code{scanf}, etc., to make sure that
3188the arguments supplied have types appropriate to the format string
3189specified, and that the conversions specified in the format string make
3190sense.  This includes standard functions, and others specified by format
3191attributes (@pxref{Function Attributes}), in the @code{printf},
3192@code{scanf}, @code{strftime} and @code{strfmon} (an X/Open extension,
3193not in the C standard) families (or other target-specific families).
3194Which functions are checked without format attributes having been
3195specified depends on the standard version selected, and such checks of
3196functions without the attribute specified are disabled by
3197@option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-fno-builtin}.
3198
3199The formats are checked against the format features supported by GNU
3200libc version 2.2.  These include all ISO C90 and C99 features, as well
3201as features from the Single Unix Specification and some BSD and GNU
3202extensions.  Other library implementations may not support all these
3203features; GCC does not support warning about features that go beyond a
3204particular library's limitations.  However, if @option{-pedantic} is used
3205with @option{-Wformat}, warnings will be given about format features not
3206in the selected standard version (but not for @code{strfmon} formats,
3207since those are not in any version of the C standard).  @xref{C Dialect
3208Options,,Options Controlling C Dialect}.
3209
3210Since @option{-Wformat} also checks for null format arguments for
3211several functions, @option{-Wformat} also implies @option{-Wnonnull}.
3212
3213@option{-Wformat} is included in @option{-Wall}.  For more control over some
3214aspects of format checking, the options @option{-Wformat-y2k},
3215@option{-Wno-format-extra-args}, @option{-Wno-format-zero-length},
3216@option{-Wformat-nonliteral}, @option{-Wformat-security}, and
3217@option{-Wformat=2} are available, but are not included in @option{-Wall}.
3218
3219@item -Wformat-y2k
3220@opindex Wformat-y2k
3221@opindex Wno-format-y2k
3222If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn about @code{strftime}
3223formats that may yield only a two-digit year.
3224
3225@item -Wno-format-contains-nul
3226@opindex Wno-format-contains-nul
3227@opindex Wformat-contains-nul
3228If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about format strings that
3229contain NUL bytes.
3230
3231@item -Wno-format-extra-args
3232@opindex Wno-format-extra-args
3233@opindex Wformat-extra-args
3234If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about excess arguments to a
3235@code{printf} or @code{scanf} format function.  The C standard specifies
3236that such arguments are ignored.
3237
3238Where the unused arguments lie between used arguments that are
3239specified with @samp{$} operand number specifications, normally
3240warnings are still given, since the implementation could not know what
3241type to pass to @code{va_arg} to skip the unused arguments.  However,
3242in the case of @code{scanf} formats, this option will suppress the
3243warning if the unused arguments are all pointers, since the Single
3244Unix Specification says that such unused arguments are allowed.
3245
3246@item -Wno-format-zero-length
3247@opindex Wno-format-zero-length
3248@opindex Wformat-zero-length
3249If @option{-Wformat} is specified, do not warn about zero-length formats.
3250The C standard specifies that zero-length formats are allowed.
3251
3252@item -Wformat-nonliteral
3253@opindex Wformat-nonliteral
3254@opindex Wno-format-nonliteral
3255If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn if the format string is not a
3256string literal and so cannot be checked, unless the format function
3257takes its format arguments as a @code{va_list}.
3258
3259@item -Wformat-security
3260@opindex Wformat-security
3261@opindex Wno-format-security
3262If @option{-Wformat} is specified, also warn about uses of format
3263functions that represent possible security problems.  At present, this
3264warns about calls to @code{printf} and @code{scanf} functions where the
3265format string is not a string literal and there are no format arguments,
3266as in @code{printf (foo);}.  This may be a security hole if the format
3267string came from untrusted input and contains @samp{%n}.  (This is
3268currently a subset of what @option{-Wformat-nonliteral} warns about, but
3269in future warnings may be added to @option{-Wformat-security} that are not
3270included in @option{-Wformat-nonliteral}.)
3271
3272@item -Wformat=2
3273@opindex Wformat=2
3274@opindex Wno-format=2
3275Enable @option{-Wformat} plus format checks not included in
3276@option{-Wformat}.  Currently equivalent to @samp{-Wformat
3277-Wformat-nonliteral -Wformat-security -Wformat-y2k}.
3278
3279@item -Wnonnull
3280@opindex Wnonnull
3281@opindex Wno-nonnull
3282Warn about passing a null pointer for arguments marked as
3283requiring a non-null value by the @code{nonnull} function attribute.
3284
3285@option{-Wnonnull} is included in @option{-Wall} and @option{-Wformat}.  It
3286can be disabled with the @option{-Wno-nonnull} option.
3287
3288@item -Winit-self @r{(C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
3289@opindex Winit-self
3290@opindex Wno-init-self
3291Warn about uninitialized variables that are initialized with themselves.
3292Note this option can only be used with the @option{-Wuninitialized} option.
3293
3294For example, GCC will warn about @code{i} being uninitialized in the
3295following snippet only when @option{-Winit-self} has been specified:
3296@smallexample
3297@group
3298int f()
3299@{
3300  int i = i;
3301  return i;
3302@}
3303@end group
3304@end smallexample
3305
3306@item -Wimplicit-int @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3307@opindex Wimplicit-int
3308@opindex Wno-implicit-int
3309Warn when a declaration does not specify a type.
3310This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3311
3312@item -Wimplicit-function-declaration @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3313@opindex Wimplicit-function-declaration
3314@opindex Wno-implicit-function-declaration
3315Give a warning whenever a function is used before being declared. In
3316C99 mode (@option{-std=c99} or @option{-std=gnu99}), this warning is
3317enabled by default and it is made into an error by
3318@option{-pedantic-errors}. This warning is also enabled by
3319@option{-Wall}.
3320
3321@item -Wimplicit @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3322@opindex Wimplicit
3323@opindex Wno-implicit
3324Same as @option{-Wimplicit-int} and @option{-Wimplicit-function-declaration}.
3325This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3326
3327@item -Wignored-qualifiers @r{(C and C++ only)}
3328@opindex Wignored-qualifiers
3329@opindex Wno-ignored-qualifiers
3330Warn if the return type of a function has a type qualifier
3331such as @code{const}.  For ISO C such a type qualifier has no effect,
3332since the value returned by a function is not an lvalue.
3333For C++, the warning is only emitted for scalar types or @code{void}.
3334ISO C prohibits qualified @code{void} return types on function
3335definitions, so such return types always receive a warning
3336even without this option.
3337
3338This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
3339
3340@item -Wmain
3341@opindex Wmain
3342@opindex Wno-main
3343Warn if the type of @samp{main} is suspicious.  @samp{main} should be
3344a function with external linkage, returning int, taking either zero
3345arguments, two, or three arguments of appropriate types.  This warning
3346is enabled by default in C++ and is enabled by either @option{-Wall}
3347or @option{-pedantic}.
3348
3349@item -Wmissing-braces
3350@opindex Wmissing-braces
3351@opindex Wno-missing-braces
3352Warn if an aggregate or union initializer is not fully bracketed.  In
3353the following example, the initializer for @samp{a} is not fully
3354bracketed, but that for @samp{b} is fully bracketed.
3355
3356@smallexample
3357int a[2][2] = @{ 0, 1, 2, 3 @};
3358int b[2][2] = @{ @{ 0, 1 @}, @{ 2, 3 @} @};
3359@end smallexample
3360
3361This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3362
3363@item -Wmissing-include-dirs @r{(C, C++, Objective-C and Objective-C++ only)}
3364@opindex Wmissing-include-dirs
3365@opindex Wno-missing-include-dirs
3366Warn if a user-supplied include directory does not exist.
3367
3368@item -Wparentheses
3369@opindex Wparentheses
3370@opindex Wno-parentheses
3371Warn if parentheses are omitted in certain contexts, such
3372as when there is an assignment in a context where a truth value
3373is expected, or when operators are nested whose precedence people
3374often get confused about.
3375
3376Also warn if a comparison like @samp{x<=y<=z} appears; this is
3377equivalent to @samp{(x<=y ? 1 : 0) <= z}, which is a different
3378interpretation from that of ordinary mathematical notation.
3379
3380Also warn about constructions where there may be confusion to which
3381@code{if} statement an @code{else} branch belongs.  Here is an example of
3382such a case:
3383
3384@smallexample
3385@group
3386@{
3387  if (a)
3388    if (b)
3389      foo ();
3390  else
3391    bar ();
3392@}
3393@end group
3394@end smallexample
3395
3396In C/C++, every @code{else} branch belongs to the innermost possible
3397@code{if} statement, which in this example is @code{if (b)}.  This is
3398often not what the programmer expected, as illustrated in the above
3399example by indentation the programmer chose.  When there is the
3400potential for this confusion, GCC will issue a warning when this flag
3401is specified.  To eliminate the warning, add explicit braces around
3402the innermost @code{if} statement so there is no way the @code{else}
3403could belong to the enclosing @code{if}.  The resulting code would
3404look like this:
3405
3406@smallexample
3407@group
3408@{
3409  if (a)
3410    @{
3411      if (b)
3412        foo ();
3413      else
3414        bar ();
3415    @}
3416@}
3417@end group
3418@end smallexample
3419
3420Also warn for dangerous uses of the
3421?: with omitted middle operand GNU extension. When the condition
3422in the ?: operator is a boolean expression the omitted value will
3423be always 1. Often the user expects it to be a value computed
3424inside the conditional expression instead.
3425
3426This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3427
3428@item -Wsequence-point
3429@opindex Wsequence-point
3430@opindex Wno-sequence-point
3431Warn about code that may have undefined semantics because of violations
3432of sequence point rules in the C and C++ standards.
3433
3434The C and C++ standards defines the order in which expressions in a C/C++
3435program are evaluated in terms of @dfn{sequence points}, which represent
3436a partial ordering between the execution of parts of the program: those
3437executed before the sequence point, and those executed after it.  These
3438occur after the evaluation of a full expression (one which is not part
3439of a larger expression), after the evaluation of the first operand of a
3440@code{&&}, @code{||}, @code{? :} or @code{,} (comma) operator, before a
3441function is called (but after the evaluation of its arguments and the
3442expression denoting the called function), and in certain other places.
3443Other than as expressed by the sequence point rules, the order of
3444evaluation of subexpressions of an expression is not specified.  All
3445these rules describe only a partial order rather than a total order,
3446since, for example, if two functions are called within one expression
3447with no sequence point between them, the order in which the functions
3448are called is not specified.  However, the standards committee have
3449ruled that function calls do not overlap.
3450
3451It is not specified when between sequence points modifications to the
3452values of objects take effect.  Programs whose behavior depends on this
3453have undefined behavior; the C and C++ standards specify that ``Between
3454the previous and next sequence point an object shall have its stored
3455value modified at most once by the evaluation of an expression.
3456Furthermore, the prior value shall be read only to determine the value
3457to be stored.''.  If a program breaks these rules, the results on any
3458particular implementation are entirely unpredictable.
3459
3460Examples of code with undefined behavior are @code{a = a++;}, @code{a[n]
3461= b[n++]} and @code{a[i++] = i;}.  Some more complicated cases are not
3462diagnosed by this option, and it may give an occasional false positive
3463result, but in general it has been found fairly effective at detecting
3464this sort of problem in programs.
3465
3466The standard is worded confusingly, therefore there is some debate
3467over the precise meaning of the sequence point rules in subtle cases.
3468Links to discussions of the problem, including proposed formal
3469definitions, may be found on the GCC readings page, at
3470@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/@/readings.html}.
3471
3472This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall} for C and C++.
3473
3474@item -Wreturn-type
3475@opindex Wreturn-type
3476@opindex Wno-return-type
3477Warn whenever a function is defined with a return-type that defaults
3478to @code{int}.  Also warn about any @code{return} statement with no
3479return-value in a function whose return-type is not @code{void}
3480(falling off the end of the function body is considered returning
3481without a value), and about a @code{return} statement with an
3482expression in a function whose return-type is @code{void}.
3483
3484For C++, a function without return type always produces a diagnostic
3485message, even when @option{-Wno-return-type} is specified.  The only
3486exceptions are @samp{main} and functions defined in system headers.
3487
3488This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3489
3490@item -Wswitch
3491@opindex Wswitch
3492@opindex Wno-switch
3493Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement has an index of enumerated type
3494and lacks a @code{case} for one or more of the named codes of that
3495enumeration.  (The presence of a @code{default} label prevents this
3496warning.)  @code{case} labels outside the enumeration range also
3497provoke warnings when this option is used (even if there is a
3498@code{default} label).
3499This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3500
3501@item -Wswitch-default
3502@opindex Wswitch-default
3503@opindex Wno-switch-default
3504Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement does not have a @code{default}
3505case.
3506
3507@item -Wswitch-enum
3508@opindex Wswitch-enum
3509@opindex Wno-switch-enum
3510Warn whenever a @code{switch} statement has an index of enumerated type
3511and lacks a @code{case} for one or more of the named codes of that
3512enumeration.  @code{case} labels outside the enumeration range also
3513provoke warnings when this option is used.  The only difference
3514between @option{-Wswitch} and this option is that this option gives a
3515warning about an omitted enumeration code even if there is a
3516@code{default} label.
3517
3518@item -Wsync-nand @r{(C and C++ only)}
3519@opindex Wsync-nand
3520@opindex Wno-sync-nand
3521Warn when @code{__sync_fetch_and_nand} and @code{__sync_nand_and_fetch}
3522built-in functions are used.  These functions changed semantics in GCC 4.4.
3523
3524@item -Wtrigraphs
3525@opindex Wtrigraphs
3526@opindex Wno-trigraphs
3527Warn if any trigraphs are encountered that might change the meaning of
3528the program (trigraphs within comments are not warned about).
3529This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3530
3531@item -Wunused-but-set-parameter
3532@opindex Wunused-but-set-parameter
3533@opindex Wno-unused-but-set-parameter
3534Warn whenever a function parameter is assigned to, but otherwise unused
3535(aside from its declaration).
3536
3537To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3538(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3539
3540This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wunused} together with
3541@option{-Wextra}.
3542
3543@item -Wunused-but-set-variable
3544@opindex Wunused-but-set-variable
3545@opindex Wno-unused-but-set-variable
3546Warn whenever a local variable is assigned to, but otherwise unused
3547(aside from its declaration).
3548This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3549
3550To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3551(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3552
3553This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wunused}, which is enabled
3554by @option{-Wall}.
3555
3556@item -Wunused-function
3557@opindex Wunused-function
3558@opindex Wno-unused-function
3559Warn whenever a static function is declared but not defined or a
3560non-inline static function is unused.
3561This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3562
3563@item -Wunused-label
3564@opindex Wunused-label
3565@opindex Wno-unused-label
3566Warn whenever a label is declared but not used.
3567This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3568
3569To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3570(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3571
3572@item -Wunused-local-typedefs @r{(C, Objective-C, C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
3573@opindex Wunused-local-typedefs
3574Warn when a typedef locally defined in a function is not used.
3575
3576@item -Wunused-parameter
3577@opindex Wunused-parameter
3578@opindex Wno-unused-parameter
3579Warn whenever a function parameter is unused aside from its declaration.
3580
3581To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3582(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3583
3584@item -Wno-unused-result
3585@opindex Wunused-result
3586@opindex Wno-unused-result
3587Do not warn if a caller of a function marked with attribute
3588@code{warn_unused_result} (@pxref{Function Attributes}) does not use
3589its return value. The default is @option{-Wunused-result}.
3590
3591@item -Wunused-variable
3592@opindex Wunused-variable
3593@opindex Wno-unused-variable
3594Warn whenever a local variable or non-constant static variable is unused
3595aside from its declaration.
3596This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3597
3598To suppress this warning use the @samp{unused} attribute
3599(@pxref{Variable Attributes}).
3600
3601@item -Wunused-value
3602@opindex Wunused-value
3603@opindex Wno-unused-value
3604Warn whenever a statement computes a result that is explicitly not
3605used. To suppress this warning cast the unused expression to
3606@samp{void}. This includes an expression-statement or the left-hand
3607side of a comma expression that contains no side effects. For example,
3608an expression such as @samp{x[i,j]} will cause a warning, while
3609@samp{x[(void)i,j]} will not.
3610
3611This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3612
3613@item -Wunused
3614@opindex Wunused
3615@opindex Wno-unused
3616All the above @option{-Wunused} options combined.
3617
3618In order to get a warning about an unused function parameter, you must
3619either specify @samp{-Wextra -Wunused} (note that @samp{-Wall} implies
3620@samp{-Wunused}), or separately specify @option{-Wunused-parameter}.
3621
3622@item -Wuninitialized
3623@opindex Wuninitialized
3624@opindex Wno-uninitialized
3625Warn if an automatic variable is used without first being initialized
3626or if a variable may be clobbered by a @code{setjmp} call. In C++,
3627warn if a non-static reference or non-static @samp{const} member
3628appears in a class without constructors.
3629
3630If you want to warn about code that uses the uninitialized value of the
3631variable in its own initializer, use the @option{-Winit-self} option.
3632
3633These warnings occur for individual uninitialized or clobbered
3634elements of structure, union or array variables as well as for
3635variables that are uninitialized or clobbered as a whole.  They do
3636not occur for variables or elements declared @code{volatile}.  Because
3637these warnings depend on optimization, the exact variables or elements
3638for which there are warnings will depend on the precise optimization
3639options and version of GCC used.
3640
3641Note that there may be no warning about a variable that is used only
3642to compute a value that itself is never used, because such
3643computations may be deleted by data flow analysis before the warnings
3644are printed.
3645
3646@item -Wmaybe-uninitialized
3647@opindex Wmaybe-uninitialized
3648@opindex Wno-maybe-uninitialized
3649For an automatic variable, if there exists a path from the function
3650entry to a use of the variable that is initialized, but there exist
3651some other paths the variable is not initialized, the compiler will
3652emit a warning if it can not prove the uninitialized paths do not
3653happen at run time. These warnings are made optional because GCC is
3654not smart enough to see all the reasons why the code might be correct
3655despite appearing to have an error.  Here is one example of how
3656this can happen:
3657
3658@smallexample
3659@group
3660@{
3661  int x;
3662  switch (y)
3663    @{
3664    case 1: x = 1;
3665      break;
3666    case 2: x = 4;
3667      break;
3668    case 3: x = 5;
3669    @}
3670  foo (x);
3671@}
3672@end group
3673@end smallexample
3674
3675@noindent
3676If the value of @code{y} is always 1, 2 or 3, then @code{x} is
3677always initialized, but GCC doesn't know this. To suppress the
3678warning, the user needs to provide a default case with assert(0) or
3679similar code.
3680
3681@cindex @code{longjmp} warnings
3682This option also warns when a non-volatile automatic variable might be
3683changed by a call to @code{longjmp}.  These warnings as well are possible
3684only in optimizing compilation.
3685
3686The compiler sees only the calls to @code{setjmp}.  It cannot know
3687where @code{longjmp} will be called; in fact, a signal handler could
3688call it at any point in the code.  As a result, you may get a warning
3689even when there is in fact no problem because @code{longjmp} cannot
3690in fact be called at the place that would cause a problem.
3691
3692Some spurious warnings can be avoided if you declare all the functions
3693you use that never return as @code{noreturn}.  @xref{Function
3694Attributes}.
3695
3696This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall} or @option{-Wextra}.
3697
3698@item -Wunknown-pragmas
3699@opindex Wunknown-pragmas
3700@opindex Wno-unknown-pragmas
3701@cindex warning for unknown pragmas
3702@cindex unknown pragmas, warning
3703@cindex pragmas, warning of unknown
3704Warn when a @code{#pragma} directive is encountered that is not understood by
3705GCC@.  If this command-line option is used, warnings will even be issued
3706for unknown pragmas in system header files.  This is not the case if
3707the warnings were only enabled by the @option{-Wall} command-line option.
3708
3709@item -Wno-pragmas
3710@opindex Wno-pragmas
3711@opindex Wpragmas
3712Do not warn about misuses of pragmas, such as incorrect parameters,
3713invalid syntax, or conflicts between pragmas.  See also
3714@samp{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
3715
3716@item -Wstrict-aliasing
3717@opindex Wstrict-aliasing
3718@opindex Wno-strict-aliasing
3719This option is only active when @option{-fstrict-aliasing} is active.
3720It warns about code that might break the strict aliasing rules that the
3721compiler is using for optimization.  The warning does not catch all
3722cases, but does attempt to catch the more common pitfalls.  It is
3723included in @option{-Wall}.
3724It is equivalent to @option{-Wstrict-aliasing=3}
3725
3726@item -Wstrict-aliasing=n
3727@opindex Wstrict-aliasing=n
3728@opindex Wno-strict-aliasing=n
3729This option is only active when @option{-fstrict-aliasing} is active.
3730It warns about code that might break the strict aliasing rules that the
3731compiler is using for optimization.
3732Higher levels correspond to higher accuracy (fewer false positives).
3733Higher levels also correspond to more effort, similar to the way -O works.
3734@option{-Wstrict-aliasing} is equivalent to @option{-Wstrict-aliasing=n},
3735with n=3.
3736
3737Level 1: Most aggressive, quick, least accurate.
3738Possibly useful when higher levels
3739do not warn but -fstrict-aliasing still breaks the code, as it has very few
3740false negatives.  However, it has many false positives.
3741Warns for all pointer conversions between possibly incompatible types,
3742even if never dereferenced.  Runs in the front end only.
3743
3744Level 2: Aggressive, quick, not too precise.
3745May still have many false positives (not as many as level 1 though),
3746and few false negatives (but possibly more than level 1).
3747Unlike level 1, it only warns when an address is taken.  Warns about
3748incomplete types.  Runs in the front end only.
3749
3750Level 3 (default for @option{-Wstrict-aliasing}):
3751Should have very few false positives and few false
3752negatives.  Slightly slower than levels 1 or 2 when optimization is enabled.
3753Takes care of the common pun+dereference pattern in the front end:
3754@code{*(int*)&some_float}.
3755If optimization is enabled, it also runs in the back end, where it deals
3756with multiple statement cases using flow-sensitive points-to information.
3757Only warns when the converted pointer is dereferenced.
3758Does not warn about incomplete types.
3759
3760@item -Wstrict-overflow
3761@itemx -Wstrict-overflow=@var{n}
3762@opindex Wstrict-overflow
3763@opindex Wno-strict-overflow
3764This option is only active when @option{-fstrict-overflow} is active.
3765It warns about cases where the compiler optimizes based on the
3766assumption that signed overflow does not occur.  Note that it does not
3767warn about all cases where the code might overflow: it only warns
3768about cases where the compiler implements some optimization.  Thus
3769this warning depends on the optimization level.
3770
3771An optimization that assumes that signed overflow does not occur is
3772perfectly safe if the values of the variables involved are such that
3773overflow never does, in fact, occur.  Therefore this warning can
3774easily give a false positive: a warning about code that is not
3775actually a problem.  To help focus on important issues, several
3776warning levels are defined.  No warnings are issued for the use of
3777undefined signed overflow when estimating how many iterations a loop
3778will require, in particular when determining whether a loop will be
3779executed at all.
3780
3781@table @gcctabopt
3782@item -Wstrict-overflow=1
3783Warn about cases that are both questionable and easy to avoid.  For
3784example: @code{x + 1 > x}; with @option{-fstrict-overflow}, the
3785compiler will simplify this to @code{1}.  This level of
3786@option{-Wstrict-overflow} is enabled by @option{-Wall}; higher levels
3787are not, and must be explicitly requested.
3788
3789@item -Wstrict-overflow=2
3790Also warn about other cases where a comparison is simplified to a
3791constant.  For example: @code{abs (x) >= 0}.  This can only be
3792simplified when @option{-fstrict-overflow} is in effect, because
3793@code{abs (INT_MIN)} overflows to @code{INT_MIN}, which is less than
3794zero.  @option{-Wstrict-overflow} (with no level) is the same as
3795@option{-Wstrict-overflow=2}.
3796
3797@item -Wstrict-overflow=3
3798Also warn about other cases where a comparison is simplified.  For
3799example: @code{x + 1 > 1} will be simplified to @code{x > 0}.
3800
3801@item -Wstrict-overflow=4
3802Also warn about other simplifications not covered by the above cases.
3803For example: @code{(x * 10) / 5} will be simplified to @code{x * 2}.
3804
3805@item -Wstrict-overflow=5
3806Also warn about cases where the compiler reduces the magnitude of a
3807constant involved in a comparison.  For example: @code{x + 2 > y} will
3808be simplified to @code{x + 1 >= y}.  This is reported only at the
3809highest warning level because this simplification applies to many
3810comparisons, so this warning level will give a very large number of
3811false positives.
3812@end table
3813
3814@item -Wsuggest-attribute=@r{[}pure@r{|}const@r{|}noreturn@r{]}
3815@opindex Wsuggest-attribute=
3816@opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=
3817Warn for cases where adding an attribute may be beneficial. The
3818attributes currently supported are listed below.
3819
3820@table @gcctabopt
3821@item -Wsuggest-attribute=pure
3822@itemx -Wsuggest-attribute=const
3823@itemx -Wsuggest-attribute=noreturn
3824@opindex Wsuggest-attribute=pure
3825@opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=pure
3826@opindex Wsuggest-attribute=const
3827@opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=const
3828@opindex Wsuggest-attribute=noreturn
3829@opindex Wno-suggest-attribute=noreturn
3830
3831Warn about functions that might be candidates for attributes
3832@code{pure}, @code{const} or @code{noreturn}.  The compiler only warns for
3833functions visible in other compilation units or (in the case of @code{pure} and
3834@code{const}) if it cannot prove that the function returns normally. A function
3835returns normally if it doesn't contain an infinite loop nor returns abnormally
3836by throwing, calling @code{abort()} or trapping.  This analysis requires option
3837@option{-fipa-pure-const}, which is enabled by default at @option{-O} and
3838higher.  Higher optimization levels improve the accuracy of the analysis.
3839@end table
3840
3841@item -Warray-bounds
3842@opindex Wno-array-bounds
3843@opindex Warray-bounds
3844This option is only active when @option{-ftree-vrp} is active
3845(default for @option{-O2} and above). It warns about subscripts to arrays
3846that are always out of bounds. This warning is enabled by @option{-Wall}.
3847
3848@item -Wno-div-by-zero
3849@opindex Wno-div-by-zero
3850@opindex Wdiv-by-zero
3851Do not warn about compile-time integer division by zero.  Floating-point
3852division by zero is not warned about, as it can be a legitimate way of
3853obtaining infinities and NaNs.
3854
3855@item -Wsystem-headers
3856@opindex Wsystem-headers
3857@opindex Wno-system-headers
3858@cindex warnings from system headers
3859@cindex system headers, warnings from
3860Print warning messages for constructs found in system header files.
3861Warnings from system headers are normally suppressed, on the assumption
3862that they usually do not indicate real problems and would only make the
3863compiler output harder to read.  Using this command-line option tells
3864GCC to emit warnings from system headers as if they occurred in user
3865code.  However, note that using @option{-Wall} in conjunction with this
3866option will @emph{not} warn about unknown pragmas in system
3867headers---for that, @option{-Wunknown-pragmas} must also be used.
3868
3869@item -Wtrampolines
3870@opindex Wtrampolines
3871@opindex Wno-trampolines
3872 Warn about trampolines generated for pointers to nested functions.
3873
3874 A trampoline is a small piece of data or code that is created at run
3875 time on the stack when the address of a nested function is taken, and
3876 is used to call the nested function indirectly.  For some targets, it
3877 is made up of data only and thus requires no special treatment.  But,
3878 for most targets, it is made up of code and thus requires the stack
3879 to be made executable in order for the program to work properly.
3880
3881@item -Wfloat-equal
3882@opindex Wfloat-equal
3883@opindex Wno-float-equal
3884Warn if floating-point values are used in equality comparisons.
3885
3886The idea behind this is that sometimes it is convenient (for the
3887programmer) to consider floating-point values as approximations to
3888infinitely precise real numbers.  If you are doing this, then you need
3889to compute (by analyzing the code, or in some other way) the maximum or
3890likely maximum error that the computation introduces, and allow for it
3891when performing comparisons (and when producing output, but that's a
3892different problem).  In particular, instead of testing for equality, you
3893would check to see whether the two values have ranges that overlap; and
3894this is done with the relational operators, so equality comparisons are
3895probably mistaken.
3896
3897@item -Wtraditional @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3898@opindex Wtraditional
3899@opindex Wno-traditional
3900Warn about certain constructs that behave differently in traditional and
3901ISO C@.  Also warn about ISO C constructs that have no traditional C
3902equivalent, and/or problematic constructs that should be avoided.
3903
3904@itemize @bullet
3905@item
3906Macro parameters that appear within string literals in the macro body.
3907In traditional C macro replacement takes place within string literals,
3908but does not in ISO C@.
3909
3910@item
3911In traditional C, some preprocessor directives did not exist.
3912Traditional preprocessors would only consider a line to be a directive
3913if the @samp{#} appeared in column 1 on the line.  Therefore
3914@option{-Wtraditional} warns about directives that traditional C
3915understands but would ignore because the @samp{#} does not appear as the
3916first character on the line.  It also suggests you hide directives like
3917@samp{#pragma} not understood by traditional C by indenting them.  Some
3918traditional implementations would not recognize @samp{#elif}, so it
3919suggests avoiding it altogether.
3920
3921@item
3922A function-like macro that appears without arguments.
3923
3924@item
3925The unary plus operator.
3926
3927@item
3928The @samp{U} integer constant suffix, or the @samp{F} or @samp{L} floating-point
3929constant suffixes.  (Traditional C does support the @samp{L} suffix on integer
3930constants.)  Note, these suffixes appear in macros defined in the system
3931headers of most modern systems, e.g.@: the @samp{_MIN}/@samp{_MAX} macros in @code{<limits.h>}.
3932Use of these macros in user code might normally lead to spurious
3933warnings, however GCC's integrated preprocessor has enough context to
3934avoid warning in these cases.
3935
3936@item
3937A function declared external in one block and then used after the end of
3938the block.
3939
3940@item
3941A @code{switch} statement has an operand of type @code{long}.
3942
3943@item
3944A non-@code{static} function declaration follows a @code{static} one.
3945This construct is not accepted by some traditional C compilers.
3946
3947@item
3948The ISO type of an integer constant has a different width or
3949signedness from its traditional type.  This warning is only issued if
3950the base of the constant is ten.  I.e.@: hexadecimal or octal values, which
3951typically represent bit patterns, are not warned about.
3952
3953@item
3954Usage of ISO string concatenation is detected.
3955
3956@item
3957Initialization of automatic aggregates.
3958
3959@item
3960Identifier conflicts with labels.  Traditional C lacks a separate
3961namespace for labels.
3962
3963@item
3964Initialization of unions.  If the initializer is zero, the warning is
3965omitted.  This is done under the assumption that the zero initializer in
3966user code appears conditioned on e.g.@: @code{__STDC__} to avoid missing
3967initializer warnings and relies on default initialization to zero in the
3968traditional C case.
3969
3970@item
3971Conversions by prototypes between fixed/floating-point values and vice
3972versa.  The absence of these prototypes when compiling with traditional
3973C would cause serious problems.  This is a subset of the possible
3974conversion warnings, for the full set use @option{-Wtraditional-conversion}.
3975
3976@item
3977Use of ISO C style function definitions.  This warning intentionally is
3978@emph{not} issued for prototype declarations or variadic functions
3979because these ISO C features will appear in your code when using
3980libiberty's traditional C compatibility macros, @code{PARAMS} and
3981@code{VPARAMS}.  This warning is also bypassed for nested functions
3982because that feature is already a GCC extension and thus not relevant to
3983traditional C compatibility.
3984@end itemize
3985
3986@item -Wtraditional-conversion @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3987@opindex Wtraditional-conversion
3988@opindex Wno-traditional-conversion
3989Warn if a prototype causes a type conversion that is different from what
3990would happen to the same argument in the absence of a prototype.  This
3991includes conversions of fixed point to floating and vice versa, and
3992conversions changing the width or signedness of a fixed-point argument
3993except when the same as the default promotion.
3994
3995@item -Wdeclaration-after-statement @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
3996@opindex Wdeclaration-after-statement
3997@opindex Wno-declaration-after-statement
3998Warn when a declaration is found after a statement in a block.  This
3999construct, known from C++, was introduced with ISO C99 and is by default
4000allowed in GCC@.  It is not supported by ISO C90 and was not supported by
4001GCC versions before GCC 3.0.  @xref{Mixed Declarations}.
4002
4003@item -Wundef
4004@opindex Wundef
4005@opindex Wno-undef
4006Warn if an undefined identifier is evaluated in an @samp{#if} directive.
4007
4008@item -Wno-endif-labels
4009@opindex Wno-endif-labels
4010@opindex Wendif-labels
4011Do not warn whenever an @samp{#else} or an @samp{#endif} are followed by text.
4012
4013@item -Wshadow
4014@opindex Wshadow
4015@opindex Wno-shadow
4016Warn whenever a local variable or type declaration shadows another variable,
4017parameter, type, or class member (in C++), or whenever a built-in function
4018is shadowed. Note that in C++, the compiler will not warn if a local variable
4019shadows a struct/class/enum, but will warn if it shadows an explicit typedef.
4020
4021@item -Wlarger-than=@var{len}
4022@opindex Wlarger-than=@var{len}
4023@opindex Wlarger-than-@var{len}
4024Warn whenever an object of larger than @var{len} bytes is defined.
4025
4026@item -Wframe-larger-than=@var{len}
4027@opindex Wframe-larger-than
4028Warn if the size of a function frame is larger than @var{len} bytes.
4029The computation done to determine the stack frame size is approximate
4030and not conservative.
4031The actual requirements may be somewhat greater than @var{len}
4032even if you do not get a warning.  In addition, any space allocated
4033via @code{alloca}, variable-length arrays, or related constructs
4034is not included by the compiler when determining
4035whether or not to issue a warning.
4036
4037@item -Wno-free-nonheap-object
4038@opindex Wno-free-nonheap-object
4039@opindex Wfree-nonheap-object
4040Do not warn when attempting to free an object that was not allocated
4041on the heap.
4042
4043@item -Wstack-usage=@var{len}
4044@opindex Wstack-usage
4045Warn if the stack usage of a function might be larger than @var{len} bytes.
4046The computation done to determine the stack usage is conservative.
4047Any space allocated via @code{alloca}, variable-length arrays, or related
4048constructs is included by the compiler when determining whether or not to
4049issue a warning.
4050
4051The message is in keeping with the output of @option{-fstack-usage}.
4052
4053@itemize
4054@item
4055If the stack usage is fully static but exceeds the specified amount, it's:
4056
4057@smallexample
4058  warning: stack usage is 1120 bytes
4059@end smallexample
4060@item
4061If the stack usage is (partly) dynamic but bounded, it's:
4062
4063@smallexample
4064  warning: stack usage might be 1648 bytes
4065@end smallexample
4066@item
4067If the stack usage is (partly) dynamic and not bounded, it's:
4068
4069@smallexample
4070  warning: stack usage might be unbounded
4071@end smallexample
4072@end itemize
4073
4074@item -Wunsafe-loop-optimizations
4075@opindex Wunsafe-loop-optimizations
4076@opindex Wno-unsafe-loop-optimizations
4077Warn if the loop cannot be optimized because the compiler could not
4078assume anything on the bounds of the loop indices.  With
4079@option{-funsafe-loop-optimizations} warn if the compiler made
4080such assumptions.
4081
4082@item -Wno-pedantic-ms-format @r{(MinGW targets only)}
4083@opindex Wno-pedantic-ms-format
4084@opindex Wpedantic-ms-format
4085Disables the warnings about non-ISO @code{printf} / @code{scanf} format
4086width specifiers @code{I32}, @code{I64}, and @code{I} used on Windows targets
4087depending on the MS runtime, when you are using the options @option{-Wformat}
4088and @option{-pedantic} without gnu-extensions.
4089
4090@item -Wpointer-arith
4091@opindex Wpointer-arith
4092@opindex Wno-pointer-arith
4093Warn about anything that depends on the ``size of'' a function type or
4094of @code{void}.  GNU C assigns these types a size of 1, for
4095convenience in calculations with @code{void *} pointers and pointers
4096to functions.  In C++, warn also when an arithmetic operation involves
4097@code{NULL}.  This warning is also enabled by @option{-pedantic}.
4098
4099@item -Wtype-limits
4100@opindex Wtype-limits
4101@opindex Wno-type-limits
4102Warn if a comparison is always true or always false due to the limited
4103range of the data type, but do not warn for constant expressions.  For
4104example, warn if an unsigned variable is compared against zero with
4105@samp{<} or @samp{>=}.  This warning is also enabled by
4106@option{-Wextra}.
4107
4108@item -Wbad-function-cast @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4109@opindex Wbad-function-cast
4110@opindex Wno-bad-function-cast
4111Warn whenever a function call is cast to a non-matching type.
4112For example, warn if @code{int malloc()} is cast to @code{anything *}.
4113
4114@item -Wc++-compat @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4115Warn about ISO C constructs that are outside of the common subset of
4116ISO C and ISO C++, e.g.@: request for implicit conversion from
4117@code{void *} to a pointer to non-@code{void} type.
4118
4119@item -Wc++11-compat @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4120Warn about C++ constructs whose meaning differs between ISO C++ 1998
4121and ISO C++ 2011, e.g., identifiers in ISO C++ 1998 that are keywords
4122in ISO C++ 2011.  This warning turns on @option{-Wnarrowing} and is
4123enabled by @option{-Wall}.
4124
4125@item -Wcast-qual
4126@opindex Wcast-qual
4127@opindex Wno-cast-qual
4128Warn whenever a pointer is cast so as to remove a type qualifier from
4129the target type.  For example, warn if a @code{const char *} is cast
4130to an ordinary @code{char *}.
4131
4132Also warn when making a cast that introduces a type qualifier in an
4133unsafe way.  For example, casting @code{char **} to @code{const char **}
4134is unsafe, as in this example:
4135
4136@smallexample
4137  /* p is char ** value.  */
4138  const char **q = (const char **) p;
4139  /* Assignment of readonly string to const char * is OK.  */
4140  *q = "string";
4141  /* Now char** pointer points to read-only memory.  */
4142  **p = 'b';
4143@end smallexample
4144
4145@item -Wcast-align
4146@opindex Wcast-align
4147@opindex Wno-cast-align
4148Warn whenever a pointer is cast such that the required alignment of the
4149target is increased.  For example, warn if a @code{char *} is cast to
4150an @code{int *} on machines where integers can only be accessed at
4151two- or four-byte boundaries.
4152
4153@item -Wwrite-strings
4154@opindex Wwrite-strings
4155@opindex Wno-write-strings
4156When compiling C, give string constants the type @code{const
4157char[@var{length}]} so that copying the address of one into a
4158non-@code{const} @code{char *} pointer will get a warning.  These
4159warnings will help you find at compile time code that can try to write
4160into a string constant, but only if you have been very careful about
4161using @code{const} in declarations and prototypes.  Otherwise, it will
4162just be a nuisance. This is why we did not make @option{-Wall} request
4163these warnings.
4164
4165When compiling C++, warn about the deprecated conversion from string
4166literals to @code{char *}.  This warning is enabled by default for C++
4167programs.
4168
4169@item -Wclobbered
4170@opindex Wclobbered
4171@opindex Wno-clobbered
4172Warn for variables that might be changed by @samp{longjmp} or
4173@samp{vfork}.  This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
4174
4175@item -Wconversion
4176@opindex Wconversion
4177@opindex Wno-conversion
4178Warn for implicit conversions that may alter a value. This includes
4179conversions between real and integer, like @code{abs (x)} when
4180@code{x} is @code{double}; conversions between signed and unsigned,
4181like @code{unsigned ui = -1}; and conversions to smaller types, like
4182@code{sqrtf (M_PI)}. Do not warn for explicit casts like @code{abs
4183((int) x)} and @code{ui = (unsigned) -1}, or if the value is not
4184changed by the conversion like in @code{abs (2.0)}.  Warnings about
4185conversions between signed and unsigned integers can be disabled by
4186using @option{-Wno-sign-conversion}.
4187
4188For C++, also warn for confusing overload resolution for user-defined
4189conversions; and conversions that will never use a type conversion
4190operator: conversions to @code{void}, the same type, a base class or a
4191reference to them. Warnings about conversions between signed and
4192unsigned integers are disabled by default in C++ unless
4193@option{-Wsign-conversion} is explicitly enabled.
4194
4195@item -Wno-conversion-null @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4196@opindex Wconversion-null
4197@opindex Wno-conversion-null
4198Do not warn for conversions between @code{NULL} and non-pointer
4199types. @option{-Wconversion-null} is enabled by default.
4200
4201@item -Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4202@opindex Wzero-as-null-pointer-constant
4203@opindex Wno-zero-as-null-pointer-constant
4204Warn when a literal '0' is used as null pointer constant.  This can
4205be useful to facilitate the conversion to @code{nullptr} in C++11.
4206
4207@item -Wempty-body
4208@opindex Wempty-body
4209@opindex Wno-empty-body
4210Warn if an empty body occurs in an @samp{if}, @samp{else} or @samp{do
4211while} statement.  This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
4212
4213@item -Wenum-compare
4214@opindex Wenum-compare
4215@opindex Wno-enum-compare
4216Warn about a comparison between values of different enumerated types.
4217In C++ enumeral mismatches in conditional expressions are also
4218diagnosed and the warning is enabled by default.  In C this warning is
4219enabled by @option{-Wall}.
4220
4221@item -Wjump-misses-init @r{(C, Objective-C only)}
4222@opindex Wjump-misses-init
4223@opindex Wno-jump-misses-init
4224Warn if a @code{goto} statement or a @code{switch} statement jumps
4225forward across the initialization of a variable, or jumps backward to a
4226label after the variable has been initialized.  This only warns about
4227variables that are initialized when they are declared.  This warning is
4228only supported for C and Objective-C; in C++ this sort of branch is an
4229error in any case.
4230
4231@option{-Wjump-misses-init} is included in @option{-Wc++-compat}.  It
4232can be disabled with the @option{-Wno-jump-misses-init} option.
4233
4234@item -Wsign-compare
4235@opindex Wsign-compare
4236@opindex Wno-sign-compare
4237@cindex warning for comparison of signed and unsigned values
4238@cindex comparison of signed and unsigned values, warning
4239@cindex signed and unsigned values, comparison warning
4240Warn when a comparison between signed and unsigned values could produce
4241an incorrect result when the signed value is converted to unsigned.
4242This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}; to get the other warnings
4243of @option{-Wextra} without this warning, use @samp{-Wextra -Wno-sign-compare}.
4244
4245@item -Wsign-conversion
4246@opindex Wsign-conversion
4247@opindex Wno-sign-conversion
4248Warn for implicit conversions that may change the sign of an integer
4249value, like assigning a signed integer expression to an unsigned
4250integer variable. An explicit cast silences the warning. In C, this
4251option is enabled also by @option{-Wconversion}.
4252
4253@item -Waddress
4254@opindex Waddress
4255@opindex Wno-address
4256Warn about suspicious uses of memory addresses. These include using
4257the address of a function in a conditional expression, such as
4258@code{void func(void); if (func)}, and comparisons against the memory
4259address of a string literal, such as @code{if (x == "abc")}.  Such
4260uses typically indicate a programmer error: the address of a function
4261always evaluates to true, so their use in a conditional usually
4262indicate that the programmer forgot the parentheses in a function
4263call; and comparisons against string literals result in unspecified
4264behavior and are not portable in C, so they usually indicate that the
4265programmer intended to use @code{strcmp}.  This warning is enabled by
4266@option{-Wall}.
4267
4268@item -Wlogical-op
4269@opindex Wlogical-op
4270@opindex Wno-logical-op
4271Warn about suspicious uses of logical operators in expressions.
4272This includes using logical operators in contexts where a
4273bit-wise operator is likely to be expected.
4274
4275@item -Waggregate-return
4276@opindex Waggregate-return
4277@opindex Wno-aggregate-return
4278Warn if any functions that return structures or unions are defined or
4279called.  (In languages where you can return an array, this also elicits
4280a warning.)
4281
4282@item -Wno-attributes
4283@opindex Wno-attributes
4284@opindex Wattributes
4285Do not warn if an unexpected @code{__attribute__} is used, such as
4286unrecognized attributes, function attributes applied to variables,
4287etc.  This will not stop errors for incorrect use of supported
4288attributes.
4289
4290@item -Wno-builtin-macro-redefined
4291@opindex Wno-builtin-macro-redefined
4292@opindex Wbuiltin-macro-redefined
4293Do not warn if certain built-in macros are redefined.  This suppresses
4294warnings for redefinition of @code{__TIMESTAMP__}, @code{__TIME__},
4295@code{__DATE__}, @code{__FILE__}, and @code{__BASE_FILE__}.
4296
4297@item -Wstrict-prototypes @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4298@opindex Wstrict-prototypes
4299@opindex Wno-strict-prototypes
4300Warn if a function is declared or defined without specifying the
4301argument types.  (An old-style function definition is permitted without
4302a warning if preceded by a declaration that specifies the argument
4303types.)
4304
4305@item -Wold-style-declaration @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4306@opindex Wold-style-declaration
4307@opindex Wno-old-style-declaration
4308Warn for obsolescent usages, according to the C Standard, in a
4309declaration. For example, warn if storage-class specifiers like
4310@code{static} are not the first things in a declaration.  This warning
4311is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
4312
4313@item -Wold-style-definition @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4314@opindex Wold-style-definition
4315@opindex Wno-old-style-definition
4316Warn if an old-style function definition is used.  A warning is given
4317even if there is a previous prototype.
4318
4319@item -Wmissing-parameter-type @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4320@opindex Wmissing-parameter-type
4321@opindex Wno-missing-parameter-type
4322A function parameter is declared without a type specifier in K&R-style
4323functions:
4324
4325@smallexample
4326void foo(bar) @{ @}
4327@end smallexample
4328
4329This warning is also enabled by @option{-Wextra}.
4330
4331@item -Wmissing-prototypes @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4332@opindex Wmissing-prototypes
4333@opindex Wno-missing-prototypes
4334Warn if a global function is defined without a previous prototype
4335declaration.  This warning is issued even if the definition itself
4336provides a prototype.  The aim is to detect global functions that
4337are not declared in header files.
4338
4339@item -Wmissing-declarations
4340@opindex Wmissing-declarations
4341@opindex Wno-missing-declarations
4342Warn if a global function is defined without a previous declaration.
4343Do so even if the definition itself provides a prototype.
4344Use this option to detect global functions that are not declared in
4345header files.  In C++, no warnings are issued for function templates,
4346or for inline functions, or for functions in anonymous namespaces.
4347
4348@item -Wmissing-field-initializers
4349@opindex Wmissing-field-initializers
4350@opindex Wno-missing-field-initializers
4351@opindex W
4352@opindex Wextra
4353@opindex Wno-extra
4354Warn if a structure's initializer has some fields missing.  For
4355example, the following code would cause such a warning, because
4356@code{x.h} is implicitly zero:
4357
4358@smallexample
4359struct s @{ int f, g, h; @};
4360struct s x = @{ 3, 4 @};
4361@end smallexample
4362
4363This option does not warn about designated initializers, so the following
4364modification would not trigger a warning:
4365
4366@smallexample
4367struct s @{ int f, g, h; @};
4368struct s x = @{ .f = 3, .g = 4 @};
4369@end smallexample
4370
4371This warning is included in @option{-Wextra}.  To get other @option{-Wextra}
4372warnings without this one, use @samp{-Wextra -Wno-missing-field-initializers}.
4373
4374@item -Wmissing-format-attribute
4375@opindex Wmissing-format-attribute
4376@opindex Wno-missing-format-attribute
4377@opindex Wformat
4378@opindex Wno-format
4379Warn about function pointers that might be candidates for @code{format}
4380attributes.  Note these are only possible candidates, not absolute ones.
4381GCC will guess that function pointers with @code{format} attributes that
4382are used in assignment, initialization, parameter passing or return
4383statements should have a corresponding @code{format} attribute in the
4384resulting type.  I.e.@: the left-hand side of the assignment or
4385initialization, the type of the parameter variable, or the return type
4386of the containing function respectively should also have a @code{format}
4387attribute to avoid the warning.
4388
4389GCC will also warn about function definitions that might be
4390candidates for @code{format} attributes.  Again, these are only
4391possible candidates.  GCC will guess that @code{format} attributes
4392might be appropriate for any function that calls a function like
4393@code{vprintf} or @code{vscanf}, but this might not always be the
4394case, and some functions for which @code{format} attributes are
4395appropriate may not be detected.
4396
4397@item -Wno-multichar
4398@opindex Wno-multichar
4399@opindex Wmultichar
4400Do not warn if a multicharacter constant (@samp{'FOOF'}) is used.
4401Usually they indicate a typo in the user's code, as they have
4402implementation-defined values, and should not be used in portable code.
4403
4404@item -Wnormalized=<none|id|nfc|nfkc>
4405@opindex Wnormalized=
4406@cindex NFC
4407@cindex NFKC
4408@cindex character set, input normalization
4409In ISO C and ISO C++, two identifiers are different if they are
4410different sequences of characters.  However, sometimes when characters
4411outside the basic ASCII character set are used, you can have two
4412different character sequences that look the same.  To avoid confusion,
4413the ISO 10646 standard sets out some @dfn{normalization rules} which
4414when applied ensure that two sequences that look the same are turned into
4415the same sequence.  GCC can warn you if you are using identifiers that
4416have not been normalized; this option controls that warning.
4417
4418There are four levels of warning supported by GCC.  The default is
4419@option{-Wnormalized=nfc}, which warns about any identifier that is
4420not in the ISO 10646 ``C'' normalized form, @dfn{NFC}.  NFC is the
4421recommended form for most uses.
4422
4423Unfortunately, there are some characters allowed in identifiers by
4424ISO C and ISO C++ that, when turned into NFC, are not allowed in
4425identifiers.  That is, there's no way to use these symbols in portable
4426ISO C or C++ and have all your identifiers in NFC@.
4427@option{-Wnormalized=id} suppresses the warning for these characters.
4428It is hoped that future versions of the standards involved will correct
4429this, which is why this option is not the default.
4430
4431You can switch the warning off for all characters by writing
4432@option{-Wnormalized=none}.  You would only want to do this if you
4433were using some other normalization scheme (like ``D''), because
4434otherwise you can easily create bugs that are literally impossible to see.
4435
4436Some characters in ISO 10646 have distinct meanings but look identical
4437in some fonts or display methodologies, especially once formatting has
4438been applied.  For instance @code{\u207F}, ``SUPERSCRIPT LATIN SMALL
4439LETTER N'', will display just like a regular @code{n} that has been
4440placed in a superscript.  ISO 10646 defines the @dfn{NFKC}
4441normalization scheme to convert all these into a standard form as
4442well, and GCC will warn if your code is not in NFKC if you use
4443@option{-Wnormalized=nfkc}.  This warning is comparable to warning
4444about every identifier that contains the letter O because it might be
4445confused with the digit 0, and so is not the default, but may be
4446useful as a local coding convention if the programming environment is
4447unable to be fixed to display these characters distinctly.
4448
4449@item -Wno-deprecated
4450@opindex Wno-deprecated
4451@opindex Wdeprecated
4452Do not warn about usage of deprecated features.  @xref{Deprecated Features}.
4453
4454@item -Wno-deprecated-declarations
4455@opindex Wno-deprecated-declarations
4456@opindex Wdeprecated-declarations
4457Do not warn about uses of functions (@pxref{Function Attributes}),
4458variables (@pxref{Variable Attributes}), and types (@pxref{Type
4459Attributes}) marked as deprecated by using the @code{deprecated}
4460attribute.
4461
4462@item -Wno-overflow
4463@opindex Wno-overflow
4464@opindex Woverflow
4465Do not warn about compile-time overflow in constant expressions.
4466
4467@item -Woverride-init @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4468@opindex Woverride-init
4469@opindex Wno-override-init
4470@opindex W
4471@opindex Wextra
4472@opindex Wno-extra
4473Warn if an initialized field without side effects is overridden when
4474using designated initializers (@pxref{Designated Inits, , Designated
4475Initializers}).
4476
4477This warning is included in @option{-Wextra}.  To get other
4478@option{-Wextra} warnings without this one, use @samp{-Wextra
4479-Wno-override-init}.
4480
4481@item -Wpacked
4482@opindex Wpacked
4483@opindex Wno-packed
4484Warn if a structure is given the packed attribute, but the packed
4485attribute has no effect on the layout or size of the structure.
4486Such structures may be mis-aligned for little benefit.  For
4487instance, in this code, the variable @code{f.x} in @code{struct bar}
4488will be misaligned even though @code{struct bar} does not itself
4489have the packed attribute:
4490
4491@smallexample
4492@group
4493struct foo @{
4494  int x;
4495  char a, b, c, d;
4496@} __attribute__((packed));
4497struct bar @{
4498  char z;
4499  struct foo f;
4500@};
4501@end group
4502@end smallexample
4503
4504@item -Wpacked-bitfield-compat
4505@opindex Wpacked-bitfield-compat
4506@opindex Wno-packed-bitfield-compat
4507The 4.1, 4.2 and 4.3 series of GCC ignore the @code{packed} attribute
4508on bit-fields of type @code{char}.  This has been fixed in GCC 4.4 but
4509the change can lead to differences in the structure layout.  GCC
4510informs you when the offset of such a field has changed in GCC 4.4.
4511For example there is no longer a 4-bit padding between field @code{a}
4512and @code{b} in this structure:
4513
4514@smallexample
4515struct foo
4516@{
4517  char a:4;
4518  char b:8;
4519@} __attribute__ ((packed));
4520@end smallexample
4521
4522This warning is enabled by default.  Use
4523@option{-Wno-packed-bitfield-compat} to disable this warning.
4524
4525@item -Wpadded
4526@opindex Wpadded
4527@opindex Wno-padded
4528Warn if padding is included in a structure, either to align an element
4529of the structure or to align the whole structure.  Sometimes when this
4530happens it is possible to rearrange the fields of the structure to
4531reduce the padding and so make the structure smaller.
4532
4533@item -Wredundant-decls
4534@opindex Wredundant-decls
4535@opindex Wno-redundant-decls
4536Warn if anything is declared more than once in the same scope, even in
4537cases where multiple declaration is valid and changes nothing.
4538
4539@item -Wnested-externs @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4540@opindex Wnested-externs
4541@opindex Wno-nested-externs
4542Warn if an @code{extern} declaration is encountered within a function.
4543
4544@item -Winline
4545@opindex Winline
4546@opindex Wno-inline
4547Warn if a function can not be inlined and it was declared as inline.
4548Even with this option, the compiler will not warn about failures to
4549inline functions declared in system headers.
4550
4551The compiler uses a variety of heuristics to determine whether or not
4552to inline a function.  For example, the compiler takes into account
4553the size of the function being inlined and the amount of inlining
4554that has already been done in the current function.  Therefore,
4555seemingly insignificant changes in the source program can cause the
4556warnings produced by @option{-Winline} to appear or disappear.
4557
4558@item -Wno-invalid-offsetof @r{(C++ and Objective-C++ only)}
4559@opindex Wno-invalid-offsetof
4560@opindex Winvalid-offsetof
4561Suppress warnings from applying the @samp{offsetof} macro to a non-POD
4562type.  According to the 1998 ISO C++ standard, applying @samp{offsetof}
4563to a non-POD type is undefined.  In existing C++ implementations,
4564however, @samp{offsetof} typically gives meaningful results even when
4565applied to certain kinds of non-POD types. (Such as a simple
4566@samp{struct} that fails to be a POD type only by virtue of having a
4567constructor.)  This flag is for users who are aware that they are
4568writing nonportable code and who have deliberately chosen to ignore the
4569warning about it.
4570
4571The restrictions on @samp{offsetof} may be relaxed in a future version
4572of the C++ standard.
4573
4574@item -Wno-int-to-pointer-cast
4575@opindex Wno-int-to-pointer-cast
4576@opindex Wint-to-pointer-cast
4577Suppress warnings from casts to pointer type of an integer of a
4578different size. In C++, casting to a pointer type of smaller size is
4579an error. @option{Wint-to-pointer-cast} is enabled by default.
4580
4581
4582@item -Wno-pointer-to-int-cast @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4583@opindex Wno-pointer-to-int-cast
4584@opindex Wpointer-to-int-cast
4585Suppress warnings from casts from a pointer to an integer type of a
4586different size.
4587
4588@item -Winvalid-pch
4589@opindex Winvalid-pch
4590@opindex Wno-invalid-pch
4591Warn if a precompiled header (@pxref{Precompiled Headers}) is found in
4592the search path but can't be used.
4593
4594@item -Wlong-long
4595@opindex Wlong-long
4596@opindex Wno-long-long
4597Warn if @samp{long long} type is used.  This is enabled by either
4598@option{-pedantic} or @option{-Wtraditional} in ISO C90 and C++98
4599modes.  To inhibit the warning messages, use @option{-Wno-long-long}.
4600
4601@item -Wvariadic-macros
4602@opindex Wvariadic-macros
4603@opindex Wno-variadic-macros
4604Warn if variadic macros are used in pedantic ISO C90 mode, or the GNU
4605alternate syntax when in pedantic ISO C99 mode.  This is default.
4606To inhibit the warning messages, use @option{-Wno-variadic-macros}.
4607
4608@item -Wvector-operation-performance
4609@opindex Wvector-operation-performance
4610@opindex Wno-vector-operation-performance
4611Warn if vector operation is not implemented via SIMD capabilities of the
4612architecture.  Mainly useful for the performance tuning.
4613Vector operation can be implemented @code{piecewise}, which means that the
4614scalar operation is performed on every vector element;
4615@code{in parallel}, which means that the vector operation is implemented
4616using scalars of wider type, which normally is more performance efficient;
4617and @code{as a single scalar}, which means that vector fits into a
4618scalar type.
4619
4620@item -Wvla
4621@opindex Wvla
4622@opindex Wno-vla
4623Warn if variable length array is used in the code.
4624@option{-Wno-vla} will prevent the @option{-pedantic} warning of
4625the variable length array.
4626
4627@item -Wvolatile-register-var
4628@opindex Wvolatile-register-var
4629@opindex Wno-volatile-register-var
4630Warn if a register variable is declared volatile.  The volatile
4631modifier does not inhibit all optimizations that may eliminate reads
4632and/or writes to register variables.  This warning is enabled by
4633@option{-Wall}.
4634
4635@item -Wdisabled-optimization
4636@opindex Wdisabled-optimization
4637@opindex Wno-disabled-optimization
4638Warn if a requested optimization pass is disabled.  This warning does
4639not generally indicate that there is anything wrong with your code; it
4640merely indicates that GCC's optimizers were unable to handle the code
4641effectively.  Often, the problem is that your code is too big or too
4642complex; GCC will refuse to optimize programs when the optimization
4643itself is likely to take inordinate amounts of time.
4644
4645@item -Wpointer-sign @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4646@opindex Wpointer-sign
4647@opindex Wno-pointer-sign
4648Warn for pointer argument passing or assignment with different signedness.
4649This option is only supported for C and Objective-C@.  It is implied by
4650@option{-Wall} and by @option{-pedantic}, which can be disabled with
4651@option{-Wno-pointer-sign}.
4652
4653@item -Wstack-protector
4654@opindex Wstack-protector
4655@opindex Wno-stack-protector
4656This option is only active when @option{-fstack-protector} is active.  It
4657warns about functions that will not be protected against stack smashing.
4658
4659@item -Wno-mudflap
4660@opindex Wno-mudflap
4661Suppress warnings about constructs that cannot be instrumented by
4662@option{-fmudflap}.
4663
4664@item -Woverlength-strings
4665@opindex Woverlength-strings
4666@opindex Wno-overlength-strings
4667Warn about string constants that are longer than the ``minimum
4668maximum'' length specified in the C standard.  Modern compilers
4669generally allow string constants that are much longer than the
4670standard's minimum limit, but very portable programs should avoid
4671using longer strings.
4672
4673The limit applies @emph{after} string constant concatenation, and does
4674not count the trailing NUL@.  In C90, the limit was 509 characters; in
4675C99, it was raised to 4095.  C++98 does not specify a normative
4676minimum maximum, so we do not diagnose overlength strings in C++@.
4677
4678This option is implied by @option{-pedantic}, and can be disabled with
4679@option{-Wno-overlength-strings}.
4680
4681@item -Wunsuffixed-float-constants @r{(C and Objective-C only)}
4682@opindex Wunsuffixed-float-constants
4683
4684GCC will issue a warning for any floating constant that does not have
4685a suffix.  When used together with @option{-Wsystem-headers} it will
4686warn about such constants in system header files.  This can be useful
4687when preparing code to use with the @code{FLOAT_CONST_DECIMAL64} pragma
4688from the decimal floating-point extension to C99.
4689@end table
4690
4691@node Debugging Options
4692@section Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC
4693@cindex options, debugging
4694@cindex debugging information options
4695
4696GCC has various special options that are used for debugging
4697either your program or GCC:
4698
4699@table @gcctabopt
4700@item -g
4701@opindex g
4702Produce debugging information in the operating system's native format
4703(stabs, COFF, XCOFF, or DWARF 2)@.  GDB can work with this debugging
4704information.
4705
4706On most systems that use stabs format, @option{-g} enables use of extra
4707debugging information that only GDB can use; this extra information
4708makes debugging work better in GDB but will probably make other debuggers
4709crash or
4710refuse to read the program.  If you want to control for certain whether
4711to generate the extra information, use @option{-gstabs+}, @option{-gstabs},
4712@option{-gxcoff+}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms} (see below).
4713
4714GCC allows you to use @option{-g} with
4715@option{-O}.  The shortcuts taken by optimized code may occasionally
4716produce surprising results: some variables you declared may not exist
4717at all; flow of control may briefly move where you did not expect it;
4718some statements may not be executed because they compute constant
4719results or their values were already at hand; some statements may
4720execute in different places because they were moved out of loops.
4721
4722Nevertheless it proves possible to debug optimized output.  This makes
4723it reasonable to use the optimizer for programs that might have bugs.
4724
4725The following options are useful when GCC is generated with the
4726capability for more than one debugging format.
4727
4728@item -ggdb
4729@opindex ggdb
4730Produce debugging information for use by GDB@.  This means to use the
4731most expressive format available (DWARF 2, stabs, or the native format
4732if neither of those are supported), including GDB extensions if at all
4733possible.
4734
4735@item -gstabs
4736@opindex gstabs
4737Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
4738without GDB extensions.  This is the format used by DBX on most BSD
4739systems.  On MIPS, Alpha and System V Release 4 systems this option
4740produces stabs debugging output that is not understood by DBX or SDB@.
4741On System V Release 4 systems this option requires the GNU assembler.
4742
4743@item -feliminate-unused-debug-symbols
4744@opindex feliminate-unused-debug-symbols
4745Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
4746for only symbols that are actually used.
4747
4748@item -femit-class-debug-always
4749Instead of emitting debugging information for a C++ class in only one
4750object file, emit it in all object files using the class.  This option
4751should be used only with debuggers that are unable to handle the way GCC
4752normally emits debugging information for classes because using this
4753option will increase the size of debugging information by as much as a
4754factor of two.
4755
4756@item -fno-debug-types-section
4757@opindex fno-debug-types-section
4758@opindex fdebug-types-section
4759By default when using DWARF v4 or higher type DIEs will be put into
4760their own .debug_types section instead of making them part of the
4761.debug_info section.  It is more efficient to put them in a separate
4762comdat sections since the linker will then be able to remove duplicates.
4763But not all DWARF consumers support .debug_types sections yet.
4764
4765@item -gstabs+
4766@opindex gstabs+
4767Produce debugging information in stabs format (if that is supported),
4768using GNU extensions understood only by the GNU debugger (GDB)@.  The
4769use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers crash or
4770refuse to read the program.
4771
4772@item -gcoff
4773@opindex gcoff
4774Produce debugging information in COFF format (if that is supported).
4775This is the format used by SDB on most System V systems prior to
4776System V Release 4.
4777
4778@item -gxcoff
4779@opindex gxcoff
4780Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is supported).
4781This is the format used by the DBX debugger on IBM RS/6000 systems.
4782
4783@item -gxcoff+
4784@opindex gxcoff+
4785Produce debugging information in XCOFF format (if that is supported),
4786using GNU extensions understood only by the GNU debugger (GDB)@.  The
4787use of these extensions is likely to make other debuggers crash or
4788refuse to read the program, and may cause assemblers other than the GNU
4789assembler (GAS) to fail with an error.
4790
4791@item -gdwarf-@var{version}
4792@opindex gdwarf-@var{version}
4793Produce debugging information in DWARF format (if that is
4794supported).  This is the format used by DBX on IRIX 6.  The value
4795of @var{version} may be either 2, 3 or 4; the default version is 2.
4796
4797Note that with DWARF version 2 some ports require, and will always
4798use, some non-conflicting DWARF 3 extensions in the unwind tables.
4799
4800Version 4 may require GDB 7.0 and @option{-fvar-tracking-assignments}
4801for maximum benefit.
4802
4803@item -grecord-gcc-switches
4804@opindex grecord-gcc-switches
4805This switch causes the command-line options used to invoke the
4806compiler that may affect code generation to be appended to the
4807DW_AT_producer attribute in DWARF debugging information.  The options
4808are concatenated with spaces separating them from each other and from
4809the compiler version.  See also @option{-frecord-gcc-switches} for another
4810way of storing compiler options into the object file.
4811
4812@item -gno-record-gcc-switches
4813@opindex gno-record-gcc-switches
4814Disallow appending command-line options to the DW_AT_producer attribute
4815in DWARF debugging information.  This is the default.
4816
4817@item -gstrict-dwarf
4818@opindex gstrict-dwarf
4819Disallow using extensions of later DWARF standard version than selected
4820with @option{-gdwarf-@var{version}}.  On most targets using non-conflicting
4821DWARF extensions from later standard versions is allowed.
4822
4823@item -gno-strict-dwarf
4824@opindex gno-strict-dwarf
4825Allow using extensions of later DWARF standard version than selected with
4826@option{-gdwarf-@var{version}}.
4827
4828@item -gvms
4829@opindex gvms
4830Produce debugging information in VMS debug format (if that is
4831supported).  This is the format used by DEBUG on VMS systems.
4832
4833@item -g@var{level}
4834@itemx -ggdb@var{level}
4835@itemx -gstabs@var{level}
4836@itemx -gcoff@var{level}
4837@itemx -gxcoff@var{level}
4838@itemx -gvms@var{level}
4839Request debugging information and also use @var{level} to specify how
4840much information.  The default level is 2.
4841
4842Level 0 produces no debug information at all.  Thus, @option{-g0} negates
4843@option{-g}.
4844
4845Level 1 produces minimal information, enough for making backtraces in
4846parts of the program that you don't plan to debug.  This includes
4847descriptions of functions and external variables, but no information
4848about local variables and no line numbers.
4849
4850Level 3 includes extra information, such as all the macro definitions
4851present in the program.  Some debuggers support macro expansion when
4852you use @option{-g3}.
4853
4854@option{-gdwarf-2} does not accept a concatenated debug level, because
4855GCC used to support an option @option{-gdwarf} that meant to generate
4856debug information in version 1 of the DWARF format (which is very
4857different from version 2), and it would have been too confusing.  That
4858debug format is long obsolete, but the option cannot be changed now.
4859Instead use an additional @option{-g@var{level}} option to change the
4860debug level for DWARF.
4861
4862@item -gtoggle
4863@opindex gtoggle
4864Turn off generation of debug info, if leaving out this option would have
4865generated it, or turn it on at level 2 otherwise.  The position of this
4866argument in the command line does not matter, it takes effect after all
4867other options are processed, and it does so only once, no matter how
4868many times it is given.  This is mainly intended to be used with
4869@option{-fcompare-debug}.
4870
4871@item -fdump-final-insns@r{[}=@var{file}@r{]}
4872@opindex fdump-final-insns
4873Dump the final internal representation (RTL) to @var{file}.  If the
4874optional argument is omitted (or if @var{file} is @code{.}), the name
4875of the dump file will be determined by appending @code{.gkd} to the
4876compilation output file name.
4877
4878@item -fcompare-debug@r{[}=@var{opts}@r{]}
4879@opindex fcompare-debug
4880@opindex fno-compare-debug
4881If no error occurs during compilation, run the compiler a second time,
4882adding @var{opts} and @option{-fcompare-debug-second} to the arguments
4883passed to the second compilation.  Dump the final internal
4884representation in both compilations, and print an error if they differ.
4885
4886If the equal sign is omitted, the default @option{-gtoggle} is used.
4887
4888The environment variable @env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG}, if defined, non-empty
4889and nonzero, implicitly enables @option{-fcompare-debug}.  If
4890@env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} is defined to a string starting with a dash,
4891then it is used for @var{opts}, otherwise the default @option{-gtoggle}
4892is used.
4893
4894@option{-fcompare-debug=}, with the equal sign but without @var{opts},
4895is equivalent to @option{-fno-compare-debug}, which disables the dumping
4896of the final representation and the second compilation, preventing even
4897@env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} from taking effect.
4898
4899To verify full coverage during @option{-fcompare-debug} testing, set
4900@env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} to say @samp{-fcompare-debug-not-overridden},
4901which GCC will reject as an invalid option in any actual compilation
4902(rather than preprocessing, assembly or linking).  To get just a
4903warning, setting @env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} to @samp{-w%n-fcompare-debug
4904not overridden} will do.
4905
4906@item -fcompare-debug-second
4907@opindex fcompare-debug-second
4908This option is implicitly passed to the compiler for the second
4909compilation requested by @option{-fcompare-debug}, along with options to
4910silence warnings, and omitting other options that would cause
4911side-effect compiler outputs to files or to the standard output.  Dump
4912files and preserved temporary files are renamed so as to contain the
4913@code{.gk} additional extension during the second compilation, to avoid
4914overwriting those generated by the first.
4915
4916When this option is passed to the compiler driver, it causes the
4917@emph{first} compilation to be skipped, which makes it useful for little
4918other than debugging the compiler proper.
4919
4920@item -feliminate-dwarf2-dups
4921@opindex feliminate-dwarf2-dups
4922Compress DWARF2 debugging information by eliminating duplicated
4923information about each symbol.  This option only makes sense when
4924generating DWARF2 debugging information with @option{-gdwarf-2}.
4925
4926@item -femit-struct-debug-baseonly
4927Emit debug information for struct-like types
4928only when the base name of the compilation source file
4929matches the base name of file in which the struct was defined.
4930
4931This option substantially reduces the size of debugging information,
4932but at significant potential loss in type information to the debugger.
4933See @option{-femit-struct-debug-reduced} for a less aggressive option.
4934See @option{-femit-struct-debug-detailed} for more detailed control.
4935
4936This option works only with DWARF 2.
4937
4938@item -femit-struct-debug-reduced
4939Emit debug information for struct-like types
4940only when the base name of the compilation source file
4941matches the base name of file in which the type was defined,
4942unless the struct is a template or defined in a system header.
4943
4944This option significantly reduces the size of debugging information,
4945with some potential loss in type information to the debugger.
4946See @option{-femit-struct-debug-baseonly} for a more aggressive option.
4947See @option{-femit-struct-debug-detailed} for more detailed control.
4948
4949This option works only with DWARF 2.
4950
4951@item -femit-struct-debug-detailed@r{[}=@var{spec-list}@r{]}
4952Specify the struct-like types
4953for which the compiler will generate debug information.
4954The intent is to reduce duplicate struct debug information
4955between different object files within the same program.
4956
4957This option is a detailed version of
4958@option{-femit-struct-debug-reduced} and @option{-femit-struct-debug-baseonly},
4959which will serve for most needs.
4960
4961A specification has the syntax@*
4962[@samp{dir:}|@samp{ind:}][@samp{ord:}|@samp{gen:}](@samp{any}|@samp{sys}|@samp{base}|@samp{none})
4963
4964The optional first word limits the specification to
4965structs that are used directly (@samp{dir:}) or used indirectly (@samp{ind:}).
4966A struct type is used directly when it is the type of a variable, member.
4967Indirect uses arise through pointers to structs.
4968That is, when use of an incomplete struct would be legal, the use is indirect.
4969An example is
4970@samp{struct one direct; struct two * indirect;}.
4971
4972The optional second word limits the specification to
4973ordinary structs (@samp{ord:}) or generic structs (@samp{gen:}).
4974Generic structs are a bit complicated to explain.
4975For C++, these are non-explicit specializations of template classes,
4976or non-template classes within the above.
4977Other programming languages have generics,
4978but @samp{-femit-struct-debug-detailed} does not yet implement them.
4979
4980The third word specifies the source files for those
4981structs for which the compiler will emit debug information.
4982The values @samp{none} and @samp{any} have the normal meaning.
4983The value @samp{base} means that
4984the base of name of the file in which the type declaration appears
4985must match the base of the name of the main compilation file.
4986In practice, this means that
4987types declared in @file{foo.c} and @file{foo.h} will have debug information,
4988but types declared in other header will not.
4989The value @samp{sys} means those types satisfying @samp{base}
4990or declared in system or compiler headers.
4991
4992You may need to experiment to determine the best settings for your application.
4993
4994The default is @samp{-femit-struct-debug-detailed=all}.
4995
4996This option works only with DWARF 2.
4997
4998@item -fno-merge-debug-strings
4999@opindex fmerge-debug-strings
5000@opindex fno-merge-debug-strings
5001Direct the linker to not merge together strings in the debugging
5002information that are identical in different object files.  Merging is
5003not supported by all assemblers or linkers.  Merging decreases the size
5004of the debug information in the output file at the cost of increasing
5005link processing time.  Merging is enabled by default.
5006
5007@item -fdebug-prefix-map=@var{old}=@var{new}
5008@opindex fdebug-prefix-map
5009When compiling files in directory @file{@var{old}}, record debugging
5010information describing them as in @file{@var{new}} instead.
5011
5012@item -fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm
5013@opindex fdwarf2-cfi-asm
5014@opindex fno-dwarf2-cfi-asm
5015Emit DWARF 2 unwind info as compiler generated @code{.eh_frame} section
5016instead of using GAS @code{.cfi_*} directives.
5017
5018@cindex @command{prof}
5019@item -p
5020@opindex p
5021Generate extra code to write profile information suitable for the
5022analysis program @command{prof}.  You must use this option when compiling
5023the source files you want data about, and you must also use it when
5024linking.
5025
5026@cindex @command{gprof}
5027@item -pg
5028@opindex pg
5029Generate extra code to write profile information suitable for the
5030analysis program @command{gprof}.  You must use this option when compiling
5031the source files you want data about, and you must also use it when
5032linking.
5033
5034@item -Q
5035@opindex Q
5036Makes the compiler print out each function name as it is compiled, and
5037print some statistics about each pass when it finishes.
5038
5039@item -ftime-report
5040@opindex ftime-report
5041Makes the compiler print some statistics about the time consumed by each
5042pass when it finishes.
5043
5044@item -fmem-report
5045@opindex fmem-report
5046Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory
5047allocation when it finishes.
5048
5049@item -fpre-ipa-mem-report
5050@opindex fpre-ipa-mem-report
5051@item -fpost-ipa-mem-report
5052@opindex fpost-ipa-mem-report
5053Makes the compiler print some statistics about permanent memory
5054allocation before or after interprocedural optimization.
5055
5056@item -fstack-usage
5057@opindex fstack-usage
5058Makes the compiler output stack usage information for the program, on a
5059per-function basis.  The filename for the dump is made by appending
5060@file{.su} to the @var{auxname}.  @var{auxname} is generated from the name of
5061the output file, if explicitly specified and it is not an executable,
5062otherwise it is the basename of the source file.  An entry is made up
5063of three fields:
5064
5065@itemize
5066@item
5067The name of the function.
5068@item
5069A number of bytes.
5070@item
5071One or more qualifiers: @code{static}, @code{dynamic}, @code{bounded}.
5072@end itemize
5073
5074The qualifier @code{static} means that the function manipulates the stack
5075statically: a fixed number of bytes are allocated for the frame on function
5076entry and released on function exit; no stack adjustments are otherwise made
5077in the function.  The second field is this fixed number of bytes.
5078
5079The qualifier @code{dynamic} means that the function manipulates the stack
5080dynamically: in addition to the static allocation described above, stack
5081adjustments are made in the body of the function, for example to push/pop
5082arguments around function calls.  If the qualifier @code{bounded} is also
5083present, the amount of these adjustments is bounded at compile time and
5084the second field is an upper bound of the total amount of stack used by
5085the function.  If it is not present, the amount of these adjustments is
5086not bounded at compile time and the second field only represents the
5087bounded part.
5088
5089@item -fprofile-arcs
5090@opindex fprofile-arcs
5091Add code so that program flow @dfn{arcs} are instrumented.  During
5092execution the program records how many times each branch and call is
5093executed and how many times it is taken or returns.  When the compiled
5094program exits it saves this data to a file called
5095@file{@var{auxname}.gcda} for each source file.  The data may be used for
5096profile-directed optimizations (@option{-fbranch-probabilities}), or for
5097test coverage analysis (@option{-ftest-coverage}).  Each object file's
5098@var{auxname} is generated from the name of the output file, if
5099explicitly specified and it is not the final executable, otherwise it is
5100the basename of the source file.  In both cases any suffix is removed
5101(e.g.@: @file{foo.gcda} for input file @file{dir/foo.c}, or
5102@file{dir/foo.gcda} for output file specified as @option{-o dir/foo.o}).
5103@xref{Cross-profiling}.
5104
5105@cindex @command{gcov}
5106@item --coverage
5107@opindex coverage
5108
5109This option is used to compile and link code instrumented for coverage
5110analysis.  The option is a synonym for @option{-fprofile-arcs}
5111@option{-ftest-coverage} (when compiling) and @option{-lgcov} (when
5112linking).  See the documentation for those options for more details.
5113
5114@itemize
5115
5116@item
5117Compile the source files with @option{-fprofile-arcs} plus optimization
5118and code generation options.  For test coverage analysis, use the
5119additional @option{-ftest-coverage} option.  You do not need to profile
5120every source file in a program.
5121
5122@item
5123Link your object files with @option{-lgcov} or @option{-fprofile-arcs}
5124(the latter implies the former).
5125
5126@item
5127Run the program on a representative workload to generate the arc profile
5128information.  This may be repeated any number of times.  You can run
5129concurrent instances of your program, and provided that the file system
5130supports locking, the data files will be correctly updated.  Also
5131@code{fork} calls are detected and correctly handled (double counting
5132will not happen).
5133
5134@item
5135For profile-directed optimizations, compile the source files again with
5136the same optimization and code generation options plus
5137@option{-fbranch-probabilities} (@pxref{Optimize Options,,Options that
5138Control Optimization}).
5139
5140@item
5141For test coverage analysis, use @command{gcov} to produce human readable
5142information from the @file{.gcno} and @file{.gcda} files.  Refer to the
5143@command{gcov} documentation for further information.
5144
5145@end itemize
5146
5147With @option{-fprofile-arcs}, for each function of your program GCC
5148creates a program flow graph, then finds a spanning tree for the graph.
5149Only arcs that are not on the spanning tree have to be instrumented: the
5150compiler adds code to count the number of times that these arcs are
5151executed.  When an arc is the only exit or only entrance to a block, the
5152instrumentation code can be added to the block; otherwise, a new basic
5153block must be created to hold the instrumentation code.
5154
5155@need 2000
5156@item -ftest-coverage
5157@opindex ftest-coverage
5158Produce a notes file that the @command{gcov} code-coverage utility
5159(@pxref{Gcov,, @command{gcov}---a Test Coverage Program}) can use to
5160show program coverage.  Each source file's note file is called
5161@file{@var{auxname}.gcno}.  Refer to the @option{-fprofile-arcs} option
5162above for a description of @var{auxname} and instructions on how to
5163generate test coverage data.  Coverage data will match the source files
5164more closely, if you do not optimize.
5165
5166@item -fdbg-cnt-list
5167@opindex fdbg-cnt-list
5168Print the name and the counter upper bound for all debug counters.
5169
5170
5171@item -fdbg-cnt=@var{counter-value-list}
5172@opindex fdbg-cnt
5173Set the internal debug counter upper bound.  @var{counter-value-list}
5174is a comma-separated list of @var{name}:@var{value} pairs
5175which sets the upper bound of each debug counter @var{name} to @var{value}.
5176All debug counters have the initial upper bound of @var{UINT_MAX},
5177thus dbg_cnt() returns true always unless the upper bound is set by this option.
5178e.g. With -fdbg-cnt=dce:10,tail_call:0
5179dbg_cnt(dce) will return true only for first 10 invocations
5180
5181@item -fenable-@var{kind}-@var{pass}
5182@itemx -fdisable-@var{kind}-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5183@opindex fdisable-
5184@opindex fenable-
5185
5186This is a set of debugging options that are used to explicitly disable/enable
5187optimization passes. For compiler users, regular options for enabling/disabling
5188passes should be used instead.
5189
5190@itemize
5191
5192@item -fdisable-ipa-@var{pass}
5193Disable ipa pass @var{pass}. @var{pass} is the pass name.  If the same pass is
5194statically invoked in the compiler multiple times, the pass name should be
5195appended with a sequential number starting from 1.
5196
5197@item -fdisable-rtl-@var{pass}
5198@item -fdisable-rtl-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5199Disable rtl pass @var{pass}.  @var{pass} is the pass name.  If the same pass is
5200statically invoked in the compiler multiple times, the pass name should be
5201appended with a sequential number starting from 1.  @var{range-list} is a comma
5202seperated list of function ranges or assembler names.  Each range is a number
5203pair seperated by a colon.  The range is inclusive in both ends.  If the range
5204is trivial, the number pair can be simplified as a single number.  If the
5205function's cgraph node's @var{uid} is falling within one of the specified ranges,
5206the @var{pass} is disabled for that function.  The @var{uid} is shown in the
5207function header of a dump file, and the pass names can be dumped by using
5208option @option{-fdump-passes}.
5209
5210@item -fdisable-tree-@var{pass}
5211@item -fdisable-tree-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5212Disable tree pass @var{pass}.  See @option{-fdisable-rtl} for the description of
5213option arguments.
5214
5215@item -fenable-ipa-@var{pass}
5216Enable ipa pass @var{pass}.  @var{pass} is the pass name.  If the same pass is
5217statically invoked in the compiler multiple times, the pass name should be
5218appended with a sequential number starting from 1.
5219
5220@item -fenable-rtl-@var{pass}
5221@item -fenable-rtl-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5222Enable rtl pass @var{pass}.  See @option{-fdisable-rtl} for option argument
5223description and examples.
5224
5225@item -fenable-tree-@var{pass}
5226@item -fenable-tree-@var{pass}=@var{range-list}
5227Enable tree pass @var{pass}.  See @option{-fdisable-rtl} for the description
5228of option arguments.
5229
5230@smallexample
5231
5232# disable ccp1 for all functions
5233   -fdisable-tree-ccp1
5234# disable complete unroll for function whose cgraph node uid is 1
5235   -fenable-tree-cunroll=1
5236# disable gcse2 for functions at the following ranges [1,1],
5237# [300,400], and [400,1000]
5238# disable gcse2 for functions foo and foo2
5239   -fdisable-rtl-gcse2=foo,foo2
5240# disable early inlining
5241   -fdisable-tree-einline
5242# disable ipa inlining
5243   -fdisable-ipa-inline
5244# enable tree full unroll
5245   -fenable-tree-unroll
5246
5247@end smallexample
5248
5249@end itemize
5250
5251@item -d@var{letters}
5252@itemx -fdump-rtl-@var{pass}
5253@opindex d
5254Says to make debugging dumps during compilation at times specified by
5255@var{letters}.  This is used for debugging the RTL-based passes of the
5256compiler.  The file names for most of the dumps are made by appending
5257a pass number and a word to the @var{dumpname}, and the files are
5258created in the directory of the output file.  Note that the pass
5259number is computed statically as passes get registered into the pass
5260manager.  Thus the numbering is not related to the dynamic order of
5261execution of passes.  In particular, a pass installed by a plugin
5262could have a number over 200 even if it executed quite early.
5263@var{dumpname} is generated from the name of the output file, if
5264explicitly specified and it is not an executable, otherwise it is the
5265basename of the source file. These switches may have different effects
5266when @option{-E} is used for preprocessing.
5267
5268Debug dumps can be enabled with a @option{-fdump-rtl} switch or some
5269@option{-d} option @var{letters}.  Here are the possible
5270letters for use in @var{pass} and @var{letters}, and their meanings:
5271
5272@table @gcctabopt
5273
5274@item -fdump-rtl-alignments
5275@opindex fdump-rtl-alignments
5276Dump after branch alignments have been computed.
5277
5278@item -fdump-rtl-asmcons
5279@opindex fdump-rtl-asmcons
5280Dump after fixing rtl statements that have unsatisfied in/out constraints.
5281
5282@item -fdump-rtl-auto_inc_dec
5283@opindex fdump-rtl-auto_inc_dec
5284Dump after auto-inc-dec discovery.  This pass is only run on
5285architectures that have auto inc or auto dec instructions.
5286
5287@item -fdump-rtl-barriers
5288@opindex fdump-rtl-barriers
5289Dump after cleaning up the barrier instructions.
5290
5291@item -fdump-rtl-bbpart
5292@opindex fdump-rtl-bbpart
5293Dump after partitioning hot and cold basic blocks.
5294
5295@item -fdump-rtl-bbro
5296@opindex fdump-rtl-bbro
5297Dump after block reordering.
5298
5299@item -fdump-rtl-btl1
5300@itemx -fdump-rtl-btl2
5301@opindex fdump-rtl-btl2
5302@opindex fdump-rtl-btl2
5303@option{-fdump-rtl-btl1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-btl2} enable dumping
5304after the two branch
5305target load optimization passes.
5306
5307@item -fdump-rtl-bypass
5308@opindex fdump-rtl-bypass
5309Dump after jump bypassing and control flow optimizations.
5310
5311@item -fdump-rtl-combine
5312@opindex fdump-rtl-combine
5313Dump after the RTL instruction combination pass.
5314
5315@item -fdump-rtl-compgotos
5316@opindex fdump-rtl-compgotos
5317Dump after duplicating the computed gotos.
5318
5319@item -fdump-rtl-ce1
5320@itemx -fdump-rtl-ce2
5321@itemx -fdump-rtl-ce3
5322@opindex fdump-rtl-ce1
5323@opindex fdump-rtl-ce2
5324@opindex fdump-rtl-ce3
5325@option{-fdump-rtl-ce1}, @option{-fdump-rtl-ce2}, and
5326@option{-fdump-rtl-ce3} enable dumping after the three
5327if conversion passes.
5328
5329@item -fdump-rtl-cprop_hardreg
5330@opindex fdump-rtl-cprop_hardreg
5331Dump after hard register copy propagation.
5332
5333@item -fdump-rtl-csa
5334@opindex fdump-rtl-csa
5335Dump after combining stack adjustments.
5336
5337@item -fdump-rtl-cse1
5338@itemx -fdump-rtl-cse2
5339@opindex fdump-rtl-cse1
5340@opindex fdump-rtl-cse2
5341@option{-fdump-rtl-cse1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-cse2} enable dumping after
5342the two common sub-expression elimination passes.
5343
5344@item -fdump-rtl-dce
5345@opindex fdump-rtl-dce
5346Dump after the standalone dead code elimination passes.
5347
5348@item -fdump-rtl-dbr
5349@opindex fdump-rtl-dbr
5350Dump after delayed branch scheduling.
5351
5352@item -fdump-rtl-dce1
5353@itemx -fdump-rtl-dce2
5354@opindex fdump-rtl-dce1
5355@opindex fdump-rtl-dce2
5356@option{-fdump-rtl-dce1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-dce2} enable dumping after
5357the two dead store elimination passes.
5358
5359@item -fdump-rtl-eh
5360@opindex fdump-rtl-eh
5361Dump after finalization of EH handling code.
5362
5363@item -fdump-rtl-eh_ranges
5364@opindex fdump-rtl-eh_ranges
5365Dump after conversion of EH handling range regions.
5366
5367@item -fdump-rtl-expand
5368@opindex fdump-rtl-expand
5369Dump after RTL generation.
5370
5371@item -fdump-rtl-fwprop1
5372@itemx -fdump-rtl-fwprop2
5373@opindex fdump-rtl-fwprop1
5374@opindex fdump-rtl-fwprop2
5375@option{-fdump-rtl-fwprop1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-fwprop2} enable
5376dumping after the two forward propagation passes.
5377
5378@item -fdump-rtl-gcse1
5379@itemx -fdump-rtl-gcse2
5380@opindex fdump-rtl-gcse1
5381@opindex fdump-rtl-gcse2
5382@option{-fdump-rtl-gcse1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-gcse2} enable dumping
5383after global common subexpression elimination.
5384
5385@item -fdump-rtl-init-regs
5386@opindex fdump-rtl-init-regs
5387Dump after the initialization of the registers.
5388
5389@item -fdump-rtl-initvals
5390@opindex fdump-rtl-initvals
5391Dump after the computation of the initial value sets.
5392
5393@item -fdump-rtl-into_cfglayout
5394@opindex fdump-rtl-into_cfglayout
5395Dump after converting to cfglayout mode.
5396
5397@item -fdump-rtl-ira
5398@opindex fdump-rtl-ira
5399Dump after iterated register allocation.
5400
5401@item -fdump-rtl-jump
5402@opindex fdump-rtl-jump
5403Dump after the second jump optimization.
5404
5405@item -fdump-rtl-loop2
5406@opindex fdump-rtl-loop2
5407@option{-fdump-rtl-loop2} enables dumping after the rtl
5408loop optimization passes.
5409
5410@item -fdump-rtl-mach
5411@opindex fdump-rtl-mach
5412Dump after performing the machine dependent reorganization pass, if that
5413pass exists.
5414
5415@item -fdump-rtl-mode_sw
5416@opindex fdump-rtl-mode_sw
5417Dump after removing redundant mode switches.
5418
5419@item -fdump-rtl-rnreg
5420@opindex fdump-rtl-rnreg
5421Dump after register renumbering.
5422
5423@item -fdump-rtl-outof_cfglayout
5424@opindex fdump-rtl-outof_cfglayout
5425Dump after converting from cfglayout mode.
5426
5427@item -fdump-rtl-peephole2
5428@opindex fdump-rtl-peephole2
5429Dump after the peephole pass.
5430
5431@item -fdump-rtl-postreload
5432@opindex fdump-rtl-postreload
5433Dump after post-reload optimizations.
5434
5435@item -fdump-rtl-pro_and_epilogue
5436@opindex fdump-rtl-pro_and_epilogue
5437Dump after generating the function prologues and epilogues.
5438
5439@item -fdump-rtl-regmove
5440@opindex fdump-rtl-regmove
5441Dump after the register move pass.
5442
5443@item -fdump-rtl-sched1
5444@itemx -fdump-rtl-sched2
5445@opindex fdump-rtl-sched1
5446@opindex fdump-rtl-sched2
5447@option{-fdump-rtl-sched1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-sched2} enable dumping
5448after the basic block scheduling passes.
5449
5450@item -fdump-rtl-see
5451@opindex fdump-rtl-see
5452Dump after sign extension elimination.
5453
5454@item -fdump-rtl-seqabstr
5455@opindex fdump-rtl-seqabstr
5456Dump after common sequence discovery.
5457
5458@item -fdump-rtl-shorten
5459@opindex fdump-rtl-shorten
5460Dump after shortening branches.
5461
5462@item -fdump-rtl-sibling
5463@opindex fdump-rtl-sibling
5464Dump after sibling call optimizations.
5465
5466@item -fdump-rtl-split1
5467@itemx -fdump-rtl-split2
5468@itemx -fdump-rtl-split3
5469@itemx -fdump-rtl-split4
5470@itemx -fdump-rtl-split5
5471@opindex fdump-rtl-split1
5472@opindex fdump-rtl-split2
5473@opindex fdump-rtl-split3
5474@opindex fdump-rtl-split4
5475@opindex fdump-rtl-split5
5476@option{-fdump-rtl-split1}, @option{-fdump-rtl-split2},
5477@option{-fdump-rtl-split3}, @option{-fdump-rtl-split4} and
5478@option{-fdump-rtl-split5} enable dumping after five rounds of
5479instruction splitting.
5480
5481@item -fdump-rtl-sms
5482@opindex fdump-rtl-sms
5483Dump after modulo scheduling.  This pass is only run on some
5484architectures.
5485
5486@item -fdump-rtl-stack
5487@opindex fdump-rtl-stack
5488Dump after conversion from GCC's "flat register file" registers to the
5489x87's stack-like registers.  This pass is only run on x86 variants.
5490
5491@item -fdump-rtl-subreg1
5492@itemx -fdump-rtl-subreg2
5493@opindex fdump-rtl-subreg1
5494@opindex fdump-rtl-subreg2
5495@option{-fdump-rtl-subreg1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-subreg2} enable dumping after
5496the two subreg expansion passes.
5497
5498@item -fdump-rtl-unshare
5499@opindex fdump-rtl-unshare
5500Dump after all rtl has been unshared.
5501
5502@item -fdump-rtl-vartrack
5503@opindex fdump-rtl-vartrack
5504Dump after variable tracking.
5505
5506@item -fdump-rtl-vregs
5507@opindex fdump-rtl-vregs
5508Dump after converting virtual registers to hard registers.
5509
5510@item -fdump-rtl-web
5511@opindex fdump-rtl-web
5512Dump after live range splitting.
5513
5514@item -fdump-rtl-regclass
5515@itemx -fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_init
5516@itemx -fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_finish
5517@itemx -fdump-rtl-dfinit
5518@itemx -fdump-rtl-dfinish
5519@opindex fdump-rtl-regclass
5520@opindex fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_init
5521@opindex fdump-rtl-subregs_of_mode_finish
5522@opindex fdump-rtl-dfinit
5523@opindex fdump-rtl-dfinish
5524These dumps are defined but always produce empty files.
5525
5526@item -da
5527@itemx -fdump-rtl-all
5528@opindex da
5529@opindex fdump-rtl-all
5530Produce all the dumps listed above.
5531
5532@item -dA
5533@opindex dA
5534Annotate the assembler output with miscellaneous debugging information.
5535
5536@item -dD
5537@opindex dD
5538Dump all macro definitions, at the end of preprocessing, in addition to
5539normal output.
5540
5541@item -dH
5542@opindex dH
5543Produce a core dump whenever an error occurs.
5544
5545@item -dp
5546@opindex dp
5547Annotate the assembler output with a comment indicating which
5548pattern and alternative was used.  The length of each instruction is
5549also printed.
5550
5551@item -dP
5552@opindex dP
5553Dump the RTL in the assembler output as a comment before each instruction.
5554Also turns on @option{-dp} annotation.
5555
5556@item -dv
5557@opindex dv
5558For each of the other indicated dump files (@option{-fdump-rtl-@var{pass}}),
5559dump a representation of the control flow graph suitable for viewing with VCG
5560to @file{@var{file}.@var{pass}.vcg}.
5561
5562@item -dx
5563@opindex dx
5564Just generate RTL for a function instead of compiling it.  Usually used
5565with @option{-fdump-rtl-expand}.
5566@end table
5567
5568@item -fdump-noaddr
5569@opindex fdump-noaddr
5570When doing debugging dumps, suppress address output.  This makes it more
5571feasible to use diff on debugging dumps for compiler invocations with
5572different compiler binaries and/or different
5573text / bss / data / heap / stack / dso start locations.
5574
5575@item -fdump-unnumbered
5576@opindex fdump-unnumbered
5577When doing debugging dumps, suppress instruction numbers and address output.
5578This makes it more feasible to use diff on debugging dumps for compiler
5579invocations with different options, in particular with and without
5580@option{-g}.
5581
5582@item -fdump-unnumbered-links
5583@opindex fdump-unnumbered-links
5584When doing debugging dumps (see @option{-d} option above), suppress
5585instruction numbers for the links to the previous and next instructions
5586in a sequence.
5587
5588@item -fdump-translation-unit @r{(C++ only)}
5589@itemx -fdump-translation-unit-@var{options} @r{(C++ only)}
5590@opindex fdump-translation-unit
5591Dump a representation of the tree structure for the entire translation
5592unit to a file.  The file name is made by appending @file{.tu} to the
5593source file name, and the file is created in the same directory as the
5594output file.  If the @samp{-@var{options}} form is used, @var{options}
5595controls the details of the dump as described for the
5596@option{-fdump-tree} options.
5597
5598@item -fdump-class-hierarchy @r{(C++ only)}
5599@itemx -fdump-class-hierarchy-@var{options} @r{(C++ only)}
5600@opindex fdump-class-hierarchy
5601Dump a representation of each class's hierarchy and virtual function
5602table layout to a file.  The file name is made by appending
5603@file{.class} to the source file name, and the file is created in the
5604same directory as the output file.  If the @samp{-@var{options}} form
5605is used, @var{options} controls the details of the dump as described
5606for the @option{-fdump-tree} options.
5607
5608@item -fdump-ipa-@var{switch}
5609@opindex fdump-ipa
5610Control the dumping at various stages of inter-procedural analysis
5611language tree to a file.  The file name is generated by appending a
5612switch specific suffix to the source file name, and the file is created
5613in the same directory as the output file.  The following dumps are
5614possible:
5615
5616@table @samp
5617@item all
5618Enables all inter-procedural analysis dumps.
5619
5620@item cgraph
5621Dumps information about call-graph optimization, unused function removal,
5622and inlining decisions.
5623
5624@item inline
5625Dump after function inlining.
5626
5627@end table
5628
5629@item -fdump-passes
5630@opindex fdump-passes
5631Dump the list of optimization passes that are turned on and off by
5632the current command-line options.
5633
5634@item -fdump-statistics-@var{option}
5635@opindex fdump-statistics
5636Enable and control dumping of pass statistics in a separate file.  The
5637file name is generated by appending a suffix ending in
5638@samp{.statistics} to the source file name, and the file is created in
5639the same directory as the output file.  If the @samp{-@var{option}}
5640form is used, @samp{-stats} will cause counters to be summed over the
5641whole compilation unit while @samp{-details} will dump every event as
5642the passes generate them.  The default with no option is to sum
5643counters for each function compiled.
5644
5645@item -fdump-tree-@var{switch}
5646@itemx -fdump-tree-@var{switch}-@var{options}
5647@opindex fdump-tree
5648Control the dumping at various stages of processing the intermediate
5649language tree to a file.  The file name is generated by appending a
5650switch specific suffix to the source file name, and the file is
5651created in the same directory as the output file.  If the
5652@samp{-@var{options}} form is used, @var{options} is a list of
5653@samp{-} separated options which control the details of the dump.  Not
5654all options are applicable to all dumps; those that are not
5655meaningful will be ignored.  The following options are available
5656
5657@table @samp
5658@item address
5659Print the address of each node.  Usually this is not meaningful as it
5660changes according to the environment and source file.  Its primary use
5661is for tying up a dump file with a debug environment.
5662@item asmname
5663If @code{DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME} has been set for a given decl, use that
5664in the dump instead of @code{DECL_NAME}.  Its primary use is ease of
5665use working backward from mangled names in the assembly file.
5666@item slim
5667Inhibit dumping of members of a scope or body of a function merely
5668because that scope has been reached.  Only dump such items when they
5669are directly reachable by some other path.  When dumping pretty-printed
5670trees, this option inhibits dumping the bodies of control structures.
5671@item raw
5672Print a raw representation of the tree.  By default, trees are
5673pretty-printed into a C-like representation.
5674@item details
5675Enable more detailed dumps (not honored by every dump option).
5676@item stats
5677Enable dumping various statistics about the pass (not honored by every dump
5678option).
5679@item blocks
5680Enable showing basic block boundaries (disabled in raw dumps).
5681@item vops
5682Enable showing virtual operands for every statement.
5683@item lineno
5684Enable showing line numbers for statements.
5685@item uid
5686Enable showing the unique ID (@code{DECL_UID}) for each variable.
5687@item verbose
5688Enable showing the tree dump for each statement.
5689@item eh
5690Enable showing the EH region number holding each statement.
5691@item scev
5692Enable showing scalar evolution analysis details.
5693@item all
5694Turn on all options, except @option{raw}, @option{slim}, @option{verbose}
5695and @option{lineno}.
5696@end table
5697
5698The following tree dumps are possible:
5699@table @samp
5700
5701@item original
5702@opindex fdump-tree-original
5703Dump before any tree based optimization, to @file{@var{file}.original}.
5704
5705@item optimized
5706@opindex fdump-tree-optimized
5707Dump after all tree based optimization, to @file{@var{file}.optimized}.
5708
5709@item gimple
5710@opindex fdump-tree-gimple
5711Dump each function before and after the gimplification pass to a file.  The
5712file name is made by appending @file{.gimple} to the source file name.
5713
5714@item cfg
5715@opindex fdump-tree-cfg
5716Dump the control flow graph of each function to a file.  The file name is
5717made by appending @file{.cfg} to the source file name.
5718
5719@item vcg
5720@opindex fdump-tree-vcg
5721Dump the control flow graph of each function to a file in VCG format.  The
5722file name is made by appending @file{.vcg} to the source file name.  Note
5723that if the file contains more than one function, the generated file cannot
5724be used directly by VCG@.  You will need to cut and paste each function's
5725graph into its own separate file first.
5726
5727@item ch
5728@opindex fdump-tree-ch
5729Dump each function after copying loop headers.  The file name is made by
5730appending @file{.ch} to the source file name.
5731
5732@item ssa
5733@opindex fdump-tree-ssa
5734Dump SSA related information to a file.  The file name is made by appending
5735@file{.ssa} to the source file name.
5736
5737@item alias
5738@opindex fdump-tree-alias
5739Dump aliasing information for each function.  The file name is made by
5740appending @file{.alias} to the source file name.
5741
5742@item ccp
5743@opindex fdump-tree-ccp
5744Dump each function after CCP@.  The file name is made by appending
5745@file{.ccp} to the source file name.
5746
5747@item storeccp
5748@opindex fdump-tree-storeccp
5749Dump each function after STORE-CCP@.  The file name is made by appending
5750@file{.storeccp} to the source file name.
5751
5752@item pre
5753@opindex fdump-tree-pre
5754Dump trees after partial redundancy elimination.  The file name is made
5755by appending @file{.pre} to the source file name.
5756
5757@item fre
5758@opindex fdump-tree-fre
5759Dump trees after full redundancy elimination.  The file name is made
5760by appending @file{.fre} to the source file name.
5761
5762@item copyprop
5763@opindex fdump-tree-copyprop
5764Dump trees after copy propagation.  The file name is made
5765by appending @file{.copyprop} to the source file name.
5766
5767@item store_copyprop
5768@opindex fdump-tree-store_copyprop
5769Dump trees after store copy-propagation.  The file name is made
5770by appending @file{.store_copyprop} to the source file name.
5771
5772@item dce
5773@opindex fdump-tree-dce
5774Dump each function after dead code elimination.  The file name is made by
5775appending @file{.dce} to the source file name.
5776
5777@item mudflap
5778@opindex fdump-tree-mudflap
5779Dump each function after adding mudflap instrumentation.  The file name is
5780made by appending @file{.mudflap} to the source file name.
5781
5782@item sra
5783@opindex fdump-tree-sra
5784Dump each function after performing scalar replacement of aggregates.  The
5785file name is made by appending @file{.sra} to the source file name.
5786
5787@item sink
5788@opindex fdump-tree-sink
5789Dump each function after performing code sinking.  The file name is made
5790by appending @file{.sink} to the source file name.
5791
5792@item dom
5793@opindex fdump-tree-dom
5794Dump each function after applying dominator tree optimizations.  The file
5795name is made by appending @file{.dom} to the source file name.
5796
5797@item dse
5798@opindex fdump-tree-dse
5799Dump each function after applying dead store elimination.  The file
5800name is made by appending @file{.dse} to the source file name.
5801
5802@item phiopt
5803@opindex fdump-tree-phiopt
5804Dump each function after optimizing PHI nodes into straightline code.  The file
5805name is made by appending @file{.phiopt} to the source file name.
5806
5807@item forwprop
5808@opindex fdump-tree-forwprop
5809Dump each function after forward propagating single use variables.  The file
5810name is made by appending @file{.forwprop} to the source file name.
5811
5812@item copyrename
5813@opindex fdump-tree-copyrename
5814Dump each function after applying the copy rename optimization.  The file
5815name is made by appending @file{.copyrename} to the source file name.
5816
5817@item nrv
5818@opindex fdump-tree-nrv
5819Dump each function after applying the named return value optimization on
5820generic trees.  The file name is made by appending @file{.nrv} to the source
5821file name.
5822
5823@item vect
5824@opindex fdump-tree-vect
5825Dump each function after applying vectorization of loops.  The file name is
5826made by appending @file{.vect} to the source file name.
5827
5828@item slp
5829@opindex fdump-tree-slp
5830Dump each function after applying vectorization of basic blocks.  The file name
5831is made by appending @file{.slp} to the source file name.
5832
5833@item vrp
5834@opindex fdump-tree-vrp
5835Dump each function after Value Range Propagation (VRP).  The file name
5836is made by appending @file{.vrp} to the source file name.
5837
5838@item all
5839@opindex fdump-tree-all
5840Enable all the available tree dumps with the flags provided in this option.
5841@end table
5842
5843@item -ftree-vectorizer-verbose=@var{n}
5844@opindex ftree-vectorizer-verbose
5845This option controls the amount of debugging output the vectorizer prints.
5846This information is written to standard error, unless
5847@option{-fdump-tree-all} or @option{-fdump-tree-vect} is specified,
5848in which case it is output to the usual dump listing file, @file{.vect}.
5849For @var{n}=0 no diagnostic information is reported.
5850If @var{n}=1 the vectorizer reports each loop that got vectorized,
5851and the total number of loops that got vectorized.
5852If @var{n}=2 the vectorizer also reports non-vectorized loops that passed
5853the first analysis phase (vect_analyze_loop_form) - i.e.@: countable,
5854inner-most, single-bb, single-entry/exit loops.  This is the same verbosity
5855level that @option{-fdump-tree-vect-stats} uses.
5856Higher verbosity levels mean either more information dumped for each
5857reported loop, or same amount of information reported for more loops:
5858if @var{n}=3, vectorizer cost model information is reported.
5859If @var{n}=4, alignment related information is added to the reports.
5860If @var{n}=5, data-references related information (e.g.@: memory dependences,
5861memory access-patterns) is added to the reports.
5862If @var{n}=6, the vectorizer reports also non-vectorized inner-most loops
5863that did not pass the first analysis phase (i.e., may not be countable, or
5864may have complicated control-flow).
5865If @var{n}=7, the vectorizer reports also non-vectorized nested loops.
5866If @var{n}=8, SLP related information is added to the reports.
5867For @var{n}=9, all the information the vectorizer generates during its
5868analysis and transformation is reported.  This is the same verbosity level
5869that @option{-fdump-tree-vect-details} uses.
5870
5871@item -frandom-seed=@var{string}
5872@opindex frandom-seed
5873This option provides a seed that GCC uses when it would otherwise use
5874random numbers.  It is used to generate certain symbol names
5875that have to be different in every compiled file.  It is also used to
5876place unique stamps in coverage data files and the object files that
5877produce them.  You can use the @option{-frandom-seed} option to produce
5878reproducibly identical object files.
5879
5880The @var{string} should be different for every file you compile.
5881
5882@item -fsched-verbose=@var{n}
5883@opindex fsched-verbose
5884On targets that use instruction scheduling, this option controls the
5885amount of debugging output the scheduler prints.  This information is
5886written to standard error, unless @option{-fdump-rtl-sched1} or
5887@option{-fdump-rtl-sched2} is specified, in which case it is output
5888to the usual dump listing file, @file{.sched1} or @file{.sched2}
5889respectively.  However for @var{n} greater than nine, the output is
5890always printed to standard error.
5891
5892For @var{n} greater than zero, @option{-fsched-verbose} outputs the
5893same information as @option{-fdump-rtl-sched1} and @option{-fdump-rtl-sched2}.
5894For @var{n} greater than one, it also output basic block probabilities,
5895detailed ready list information and unit/insn info.  For @var{n} greater
5896than two, it includes RTL at abort point, control-flow and regions info.
5897And for @var{n} over four, @option{-fsched-verbose} also includes
5898dependence info.
5899
5900@item -save-temps
5901@itemx -save-temps=cwd
5902@opindex save-temps
5903Store the usual ``temporary'' intermediate files permanently; place them
5904in the current directory and name them based on the source file.  Thus,
5905compiling @file{foo.c} with @samp{-c -save-temps} would produce files
5906@file{foo.i} and @file{foo.s}, as well as @file{foo.o}.  This creates a
5907preprocessed @file{foo.i} output file even though the compiler now
5908normally uses an integrated preprocessor.
5909
5910When used in combination with the @option{-x} command-line option,
5911@option{-save-temps} is sensible enough to avoid over writing an
5912input source file with the same extension as an intermediate file.
5913The corresponding intermediate file may be obtained by renaming the
5914source file before using @option{-save-temps}.
5915
5916If you invoke GCC in parallel, compiling several different source
5917files that share a common base name in different subdirectories or the
5918same source file compiled for multiple output destinations, it is
5919likely that the different parallel compilers will interfere with each
5920other, and overwrite the temporary files.  For instance:
5921
5922@smallexample
5923gcc -save-temps -o outdir1/foo.o indir1/foo.c&
5924gcc -save-temps -o outdir2/foo.o indir2/foo.c&
5925@end smallexample
5926
5927may result in @file{foo.i} and @file{foo.o} being written to
5928simultaneously by both compilers.
5929
5930@item -save-temps=obj
5931@opindex save-temps=obj
5932Store the usual ``temporary'' intermediate files permanently.  If the
5933@option{-o} option is used, the temporary files are based on the
5934object file.  If the @option{-o} option is not used, the
5935@option{-save-temps=obj} switch behaves like @option{-save-temps}.
5936
5937For example:
5938
5939@smallexample
5940gcc -save-temps=obj -c foo.c
5941gcc -save-temps=obj -c bar.c -o dir/xbar.o
5942gcc -save-temps=obj foobar.c -o dir2/yfoobar
5943@end smallexample
5944
5945would create @file{foo.i}, @file{foo.s}, @file{dir/xbar.i},
5946@file{dir/xbar.s}, @file{dir2/yfoobar.i}, @file{dir2/yfoobar.s}, and
5947@file{dir2/yfoobar.o}.
5948
5949@item -time@r{[}=@var{file}@r{]}
5950@opindex time
5951Report the CPU time taken by each subprocess in the compilation
5952sequence.  For C source files, this is the compiler proper and assembler
5953(plus the linker if linking is done).
5954
5955Without the specification of an output file, the output looks like this:
5956
5957@smallexample
5958# cc1 0.12 0.01
5959# as 0.00 0.01
5960@end smallexample
5961
5962The first number on each line is the ``user time'', that is time spent
5963executing the program itself.  The second number is ``system time'',
5964time spent executing operating system routines on behalf of the program.
5965Both numbers are in seconds.
5966
5967With the specification of an output file, the output is appended to the
5968named file, and it looks like this:
5969
5970@smallexample
59710.12 0.01 cc1 @var{options}
59720.00 0.01 as @var{options}
5973@end smallexample
5974
5975The ``user time'' and the ``system time'' are moved before the program
5976name, and the options passed to the program are displayed, so that one
5977can later tell what file was being compiled, and with which options.
5978
5979@item -fvar-tracking
5980@opindex fvar-tracking
5981Run variable tracking pass.  It computes where variables are stored at each
5982position in code.  Better debugging information is then generated
5983(if the debugging information format supports this information).
5984
5985It is enabled by default when compiling with optimization (@option{-Os},
5986@option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @dots{}), debugging information (@option{-g}) and
5987the debug info format supports it.
5988
5989@item -fvar-tracking-assignments
5990@opindex fvar-tracking-assignments
5991@opindex fno-var-tracking-assignments
5992Annotate assignments to user variables early in the compilation and
5993attempt to carry the annotations over throughout the compilation all the
5994way to the end, in an attempt to improve debug information while
5995optimizing.  Use of @option{-gdwarf-4} is recommended along with it.
5996
5997It can be enabled even if var-tracking is disabled, in which case
5998annotations will be created and maintained, but discarded at the end.
5999
6000@item -fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle
6001@opindex fvar-tracking-assignments-toggle
6002@opindex fno-var-tracking-assignments-toggle
6003Toggle @option{-fvar-tracking-assignments}, in the same way that
6004@option{-gtoggle} toggles @option{-g}.
6005
6006@item -print-file-name=@var{library}
6007@opindex print-file-name
6008Print the full absolute name of the library file @var{library} that
6009would be used when linking---and don't do anything else.  With this
6010option, GCC does not compile or link anything; it just prints the
6011file name.
6012
6013@item -print-multi-directory
6014@opindex print-multi-directory
6015Print the directory name corresponding to the multilib selected by any
6016other switches present in the command line.  This directory is supposed
6017to exist in @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.
6018
6019@item -print-multi-lib
6020@opindex print-multi-lib
6021Print the mapping from multilib directory names to compiler switches
6022that enable them.  The directory name is separated from the switches by
6023@samp{;}, and each switch starts with an @samp{@@} instead of the
6024@samp{-}, without spaces between multiple switches.  This is supposed to
6025ease shell-processing.
6026
6027@item -print-multi-os-directory
6028@opindex print-multi-os-directory
6029Print the path to OS libraries for the selected
6030multilib, relative to some @file{lib} subdirectory.  If OS libraries are
6031present in the @file{lib} subdirectory and no multilibs are used, this is
6032usually just @file{.}, if OS libraries are present in @file{lib@var{suffix}}
6033sibling directories this prints e.g.@: @file{../lib64}, @file{../lib} or
6034@file{../lib32}, or if OS libraries are present in @file{lib/@var{subdir}}
6035subdirectories it prints e.g.@: @file{amd64}, @file{sparcv9} or @file{ev6}.
6036
6037@item -print-multiarch
6038@opindex print-multiarch
6039Print the path to OS libraries for the selected multiarch,
6040relative to some @file{lib} subdirectory.
6041
6042@item -print-prog-name=@var{program}
6043@opindex print-prog-name
6044Like @option{-print-file-name}, but searches for a program such as @samp{cpp}.
6045
6046@item -print-libgcc-file-name
6047@opindex print-libgcc-file-name
6048Same as @option{-print-file-name=libgcc.a}.
6049
6050This is useful when you use @option{-nostdlib} or @option{-nodefaultlibs}
6051but you do want to link with @file{libgcc.a}.  You can do
6052
6053@smallexample
6054gcc -nostdlib @var{files}@dots{} `gcc -print-libgcc-file-name`
6055@end smallexample
6056
6057@item -print-search-dirs
6058@opindex print-search-dirs
6059Print the name of the configured installation directory and a list of
6060program and library directories @command{gcc} will search---and don't do anything else.
6061
6062This is useful when @command{gcc} prints the error message
6063@samp{installation problem, cannot exec cpp0: No such file or directory}.
6064To resolve this you either need to put @file{cpp0} and the other compiler
6065components where @command{gcc} expects to find them, or you can set the environment
6066variable @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} to the directory where you installed them.
6067Don't forget the trailing @samp{/}.
6068@xref{Environment Variables}.
6069
6070@item -print-sysroot
6071@opindex print-sysroot
6072Print the target sysroot directory that will be used during
6073compilation.  This is the target sysroot specified either at configure
6074time or using the @option{--sysroot} option, possibly with an extra
6075suffix that depends on compilation options.  If no target sysroot is
6076specified, the option prints nothing.
6077
6078@item -print-sysroot-headers-suffix
6079@opindex print-sysroot-headers-suffix
6080Print the suffix added to the target sysroot when searching for
6081headers, or give an error if the compiler is not configured with such
6082a suffix---and don't do anything else.
6083
6084@item -dumpmachine
6085@opindex dumpmachine
6086Print the compiler's target machine (for example,
6087@samp{i686-pc-linux-gnu})---and don't do anything else.
6088
6089@item -dumpversion
6090@opindex dumpversion
6091Print the compiler version (for example, @samp{3.0})---and don't do
6092anything else.
6093
6094@item -dumpspecs
6095@opindex dumpspecs
6096Print the compiler's built-in specs---and don't do anything else.  (This
6097is used when GCC itself is being built.)  @xref{Spec Files}.
6098
6099@item -feliminate-unused-debug-types
6100@opindex feliminate-unused-debug-types
6101Normally, when producing DWARF2 output, GCC will emit debugging
6102information for all types declared in a compilation
6103unit, regardless of whether or not they are actually used
6104in that compilation unit.  Sometimes this is useful, such as
6105if, in the debugger, you want to cast a value to a type that is
6106not actually used in your program (but is declared).  More often,
6107however, this results in a significant amount of wasted space.
6108With this option, GCC will avoid producing debug symbol output
6109for types that are nowhere used in the source file being compiled.
6110@end table
6111
6112@node Optimize Options
6113@section Options That Control Optimization
6114@cindex optimize options
6115@cindex options, optimization
6116
6117These options control various sorts of optimizations.
6118
6119Without any optimization option, the compiler's goal is to reduce the
6120cost of compilation and to make debugging produce the expected
6121results.  Statements are independent: if you stop the program with a
6122breakpoint between statements, you can then assign a new value to any
6123variable or change the program counter to any other statement in the
6124function and get exactly the results you would expect from the source
6125code.
6126
6127Turning on optimization flags makes the compiler attempt to improve
6128the performance and/or code size at the expense of compilation time
6129and possibly the ability to debug the program.
6130
6131The compiler performs optimization based on the knowledge it has of the
6132program.  Compiling multiple files at once to a single output file mode allows
6133the compiler to use information gained from all of the files when compiling
6134each of them.
6135
6136Not all optimizations are controlled directly by a flag.  Only
6137optimizations that have a flag are listed in this section.
6138
6139Most optimizations are only enabled if an @option{-O} level is set on
6140the command line.  Otherwise they are disabled, even if individual
6141optimization flags are specified.
6142
6143Depending on the target and how GCC was configured, a slightly different
6144set of optimizations may be enabled at each @option{-O} level than
6145those listed here.  You can invoke GCC with @samp{-Q --help=optimizers}
6146to find out the exact set of optimizations that are enabled at each level.
6147@xref{Overall Options}, for examples.
6148
6149@table @gcctabopt
6150@item -O
6151@itemx -O1
6152@opindex O
6153@opindex O1
6154Optimize.  Optimizing compilation takes somewhat more time, and a lot
6155more memory for a large function.
6156
6157With @option{-O}, the compiler tries to reduce code size and execution
6158time, without performing any optimizations that take a great deal of
6159compilation time.
6160
6161@option{-O} turns on the following optimization flags:
6162@gccoptlist{
6163-fauto-inc-dec @gol
6164-fcompare-elim @gol
6165-fcprop-registers @gol
6166-fdce @gol
6167-fdefer-pop @gol
6168-fdelayed-branch @gol
6169-fdse @gol
6170-fguess-branch-probability @gol
6171-fif-conversion2 @gol
6172-fif-conversion @gol
6173-fipa-pure-const @gol
6174-fipa-profile @gol
6175-fipa-reference @gol
6176-fmerge-constants
6177-fsplit-wide-types @gol
6178-ftree-bit-ccp @gol
6179-ftree-builtin-call-dce @gol
6180-ftree-ccp @gol
6181-ftree-ch @gol
6182-ftree-copyrename @gol
6183-ftree-dce @gol
6184-ftree-dominator-opts @gol
6185-ftree-dse @gol
6186-ftree-forwprop @gol
6187-ftree-fre @gol
6188-ftree-phiprop @gol
6189-ftree-sra @gol
6190-ftree-pta @gol
6191-ftree-ter @gol
6192-funit-at-a-time}
6193
6194@option{-O} also turns on @option{-fomit-frame-pointer} on machines
6195where doing so does not interfere with debugging.
6196
6197@item -O2
6198@opindex O2
6199Optimize even more.  GCC performs nearly all supported optimizations
6200that do not involve a space-speed tradeoff.
6201As compared to @option{-O}, this option increases both compilation time
6202and the performance of the generated code.
6203
6204@option{-O2} turns on all optimization flags specified by @option{-O}.  It
6205also turns on the following optimization flags:
6206@gccoptlist{-fthread-jumps @gol
6207-falign-functions  -falign-jumps @gol
6208-falign-loops  -falign-labels @gol
6209-fcaller-saves @gol
6210-fcrossjumping @gol
6211-fcse-follow-jumps  -fcse-skip-blocks @gol
6212-fdelete-null-pointer-checks @gol
6213-fdevirtualize @gol
6214-fexpensive-optimizations @gol
6215-fgcse  -fgcse-lm  @gol
6216-finline-small-functions @gol
6217-findirect-inlining @gol
6218-fipa-sra @gol
6219-foptimize-sibling-calls @gol
6220-fpartial-inlining @gol
6221-fpeephole2 @gol
6222-fregmove @gol
6223-freorder-blocks  -freorder-functions @gol
6224-frerun-cse-after-loop  @gol
6225-fsched-interblock  -fsched-spec @gol
6226-fschedule-insns  -fschedule-insns2 @gol
6227-fstrict-aliasing -fstrict-overflow @gol
6228-ftree-switch-conversion -ftree-tail-merge @gol
6229-ftree-pre @gol
6230-ftree-vrp}
6231
6232Please note the warning under @option{-fgcse} about
6233invoking @option{-O2} on programs that use computed gotos.
6234
6235@item -O3
6236@opindex O3
6237Optimize yet more.  @option{-O3} turns on all optimizations specified
6238by @option{-O2} and also turns on the @option{-finline-functions},
6239@option{-funswitch-loops}, @option{-fpredictive-commoning},
6240@option{-fgcse-after-reload}, @option{-ftree-vectorize} and
6241@option{-fipa-cp-clone} options.
6242
6243@item -O0
6244@opindex O0
6245Reduce compilation time and make debugging produce the expected
6246results.  This is the default.
6247
6248@item -Os
6249@opindex Os
6250Optimize for size.  @option{-Os} enables all @option{-O2} optimizations that
6251do not typically increase code size.  It also performs further
6252optimizations designed to reduce code size.
6253
6254@option{-Os} disables the following optimization flags:
6255@gccoptlist{-falign-functions  -falign-jumps  -falign-loops @gol
6256-falign-labels  -freorder-blocks  -freorder-blocks-and-partition @gol
6257-fprefetch-loop-arrays  -ftree-vect-loop-version}
6258
6259@item -Ofast
6260@opindex Ofast
6261Disregard strict standards compliance.  @option{-Ofast} enables all
6262@option{-O3} optimizations.  It also enables optimizations that are not
6263valid for all standard compliant programs.
6264It turns on @option{-ffast-math} and the Fortran-specific
6265@option{-fno-protect-parens} and @option{-fstack-arrays}.
6266
6267If you use multiple @option{-O} options, with or without level numbers,
6268the last such option is the one that is effective.
6269@end table
6270
6271Options of the form @option{-f@var{flag}} specify machine-independent
6272flags.  Most flags have both positive and negative forms; the negative
6273form of @option{-ffoo} would be @option{-fno-foo}.  In the table
6274below, only one of the forms is listed---the one you typically will
6275use.  You can figure out the other form by either removing @samp{no-}
6276or adding it.
6277
6278The following options control specific optimizations.  They are either
6279activated by @option{-O} options or are related to ones that are.  You
6280can use the following flags in the rare cases when ``fine-tuning'' of
6281optimizations to be performed is desired.
6282
6283@table @gcctabopt
6284@item -fno-default-inline
6285@opindex fno-default-inline
6286Do not make member functions inline by default merely because they are
6287defined inside the class scope (C++ only).  Otherwise, when you specify
6288@w{@option{-O}}, member functions defined inside class scope are compiled
6289inline by default; i.e., you don't need to add @samp{inline} in front of
6290the member function name.
6291
6292@item -fno-defer-pop
6293@opindex fno-defer-pop
6294Always pop the arguments to each function call as soon as that function
6295returns.  For machines that must pop arguments after a function call,
6296the compiler normally lets arguments accumulate on the stack for several
6297function calls and pops them all at once.
6298
6299Disabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6300
6301@item -fforward-propagate
6302@opindex fforward-propagate
6303Perform a forward propagation pass on RTL@.  The pass tries to combine two
6304instructions and checks if the result can be simplified.  If loop unrolling
6305is active, two passes are performed and the second is scheduled after
6306loop unrolling.
6307
6308This option is enabled by default at optimization levels @option{-O},
6309@option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6310
6311@item -ffp-contract=@var{style}
6312@opindex ffp-contract
6313@option{-ffp-contract=off} disables floating-point expression contraction.
6314@option{-ffp-contract=fast} enables floating-point expression contraction
6315such as forming of fused multiply-add operations if the target has
6316native support for them.
6317@option{-ffp-contract=on} enables floating-point expression contraction
6318if allowed by the language standard.  This is currently not implemented
6319and treated equal to @option{-ffp-contract=off}.
6320
6321The default is @option{-ffp-contract=fast}.
6322
6323@item -fomit-frame-pointer
6324@opindex fomit-frame-pointer
6325Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for functions that
6326don't need one.  This avoids the instructions to save, set up and
6327restore frame pointers; it also makes an extra register available
6328in many functions.  @strong{It also makes debugging impossible on
6329some machines.}
6330
6331On some machines, such as the VAX, this flag has no effect, because
6332the standard calling sequence automatically handles the frame pointer
6333and nothing is saved by pretending it doesn't exist.  The
6334machine-description macro @code{FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} controls
6335whether a target machine supports this flag.  @xref{Registers,,Register
6336Usage, gccint, GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.
6337
6338Starting with GCC version 4.6, the default setting (when not optimizing for
6339size) for 32-bit Linux x86 and 32-bit Darwin x86 targets has been changed to
6340@option{-fomit-frame-pointer}.  The default can be reverted to
6341@option{-fno-omit-frame-pointer} by configuring GCC with the
6342@option{--enable-frame-pointer} configure option.
6343
6344Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6345
6346@item -foptimize-sibling-calls
6347@opindex foptimize-sibling-calls
6348Optimize sibling and tail recursive calls.
6349
6350Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6351
6352@item -fno-inline
6353@opindex fno-inline
6354Do not expand any functions inline apart from those marked with
6355the @code{always_inline} attribute.  This is the default when not
6356optimizing.
6357
6358Single functions can be exempted from inlining by marking them
6359with the @code{noinline} attribute.
6360
6361@item -finline-small-functions
6362@opindex finline-small-functions
6363Integrate functions into their callers when their body is smaller than expected
6364function call code (so overall size of program gets smaller).  The compiler
6365heuristically decides which functions are simple enough to be worth integrating
6366in this way.  This inlining applies to all functions, even those not declared
6367inline.
6368
6369Enabled at level @option{-O2}.
6370
6371@item -findirect-inlining
6372@opindex findirect-inlining
6373Inline also indirect calls that are discovered to be known at compile
6374time thanks to previous inlining.  This option has any effect only
6375when inlining itself is turned on by the @option{-finline-functions}
6376or @option{-finline-small-functions} options.
6377
6378Enabled at level @option{-O2}.
6379
6380@item -finline-functions
6381@opindex finline-functions
6382Consider all functions for inlining, even if they are not declared inline.
6383The compiler heuristically decides which functions are worth integrating
6384in this way.
6385
6386If all calls to a given function are integrated, and the function is
6387declared @code{static}, then the function is normally not output as
6388assembler code in its own right.
6389
6390Enabled at level @option{-O3}.
6391
6392@item -finline-functions-called-once
6393@opindex finline-functions-called-once
6394Consider all @code{static} functions called once for inlining into their
6395caller even if they are not marked @code{inline}.  If a call to a given
6396function is integrated, then the function is not output as assembler code
6397in its own right.
6398
6399Enabled at levels @option{-O1}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3} and @option{-Os}.
6400
6401@item -fearly-inlining
6402@opindex fearly-inlining
6403Inline functions marked by @code{always_inline} and functions whose body seems
6404smaller than the function call overhead early before doing
6405@option{-fprofile-generate} instrumentation and real inlining pass.  Doing so
6406makes profiling significantly cheaper and usually inlining faster on programs
6407having large chains of nested wrapper functions.
6408
6409Enabled by default.
6410
6411@item -fipa-sra
6412@opindex fipa-sra
6413Perform interprocedural scalar replacement of aggregates, removal of
6414unused parameters and replacement of parameters passed by reference
6415by parameters passed by value.
6416
6417Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3} and @option{-Os}.
6418
6419@item -finline-limit=@var{n}
6420@opindex finline-limit
6421By default, GCC limits the size of functions that can be inlined.  This flag
6422allows coarse control of this limit.  @var{n} is the size of functions that
6423can be inlined in number of pseudo instructions.
6424
6425Inlining is actually controlled by a number of parameters, which may be
6426specified individually by using @option{--param @var{name}=@var{value}}.
6427The @option{-finline-limit=@var{n}} option sets some of these parameters
6428as follows:
6429
6430@table @gcctabopt
6431@item max-inline-insns-single
6432is set to @var{n}/2.
6433@item max-inline-insns-auto
6434is set to @var{n}/2.
6435@end table
6436
6437See below for a documentation of the individual
6438parameters controlling inlining and for the defaults of these parameters.
6439
6440@emph{Note:} there may be no value to @option{-finline-limit} that results
6441in default behavior.
6442
6443@emph{Note:} pseudo instruction represents, in this particular context, an
6444abstract measurement of function's size.  In no way does it represent a count
6445of assembly instructions and as such its exact meaning might change from one
6446release to an another.
6447
6448@item -fno-keep-inline-dllexport
6449@opindex -fno-keep-inline-dllexport
6450This is a more fine-grained version of @option{-fkeep-inline-functions},
6451which applies only to functions that are declared using the @code{dllexport}
6452attribute or declspec (@xref{Function Attributes,,Declaring Attributes of
6453Functions}.)
6454
6455@item -fkeep-inline-functions
6456@opindex fkeep-inline-functions
6457In C, emit @code{static} functions that are declared @code{inline}
6458into the object file, even if the function has been inlined into all
6459of its callers.  This switch does not affect functions using the
6460@code{extern inline} extension in GNU C90@.  In C++, emit any and all
6461inline functions into the object file.
6462
6463@item -fkeep-static-consts
6464@opindex fkeep-static-consts
6465Emit variables declared @code{static const} when optimization isn't turned
6466on, even if the variables aren't referenced.
6467
6468GCC enables this option by default.  If you want to force the compiler to
6469check if the variable was referenced, regardless of whether or not
6470optimization is turned on, use the @option{-fno-keep-static-consts} option.
6471
6472@item -fmerge-constants
6473@opindex fmerge-constants
6474Attempt to merge identical constants (string constants and floating-point
6475constants) across compilation units.
6476
6477This option is the default for optimized compilation if the assembler and
6478linker support it.  Use @option{-fno-merge-constants} to inhibit this
6479behavior.
6480
6481Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6482
6483@item -fmerge-all-constants
6484@opindex fmerge-all-constants
6485Attempt to merge identical constants and identical variables.
6486
6487This option implies @option{-fmerge-constants}.  In addition to
6488@option{-fmerge-constants} this considers e.g.@: even constant initialized
6489arrays or initialized constant variables with integral or floating-point
6490types.  Languages like C or C++ require each variable, including multiple
6491instances of the same variable in recursive calls, to have distinct locations,
6492so using this option will result in non-conforming
6493behavior.
6494
6495@item -fmodulo-sched
6496@opindex fmodulo-sched
6497Perform swing modulo scheduling immediately before the first scheduling
6498pass.  This pass looks at innermost loops and reorders their
6499instructions by overlapping different iterations.
6500
6501@item -fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves
6502@opindex fmodulo-sched-allow-regmoves
6503Perform more aggressive SMS based modulo scheduling with register moves
6504allowed.  By setting this flag certain anti-dependences edges will be
6505deleted which will trigger the generation of reg-moves based on the
6506life-range analysis.  This option is effective only with
6507@option{-fmodulo-sched} enabled.
6508
6509@item -fno-branch-count-reg
6510@opindex fno-branch-count-reg
6511Do not use ``decrement and branch'' instructions on a count register,
6512but instead generate a sequence of instructions that decrement a
6513register, compare it against zero, then branch based upon the result.
6514This option is only meaningful on architectures that support such
6515instructions, which include x86, PowerPC, IA-64 and S/390.
6516
6517The default is @option{-fbranch-count-reg}.
6518
6519@item -fno-function-cse
6520@opindex fno-function-cse
6521Do not put function addresses in registers; make each instruction that
6522calls a constant function contain the function's address explicitly.
6523
6524This option results in less efficient code, but some strange hacks
6525that alter the assembler output may be confused by the optimizations
6526performed when this option is not used.
6527
6528The default is @option{-ffunction-cse}
6529
6530@item -fno-zero-initialized-in-bss
6531@opindex fno-zero-initialized-in-bss
6532If the target supports a BSS section, GCC by default puts variables that
6533are initialized to zero into BSS@.  This can save space in the resulting
6534code.
6535
6536This option turns off this behavior because some programs explicitly
6537rely on variables going to the data section.  E.g., so that the
6538resulting executable can find the beginning of that section and/or make
6539assumptions based on that.
6540
6541The default is @option{-fzero-initialized-in-bss}.
6542
6543@item -fmudflap -fmudflapth -fmudflapir
6544@opindex fmudflap
6545@opindex fmudflapth
6546@opindex fmudflapir
6547@cindex bounds checking
6548@cindex mudflap
6549For front-ends that support it (C and C++), instrument all risky
6550pointer/array dereferencing operations, some standard library
6551string/heap functions, and some other associated constructs with
6552range/validity tests.  Modules so instrumented should be immune to
6553buffer overflows, invalid heap use, and some other classes of C/C++
6554programming errors.  The instrumentation relies on a separate runtime
6555library (@file{libmudflap}), which will be linked into a program if
6556@option{-fmudflap} is given at link time.  Run-time behavior of the
6557instrumented program is controlled by the @env{MUDFLAP_OPTIONS}
6558environment variable.  See @code{env MUDFLAP_OPTIONS=-help a.out}
6559for its options.
6560
6561Use @option{-fmudflapth} instead of @option{-fmudflap} to compile and to
6562link if your program is multi-threaded.  Use @option{-fmudflapir}, in
6563addition to @option{-fmudflap} or @option{-fmudflapth}, if
6564instrumentation should ignore pointer reads.  This produces less
6565instrumentation (and therefore faster execution) and still provides
6566some protection against outright memory corrupting writes, but allows
6567erroneously read data to propagate within a program.
6568
6569@item -fthread-jumps
6570@opindex fthread-jumps
6571Perform optimizations where we check to see if a jump branches to a
6572location where another comparison subsumed by the first is found.  If
6573so, the first branch is redirected to either the destination of the
6574second branch or a point immediately following it, depending on whether
6575the condition is known to be true or false.
6576
6577Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6578
6579@item -fsplit-wide-types
6580@opindex fsplit-wide-types
6581When using a type that occupies multiple registers, such as @code{long
6582long} on a 32-bit system, split the registers apart and allocate them
6583independently.  This normally generates better code for those types,
6584but may make debugging more difficult.
6585
6586Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3},
6587@option{-Os}.
6588
6589@item -fcse-follow-jumps
6590@opindex fcse-follow-jumps
6591In common subexpression elimination (CSE), scan through jump instructions
6592when the target of the jump is not reached by any other path.  For
6593example, when CSE encounters an @code{if} statement with an
6594@code{else} clause, CSE will follow the jump when the condition
6595tested is false.
6596
6597Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6598
6599@item -fcse-skip-blocks
6600@opindex fcse-skip-blocks
6601This is similar to @option{-fcse-follow-jumps}, but causes CSE to
6602follow jumps that conditionally skip over blocks.  When CSE
6603encounters a simple @code{if} statement with no else clause,
6604@option{-fcse-skip-blocks} causes CSE to follow the jump around the
6605body of the @code{if}.
6606
6607Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6608
6609@item -frerun-cse-after-loop
6610@opindex frerun-cse-after-loop
6611Re-run common subexpression elimination after loop optimizations has been
6612performed.
6613
6614Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6615
6616@item -fgcse
6617@opindex fgcse
6618Perform a global common subexpression elimination pass.
6619This pass also performs global constant and copy propagation.
6620
6621@emph{Note:} When compiling a program using computed gotos, a GCC
6622extension, you may get better run-time performance if you disable
6623the global common subexpression elimination pass by adding
6624@option{-fno-gcse} to the command line.
6625
6626Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6627
6628@item -fgcse-lm
6629@opindex fgcse-lm
6630When @option{-fgcse-lm} is enabled, global common subexpression elimination will
6631attempt to move loads that are only killed by stores into themselves.  This
6632allows a loop containing a load/store sequence to be changed to a load outside
6633the loop, and a copy/store within the loop.
6634
6635Enabled by default when gcse is enabled.
6636
6637@item -fgcse-sm
6638@opindex fgcse-sm
6639When @option{-fgcse-sm} is enabled, a store motion pass is run after
6640global common subexpression elimination.  This pass will attempt to move
6641stores out of loops.  When used in conjunction with @option{-fgcse-lm},
6642loops containing a load/store sequence can be changed to a load before
6643the loop and a store after the loop.
6644
6645Not enabled at any optimization level.
6646
6647@item -fgcse-las
6648@opindex fgcse-las
6649When @option{-fgcse-las} is enabled, the global common subexpression
6650elimination pass eliminates redundant loads that come after stores to the
6651same memory location (both partial and full redundancies).
6652
6653Not enabled at any optimization level.
6654
6655@item -fgcse-after-reload
6656@opindex fgcse-after-reload
6657When @option{-fgcse-after-reload} is enabled, a redundant load elimination
6658pass is performed after reload.  The purpose of this pass is to cleanup
6659redundant spilling.
6660
6661@item -funsafe-loop-optimizations
6662@opindex funsafe-loop-optimizations
6663If given, the loop optimizer will assume that loop indices do not
6664overflow, and that the loops with nontrivial exit condition are not
6665infinite.  This enables a wider range of loop optimizations even if
6666the loop optimizer itself cannot prove that these assumptions are valid.
6667Using @option{-Wunsafe-loop-optimizations}, the compiler will warn you
6668if it finds this kind of loop.
6669
6670@item -fcrossjumping
6671@opindex fcrossjumping
6672Perform cross-jumping transformation.  This transformation unifies equivalent code and save code size.  The
6673resulting code may or may not perform better than without cross-jumping.
6674
6675Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6676
6677@item -fauto-inc-dec
6678@opindex fauto-inc-dec
6679Combine increments or decrements of addresses with memory accesses.
6680This pass is always skipped on architectures that do not have
6681instructions to support this.  Enabled by default at @option{-O} and
6682higher on architectures that support this.
6683
6684@item -fdce
6685@opindex fdce
6686Perform dead code elimination (DCE) on RTL@.
6687Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
6688
6689@item -fdse
6690@opindex fdse
6691Perform dead store elimination (DSE) on RTL@.
6692Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
6693
6694@item -fif-conversion
6695@opindex fif-conversion
6696Attempt to transform conditional jumps into branch-less equivalents.  This
6697include use of conditional moves, min, max, set flags and abs instructions, and
6698some tricks doable by standard arithmetics.  The use of conditional execution
6699on chips where it is available is controlled by @code{if-conversion2}.
6700
6701Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6702
6703@item -fif-conversion2
6704@opindex fif-conversion2
6705Use conditional execution (where available) to transform conditional jumps into
6706branch-less equivalents.
6707
6708Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6709
6710@item -fdelete-null-pointer-checks
6711@opindex fdelete-null-pointer-checks
6712Assume that programs cannot safely dereference null pointers, and that
6713no code or data element resides there.  This enables simple constant
6714folding optimizations at all optimization levels.  In addition, other
6715optimization passes in GCC use this flag to control global dataflow
6716analyses that eliminate useless checks for null pointers; these assume
6717that if a pointer is checked after it has already been dereferenced,
6718it cannot be null.
6719
6720Note however that in some environments this assumption is not true.
6721Use @option{-fno-delete-null-pointer-checks} to disable this optimization
6722for programs that depend on that behavior.
6723
6724Some targets, especially embedded ones, disable this option at all levels.
6725Otherwise it is enabled at all levels: @option{-O0}, @option{-O1},
6726@option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.  Passes that use the information
6727are enabled independently at different optimization levels.
6728
6729@item -fdevirtualize
6730@opindex fdevirtualize
6731Attempt to convert calls to virtual functions to direct calls.  This
6732is done both within a procedure and interprocedurally as part of
6733indirect inlining (@code{-findirect-inlining}) and interprocedural constant
6734propagation (@option{-fipa-cp}).
6735Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6736
6737@item -fexpensive-optimizations
6738@opindex fexpensive-optimizations
6739Perform a number of minor optimizations that are relatively expensive.
6740
6741Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6742
6743@item -free
6744@opindex free
6745Attempt to remove redundant extension instructions.  This is especially
6746helpful for the x86-64 architecture which implicitly zero-extends in 64-bit
6747registers after writing to their lower 32-bit half.
6748
6749Enabled for x86 at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
6750
6751@item -foptimize-register-move
6752@itemx -fregmove
6753@opindex foptimize-register-move
6754@opindex fregmove
6755Attempt to reassign register numbers in move instructions and as
6756operands of other simple instructions in order to maximize the amount of
6757register tying.  This is especially helpful on machines with two-operand
6758instructions.
6759
6760Note @option{-fregmove} and @option{-foptimize-register-move} are the same
6761optimization.
6762
6763Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6764
6765@item -fira-algorithm=@var{algorithm}
6766Use the specified coloring algorithm for the integrated register
6767allocator.  The @var{algorithm} argument can be @samp{priority}, which
6768specifies Chow's priority coloring, or @samp{CB}, which specifies
6769Chaitin-Briggs coloring.  Chaitin-Briggs coloring is not implemented
6770for all architectures, but for those targets that do support it, it is
6771the default because it generates better code.
6772
6773@item -fira-region=@var{region}
6774Use specified regions for the integrated register allocator.  The
6775@var{region} argument should be one of the following:
6776
6777@table @samp
6778
6779@item all
6780Use all loops as register allocation regions.
6781This can give the best results for machines with a small and/or
6782irregular register set.
6783
6784@item mixed
6785Use all loops except for loops with small register pressure
6786as the regions.  This value usually gives
6787the best results in most cases and for most architectures,
6788and is enabled by default when compiling with optimization for speed
6789(@option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @dots{}).
6790
6791@item one
6792Use all functions as a single region.
6793This typically results in the smallest code size, and is enabled by default for
6794@option{-Os} or @option{-O0}.
6795
6796@end table
6797
6798@item -fira-loop-pressure
6799@opindex fira-loop-pressure
6800Use IRA to evaluate register pressure in loops for decisions to move
6801loop invariants.  This option usually results in generation
6802of faster and smaller code on machines with large register files (>= 32
6803registers), but it can slow the compiler down.
6804
6805This option is enabled at level @option{-O3} for some targets.
6806
6807@item -fno-ira-share-save-slots
6808@opindex fno-ira-share-save-slots
6809Disable sharing of stack slots used for saving call-used hard
6810registers living through a call.  Each hard register gets a
6811separate stack slot, and as a result function stack frames are
6812larger.
6813
6814@item -fno-ira-share-spill-slots
6815@opindex fno-ira-share-spill-slots
6816Disable sharing of stack slots allocated for pseudo-registers.  Each
6817pseudo-register that does not get a hard register gets a separate
6818stack slot, and as a result function stack frames are larger.
6819
6820@item -fira-verbose=@var{n}
6821@opindex fira-verbose
6822Control the verbosity of the dump file for the integrated register allocator.
6823The default value is 5.  If the value @var{n} is greater or equal to 10,
6824the dump output is sent to stderr using the same format as @var{n} minus 10.
6825
6826@item -fdelayed-branch
6827@opindex fdelayed-branch
6828If supported for the target machine, attempt to reorder instructions
6829to exploit instruction slots available after delayed branch
6830instructions.
6831
6832Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6833
6834@item -fschedule-insns
6835@opindex fschedule-insns
6836If supported for the target machine, attempt to reorder instructions to
6837eliminate execution stalls due to required data being unavailable.  This
6838helps machines that have slow floating point or memory load instructions
6839by allowing other instructions to be issued until the result of the load
6840or floating-point instruction is required.
6841
6842Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
6843
6844@item -fschedule-insns2
6845@opindex fschedule-insns2
6846Similar to @option{-fschedule-insns}, but requests an additional pass of
6847instruction scheduling after register allocation has been done.  This is
6848especially useful on machines with a relatively small number of
6849registers and where memory load instructions take more than one cycle.
6850
6851Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
6852
6853@item -fno-sched-interblock
6854@opindex fno-sched-interblock
6855Don't schedule instructions across basic blocks.  This is normally
6856enabled by default when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@:
6857with @option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6858
6859@item -fno-sched-spec
6860@opindex fno-sched-spec
6861Don't allow speculative motion of non-load instructions.  This is normally
6862enabled by default when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@:
6863with @option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6864
6865@item -fsched-pressure
6866@opindex fsched-pressure
6867Enable register pressure sensitive insn scheduling before the register
6868allocation.  This only makes sense when scheduling before register
6869allocation is enabled, i.e.@: with @option{-fschedule-insns} or at
6870@option{-O2} or higher.  Usage of this option can improve the
6871generated code and decrease its size by preventing register pressure
6872increase above the number of available hard registers and as a
6873consequence register spills in the register allocation.
6874
6875@item -fsched-spec-load
6876@opindex fsched-spec-load
6877Allow speculative motion of some load instructions.  This only makes
6878sense when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@: with
6879@option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6880
6881@item -fsched-spec-load-dangerous
6882@opindex fsched-spec-load-dangerous
6883Allow speculative motion of more load instructions.  This only makes
6884sense when scheduling before register allocation, i.e.@: with
6885@option{-fschedule-insns} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6886
6887@item -fsched-stalled-insns
6888@itemx -fsched-stalled-insns=@var{n}
6889@opindex fsched-stalled-insns
6890Define how many insns (if any) can be moved prematurely from the queue
6891of stalled insns into the ready list, during the second scheduling pass.
6892@option{-fno-sched-stalled-insns} means that no insns will be moved
6893prematurely, @option{-fsched-stalled-insns=0} means there is no limit
6894on how many queued insns can be moved prematurely.
6895@option{-fsched-stalled-insns} without a value is equivalent to
6896@option{-fsched-stalled-insns=1}.
6897
6898@item -fsched-stalled-insns-dep
6899@itemx -fsched-stalled-insns-dep=@var{n}
6900@opindex fsched-stalled-insns-dep
6901Define how many insn groups (cycles) will be examined for a dependency
6902on a stalled insn that is candidate for premature removal from the queue
6903of stalled insns.  This has an effect only during the second scheduling pass,
6904and only if @option{-fsched-stalled-insns} is used.
6905@option{-fno-sched-stalled-insns-dep} is equivalent to
6906@option{-fsched-stalled-insns-dep=0}.
6907@option{-fsched-stalled-insns-dep} without a value is equivalent to
6908@option{-fsched-stalled-insns-dep=1}.
6909
6910@item -fsched2-use-superblocks
6911@opindex fsched2-use-superblocks
6912When scheduling after register allocation, do use superblock scheduling
6913algorithm.  Superblock scheduling allows motion across basic block boundaries
6914resulting on faster schedules.  This option is experimental, as not all machine
6915descriptions used by GCC model the CPU closely enough to avoid unreliable
6916results from the algorithm.
6917
6918This only makes sense when scheduling after register allocation, i.e.@: with
6919@option{-fschedule-insns2} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6920
6921@item -fsched-group-heuristic
6922@opindex fsched-group-heuristic
6923Enable the group heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors
6924the instruction that belongs to a schedule group.  This is enabled
6925by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.@: with @option{-fschedule-insns}
6926or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6927
6928@item -fsched-critical-path-heuristic
6929@opindex fsched-critical-path-heuristic
6930Enable the critical-path heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors
6931instructions on the critical path.  This is enabled by default when
6932scheduling is enabled, i.e.@: with @option{-fschedule-insns}
6933or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6934
6935@item -fsched-spec-insn-heuristic
6936@opindex fsched-spec-insn-heuristic
6937Enable the speculative instruction heuristic in the scheduler.  This
6938heuristic favors speculative instructions with greater dependency weakness.
6939This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.@:
6940with @option{-fschedule-insns} or @option{-fschedule-insns2}
6941or at @option{-O2} or higher.
6942
6943@item -fsched-rank-heuristic
6944@opindex fsched-rank-heuristic
6945Enable the rank heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic favors
6946the instruction belonging to a basic block with greater size or frequency.
6947This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.@:
6948with @option{-fschedule-insns} or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or
6949at @option{-O2} or higher.
6950
6951@item -fsched-last-insn-heuristic
6952@opindex fsched-last-insn-heuristic
6953Enable the last-instruction heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic
6954favors the instruction that is less dependent on the last instruction
6955scheduled.  This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled,
6956i.e.@: with @option{-fschedule-insns} or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or
6957at @option{-O2} or higher.
6958
6959@item -fsched-dep-count-heuristic
6960@opindex fsched-dep-count-heuristic
6961Enable the dependent-count heuristic in the scheduler.  This heuristic
6962favors the instruction that has more instructions depending on it.
6963This is enabled by default when scheduling is enabled, i.e.@:
6964with @option{-fschedule-insns} or @option{-fschedule-insns2} or
6965at @option{-O2} or higher.
6966
6967@item -freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops
6968@opindex freschedule-modulo-scheduled-loops
6969The modulo scheduling comes before the traditional scheduling, if a loop
6970was modulo scheduled we may want to prevent the later scheduling passes
6971from changing its schedule, we use this option to control that.
6972
6973@item -fselective-scheduling
6974@opindex fselective-scheduling
6975Schedule instructions using selective scheduling algorithm.  Selective
6976scheduling runs instead of the first scheduler pass.
6977
6978@item -fselective-scheduling2
6979@opindex fselective-scheduling2
6980Schedule instructions using selective scheduling algorithm.  Selective
6981scheduling runs instead of the second scheduler pass.
6982
6983@item -fsel-sched-pipelining
6984@opindex fsel-sched-pipelining
6985Enable software pipelining of innermost loops during selective scheduling.
6986This option has no effect until one of @option{-fselective-scheduling} or
6987@option{-fselective-scheduling2} is turned on.
6988
6989@item -fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops
6990@opindex fsel-sched-pipelining-outer-loops
6991When pipelining loops during selective scheduling, also pipeline outer loops.
6992This option has no effect until @option{-fsel-sched-pipelining} is turned on.
6993
6994@item -fshrink-wrap
6995@opindex fshrink-wrap
6996Emit function prologues only before parts of the function that need it,
6997rather than at the top of the function.  This flag is enabled by default at
6998@option{-O} and higher.
6999
7000@item -fcaller-saves
7001@opindex fcaller-saves
7002Enable values to be allocated in registers that will be clobbered by
7003function calls, by emitting extra instructions to save and restore the
7004registers around such calls.  Such allocation is done only when it
7005seems to result in better code than would otherwise be produced.
7006
7007This option is always enabled by default on certain machines, usually
7008those which have no call-preserved registers to use instead.
7009
7010Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7011
7012@item -fcombine-stack-adjustments
7013@opindex fcombine-stack-adjustments
7014Tracks stack adjustments (pushes and pops) and stack memory references
7015and then tries to find ways to combine them.
7016
7017Enabled by default at @option{-O1} and higher.
7018
7019@item -fconserve-stack
7020@opindex fconserve-stack
7021Attempt to minimize stack usage.  The compiler will attempt to use less
7022stack space, even if that makes the program slower.  This option
7023implies setting the @option{large-stack-frame} parameter to 100
7024and the @option{large-stack-frame-growth} parameter to 400.
7025
7026@item -ftree-reassoc
7027@opindex ftree-reassoc
7028Perform reassociation on trees.  This flag is enabled by default
7029at @option{-O} and higher.
7030
7031@item -ftree-pre
7032@opindex ftree-pre
7033Perform partial redundancy elimination (PRE) on trees.  This flag is
7034enabled by default at @option{-O2} and @option{-O3}.
7035
7036@item -ftree-forwprop
7037@opindex ftree-forwprop
7038Perform forward propagation on trees.  This flag is enabled by default
7039at @option{-O} and higher.
7040
7041@item -ftree-fre
7042@opindex ftree-fre
7043Perform full redundancy elimination (FRE) on trees.  The difference
7044between FRE and PRE is that FRE only considers expressions
7045that are computed on all paths leading to the redundant computation.
7046This analysis is faster than PRE, though it exposes fewer redundancies.
7047This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7048
7049@item -ftree-phiprop
7050@opindex ftree-phiprop
7051Perform hoisting of loads from conditional pointers on trees.  This
7052pass is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7053
7054@item -ftree-copy-prop
7055@opindex ftree-copy-prop
7056Perform copy propagation on trees.  This pass eliminates unnecessary
7057copy operations.  This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and
7058higher.
7059
7060@item -fipa-pure-const
7061@opindex fipa-pure-const
7062Discover which functions are pure or constant.
7063Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7064
7065@item -fipa-reference
7066@opindex fipa-reference
7067Discover which static variables do not escape cannot escape the
7068compilation unit.
7069Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7070
7071@item -fipa-pta
7072@opindex fipa-pta
7073Perform interprocedural pointer analysis and interprocedural modification
7074and reference analysis.  This option can cause excessive memory and
7075compile-time usage on large compilation units.  It is not enabled by
7076default at any optimization level.
7077
7078@item -fipa-profile
7079@opindex fipa-profile
7080Perform interprocedural profile propagation.  The functions called only from
7081cold functions are marked as cold. Also functions executed once (such as
7082@code{cold}, @code{noreturn}, static constructors or destructors) are identified. Cold
7083functions and loop less parts of functions executed once are then optimized for
7084size.
7085Enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7086
7087@item -fipa-cp
7088@opindex fipa-cp
7089Perform interprocedural constant propagation.
7090This optimization analyzes the program to determine when values passed
7091to functions are constants and then optimizes accordingly.
7092This optimization can substantially increase performance
7093if the application has constants passed to functions.
7094This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O2}, @option{-Os} and @option{-O3}.
7095
7096@item -fipa-cp-clone
7097@opindex fipa-cp-clone
7098Perform function cloning to make interprocedural constant propagation stronger.
7099When enabled, interprocedural constant propagation will perform function cloning
7100when externally visible function can be called with constant arguments.
7101Because this optimization can create multiple copies of functions,
7102it may significantly increase code size
7103(see @option{--param ipcp-unit-growth=@var{value}}).
7104This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O3}.
7105
7106@item -fipa-matrix-reorg
7107@opindex fipa-matrix-reorg
7108Perform matrix flattening and transposing.
7109Matrix flattening tries to replace an @math{m}-dimensional matrix
7110with its equivalent @math{n}-dimensional matrix, where @math{n < m}.
7111This reduces the level of indirection needed for accessing the elements
7112of the matrix. The second optimization is matrix transposing, which
7113attempts to change the order of the matrix's dimensions in order to
7114improve cache locality.
7115Both optimizations need the @option{-fwhole-program} flag.
7116Transposing is enabled only if profiling information is available.
7117
7118@item -ftree-sink
7119@opindex ftree-sink
7120Perform forward store motion  on trees.  This flag is
7121enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7122
7123@item -ftree-bit-ccp
7124@opindex ftree-bit-ccp
7125Perform sparse conditional bit constant propagation on trees and propagate
7126pointer alignment information.
7127This pass only operates on local scalar variables and is enabled by default
7128at @option{-O} and higher.  It requires that @option{-ftree-ccp} is enabled.
7129
7130@item -ftree-ccp
7131@opindex ftree-ccp
7132Perform sparse conditional constant propagation (CCP) on trees.  This
7133pass only operates on local scalar variables and is enabled by default
7134at @option{-O} and higher.
7135
7136@item -ftree-switch-conversion
7137Perform conversion of simple initializations in a switch to
7138initializations from a scalar array.  This flag is enabled by default
7139at @option{-O2} and higher.
7140
7141@item -ftree-tail-merge
7142Look for identical code sequences.  When found, replace one with a jump to the
7143other.  This optimization is known as tail merging or cross jumping.  This flag
7144is enabled by default at @option{-O2} and higher.  The compilation time
7145in this pass can
7146be limited using @option{max-tail-merge-comparisons} parameter and
7147@option{max-tail-merge-iterations} parameter.
7148
7149@item -ftree-dce
7150@opindex ftree-dce
7151Perform dead code elimination (DCE) on trees.  This flag is enabled by
7152default at @option{-O} and higher.
7153
7154@item -ftree-builtin-call-dce
7155@opindex ftree-builtin-call-dce
7156Perform conditional dead code elimination (DCE) for calls to builtin functions
7157that may set @code{errno} but are otherwise side-effect free.  This flag is
7158enabled by default at @option{-O2} and higher if @option{-Os} is not also
7159specified.
7160
7161@item -ftree-dominator-opts
7162@opindex ftree-dominator-opts
7163Perform a variety of simple scalar cleanups (constant/copy
7164propagation, redundancy elimination, range propagation and expression
7165simplification) based on a dominator tree traversal.  This also
7166performs jump threading (to reduce jumps to jumps). This flag is
7167enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7168
7169@item -ftree-dse
7170@opindex ftree-dse
7171Perform dead store elimination (DSE) on trees.  A dead store is a store into
7172a memory location that is later overwritten by another store without
7173any intervening loads.  In this case the earlier store can be deleted.  This
7174flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7175
7176@item -ftree-ch
7177@opindex ftree-ch
7178Perform loop header copying on trees.  This is beneficial since it increases
7179effectiveness of code motion optimizations.  It also saves one jump.  This flag
7180is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.  It is not enabled
7181for @option{-Os}, since it usually increases code size.
7182
7183@item -ftree-loop-optimize
7184@opindex ftree-loop-optimize
7185Perform loop optimizations on trees.  This flag is enabled by default
7186at @option{-O} and higher.
7187
7188@item -ftree-loop-linear
7189@opindex ftree-loop-linear
7190Perform loop interchange transformations on tree.  Same as
7191@option{-floop-interchange}.  To use this code transformation, GCC has
7192to be configured with @option{--with-ppl} and @option{--with-cloog} to
7193enable the Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.
7194
7195@item -floop-interchange
7196@opindex floop-interchange
7197Perform loop interchange transformations on loops.  Interchanging two
7198nested loops switches the inner and outer loops.  For example, given a
7199loop like:
7200@smallexample
7201DO J = 1, M
7202  DO I = 1, N
7203    A(J, I) = A(J, I) * C
7204  ENDDO
7205ENDDO
7206@end smallexample
7207loop interchange will transform the loop as if the user had written:
7208@smallexample
7209DO I = 1, N
7210  DO J = 1, M
7211    A(J, I) = A(J, I) * C
7212  ENDDO
7213ENDDO
7214@end smallexample
7215which can be beneficial when @code{N} is larger than the caches,
7216because in Fortran, the elements of an array are stored in memory
7217contiguously by column, and the original loop iterates over rows,
7218potentially creating at each access a cache miss.  This optimization
7219applies to all the languages supported by GCC and is not limited to
7220Fortran.  To use this code transformation, GCC has to be configured
7221with @option{--with-ppl} and @option{--with-cloog} to enable the
7222Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.
7223
7224@item -floop-strip-mine
7225@opindex floop-strip-mine
7226Perform loop strip mining transformations on loops.  Strip mining
7227splits a loop into two nested loops.  The outer loop has strides
7228equal to the strip size and the inner loop has strides of the
7229original loop within a strip.  The strip length can be changed
7230using the @option{loop-block-tile-size} parameter.  For example,
7231given a loop like:
7232@smallexample
7233DO I = 1, N
7234  A(I) = A(I) + C
7235ENDDO
7236@end smallexample
7237loop strip mining will transform the loop as if the user had written:
7238@smallexample
7239DO II = 1, N, 51
7240  DO I = II, min (II + 50, N)
7241    A(I) = A(I) + C
7242  ENDDO
7243ENDDO
7244@end smallexample
7245This optimization applies to all the languages supported by GCC and is
7246not limited to Fortran.  To use this code transformation, GCC has to
7247be configured with @option{--with-ppl} and @option{--with-cloog} to
7248enable the Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.
7249
7250@item -floop-block
7251@opindex floop-block
7252Perform loop blocking transformations on loops.  Blocking strip mines
7253each loop in the loop nest such that the memory accesses of the
7254element loops fit inside caches.  The strip length can be changed
7255using the @option{loop-block-tile-size} parameter.  For example, given
7256a loop like:
7257@smallexample
7258DO I = 1, N
7259  DO J = 1, M
7260    A(J, I) = B(I) + C(J)
7261  ENDDO
7262ENDDO
7263@end smallexample
7264loop blocking will transform the loop as if the user had written:
7265@smallexample
7266DO II = 1, N, 51
7267  DO JJ = 1, M, 51
7268    DO I = II, min (II + 50, N)
7269      DO J = JJ, min (JJ + 50, M)
7270        A(J, I) = B(I) + C(J)
7271      ENDDO
7272    ENDDO
7273  ENDDO
7274ENDDO
7275@end smallexample
7276which can be beneficial when @code{M} is larger than the caches,
7277because the innermost loop will iterate over a smaller amount of data
7278which can be kept in the caches.  This optimization applies to all the
7279languages supported by GCC and is not limited to Fortran.  To use this
7280code transformation, GCC has to be configured with @option{--with-ppl}
7281and @option{--with-cloog} to enable the Graphite loop transformation
7282infrastructure.
7283
7284@item -fgraphite-identity
7285@opindex fgraphite-identity
7286Enable the identity transformation for graphite.  For every SCoP we generate
7287the polyhedral representation and transform it back to gimple.  Using
7288@option{-fgraphite-identity} we can check the costs or benefits of the
7289GIMPLE -> GRAPHITE -> GIMPLE transformation.  Some minimal optimizations
7290are also performed by the code generator CLooG, like index splitting and
7291dead code elimination in loops.
7292
7293@item -floop-flatten
7294@opindex floop-flatten
7295Removes the loop nesting structure: transforms the loop nest into a
7296single loop.  This transformation can be useful as an enablement
7297transform for vectorization and parallelization.  This feature
7298is experimental.
7299To use this code transformation, GCC has to be configured
7300with @option{--with-ppl} and @option{--with-cloog} to enable the
7301Graphite loop transformation infrastructure.
7302
7303@item -floop-parallelize-all
7304@opindex floop-parallelize-all
7305Use the Graphite data dependence analysis to identify loops that can
7306be parallelized.  Parallelize all the loops that can be analyzed to
7307not contain loop carried dependences without checking that it is
7308profitable to parallelize the loops.
7309
7310@item -fcheck-data-deps
7311@opindex fcheck-data-deps
7312Compare the results of several data dependence analyzers.  This option
7313is used for debugging the data dependence analyzers.
7314
7315@item -ftree-loop-if-convert
7316Attempt to transform conditional jumps in the innermost loops to
7317branch-less equivalents.  The intent is to remove control-flow from
7318the innermost loops in order to improve the ability of the
7319vectorization pass to handle these loops.  This is enabled by default
7320if vectorization is enabled.
7321
7322@item -ftree-loop-if-convert-stores
7323Attempt to also if-convert conditional jumps containing memory writes.
7324This transformation can be unsafe for multi-threaded programs as it
7325transforms conditional memory writes into unconditional memory writes.
7326For example,
7327@smallexample
7328for (i = 0; i < N; i++)
7329  if (cond)
7330    A[i] = expr;
7331@end smallexample
7332would be transformed to
7333@smallexample
7334for (i = 0; i < N; i++)
7335  A[i] = cond ? expr : A[i];
7336@end smallexample
7337potentially producing data races.
7338
7339@item -ftree-loop-distribution
7340Perform loop distribution.  This flag can improve cache performance on
7341big loop bodies and allow further loop optimizations, like
7342parallelization or vectorization, to take place.  For example, the loop
7343@smallexample
7344DO I = 1, N
7345  A(I) = B(I) + C
7346  D(I) = E(I) * F
7347ENDDO
7348@end smallexample
7349is transformed to
7350@smallexample
7351DO I = 1, N
7352   A(I) = B(I) + C
7353ENDDO
7354DO I = 1, N
7355   D(I) = E(I) * F
7356ENDDO
7357@end smallexample
7358
7359@item -ftree-loop-distribute-patterns
7360Perform loop distribution of patterns that can be code generated with
7361calls to a library.  This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O3}.
7362
7363This pass distributes the initialization loops and generates a call to
7364memset zero.  For example, the loop
7365@smallexample
7366DO I = 1, N
7367  A(I) = 0
7368  B(I) = A(I) + I
7369ENDDO
7370@end smallexample
7371is transformed to
7372@smallexample
7373DO I = 1, N
7374   A(I) = 0
7375ENDDO
7376DO I = 1, N
7377   B(I) = A(I) + I
7378ENDDO
7379@end smallexample
7380and the initialization loop is transformed into a call to memset zero.
7381
7382@item -ftree-loop-im
7383@opindex ftree-loop-im
7384Perform loop invariant motion on trees.  This pass moves only invariants that
7385would be hard to handle at RTL level (function calls, operations that expand to
7386nontrivial sequences of insns).  With @option{-funswitch-loops} it also moves
7387operands of conditions that are invariant out of the loop, so that we can use
7388just trivial invariantness analysis in loop unswitching.  The pass also includes
7389store motion.
7390
7391@item -ftree-loop-ivcanon
7392@opindex ftree-loop-ivcanon
7393Create a canonical counter for number of iterations in loops for which
7394determining number of iterations requires complicated analysis.  Later
7395optimizations then may determine the number easily.  Useful especially
7396in connection with unrolling.
7397
7398@item -fivopts
7399@opindex fivopts
7400Perform induction variable optimizations (strength reduction, induction
7401variable merging and induction variable elimination) on trees.
7402
7403@item -ftree-parallelize-loops=n
7404@opindex ftree-parallelize-loops
7405Parallelize loops, i.e., split their iteration space to run in n threads.
7406This is only possible for loops whose iterations are independent
7407and can be arbitrarily reordered.  The optimization is only
7408profitable on multiprocessor machines, for loops that are CPU-intensive,
7409rather than constrained e.g.@: by memory bandwidth.  This option
7410implies @option{-pthread}, and thus is only supported on targets
7411that have support for @option{-pthread}.
7412
7413@item -ftree-pta
7414@opindex ftree-pta
7415Perform function-local points-to analysis on trees.  This flag is
7416enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7417
7418@item -ftree-sra
7419@opindex ftree-sra
7420Perform scalar replacement of aggregates.  This pass replaces structure
7421references with scalars to prevent committing structures to memory too
7422early.  This flag is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7423
7424@item -ftree-copyrename
7425@opindex ftree-copyrename
7426Perform copy renaming on trees.  This pass attempts to rename compiler
7427temporaries to other variables at copy locations, usually resulting in
7428variable names which more closely resemble the original variables.  This flag
7429is enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7430
7431@item -ftree-ter
7432@opindex ftree-ter
7433Perform temporary expression replacement during the SSA->normal phase.  Single
7434use/single def temporaries are replaced at their use location with their
7435defining expression.  This results in non-GIMPLE code, but gives the expanders
7436much more complex trees to work on resulting in better RTL generation.  This is
7437enabled by default at @option{-O} and higher.
7438
7439@item -ftree-vectorize
7440@opindex ftree-vectorize
7441Perform loop vectorization on trees. This flag is enabled by default at
7442@option{-O3}.
7443
7444@item -ftree-slp-vectorize
7445@opindex ftree-slp-vectorize
7446Perform basic block vectorization on trees. This flag is enabled by default at
7447@option{-O3} and when @option{-ftree-vectorize} is enabled.
7448
7449@item -ftree-vect-loop-version
7450@opindex ftree-vect-loop-version
7451Perform loop versioning when doing loop vectorization on trees.  When a loop
7452appears to be vectorizable except that data alignment or data dependence cannot
7453be determined at compile time, then vectorized and non-vectorized versions of
7454the loop are generated along with run-time checks for alignment or dependence
7455to control which version is executed.  This option is enabled by default
7456except at level @option{-Os} where it is disabled.
7457
7458@item -fvect-cost-model
7459@opindex fvect-cost-model
7460Enable cost model for vectorization.
7461
7462@item -ftree-vrp
7463@opindex ftree-vrp
7464Perform Value Range Propagation on trees.  This is similar to the
7465constant propagation pass, but instead of values, ranges of values are
7466propagated.  This allows the optimizers to remove unnecessary range
7467checks like array bound checks and null pointer checks.  This is
7468enabled by default at @option{-O2} and higher.  Null pointer check
7469elimination is only done if @option{-fdelete-null-pointer-checks} is
7470enabled.
7471
7472@item -ftracer
7473@opindex ftracer
7474Perform tail duplication to enlarge superblock size.  This transformation
7475simplifies the control flow of the function allowing other optimizations to do
7476better job.
7477
7478@item -funroll-loops
7479@opindex funroll-loops
7480Unroll loops whose number of iterations can be determined at compile
7481time or upon entry to the loop.  @option{-funroll-loops} implies
7482@option{-frerun-cse-after-loop}.  This option makes code larger,
7483and may or may not make it run faster.
7484
7485@item -funroll-all-loops
7486@opindex funroll-all-loops
7487Unroll all loops, even if their number of iterations is uncertain when
7488the loop is entered.  This usually makes programs run more slowly.
7489@option{-funroll-all-loops} implies the same options as
7490@option{-funroll-loops},
7491
7492@item -fsplit-ivs-in-unroller
7493@opindex fsplit-ivs-in-unroller
7494Enables expressing of values of induction variables in later iterations
7495of the unrolled loop using the value in the first iteration.  This breaks
7496long dependency chains, thus improving efficiency of the scheduling passes.
7497
7498Combination of @option{-fweb} and CSE is often sufficient to obtain the
7499same effect.  However in cases the loop body is more complicated than
7500a single basic block, this is not reliable.  It also does not work at all
7501on some of the architectures due to restrictions in the CSE pass.
7502
7503This optimization is enabled by default.
7504
7505@item -fvariable-expansion-in-unroller
7506@opindex fvariable-expansion-in-unroller
7507With this option, the compiler will create multiple copies of some
7508local variables when unrolling a loop which can result in superior code.
7509
7510@item -fpartial-inlining
7511@opindex fpartial-inlining
7512Inline parts of functions.  This option has any effect only
7513when inlining itself is turned on by the @option{-finline-functions}
7514or @option{-finline-small-functions} options.
7515
7516Enabled at level @option{-O2}.
7517
7518@item -fpredictive-commoning
7519@opindex fpredictive-commoning
7520Perform predictive commoning optimization, i.e., reusing computations
7521(especially memory loads and stores) performed in previous
7522iterations of loops.
7523
7524This option is enabled at level @option{-O3}.
7525
7526@item -fprefetch-loop-arrays
7527@opindex fprefetch-loop-arrays
7528If supported by the target machine, generate instructions to prefetch
7529memory to improve the performance of loops that access large arrays.
7530
7531This option may generate better or worse code; results are highly
7532dependent on the structure of loops within the source code.
7533
7534Disabled at level @option{-Os}.
7535
7536@item -fno-peephole
7537@itemx -fno-peephole2
7538@opindex fno-peephole
7539@opindex fno-peephole2
7540Disable any machine-specific peephole optimizations.  The difference
7541between @option{-fno-peephole} and @option{-fno-peephole2} is in how they
7542are implemented in the compiler; some targets use one, some use the
7543other, a few use both.
7544
7545@option{-fpeephole} is enabled by default.
7546@option{-fpeephole2} enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7547
7548@item -fno-guess-branch-probability
7549@opindex fno-guess-branch-probability
7550Do not guess branch probabilities using heuristics.
7551
7552GCC will use heuristics to guess branch probabilities if they are
7553not provided by profiling feedback (@option{-fprofile-arcs}).  These
7554heuristics are based on the control flow graph.  If some branch probabilities
7555are specified by @samp{__builtin_expect}, then the heuristics will be
7556used to guess branch probabilities for the rest of the control flow graph,
7557taking the @samp{__builtin_expect} info into account.  The interactions
7558between the heuristics and @samp{__builtin_expect} can be complex, and in
7559some cases, it may be useful to disable the heuristics so that the effects
7560of @samp{__builtin_expect} are easier to understand.
7561
7562The default is @option{-fguess-branch-probability} at levels
7563@option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7564
7565@item -freorder-blocks
7566@opindex freorder-blocks
7567Reorder basic blocks in the compiled function in order to reduce number of
7568taken branches and improve code locality.
7569
7570Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7571
7572@item -freorder-blocks-and-partition
7573@opindex freorder-blocks-and-partition
7574In addition to reordering basic blocks in the compiled function, in order
7575to reduce number of taken branches, partitions hot and cold basic blocks
7576into separate sections of the assembly and .o files, to improve
7577paging and cache locality performance.
7578
7579This optimization is automatically turned off in the presence of
7580exception handling, for linkonce sections, for functions with a user-defined
7581section attribute and on any architecture that does not support named
7582sections.
7583
7584@item -freorder-functions
7585@opindex freorder-functions
7586Reorder functions in the object file in order to
7587improve code locality.  This is implemented by using special
7588subsections @code{.text.hot} for most frequently executed functions and
7589@code{.text.unlikely} for unlikely executed functions.  Reordering is done by
7590the linker so object file format must support named sections and linker must
7591place them in a reasonable way.
7592
7593Also profile feedback must be available in to make this option effective.  See
7594@option{-fprofile-arcs} for details.
7595
7596Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7597
7598@item -fstrict-aliasing
7599@opindex fstrict-aliasing
7600Allow the compiler to assume the strictest aliasing rules applicable to
7601the language being compiled.  For C (and C++), this activates
7602optimizations based on the type of expressions.  In particular, an
7603object of one type is assumed never to reside at the same address as an
7604object of a different type, unless the types are almost the same.  For
7605example, an @code{unsigned int} can alias an @code{int}, but not a
7606@code{void*} or a @code{double}.  A character type may alias any other
7607type.
7608
7609@anchor{Type-punning}Pay special attention to code like this:
7610@smallexample
7611union a_union @{
7612  int i;
7613  double d;
7614@};
7615
7616int f() @{
7617  union a_union t;
7618  t.d = 3.0;
7619  return t.i;
7620@}
7621@end smallexample
7622The practice of reading from a different union member than the one most
7623recently written to (called ``type-punning'') is common.  Even with
7624@option{-fstrict-aliasing}, type-punning is allowed, provided the memory
7625is accessed through the union type.  So, the code above will work as
7626expected.  @xref{Structures unions enumerations and bit-fields
7627implementation}.  However, this code might not:
7628@smallexample
7629int f() @{
7630  union a_union t;
7631  int* ip;
7632  t.d = 3.0;
7633  ip = &t.i;
7634  return *ip;
7635@}
7636@end smallexample
7637
7638Similarly, access by taking the address, casting the resulting pointer
7639and dereferencing the result has undefined behavior, even if the cast
7640uses a union type, e.g.:
7641@smallexample
7642int f() @{
7643  double d = 3.0;
7644  return ((union a_union *) &d)->i;
7645@}
7646@end smallexample
7647
7648The @option{-fstrict-aliasing} option is enabled at levels
7649@option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7650
7651@item -fstrict-overflow
7652@opindex fstrict-overflow
7653Allow the compiler to assume strict signed overflow rules, depending
7654on the language being compiled.  For C (and C++) this means that
7655overflow when doing arithmetic with signed numbers is undefined, which
7656means that the compiler may assume that it will not happen.  This
7657permits various optimizations.  For example, the compiler will assume
7658that an expression like @code{i + 10 > i} will always be true for
7659signed @code{i}.  This assumption is only valid if signed overflow is
7660undefined, as the expression is false if @code{i + 10} overflows when
7661using twos complement arithmetic.  When this option is in effect any
7662attempt to determine whether an operation on signed numbers will
7663overflow must be written carefully to not actually involve overflow.
7664
7665This option also allows the compiler to assume strict pointer
7666semantics: given a pointer to an object, if adding an offset to that
7667pointer does not produce a pointer to the same object, the addition is
7668undefined.  This permits the compiler to conclude that @code{p + u >
7669p} is always true for a pointer @code{p} and unsigned integer
7670@code{u}.  This assumption is only valid because pointer wraparound is
7671undefined, as the expression is false if @code{p + u} overflows using
7672twos complement arithmetic.
7673
7674See also the @option{-fwrapv} option.  Using @option{-fwrapv} means
7675that integer signed overflow is fully defined: it wraps.  When
7676@option{-fwrapv} is used, there is no difference between
7677@option{-fstrict-overflow} and @option{-fno-strict-overflow} for
7678integers.  With @option{-fwrapv} certain types of overflow are
7679permitted.  For example, if the compiler gets an overflow when doing
7680arithmetic on constants, the overflowed value can still be used with
7681@option{-fwrapv}, but not otherwise.
7682
7683The @option{-fstrict-overflow} option is enabled at levels
7684@option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
7685
7686@item -falign-functions
7687@itemx -falign-functions=@var{n}
7688@opindex falign-functions
7689Align the start of functions to the next power-of-two greater than
7690@var{n}, skipping up to @var{n} bytes.  For instance,
7691@option{-falign-functions=32} aligns functions to the next 32-byte
7692boundary, but @option{-falign-functions=24} would align to the next
769332-byte boundary only if this can be done by skipping 23 bytes or less.
7694
7695@option{-fno-align-functions} and @option{-falign-functions=1} are
7696equivalent and mean that functions will not be aligned.
7697
7698Some assemblers only support this flag when @var{n} is a power of two;
7699in that case, it is rounded up.
7700
7701If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
7702
7703Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7704
7705@item -falign-labels
7706@itemx -falign-labels=@var{n}
7707@opindex falign-labels
7708Align all branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, skipping up to
7709@var{n} bytes like @option{-falign-functions}.  This option can easily
7710make code slower, because it must insert dummy operations for when the
7711branch target is reached in the usual flow of the code.
7712
7713@option{-fno-align-labels} and @option{-falign-labels=1} are
7714equivalent and mean that labels will not be aligned.
7715
7716If @option{-falign-loops} or @option{-falign-jumps} are applicable and
7717are greater than this value, then their values are used instead.
7718
7719If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default
7720which is very likely to be @samp{1}, meaning no alignment.
7721
7722Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7723
7724@item -falign-loops
7725@itemx -falign-loops=@var{n}
7726@opindex falign-loops
7727Align loops to a power-of-two boundary, skipping up to @var{n} bytes
7728like @option{-falign-functions}.  The hope is that the loop will be
7729executed many times, which will make up for any execution of the dummy
7730operations.
7731
7732@option{-fno-align-loops} and @option{-falign-loops=1} are
7733equivalent and mean that loops will not be aligned.
7734
7735If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
7736
7737Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7738
7739@item -falign-jumps
7740@itemx -falign-jumps=@var{n}
7741@opindex falign-jumps
7742Align branch targets to a power-of-two boundary, for branch targets
7743where the targets can only be reached by jumping, skipping up to @var{n}
7744bytes like @option{-falign-functions}.  In this case, no dummy operations
7745need be executed.
7746
7747@option{-fno-align-jumps} and @option{-falign-jumps=1} are
7748equivalent and mean that loops will not be aligned.
7749
7750If @var{n} is not specified or is zero, use a machine-dependent default.
7751
7752Enabled at levels @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}.
7753
7754@item -funit-at-a-time
7755@opindex funit-at-a-time
7756This option is left for compatibility reasons. @option{-funit-at-a-time}
7757has no effect, while @option{-fno-unit-at-a-time} implies
7758@option{-fno-toplevel-reorder} and @option{-fno-section-anchors}.
7759
7760Enabled by default.
7761
7762@item -fno-toplevel-reorder
7763@opindex fno-toplevel-reorder
7764Do not reorder top-level functions, variables, and @code{asm}
7765statements.  Output them in the same order that they appear in the
7766input file.  When this option is used, unreferenced static variables
7767will not be removed.  This option is intended to support existing code
7768that relies on a particular ordering.  For new code, it is better to
7769use attributes.
7770
7771Enabled at level @option{-O0}.  When disabled explicitly, it also implies
7772@option{-fno-section-anchors}, which is otherwise enabled at @option{-O0} on some
7773targets.
7774
7775@item -fweb
7776@opindex fweb
7777Constructs webs as commonly used for register allocation purposes and assign
7778each web individual pseudo register.  This allows the register allocation pass
7779to operate on pseudos directly, but also strengthens several other optimization
7780passes, such as CSE, loop optimizer and trivial dead code remover.  It can,
7781however, make debugging impossible, since variables will no longer stay in a
7782``home register''.
7783
7784Enabled by default with @option{-funroll-loops}.
7785
7786@item -fwhole-program
7787@opindex fwhole-program
7788Assume that the current compilation unit represents the whole program being
7789compiled.  All public functions and variables with the exception of @code{main}
7790and those merged by attribute @code{externally_visible} become static functions
7791and in effect are optimized more aggressively by interprocedural optimizers. If @command{gold} is used as the linker plugin, @code{externally_visible} attributes are automatically added to functions (not variable yet due to a current @command{gold} issue) that are accessed outside of LTO objects according to resolution file produced by @command{gold}.  For other linkers that cannot generate resolution file, explicit @code{externally_visible} attributes are still necessary.
7792While this option is equivalent to proper use of the @code{static} keyword for
7793programs consisting of a single file, in combination with option
7794@option{-flto} this flag can be used to
7795compile many smaller scale programs since the functions and variables become
7796local for the whole combined compilation unit, not for the single source file
7797itself.
7798
7799This option implies @option{-fwhole-file} for Fortran programs.
7800
7801@item -flto[=@var{n}]
7802@opindex flto
7803This option runs the standard link-time optimizer.  When invoked
7804with source code, it generates GIMPLE (one of GCC's internal
7805representations) and writes it to special ELF sections in the object
7806file.  When the object files are linked together, all the function
7807bodies are read from these ELF sections and instantiated as if they
7808had been part of the same translation unit.
7809
7810To use the link-time optimizer, @option{-flto} needs to be specified at
7811compile time and during the final link.  For example:
7812
7813@smallexample
7814gcc -c -O2 -flto foo.c
7815gcc -c -O2 -flto bar.c
7816gcc -o myprog -flto -O2 foo.o bar.o
7817@end smallexample
7818
7819The first two invocations to GCC save a bytecode representation
7820of GIMPLE into special ELF sections inside @file{foo.o} and
7821@file{bar.o}.  The final invocation reads the GIMPLE bytecode from
7822@file{foo.o} and @file{bar.o}, merges the two files into a single
7823internal image, and compiles the result as usual.  Since both
7824@file{foo.o} and @file{bar.o} are merged into a single image, this
7825causes all the interprocedural analyses and optimizations in GCC to
7826work across the two files as if they were a single one.  This means,
7827for example, that the inliner is able to inline functions in
7828@file{bar.o} into functions in @file{foo.o} and vice-versa.
7829
7830Another (simpler) way to enable link-time optimization is:
7831
7832@smallexample
7833gcc -o myprog -flto -O2 foo.c bar.c
7834@end smallexample
7835
7836The above generates bytecode for @file{foo.c} and @file{bar.c},
7837merges them together into a single GIMPLE representation and optimizes
7838them as usual to produce @file{myprog}.
7839
7840The only important thing to keep in mind is that to enable link-time
7841optimizations the @option{-flto} flag needs to be passed to both the
7842compile and the link commands.
7843
7844To make whole program optimization effective, it is necessary to make
7845certain whole program assumptions.  The compiler needs to know
7846what functions and variables can be accessed by libraries and runtime
7847outside of the link-time optimized unit.  When supported by the linker,
7848the linker plugin (see @option{-fuse-linker-plugin}) passes information
7849to the compiler about used and externally visible symbols.  When
7850the linker plugin is not available, @option{-fwhole-program} should be
7851used to allow the compiler to make these assumptions, which leads
7852to more aggressive optimization decisions.
7853
7854Note that when a file is compiled with @option{-flto}, the generated
7855object file is larger than a regular object file because it
7856contains GIMPLE bytecodes and the usual final code.  This means that
7857object files with LTO information can be linked as normal object
7858files; if @option{-flto} is not passed to the linker, no
7859interprocedural optimizations are applied.
7860
7861Additionally, the optimization flags used to compile individual files
7862are not necessarily related to those used at link time.  For instance,
7863
7864@smallexample
7865gcc -c -O0 -flto foo.c
7866gcc -c -O0 -flto bar.c
7867gcc -o myprog -flto -O3 foo.o bar.o
7868@end smallexample
7869
7870This produces individual object files with unoptimized assembler
7871code, but the resulting binary @file{myprog} is optimized at
7872@option{-O3}.  If, instead, the final binary is generated without
7873@option{-flto}, then @file{myprog} is not optimized.
7874
7875When producing the final binary with @option{-flto}, GCC only
7876applies link-time optimizations to those files that contain bytecode.
7877Therefore, you can mix and match object files and libraries with
7878GIMPLE bytecodes and final object code.  GCC automatically selects
7879which files to optimize in LTO mode and which files to link without
7880further processing.
7881
7882There are some code generation flags preserved by GCC when
7883generating bytecodes, as they need to be used during the final link
7884stage.  Currently, the following options are saved into the GIMPLE
7885bytecode files: @option{-fPIC}, @option{-fcommon} and all the
7886@option{-m} target flags.
7887
7888At link time, these options are read in and reapplied.  Note that the
7889current implementation makes no attempt to recognize conflicting
7890values for these options.  If different files have conflicting option
7891values (e.g., one file is compiled with @option{-fPIC} and another
7892isn't), the compiler simply uses the last value read from the
7893bytecode files.  It is recommended, then, that you compile all the files
7894participating in the same link with the same options.
7895
7896If LTO encounters objects with C linkage declared with incompatible
7897types in separate translation units to be linked together (undefined
7898behavior according to ISO C99 6.2.7), a non-fatal diagnostic may be
7899issued.  The behavior is still undefined at run time.
7900
7901Another feature of LTO is that it is possible to apply interprocedural
7902optimizations on files written in different languages.  This requires
7903support in the language front end.  Currently, the C, C++ and
7904Fortran front ends are capable of emitting GIMPLE bytecodes, so
7905something like this should work:
7906
7907@smallexample
7908gcc -c -flto foo.c
7909g++ -c -flto bar.cc
7910gfortran -c -flto baz.f90
7911g++ -o myprog -flto -O3 foo.o bar.o baz.o -lgfortran
7912@end smallexample
7913
7914Notice that the final link is done with @command{g++} to get the C++
7915runtime libraries and @option{-lgfortran} is added to get the Fortran
7916runtime libraries.  In general, when mixing languages in LTO mode, you
7917should use the same link command options as when mixing languages in a
7918regular (non-LTO) compilation; all you need to add is @option{-flto} to
7919all the compile and link commands.
7920
7921If object files containing GIMPLE bytecode are stored in a library archive, say
7922@file{libfoo.a}, it is possible to extract and use them in an LTO link if you
7923are using a linker with plugin support.  To enable this feature, use
7924the flag @option{-fuse-linker-plugin} at link time:
7925
7926@smallexample
7927gcc -o myprog -O2 -flto -fuse-linker-plugin a.o b.o -lfoo
7928@end smallexample
7929
7930With the linker plugin enabled, the linker extracts the needed
7931GIMPLE files from @file{libfoo.a} and passes them on to the running GCC
7932to make them part of the aggregated GIMPLE image to be optimized.
7933
7934If you are not using a linker with plugin support and/or do not
7935enable the linker plugin, then the objects inside @file{libfoo.a}
7936are extracted and linked as usual, but they do not participate
7937in the LTO optimization process.
7938
7939Link-time optimizations do not require the presence of the whole program to
7940operate.  If the program does not require any symbols to be exported, it is
7941possible to combine @option{-flto} and @option{-fwhole-program} to allow
7942the interprocedural optimizers to use more aggressive assumptions which may
7943lead to improved optimization opportunities.
7944Use of @option{-fwhole-program} is not needed when linker plugin is
7945active (see @option{-fuse-linker-plugin}).
7946
7947The current implementation of LTO makes no
7948attempt to generate bytecode that is portable between different
7949types of hosts.  The bytecode files are versioned and there is a
7950strict version check, so bytecode files generated in one version of
7951GCC will not work with an older/newer version of GCC.
7952
7953Link-time optimization does not work well with generation of debugging
7954information.  Combining @option{-flto} with
7955@option{-g} is currently experimental and expected to produce wrong
7956results.
7957
7958If you specify the optional @var{n}, the optimization and code
7959generation done at link time is executed in parallel using @var{n}
7960parallel jobs by utilizing an installed @command{make} program.  The
7961environment variable @env{MAKE} may be used to override the program
7962used.  The default value for @var{n} is 1.
7963
7964You can also specify @option{-flto=jobserver} to use GNU make's
7965job server mode to determine the number of parallel jobs. This
7966is useful when the Makefile calling GCC is already executing in parallel.
7967You must prepend a @samp{+} to the command recipe in the parent Makefile
7968for this to work.  This option likely only works if @env{MAKE} is
7969GNU make.
7970
7971This option is disabled by default
7972
7973@item -flto-partition=@var{alg}
7974@opindex flto-partition
7975Specify the partitioning algorithm used by the link-time optimizer.
7976The value is either @code{1to1} to specify a partitioning mirroring
7977the original source files or @code{balanced} to specify partitioning
7978into equally sized chunks (whenever possible).  Specifying @code{none}
7979as an algorithm disables partitioning and streaming completely. The
7980default value is @code{balanced}.
7981
7982@item -flto-compression-level=@var{n}
7983This option specifies the level of compression used for intermediate
7984language written to LTO object files, and is only meaningful in
7985conjunction with LTO mode (@option{-flto}).  Valid
7986values are 0 (no compression) to 9 (maximum compression).  Values
7987outside this range are clamped to either 0 or 9.  If the option is not
7988given, a default balanced compression setting is used.
7989
7990@item -flto-report
7991Prints a report with internal details on the workings of the link-time
7992optimizer.  The contents of this report vary from version to version.
7993It is meant to be useful to GCC developers when processing object
7994files in LTO mode (via @option{-flto}).
7995
7996Disabled by default.
7997
7998@item -fuse-linker-plugin
7999Enables the use of a linker plugin during link-time optimization.  This
8000option relies on plugin support in the linker, which is available in gold
8001or in GNU ld 2.21 or newer.
8002
8003This option enables the extraction of object files with GIMPLE bytecode out
8004of library archives. This improves the quality of optimization by exposing
8005more code to the link-time optimizer.  This information specifies what
8006symbols can be accessed externally (by non-LTO object or during dynamic
8007linking).  Resulting code quality improvements on binaries (and shared
8008libraries that use hidden visibility) are similar to @code{-fwhole-program}.
8009See @option{-flto} for a description of the effect of this flag and how to
8010use it.
8011
8012This option is enabled by default when LTO support in GCC is enabled
8013and GCC was configured for use with
8014a linker supporting plugins (GNU ld 2.21 or newer or gold).
8015
8016@item -ffat-lto-objects
8017@opindex ffat-lto-objects
8018Fat LTO objects are object files that contain both the intermediate language
8019and the object code. This makes them usable for both LTO linking and normal
8020linking. This option is effective only when compiling with @option{-flto}
8021and is ignored at link time.
8022
8023@option{-fno-fat-lto-objects} improves compilation time over plain LTO, but
8024requires the complete toolchain to be aware of LTO. It requires a linker with
8025linker plugin support for basic functionality.  Additionally, nm, ar and ranlib
8026need to support linker plugins to allow a full-featured build environment
8027(capable of building static libraries etc).
8028
8029The default is @option{-ffat-lto-objects} but this default is intended to
8030change in future releases when linker plugin enabled environments become more
8031common.
8032
8033@item -fcompare-elim
8034@opindex fcompare-elim
8035After register allocation and post-register allocation instruction splitting,
8036identify arithmetic instructions that compute processor flags similar to a
8037comparison operation based on that arithmetic.  If possible, eliminate the
8038explicit comparison operation.
8039
8040This pass only applies to certain targets that cannot explicitly represent
8041the comparison operation before register allocation is complete.
8042
8043Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
8044
8045@item -fcprop-registers
8046@opindex fcprop-registers
8047After register allocation and post-register allocation instruction splitting,
8048we perform a copy-propagation pass to try to reduce scheduling dependencies
8049and occasionally eliminate the copy.
8050
8051Enabled at levels @option{-O}, @option{-O2}, @option{-O3}, @option{-Os}.
8052
8053@item -fprofile-correction
8054@opindex fprofile-correction
8055Profiles collected using an instrumented binary for multi-threaded programs may
8056be inconsistent due to missed counter updates. When this option is specified,
8057GCC will use heuristics to correct or smooth out such inconsistencies. By
8058default, GCC will emit an error message when an inconsistent profile is detected.
8059
8060@item -fprofile-dir=@var{path}
8061@opindex fprofile-dir
8062
8063Set the directory to search for the profile data files in to @var{path}.
8064This option affects only the profile data generated by
8065@option{-fprofile-generate}, @option{-ftest-coverage}, @option{-fprofile-arcs}
8066and used by @option{-fprofile-use} and @option{-fbranch-probabilities}
8067and its related options.  Both absolute and relative paths can be used.
8068By default, GCC will use the current directory as @var{path}, thus the
8069profile data file will appear in the same directory as the object file.
8070
8071@item -fprofile-generate
8072@itemx -fprofile-generate=@var{path}
8073@opindex fprofile-generate
8074
8075Enable options usually used for instrumenting application to produce
8076profile useful for later recompilation with profile feedback based
8077optimization.  You must use @option{-fprofile-generate} both when
8078compiling and when linking your program.
8079
8080The following options are enabled: @code{-fprofile-arcs}, @code{-fprofile-values}, @code{-fvpt}.
8081
8082If @var{path} is specified, GCC will look at the @var{path} to find
8083the profile feedback data files. See @option{-fprofile-dir}.
8084
8085@item -fprofile-use
8086@itemx -fprofile-use=@var{path}
8087@opindex fprofile-use
8088Enable profile feedback directed optimizations, and optimizations
8089generally profitable only with profile feedback available.
8090
8091The following options are enabled: @code{-fbranch-probabilities}, @code{-fvpt},
8092@code{-funroll-loops}, @code{-fpeel-loops}, @code{-ftracer}
8093
8094By default, GCC emits an error message if the feedback profiles do not
8095match the source code.  This error can be turned into a warning by using
8096@option{-Wcoverage-mismatch}.  Note this may result in poorly optimized
8097code.
8098
8099If @var{path} is specified, GCC will look at the @var{path} to find
8100the profile feedback data files. See @option{-fprofile-dir}.
8101@end table
8102
8103The following options control compiler behavior regarding floating-point
8104arithmetic.  These options trade off between speed and
8105correctness.  All must be specifically enabled.
8106
8107@table @gcctabopt
8108@item -ffloat-store
8109@opindex ffloat-store
8110Do not store floating-point variables in registers, and inhibit other
8111options that might change whether a floating-point value is taken from a
8112register or memory.
8113
8114@cindex floating-point precision
8115This option prevents undesirable excess precision on machines such as
8116the 68000 where the floating registers (of the 68881) keep more
8117precision than a @code{double} is supposed to have.  Similarly for the
8118x86 architecture.  For most programs, the excess precision does only
8119good, but a few programs rely on the precise definition of IEEE floating
8120point.  Use @option{-ffloat-store} for such programs, after modifying
8121them to store all pertinent intermediate computations into variables.
8122
8123@item -fexcess-precision=@var{style}
8124@opindex fexcess-precision
8125This option allows further control over excess precision on machines
8126where floating-point registers have more precision than the IEEE
8127@code{float} and @code{double} types and the processor does not
8128support operations rounding to those types.  By default,
8129@option{-fexcess-precision=fast} is in effect; this means that
8130operations are carried out in the precision of the registers and that
8131it is unpredictable when rounding to the types specified in the source
8132code takes place.  When compiling C, if
8133@option{-fexcess-precision=standard} is specified then excess
8134precision will follow the rules specified in ISO C99; in particular,
8135both casts and assignments cause values to be rounded to their
8136semantic types (whereas @option{-ffloat-store} only affects
8137assignments).  This option is enabled by default for C if a strict
8138conformance option such as @option{-std=c99} is used.
8139
8140@opindex mfpmath
8141@option{-fexcess-precision=standard} is not implemented for languages
8142other than C, and has no effect if
8143@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} or @option{-ffast-math} is
8144specified.  On the x86, it also has no effect if @option{-mfpmath=sse}
8145or @option{-mfpmath=sse+387} is specified; in the former case, IEEE
8146semantics apply without excess precision, and in the latter, rounding
8147is unpredictable.
8148
8149@item -ffast-math
8150@opindex ffast-math
8151Sets @option{-fno-math-errno}, @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations},
8152@option{-ffinite-math-only}, @option{-fno-rounding-math},
8153@option{-fno-signaling-nans} and @option{-fcx-limited-range}.
8154
8155This option causes the preprocessor macro @code{__FAST_MATH__} to be defined.
8156
8157This option is not turned on by any @option{-O} option besides
8158@option{-Ofast} since it can result in incorrect output for programs
8159that depend on an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications
8160for math functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs
8161that do not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8162
8163@item -fno-math-errno
8164@opindex fno-math-errno
8165Do not set ERRNO after calling math functions that are executed
8166with a single instruction, e.g., sqrt.  A program that relies on
8167IEEE exceptions for math error handling may want to use this flag
8168for speed while maintaining IEEE arithmetic compatibility.
8169
8170This option is not turned on by any @option{-O} option since
8171it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on
8172an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
8173math functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs
8174that do not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8175
8176The default is @option{-fmath-errno}.
8177
8178On Darwin systems, the math library never sets @code{errno}.  There is
8179therefore no reason for the compiler to consider the possibility that
8180it might, and @option{-fno-math-errno} is the default.
8181
8182@item -funsafe-math-optimizations
8183@opindex funsafe-math-optimizations
8184
8185Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that (a) assume
8186that arguments and results are valid and (b) may violate IEEE or
8187ANSI standards.  When used at link-time, it may include libraries
8188or startup files that change the default FPU control word or other
8189similar optimizations.
8190
8191This option is not turned on by any @option{-O} option since
8192it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on
8193an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
8194math functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs
8195that do not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8196Enables @option{-fno-signed-zeros}, @option{-fno-trapping-math},
8197@option{-fassociative-math} and @option{-freciprocal-math}.
8198
8199The default is @option{-fno-unsafe-math-optimizations}.
8200
8201@item -fassociative-math
8202@opindex fassociative-math
8203
8204Allow re-association of operands in series of floating-point operations.
8205This violates the ISO C and C++ language standard by possibly changing
8206computation result.  NOTE: re-ordering may change the sign of zero as
8207well as ignore NaNs and inhibit or create underflow or overflow (and
8208thus cannot be used on code that relies on rounding behavior like
8209@code{(x + 2**52) - 2**52}.  May also reorder floating-point comparisons
8210and thus may not be used when ordered comparisons are required.
8211This option requires that both @option{-fno-signed-zeros} and
8212@option{-fno-trapping-math} be in effect.  Moreover, it doesn't make
8213much sense with @option{-frounding-math}. For Fortran the option
8214is automatically enabled when both @option{-fno-signed-zeros} and
8215@option{-fno-trapping-math} are in effect.
8216
8217The default is @option{-fno-associative-math}.
8218
8219@item -freciprocal-math
8220@opindex freciprocal-math
8221
8222Allow the reciprocal of a value to be used instead of dividing by
8223the value if this enables optimizations.  For example @code{x / y}
8224can be replaced with @code{x * (1/y)}, which is useful if @code{(1/y)}
8225is subject to common subexpression elimination.  Note that this loses
8226precision and increases the number of flops operating on the value.
8227
8228The default is @option{-fno-reciprocal-math}.
8229
8230@item -ffinite-math-only
8231@opindex ffinite-math-only
8232Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that assume
8233that arguments and results are not NaNs or +-Infs.
8234
8235This option is not turned on by any @option{-O} option since
8236it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on
8237an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
8238math functions. It may, however, yield faster code for programs
8239that do not require the guarantees of these specifications.
8240
8241The default is @option{-fno-finite-math-only}.
8242
8243@item -fno-signed-zeros
8244@opindex fno-signed-zeros
8245Allow optimizations for floating-point arithmetic that ignore the
8246signedness of zero.  IEEE arithmetic specifies the behavior of
8247distinct +0.0 and @minus{}0.0 values, which then prohibits simplification
8248of expressions such as x+0.0 or 0.0*x (even with @option{-ffinite-math-only}).
8249This option implies that the sign of a zero result isn't significant.
8250
8251The default is @option{-fsigned-zeros}.
8252
8253@item -fno-trapping-math
8254@opindex fno-trapping-math
8255Compile code assuming that floating-point operations cannot generate
8256user-visible traps.  These traps include division by zero, overflow,
8257underflow, inexact result and invalid operation.  This option requires
8258that @option{-fno-signaling-nans} be in effect.  Setting this option may
8259allow faster code if one relies on ``non-stop'' IEEE arithmetic, for example.
8260
8261This option should never be turned on by any @option{-O} option since
8262it can result in incorrect output for programs that depend on
8263an exact implementation of IEEE or ISO rules/specifications for
8264math functions.
8265
8266The default is @option{-ftrapping-math}.
8267
8268@item -frounding-math
8269@opindex frounding-math
8270Disable transformations and optimizations that assume default floating-point
8271rounding behavior.  This is round-to-zero for all floating point
8272to integer conversions, and round-to-nearest for all other arithmetic
8273truncations.  This option should be specified for programs that change
8274the FP rounding mode dynamically, or that may be executed with a
8275non-default rounding mode.  This option disables constant folding of
8276floating-point expressions at compile time (which may be affected by
8277rounding mode) and arithmetic transformations that are unsafe in the
8278presence of sign-dependent rounding modes.
8279
8280The default is @option{-fno-rounding-math}.
8281
8282This option is experimental and does not currently guarantee to
8283disable all GCC optimizations that are affected by rounding mode.
8284Future versions of GCC may provide finer control of this setting
8285using C99's @code{FENV_ACCESS} pragma.  This command-line option
8286will be used to specify the default state for @code{FENV_ACCESS}.
8287
8288@item -fsignaling-nans
8289@opindex fsignaling-nans
8290Compile code assuming that IEEE signaling NaNs may generate user-visible
8291traps during floating-point operations.  Setting this option disables
8292optimizations that may change the number of exceptions visible with
8293signaling NaNs.  This option implies @option{-ftrapping-math}.
8294
8295This option causes the preprocessor macro @code{__SUPPORT_SNAN__} to
8296be defined.
8297
8298The default is @option{-fno-signaling-nans}.
8299
8300This option is experimental and does not currently guarantee to
8301disable all GCC optimizations that affect signaling NaN behavior.
8302
8303@item -fsingle-precision-constant
8304@opindex fsingle-precision-constant
8305Treat floating-point constants as single precision instead of
8306implicitly converting them to double-precision constants.
8307
8308@item -fcx-limited-range
8309@opindex fcx-limited-range
8310When enabled, this option states that a range reduction step is not
8311needed when performing complex division.  Also, there is no checking
8312whether the result of a complex multiplication or division is @code{NaN
8313+ I*NaN}, with an attempt to rescue the situation in that case.  The
8314default is @option{-fno-cx-limited-range}, but is enabled by
8315@option{-ffast-math}.
8316
8317This option controls the default setting of the ISO C99
8318@code{CX_LIMITED_RANGE} pragma.  Nevertheless, the option applies to
8319all languages.
8320
8321@item -fcx-fortran-rules
8322@opindex fcx-fortran-rules
8323Complex multiplication and division follow Fortran rules.  Range
8324reduction is done as part of complex division, but there is no checking
8325whether the result of a complex multiplication or division is @code{NaN
8326+ I*NaN}, with an attempt to rescue the situation in that case.
8327
8328The default is @option{-fno-cx-fortran-rules}.
8329
8330@end table
8331
8332The following options control optimizations that may improve
8333performance, but are not enabled by any @option{-O} options.  This
8334section includes experimental options that may produce broken code.
8335
8336@table @gcctabopt
8337@item -fbranch-probabilities
8338@opindex fbranch-probabilities
8339After running a program compiled with @option{-fprofile-arcs}
8340(@pxref{Debugging Options,, Options for Debugging Your Program or
8341@command{gcc}}), you can compile it a second time using
8342@option{-fbranch-probabilities}, to improve optimizations based on
8343the number of times each branch was taken.  When the program
8344compiled with @option{-fprofile-arcs} exits it saves arc execution
8345counts to a file called @file{@var{sourcename}.gcda} for each source
8346file.  The information in this data file is very dependent on the
8347structure of the generated code, so you must use the same source code
8348and the same optimization options for both compilations.
8349
8350With @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, GCC puts a
8351@samp{REG_BR_PROB} note on each @samp{JUMP_INSN} and @samp{CALL_INSN}.
8352These can be used to improve optimization.  Currently, they are only
8353used in one place: in @file{reorg.c}, instead of guessing which path a
8354branch is most likely to take, the @samp{REG_BR_PROB} values are used to
8355exactly determine which path is taken more often.
8356
8357@item -fprofile-values
8358@opindex fprofile-values
8359If combined with @option{-fprofile-arcs}, it adds code so that some
8360data about values of expressions in the program is gathered.
8361
8362With @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, it reads back the data gathered
8363from profiling values of expressions for usage in optimizations.
8364
8365Enabled with @option{-fprofile-generate} and @option{-fprofile-use}.
8366
8367@item -fvpt
8368@opindex fvpt
8369If combined with @option{-fprofile-arcs}, it instructs the compiler to add
8370a code to gather information about values of expressions.
8371
8372With @option{-fbranch-probabilities}, it reads back the data gathered
8373and actually performs the optimizations based on them.
8374Currently the optimizations include specialization of division operation
8375using the knowledge about the value of the denominator.
8376
8377@item -frename-registers
8378@opindex frename-registers
8379Attempt to avoid false dependencies in scheduled code by making use
8380of registers left over after register allocation.  This optimization
8381will most benefit processors with lots of registers.  Depending on the
8382debug information format adopted by the target, however, it can
8383make debugging impossible, since variables will no longer stay in
8384a ``home register''.
8385
8386Enabled by default with @option{-funroll-loops} and @option{-fpeel-loops}.
8387
8388@item -ftracer
8389@opindex ftracer
8390Perform tail duplication to enlarge superblock size.  This transformation
8391simplifies the control flow of the function allowing other optimizations to do
8392better job.
8393
8394Enabled with @option{-fprofile-use}.
8395
8396@item -funroll-loops
8397@opindex funroll-loops
8398Unroll loops whose number of iterations can be determined at compile time or
8399upon entry to the loop.  @option{-funroll-loops} implies
8400@option{-frerun-cse-after-loop}, @option{-fweb} and @option{-frename-registers}.
8401It also turns on complete loop peeling (i.e.@: complete removal of loops with
8402small constant number of iterations).  This option makes code larger, and may
8403or may not make it run faster.
8404
8405Enabled with @option{-fprofile-use}.
8406
8407@item -funroll-all-loops
8408@opindex funroll-all-loops
8409Unroll all loops, even if their number of iterations is uncertain when
8410the loop is entered.  This usually makes programs run more slowly.
8411@option{-funroll-all-loops} implies the same options as
8412@option{-funroll-loops}.
8413
8414@item -fpeel-loops
8415@opindex fpeel-loops
8416Peels loops for which there is enough information that they do not
8417roll much (from profile feedback).  It also turns on complete loop peeling
8418(i.e.@: complete removal of loops with small constant number of iterations).
8419
8420Enabled with @option{-fprofile-use}.
8421
8422@item -fmove-loop-invariants
8423@opindex fmove-loop-invariants
8424Enables the loop invariant motion pass in the RTL loop optimizer.  Enabled
8425at level @option{-O1}
8426
8427@item -funswitch-loops
8428@opindex funswitch-loops
8429Move branches with loop invariant conditions out of the loop, with duplicates
8430of the loop on both branches (modified according to result of the condition).
8431
8432@item -ffunction-sections
8433@itemx -fdata-sections
8434@opindex ffunction-sections
8435@opindex fdata-sections
8436Place each function or data item into its own section in the output
8437file if the target supports arbitrary sections.  The name of the
8438function or the name of the data item determines the section's name
8439in the output file.
8440
8441Use these options on systems where the linker can perform optimizations
8442to improve locality of reference in the instruction space.  Most systems
8443using the ELF object format and SPARC processors running Solaris 2 have
8444linkers with such optimizations.  AIX may have these optimizations in
8445the future.
8446
8447Only use these options when there are significant benefits from doing
8448so.  When you specify these options, the assembler and linker will
8449create larger object and executable files and will also be slower.
8450You will not be able to use @code{gprof} on all systems if you
8451specify this option and you may have problems with debugging if
8452you specify both this option and @option{-g}.
8453
8454@item -fbranch-target-load-optimize
8455@opindex fbranch-target-load-optimize
8456Perform branch target register load optimization before prologue / epilogue
8457threading.
8458The use of target registers can typically be exposed only during reload,
8459thus hoisting loads out of loops and doing inter-block scheduling needs
8460a separate optimization pass.
8461
8462@item -fbranch-target-load-optimize2
8463@opindex fbranch-target-load-optimize2
8464Perform branch target register load optimization after prologue / epilogue
8465threading.
8466
8467@item -fbtr-bb-exclusive
8468@opindex fbtr-bb-exclusive
8469When performing branch target register load optimization, don't reuse
8470branch target registers in within any basic block.
8471
8472@item -fstack-protector
8473@opindex fstack-protector
8474Emit extra code to check for buffer overflows, such as stack smashing
8475attacks.  This is done by adding a guard variable to functions with
8476vulnerable objects.  This includes functions that call alloca, and
8477functions with buffers larger than 8 bytes.  The guards are initialized
8478when a function is entered and then checked when the function exits.
8479If a guard check fails, an error message is printed and the program exits.
8480
8481@item -fstack-protector-all
8482@opindex fstack-protector-all
8483Like @option{-fstack-protector} except that all functions are protected.
8484
8485@item -fsection-anchors
8486@opindex fsection-anchors
8487Try to reduce the number of symbolic address calculations by using
8488shared ``anchor'' symbols to address nearby objects.  This transformation
8489can help to reduce the number of GOT entries and GOT accesses on some
8490targets.
8491
8492For example, the implementation of the following function @code{foo}:
8493
8494@smallexample
8495static int a, b, c;
8496int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
8497@end smallexample
8498
8499would usually calculate the addresses of all three variables, but if you
8500compile it with @option{-fsection-anchors}, it will access the variables
8501from a common anchor point instead.  The effect is similar to the
8502following pseudocode (which isn't valid C):
8503
8504@smallexample
8505int foo (void)
8506@{
8507  register int *xr = &x;
8508  return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
8509@}
8510@end smallexample
8511
8512Not all targets support this option.
8513
8514@item --param @var{name}=@var{value}
8515@opindex param
8516In some places, GCC uses various constants to control the amount of
8517optimization that is done.  For example, GCC will not inline functions
8518that contain more than a certain number of instructions.  You can
8519control some of these constants on the command line using the
8520@option{--param} option.
8521
8522The names of specific parameters, and the meaning of the values, are
8523tied to the internals of the compiler, and are subject to change
8524without notice in future releases.
8525
8526In each case, the @var{value} is an integer.  The allowable choices for
8527@var{name} are given in the following table:
8528
8529@table @gcctabopt
8530@item predictable-branch-outcome
8531When branch is predicted to be taken with probability lower than this threshold
8532(in percent), then it is considered well predictable. The default is 10.
8533
8534@item max-crossjump-edges
8535The maximum number of incoming edges to consider for crossjumping.
8536The algorithm used by @option{-fcrossjumping} is @math{O(N^2)} in
8537the number of edges incoming to each block.  Increasing values mean
8538more aggressive optimization, making the compilation time increase with
8539probably small improvement in executable size.
8540
8541@item min-crossjump-insns
8542The minimum number of instructions that must be matched at the end
8543of two blocks before crossjumping will be performed on them.  This
8544value is ignored in the case where all instructions in the block being
8545crossjumped from are matched.  The default value is 5.
8546
8547@item max-grow-copy-bb-insns
8548The maximum code size expansion factor when copying basic blocks
8549instead of jumping.  The expansion is relative to a jump instruction.
8550The default value is 8.
8551
8552@item max-goto-duplication-insns
8553The maximum number of instructions to duplicate to a block that jumps
8554to a computed goto.  To avoid @math{O(N^2)} behavior in a number of
8555passes, GCC factors computed gotos early in the compilation process,
8556and unfactors them as late as possible.  Only computed jumps at the
8557end of a basic blocks with no more than max-goto-duplication-insns are
8558unfactored.  The default value is 8.
8559
8560@item max-delay-slot-insn-search
8561The maximum number of instructions to consider when looking for an
8562instruction to fill a delay slot.  If more than this arbitrary number of
8563instructions is searched, the time savings from filling the delay slot
8564will be minimal so stop searching.  Increasing values mean more
8565aggressive optimization, making the compilation time increase with probably
8566small improvement in execution time.
8567
8568@item max-delay-slot-live-search
8569When trying to fill delay slots, the maximum number of instructions to
8570consider when searching for a block with valid live register
8571information.  Increasing this arbitrarily chosen value means more
8572aggressive optimization, increasing the compilation time.  This parameter
8573should be removed when the delay slot code is rewritten to maintain the
8574control-flow graph.
8575
8576@item max-gcse-memory
8577The approximate maximum amount of memory that will be allocated in
8578order to perform the global common subexpression elimination
8579optimization.  If more memory than specified is required, the
8580optimization will not be done.
8581
8582@item max-gcse-insertion-ratio
8583If the ratio of expression insertions to deletions is larger than this value
8584for any expression, then RTL PRE will insert or remove the expression and thus
8585leave partially redundant computations in the instruction stream.  The default value is 20.
8586
8587@item max-pending-list-length
8588The maximum number of pending dependencies scheduling will allow
8589before flushing the current state and starting over.  Large functions
8590with few branches or calls can create excessively large lists which
8591needlessly consume memory and resources.
8592
8593@item max-modulo-backtrack-attempts
8594The maximum number of backtrack attempts the scheduler should make
8595when modulo scheduling a loop.  Larger values can exponentially increase
8596compilation time.
8597
8598@item max-inline-insns-single
8599Several parameters control the tree inliner used in gcc.
8600This number sets the maximum number of instructions (counted in GCC's
8601internal representation) in a single function that the tree inliner
8602will consider for inlining.  This only affects functions declared
8603inline and methods implemented in a class declaration (C++).
8604The default value is 400.
8605
8606@item max-inline-insns-auto
8607When you use @option{-finline-functions} (included in @option{-O3}),
8608a lot of functions that would otherwise not be considered for inlining
8609by the compiler will be investigated.  To those functions, a different
8610(more restrictive) limit compared to functions declared inline can
8611be applied.
8612The default value is 40.
8613
8614@item large-function-insns
8615The limit specifying really large functions.  For functions larger than this
8616limit after inlining, inlining is constrained by
8617@option{--param large-function-growth}.  This parameter is useful primarily
8618to avoid extreme compilation time caused by non-linear algorithms used by the
8619back end.
8620The default value is 2700.
8621
8622@item large-function-growth
8623Specifies maximal growth of large function caused by inlining in percents.
8624The default value is 100 which limits large function growth to 2.0 times
8625the original size.
8626
8627@item large-unit-insns
8628The limit specifying large translation unit.  Growth caused by inlining of
8629units larger than this limit is limited by @option{--param inline-unit-growth}.
8630For small units this might be too tight (consider unit consisting of function A
8631that is inline and B that just calls A three time.  If B is small relative to
8632A, the growth of unit is 300\% and yet such inlining is very sane.  For very
8633large units consisting of small inlineable functions however the overall unit
8634growth limit is needed to avoid exponential explosion of code size.  Thus for
8635smaller units, the size is increased to @option{--param large-unit-insns}
8636before applying @option{--param inline-unit-growth}.  The default is 10000
8637
8638@item inline-unit-growth
8639Specifies maximal overall growth of the compilation unit caused by inlining.
8640The default value is 30 which limits unit growth to 1.3 times the original
8641size.
8642
8643@item ipcp-unit-growth
8644Specifies maximal overall growth of the compilation unit caused by
8645interprocedural constant propagation.  The default value is 10 which limits
8646unit growth to 1.1 times the original size.
8647
8648@item large-stack-frame
8649The limit specifying large stack frames.  While inlining the algorithm is trying
8650to not grow past this limit too much.  Default value is 256 bytes.
8651
8652@item large-stack-frame-growth
8653Specifies maximal growth of large stack frames caused by inlining in percents.
8654The default value is 1000 which limits large stack frame growth to 11 times
8655the original size.
8656
8657@item max-inline-insns-recursive
8658@itemx max-inline-insns-recursive-auto
8659Specifies maximum number of instructions out-of-line copy of self recursive inline
8660function can grow into by performing recursive inlining.
8661
8662For functions declared inline @option{--param max-inline-insns-recursive} is
8663taken into account.  For function not declared inline, recursive inlining
8664happens only when @option{-finline-functions} (included in @option{-O3}) is
8665enabled and @option{--param max-inline-insns-recursive-auto} is used.  The
8666default value is 450.
8667
8668@item max-inline-recursive-depth
8669@itemx max-inline-recursive-depth-auto
8670Specifies maximum recursion depth used by the recursive inlining.
8671
8672For functions declared inline @option{--param max-inline-recursive-depth} is
8673taken into account.  For function not declared inline, recursive inlining
8674happens only when @option{-finline-functions} (included in @option{-O3}) is
8675enabled and @option{--param max-inline-recursive-depth-auto} is used.  The
8676default value is 8.
8677
8678@item min-inline-recursive-probability
8679Recursive inlining is profitable only for function having deep recursion
8680in average and can hurt for function having little recursion depth by
8681increasing the prologue size or complexity of function body to other
8682optimizers.
8683
8684When profile feedback is available (see @option{-fprofile-generate}) the actual
8685recursion depth can be guessed from probability that function will recurse via
8686given call expression.  This parameter limits inlining only to call expression
8687whose probability exceeds given threshold (in percents).  The default value is
868810.
8689
8690@item early-inlining-insns
8691Specify growth that early inliner can make.  In effect it increases amount of
8692inlining for code having large abstraction penalty.  The default value is 10.
8693
8694@item max-early-inliner-iterations
8695@itemx max-early-inliner-iterations
8696Limit of iterations of early inliner.  This basically bounds number of nested
8697indirect calls early inliner can resolve.  Deeper chains are still handled by
8698late inlining.
8699
8700@item comdat-sharing-probability
8701@itemx comdat-sharing-probability
8702Probability (in percent) that C++ inline function with comdat visibility
8703will be shared across multiple compilation units.  The default value is 20.
8704
8705@item min-vect-loop-bound
8706The minimum number of iterations under which a loop will not get vectorized
8707when @option{-ftree-vectorize} is used.  The number of iterations after
8708vectorization needs to be greater than the value specified by this option
8709to allow vectorization.  The default value is 0.
8710
8711@item gcse-cost-distance-ratio
8712Scaling factor in calculation of maximum distance an expression
8713can be moved by GCSE optimizations.  This is currently supported only in the
8714code hoisting pass.  The bigger the ratio, the more aggressive code hoisting
8715will be with simple expressions, i.e., the expressions that have cost
8716less than @option{gcse-unrestricted-cost}.  Specifying 0 will disable
8717hoisting of simple expressions.  The default value is 10.
8718
8719@item gcse-unrestricted-cost
8720Cost, roughly measured as the cost of a single typical machine
8721instruction, at which GCSE optimizations will not constrain
8722the distance an expression can travel.  This is currently
8723supported only in the code hoisting pass.  The lesser the cost,
8724the more aggressive code hoisting will be.  Specifying 0 will
8725allow all expressions to travel unrestricted distances.
8726The default value is 3.
8727
8728@item max-hoist-depth
8729The depth of search in the dominator tree for expressions to hoist.
8730This is used to avoid quadratic behavior in hoisting algorithm.
8731The value of 0 will avoid limiting the search, but may slow down compilation
8732of huge functions.  The default value is 30.
8733
8734@item max-tail-merge-comparisons
8735The maximum amount of similar bbs to compare a bb with.  This is used to
8736avoid quadratic behavior in tree tail merging.  The default value is 10.
8737
8738@item max-tail-merge-iterations
8739The maximum amount of iterations of the pass over the function.  This is used to
8740limit compilation time in tree tail merging.  The default value is 2.
8741
8742@item max-unrolled-insns
8743The maximum number of instructions that a loop should have if that loop
8744is unrolled, and if the loop is unrolled, it determines how many times
8745the loop code is unrolled.
8746
8747@item max-average-unrolled-insns
8748The maximum number of instructions biased by probabilities of their execution
8749that a loop should have if that loop is unrolled, and if the loop is unrolled,
8750it determines how many times the loop code is unrolled.
8751
8752@item max-unroll-times
8753The maximum number of unrollings of a single loop.
8754
8755@item max-peeled-insns
8756The maximum number of instructions that a loop should have if that loop
8757is peeled, and if the loop is peeled, it determines how many times
8758the loop code is peeled.
8759
8760@item max-peel-times
8761The maximum number of peelings of a single loop.
8762
8763@item max-completely-peeled-insns
8764The maximum number of insns of a completely peeled loop.
8765
8766@item max-completely-peel-times
8767The maximum number of iterations of a loop to be suitable for complete peeling.
8768
8769@item max-completely-peel-loop-nest-depth
8770The maximum depth of a loop nest suitable for complete peeling.
8771
8772@item max-unswitch-insns
8773The maximum number of insns of an unswitched loop.
8774
8775@item max-unswitch-level
8776The maximum number of branches unswitched in a single loop.
8777
8778@item lim-expensive
8779The minimum cost of an expensive expression in the loop invariant motion.
8780
8781@item iv-consider-all-candidates-bound
8782Bound on number of candidates for induction variables below that
8783all candidates are considered for each use in induction variable
8784optimizations.  Only the most relevant candidates are considered
8785if there are more candidates, to avoid quadratic time complexity.
8786
8787@item iv-max-considered-uses
8788The induction variable optimizations give up on loops that contain more
8789induction variable uses.
8790
8791@item iv-always-prune-cand-set-bound
8792If number of candidates in the set is smaller than this value,
8793we always try to remove unnecessary ivs from the set during its
8794optimization when a new iv is added to the set.
8795
8796@item scev-max-expr-size
8797Bound on size of expressions used in the scalar evolutions analyzer.
8798Large expressions slow the analyzer.
8799
8800@item scev-max-expr-complexity
8801Bound on the complexity of the expressions in the scalar evolutions analyzer.
8802Complex expressions slow the analyzer.
8803
8804@item omega-max-vars
8805The maximum number of variables in an Omega constraint system.
8806The default value is 128.
8807
8808@item omega-max-geqs
8809The maximum number of inequalities in an Omega constraint system.
8810The default value is 256.
8811
8812@item omega-max-eqs
8813The maximum number of equalities in an Omega constraint system.
8814The default value is 128.
8815
8816@item omega-max-wild-cards
8817The maximum number of wildcard variables that the Omega solver will
8818be able to insert.  The default value is 18.
8819
8820@item omega-hash-table-size
8821The size of the hash table in the Omega solver.  The default value is
8822550.
8823
8824@item omega-max-keys
8825The maximal number of keys used by the Omega solver.  The default
8826value is 500.
8827
8828@item omega-eliminate-redundant-constraints
8829When set to 1, use expensive methods to eliminate all redundant
8830constraints.  The default value is 0.
8831
8832@item vect-max-version-for-alignment-checks
8833The maximum number of run-time checks that can be performed when
8834doing loop versioning for alignment in the vectorizer.  See option
8835ftree-vect-loop-version for more information.
8836
8837@item vect-max-version-for-alias-checks
8838The maximum number of run-time checks that can be performed when
8839doing loop versioning for alias in the vectorizer.  See option
8840ftree-vect-loop-version for more information.
8841
8842@item max-iterations-to-track
8843
8844The maximum number of iterations of a loop the brute force algorithm
8845for analysis of # of iterations of the loop tries to evaluate.
8846
8847@item hot-bb-count-fraction
8848Select fraction of the maximal count of repetitions of basic block in program
8849given basic block needs to have to be considered hot.
8850
8851@item hot-bb-frequency-fraction
8852Select fraction of the entry block frequency of executions of basic block in
8853function given basic block needs to have to be considered hot.
8854
8855@item max-predicted-iterations
8856The maximum number of loop iterations we predict statically.  This is useful
8857in cases where function contain single loop with known bound and other loop
8858with unknown.  We predict the known number of iterations correctly, while
8859the unknown number of iterations average to roughly 10.  This means that the
8860loop without bounds would appear artificially cold relative to the other one.
8861
8862@item align-threshold
8863
8864Select fraction of the maximal frequency of executions of basic block in
8865function given basic block will get aligned.
8866
8867@item align-loop-iterations
8868
8869A loop expected to iterate at lest the selected number of iterations will get
8870aligned.
8871
8872@item tracer-dynamic-coverage
8873@itemx tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback
8874
8875This value is used to limit superblock formation once the given percentage of
8876executed instructions is covered.  This limits unnecessary code size
8877expansion.
8878
8879The @option{tracer-dynamic-coverage-feedback} is used only when profile
8880feedback is available.  The real profiles (as opposed to statically estimated
8881ones) are much less balanced allowing the threshold to be larger value.
8882
8883@item tracer-max-code-growth
8884Stop tail duplication once code growth has reached given percentage.  This is
8885rather hokey argument, as most of the duplicates will be eliminated later in
8886cross jumping, so it may be set to much higher values than is the desired code
8887growth.
8888
8889@item tracer-min-branch-ratio
8890
8891Stop reverse growth when the reverse probability of best edge is less than this
8892threshold (in percent).
8893
8894@item tracer-min-branch-ratio
8895@itemx tracer-min-branch-ratio-feedback
8896
8897Stop forward growth if the best edge do have probability lower than this
8898threshold.
8899
8900Similarly to @option{tracer-dynamic-coverage} two values are present, one for
8901compilation for profile feedback and one for compilation without.  The value
8902for compilation with profile feedback needs to be more conservative (higher) in
8903order to make tracer effective.
8904
8905@item max-cse-path-length
8906
8907Maximum number of basic blocks on path that cse considers.  The default is 10.
8908
8909@item max-cse-insns
8910The maximum instructions CSE process before flushing. The default is 1000.
8911
8912@item ggc-min-expand
8913
8914GCC uses a garbage collector to manage its own memory allocation.  This
8915parameter specifies the minimum percentage by which the garbage
8916collector's heap should be allowed to expand between collections.
8917Tuning this may improve compilation speed; it has no effect on code
8918generation.
8919
8920The default is 30% + 70% * (RAM/1GB) with an upper bound of 100% when
8921RAM >= 1GB@.  If @code{getrlimit} is available, the notion of "RAM" is
8922the smallest of actual RAM and @code{RLIMIT_DATA} or @code{RLIMIT_AS}.  If
8923GCC is not able to calculate RAM on a particular platform, the lower
8924bound of 30% is used.  Setting this parameter and
8925@option{ggc-min-heapsize} to zero causes a full collection to occur at
8926every opportunity.  This is extremely slow, but can be useful for
8927debugging.
8928
8929@item ggc-min-heapsize
8930
8931Minimum size of the garbage collector's heap before it begins bothering
8932to collect garbage.  The first collection occurs after the heap expands
8933by @option{ggc-min-expand}% beyond @option{ggc-min-heapsize}.  Again,
8934tuning this may improve compilation speed, and has no effect on code
8935generation.
8936
8937The default is the smaller of RAM/8, RLIMIT_RSS, or a limit that
8938tries to ensure that RLIMIT_DATA or RLIMIT_AS are not exceeded, but
8939with a lower bound of 4096 (four megabytes) and an upper bound of
8940131072 (128 megabytes).  If GCC is not able to calculate RAM on a
8941particular platform, the lower bound is used.  Setting this parameter
8942very large effectively disables garbage collection.  Setting this
8943parameter and @option{ggc-min-expand} to zero causes a full collection
8944to occur at every opportunity.
8945
8946@item max-reload-search-insns
8947The maximum number of instruction reload should look backward for equivalent
8948register.  Increasing values mean more aggressive optimization, making the
8949compilation time increase with probably slightly better performance.
8950The default value is 100.
8951
8952@item max-cselib-memory-locations
8953The maximum number of memory locations cselib should take into account.
8954Increasing values mean more aggressive optimization, making the compilation time
8955increase with probably slightly better performance.  The default value is 500.
8956
8957@item reorder-blocks-duplicate
8958@itemx reorder-blocks-duplicate-feedback
8959
8960Used by basic block reordering pass to decide whether to use unconditional
8961branch or duplicate the code on its destination.  Code is duplicated when its
8962estimated size is smaller than this value multiplied by the estimated size of
8963unconditional jump in the hot spots of the program.
8964
8965The @option{reorder-block-duplicate-feedback} is used only when profile
8966feedback is available and may be set to higher values than
8967@option{reorder-block-duplicate} since information about the hot spots is more
8968accurate.
8969
8970@item max-sched-ready-insns
8971The maximum number of instructions ready to be issued the scheduler should
8972consider at any given time during the first scheduling pass.  Increasing
8973values mean more thorough searches, making the compilation time increase
8974with probably little benefit.  The default value is 100.
8975
8976@item max-sched-region-blocks
8977The maximum number of blocks in a region to be considered for
8978interblock scheduling.  The default value is 10.
8979
8980@item max-pipeline-region-blocks
8981The maximum number of blocks in a region to be considered for
8982pipelining in the selective scheduler.  The default value is 15.
8983
8984@item max-sched-region-insns
8985The maximum number of insns in a region to be considered for
8986interblock scheduling.  The default value is 100.
8987
8988@item max-pipeline-region-insns
8989The maximum number of insns in a region to be considered for
8990pipelining in the selective scheduler.  The default value is 200.
8991
8992@item min-spec-prob
8993The minimum probability (in percents) of reaching a source block
8994for interblock speculative scheduling.  The default value is 40.
8995
8996@item max-sched-extend-regions-iters
8997The maximum number of iterations through CFG to extend regions.
89980 - disable region extension,
8999N - do at most N iterations.
9000The default value is 0.
9001
9002@item max-sched-insn-conflict-delay
9003The maximum conflict delay for an insn to be considered for speculative motion.
9004The default value is 3.
9005
9006@item sched-spec-prob-cutoff
9007The minimal probability of speculation success (in percents), so that
9008speculative insn will be scheduled.
9009The default value is 40.
9010
9011@item sched-mem-true-dep-cost
9012Minimal distance (in CPU cycles) between store and load targeting same
9013memory locations.  The default value is 1.
9014
9015@item selsched-max-lookahead
9016The maximum size of the lookahead window of selective scheduling.  It is a
9017depth of search for available instructions.
9018The default value is 50.
9019
9020@item selsched-max-sched-times
9021The maximum number of times that an instruction will be scheduled during
9022selective scheduling.  This is the limit on the number of iterations
9023through which the instruction may be pipelined.  The default value is 2.
9024
9025@item selsched-max-insns-to-rename
9026The maximum number of best instructions in the ready list that are considered
9027for renaming in the selective scheduler.  The default value is 2.
9028
9029@item sms-min-sc
9030The minimum value of stage count that swing modulo scheduler will
9031generate.  The default value is 2.
9032
9033@item max-last-value-rtl
9034The maximum size measured as number of RTLs that can be recorded in an expression
9035in combiner for a pseudo register as last known value of that register.  The default
9036is 10000.
9037
9038@item integer-share-limit
9039Small integer constants can use a shared data structure, reducing the
9040compiler's memory usage and increasing its speed.  This sets the maximum
9041value of a shared integer constant.  The default value is 256.
9042
9043@item min-virtual-mappings
9044Specifies the minimum number of virtual mappings in the incremental
9045SSA updater that should be registered to trigger the virtual mappings
9046heuristic defined by virtual-mappings-ratio.  The default value is
9047100.
9048
9049@item virtual-mappings-ratio
9050If the number of virtual mappings is virtual-mappings-ratio bigger
9051than the number of virtual symbols to be updated, then the incremental
9052SSA updater switches to a full update for those symbols.  The default
9053ratio is 3.
9054
9055@item ssp-buffer-size
9056The minimum size of buffers (i.e.@: arrays) that will receive stack smashing
9057protection when @option{-fstack-protection} is used.
9058
9059@item max-jump-thread-duplication-stmts
9060Maximum number of statements allowed in a block that needs to be
9061duplicated when threading jumps.
9062
9063@item max-fields-for-field-sensitive
9064Maximum number of fields in a structure we will treat in
9065a field sensitive manner during pointer analysis.  The default is zero
9066for -O0, and -O1 and 100 for -Os, -O2, and -O3.
9067
9068@item prefetch-latency
9069Estimate on average number of instructions that are executed before
9070prefetch finishes.  The distance we prefetch ahead is proportional
9071to this constant.  Increasing this number may also lead to less
9072streams being prefetched (see @option{simultaneous-prefetches}).
9073
9074@item simultaneous-prefetches
9075Maximum number of prefetches that can run at the same time.
9076
9077@item l1-cache-line-size
9078The size of cache line in L1 cache, in bytes.
9079
9080@item l1-cache-size
9081The size of L1 cache, in kilobytes.
9082
9083@item l2-cache-size
9084The size of L2 cache, in kilobytes.
9085
9086@item min-insn-to-prefetch-ratio
9087The minimum ratio between the number of instructions and the
9088number of prefetches to enable prefetching in a loop.
9089
9090@item prefetch-min-insn-to-mem-ratio
9091The minimum ratio between the number of instructions and the
9092number of memory references to enable prefetching in a loop.
9093
9094@item use-canonical-types
9095Whether the compiler should use the ``canonical'' type system.  By
9096default, this should always be 1, which uses a more efficient internal
9097mechanism for comparing types in C++ and Objective-C++.  However, if
9098bugs in the canonical type system are causing compilation failures,
9099set this value to 0 to disable canonical types.
9100
9101@item switch-conversion-max-branch-ratio
9102Switch initialization conversion will refuse to create arrays that are
9103bigger than @option{switch-conversion-max-branch-ratio} times the number of
9104branches in the switch.
9105
9106@item max-partial-antic-length
9107Maximum length of the partial antic set computed during the tree
9108partial redundancy elimination optimization (@option{-ftree-pre}) when
9109optimizing at @option{-O3} and above.  For some sorts of source code
9110the enhanced partial redundancy elimination optimization can run away,
9111consuming all of the memory available on the host machine.  This
9112parameter sets a limit on the length of the sets that are computed,
9113which prevents the runaway behavior.  Setting a value of 0 for
9114this parameter will allow an unlimited set length.
9115
9116@item sccvn-max-scc-size
9117Maximum size of a strongly connected component (SCC) during SCCVN
9118processing.  If this limit is hit, SCCVN processing for the whole
9119function will not be done and optimizations depending on it will
9120be disabled.  The default maximum SCC size is 10000.
9121
9122@item ira-max-loops-num
9123IRA uses regional register allocation by default.  If a function
9124contains more loops than the number given by this parameter, only at most
9125the given number of the most frequently-executed loops form regions
9126for regional register allocation.  The default value of the
9127parameter is 100.
9128
9129@item ira-max-conflict-table-size
9130Although IRA uses a sophisticated algorithm to compress the conflict
9131table, the table can still require excessive amounts of memory for
9132huge functions.  If the conflict table for a function could be more
9133than the size in MB given by this parameter, the register allocator
9134instead uses a faster, simpler, and lower-quality
9135algorithm that does not require building a pseudo-register conflict table.
9136The default value of the parameter is 2000.
9137
9138@item ira-loop-reserved-regs
9139IRA can be used to evaluate more accurate register pressure in loops
9140for decisions to move loop invariants (see @option{-O3}).  The number
9141of available registers reserved for some other purposes is given
9142by this parameter.  The default value of the parameter is 2, which is
9143the minimal number of registers needed by typical instructions.
9144This value is the best found from numerous experiments.
9145
9146@item loop-invariant-max-bbs-in-loop
9147Loop invariant motion can be very expensive, both in compilation time and
9148in amount of needed compile-time memory, with very large loops.  Loops
9149with more basic blocks than this parameter won't have loop invariant
9150motion optimization performed on them.  The default value of the
9151parameter is 1000 for -O1 and 10000 for -O2 and above.
9152
9153@item loop-max-datarefs-for-datadeps
9154Building data dapendencies is expensive for very large loops.  This
9155parameter limits the number of data references in loops that are
9156considered for data dependence analysis.  These large loops will not
9157be handled then by the optimizations using loop data dependencies.
9158The default value is 1000.
9159
9160@item max-vartrack-size
9161Sets a maximum number of hash table slots to use during variable
9162tracking dataflow analysis of any function.  If this limit is exceeded
9163with variable tracking at assignments enabled, analysis for that
9164function is retried without it, after removing all debug insns from
9165the function.  If the limit is exceeded even without debug insns, var
9166tracking analysis is completely disabled for the function.  Setting
9167the parameter to zero makes it unlimited.
9168
9169@item max-vartrack-expr-depth
9170Sets a maximum number of recursion levels when attempting to map
9171variable names or debug temporaries to value expressions.  This trades
9172compilation time for more complete debug information.  If this is set too
9173low, value expressions that are available and could be represented in
9174debug information may end up not being used; setting this higher may
9175enable the compiler to find more complex debug expressions, but compile
9176time and memory use may grow.  The default is 12.
9177
9178@item min-nondebug-insn-uid
9179Use uids starting at this parameter for nondebug insns.  The range below
9180the parameter is reserved exclusively for debug insns created by
9181@option{-fvar-tracking-assignments}, but debug insns may get
9182(non-overlapping) uids above it if the reserved range is exhausted.
9183
9184@item ipa-sra-ptr-growth-factor
9185IPA-SRA will replace a pointer to an aggregate with one or more new
9186parameters only when their cumulative size is less or equal to
9187@option{ipa-sra-ptr-growth-factor} times the size of the original
9188pointer parameter.
9189
9190@item tm-max-aggregate-size
9191When making copies of thread-local variables in a transaction, this
9192parameter specifies the size in bytes after which variables will be
9193saved with the logging functions as opposed to save/restore code
9194sequence pairs.  This option only applies when using
9195@option{-fgnu-tm}.
9196
9197@item graphite-max-nb-scop-params
9198To avoid exponential effects in the Graphite loop transforms, the
9199number of parameters in a Static Control Part (SCoP) is bounded.  The
9200default value is 10 parameters.  A variable whose value is unknown at
9201compilation time and defined outside a SCoP is a parameter of the SCoP.
9202
9203@item graphite-max-bbs-per-function
9204To avoid exponential effects in the detection of SCoPs, the size of
9205the functions analyzed by Graphite is bounded.  The default value is
9206100 basic blocks.
9207
9208@item loop-block-tile-size
9209Loop blocking or strip mining transforms, enabled with
9210@option{-floop-block} or @option{-floop-strip-mine}, strip mine each
9211loop in the loop nest by a given number of iterations.  The strip
9212length can be changed using the @option{loop-block-tile-size}
9213parameter.  The default value is 51 iterations.
9214
9215@item ipa-cp-value-list-size
9216IPA-CP attempts to track all possible values and types passed to a function's
9217parameter in order to propagate them and perform devirtualization.
9218@option{ipa-cp-value-list-size} is the maximum number of values and types it
9219stores per one formal parameter of a function.
9220
9221@item lto-partitions
9222Specify desired number of partitions produced during WHOPR compilation.
9223The number of partitions should exceed the number of CPUs used for compilation.
9224The default value is 32.
9225
9226@item lto-minpartition
9227Size of minimal partition for WHOPR (in estimated instructions).
9228This prevents expenses of splitting very small programs into too many
9229partitions.
9230
9231@item cxx-max-namespaces-for-diagnostic-help
9232The maximum number of namespaces to consult for suggestions when C++
9233name lookup fails for an identifier.  The default is 1000.
9234
9235@item sink-frequency-threshold
9236The maximum relative execution frequency (in percents) of the target block
9237relative to a statement's original block to allow statement sinking of a
9238statement.  Larger numbers result in more aggressive statement sinking.
9239The default value is 75.  A small positive adjustment is applied for
9240statements with memory operands as those are even more profitable so sink.
9241
9242@item max-stores-to-sink
9243The maximum number of conditional stores paires that can be sunk.  Set to 0
9244if either vectorization (@option{-ftree-vectorize}) or if-conversion
9245(@option{-ftree-loop-if-convert}) is disabled.  The default is 2.
9246
9247@item allow-load-data-races
9248Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on loads.
9249Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0.  This option is enabled by default
9250unless implicitly set by the @option{-fmemory-model=} option.
9251
9252@item allow-store-data-races
9253Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on stores.
9254Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0.  This option is enabled by default
9255unless implicitly set by the @option{-fmemory-model=} option.
9256
9257@item allow-packed-load-data-races
9258Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on packed data loads.
9259Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0.  This option is enabled by default
9260unless implicitly set by the @option{-fmemory-model=} option.
9261
9262@item allow-packed-store-data-races
9263Allow optimizers to introduce new data races on packed data stores.
9264Set to 1 to allow, otherwise to 0.  This option is enabled by default
9265unless implicitly set by the @option{-fmemory-model=} option.
9266
9267@item case-values-threshold
9268The smallest number of different values for which it is best to use a
9269jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.  If the value is
92700, use the default for the machine.  The default is 0.
9271
9272@item tree-reassoc-width
9273Set the maximum number of instructions executed in parallel in
9274reassociated tree. This parameter overrides target dependent
9275heuristics used by default if has non zero value.
9276
9277@end table
9278@end table
9279
9280@node Preprocessor Options
9281@section Options Controlling the Preprocessor
9282@cindex preprocessor options
9283@cindex options, preprocessor
9284
9285These options control the C preprocessor, which is run on each C source
9286file before actual compilation.
9287
9288If you use the @option{-E} option, nothing is done except preprocessing.
9289Some of these options make sense only together with @option{-E} because
9290they cause the preprocessor output to be unsuitable for actual
9291compilation.
9292
9293@table @gcctabopt
9294@item -Wp,@var{option}
9295@opindex Wp
9296You can use @option{-Wp,@var{option}} to bypass the compiler driver
9297and pass @var{option} directly through to the preprocessor.  If
9298@var{option} contains commas, it is split into multiple options at the
9299commas.  However, many options are modified, translated or interpreted
9300by the compiler driver before being passed to the preprocessor, and
9301@option{-Wp} forcibly bypasses this phase.  The preprocessor's direct
9302interface is undocumented and subject to change, so whenever possible
9303you should avoid using @option{-Wp} and let the driver handle the
9304options instead.
9305
9306@item -Xpreprocessor @var{option}
9307@opindex Xpreprocessor
9308Pass @var{option} as an option to the preprocessor.  You can use this to
9309supply system-specific preprocessor options that GCC does not know how to
9310recognize.
9311
9312If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use
9313@option{-Xpreprocessor} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
9314@end table
9315
9316@include cppopts.texi
9317
9318@node Assembler Options
9319@section Passing Options to the Assembler
9320
9321@c prevent bad page break with this line
9322You can pass options to the assembler.
9323
9324@table @gcctabopt
9325@item -Wa,@var{option}
9326@opindex Wa
9327Pass @var{option} as an option to the assembler.  If @var{option}
9328contains commas, it is split into multiple options at the commas.
9329
9330@item -Xassembler @var{option}
9331@opindex Xassembler
9332Pass @var{option} as an option to the assembler.  You can use this to
9333supply system-specific assembler options that GCC does not know how to
9334recognize.
9335
9336If you want to pass an option that takes an argument, you must use
9337@option{-Xassembler} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
9338
9339@end table
9340
9341@node Link Options
9342@section Options for Linking
9343@cindex link options
9344@cindex options, linking
9345
9346These options come into play when the compiler links object files into
9347an executable output file.  They are meaningless if the compiler is
9348not doing a link step.
9349
9350@table @gcctabopt
9351@cindex file names
9352@item @var{object-file-name}
9353A file name that does not end in a special recognized suffix is
9354considered to name an object file or library.  (Object files are
9355distinguished from libraries by the linker according to the file
9356contents.)  If linking is done, these object files are used as input
9357to the linker.
9358
9359@item -c
9360@itemx -S
9361@itemx -E
9362@opindex c
9363@opindex S
9364@opindex E
9365If any of these options is used, then the linker is not run, and
9366object file names should not be used as arguments.  @xref{Overall
9367Options}.
9368
9369@cindex Libraries
9370@item -l@var{library}
9371@itemx -l @var{library}
9372@opindex l
9373Search the library named @var{library} when linking.  (The second
9374alternative with the library as a separate argument is only for
9375POSIX compliance and is not recommended.)
9376
9377It makes a difference where in the command you write this option; the
9378linker searches and processes libraries and object files in the order they
9379are specified.  Thus, @samp{foo.o -lz bar.o} searches library @samp{z}
9380after file @file{foo.o} but before @file{bar.o}.  If @file{bar.o} refers
9381to functions in @samp{z}, those functions may not be loaded.
9382
9383The linker searches a standard list of directories for the library,
9384which is actually a file named @file{lib@var{library}.a}.  The linker
9385then uses this file as if it had been specified precisely by name.
9386
9387The directories searched include several standard system directories
9388plus any that you specify with @option{-L}.
9389
9390Normally the files found this way are library files---archive files
9391whose members are object files.  The linker handles an archive file by
9392scanning through it for members which define symbols that have so far
9393been referenced but not defined.  But if the file that is found is an
9394ordinary object file, it is linked in the usual fashion.  The only
9395difference between using an @option{-l} option and specifying a file name
9396is that @option{-l} surrounds @var{library} with @samp{lib} and @samp{.a}
9397and searches several directories.
9398
9399@item -lobjc
9400@opindex lobjc
9401You need this special case of the @option{-l} option in order to
9402link an Objective-C or Objective-C++ program.
9403
9404@item -nostartfiles
9405@opindex nostartfiles
9406Do not use the standard system startup files when linking.
9407The standard system libraries are used normally, unless @option{-nostdlib}
9408or @option{-nodefaultlibs} is used.
9409
9410@item -nodefaultlibs
9411@opindex nodefaultlibs
9412Do not use the standard system libraries when linking.
9413Only the libraries you specify will be passed to the linker, options
9414specifying linkage of the system libraries, such as @code{-static-libgcc}
9415or @code{-shared-libgcc}, will be ignored.
9416The standard startup files are used normally, unless @option{-nostartfiles}
9417is used.  The compiler may generate calls to @code{memcmp},
9418@code{memset}, @code{memcpy} and @code{memmove}.
9419These entries are usually resolved by entries in
9420libc.  These entry points should be supplied through some other
9421mechanism when this option is specified.
9422
9423@item -nostdlib
9424@opindex nostdlib
9425Do not use the standard system startup files or libraries when linking.
9426No startup files and only the libraries you specify will be passed to
9427the linker, options specifying linkage of the system libraries, such as
9428@code{-static-libgcc} or @code{-shared-libgcc}, will be ignored.
9429The compiler may generate calls to @code{memcmp}, @code{memset},
9430@code{memcpy} and @code{memmove}.
9431These entries are usually resolved by entries in
9432libc.  These entry points should be supplied through some other
9433mechanism when this option is specified.
9434
9435@cindex @option{-lgcc}, use with @option{-nostdlib}
9436@cindex @option{-nostdlib} and unresolved references
9437@cindex unresolved references and @option{-nostdlib}
9438@cindex @option{-lgcc}, use with @option{-nodefaultlibs}
9439@cindex @option{-nodefaultlibs} and unresolved references
9440@cindex unresolved references and @option{-nodefaultlibs}
9441One of the standard libraries bypassed by @option{-nostdlib} and
9442@option{-nodefaultlibs} is @file{libgcc.a}, a library of internal subroutines
9443which GCC uses to overcome shortcomings of particular machines, or special
9444needs for some languages.
9445(@xref{Interface,,Interfacing to GCC Output,gccint,GNU Compiler
9446Collection (GCC) Internals},
9447for more discussion of @file{libgcc.a}.)
9448In most cases, you need @file{libgcc.a} even when you want to avoid
9449other standard libraries.  In other words, when you specify @option{-nostdlib}
9450or @option{-nodefaultlibs} you should usually specify @option{-lgcc} as well.
9451This ensures that you have no unresolved references to internal GCC
9452library subroutines.  (For example, @samp{__main}, used to ensure C++
9453constructors will be called; @pxref{Collect2,,@code{collect2}, gccint,
9454GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.)
9455
9456@item -pie
9457@opindex pie
9458Produce a position independent executable on targets that support it.
9459For predictable results, you must also specify the same set of options
9460that were used to generate code (@option{-fpie}, @option{-fPIE},
9461or model suboptions) when you specify this option.
9462
9463@item -rdynamic
9464@opindex rdynamic
9465Pass the flag @option{-export-dynamic} to the ELF linker, on targets
9466that support it. This instructs the linker to add all symbols, not
9467only used ones, to the dynamic symbol table. This option is needed
9468for some uses of @code{dlopen} or to allow obtaining backtraces
9469from within a program.
9470
9471@item -s
9472@opindex s
9473Remove all symbol table and relocation information from the executable.
9474
9475@item -static
9476@opindex static
9477On systems that support dynamic linking, this prevents linking with the shared
9478libraries.  On other systems, this option has no effect.
9479
9480@item -shared
9481@opindex shared
9482Produce a shared object which can then be linked with other objects to
9483form an executable.  Not all systems support this option.  For predictable
9484results, you must also specify the same set of options that were used to
9485generate code (@option{-fpic}, @option{-fPIC}, or model suboptions)
9486when you specify this option.@footnote{On some systems, @samp{gcc -shared}
9487needs to build supplementary stub code for constructors to work.  On
9488multi-libbed systems, @samp{gcc -shared} must select the correct support
9489libraries to link against.  Failing to supply the correct flags may lead
9490to subtle defects.  Supplying them in cases where they are not necessary
9491is innocuous.}
9492
9493@item -shared-libgcc
9494@itemx -static-libgcc
9495@opindex shared-libgcc
9496@opindex static-libgcc
9497On systems that provide @file{libgcc} as a shared library, these options
9498force the use of either the shared or static version respectively.
9499If no shared version of @file{libgcc} was built when the compiler was
9500configured, these options have no effect.
9501
9502There are several situations in which an application should use the
9503shared @file{libgcc} instead of the static version.  The most common
9504of these is when the application wishes to throw and catch exceptions
9505across different shared libraries.  In that case, each of the libraries
9506as well as the application itself should use the shared @file{libgcc}.
9507
9508Therefore, the G++ and GCJ drivers automatically add
9509@option{-shared-libgcc} whenever you build a shared library or a main
9510executable, because C++ and Java programs typically use exceptions, so
9511this is the right thing to do.
9512
9513If, instead, you use the GCC driver to create shared libraries, you may
9514find that they will not always be linked with the shared @file{libgcc}.
9515If GCC finds, at its configuration time, that you have a non-GNU linker
9516or a GNU linker that does not support option @option{--eh-frame-hdr},
9517it will link the shared version of @file{libgcc} into shared libraries
9518by default.  Otherwise, it will take advantage of the linker and optimize
9519away the linking with the shared version of @file{libgcc}, linking with
9520the static version of libgcc by default.  This allows exceptions to
9521propagate through such shared libraries, without incurring relocation
9522costs at library load time.
9523
9524However, if a library or main executable is supposed to throw or catch
9525exceptions, you must link it using the G++ or GCJ driver, as appropriate
9526for the languages used in the program, or using the option
9527@option{-shared-libgcc}, such that it is linked with the shared
9528@file{libgcc}.
9529
9530@item -static-libstdc++
9531When the @command{g++} program is used to link a C++ program, it will
9532normally automatically link against @option{libstdc++}.  If
9533@file{libstdc++} is available as a shared library, and the
9534@option{-static} option is not used, then this will link against the
9535shared version of @file{libstdc++}.  That is normally fine.  However, it
9536is sometimes useful to freeze the version of @file{libstdc++} used by
9537the program without going all the way to a fully static link.  The
9538@option{-static-libstdc++} option directs the @command{g++} driver to
9539link @file{libstdc++} statically, without necessarily linking other
9540libraries statically.
9541
9542@item -symbolic
9543@opindex symbolic
9544Bind references to global symbols when building a shared object.  Warn
9545about any unresolved references (unless overridden by the link editor
9546option @samp{-Xlinker -z -Xlinker defs}).  Only a few systems support
9547this option.
9548
9549@item -T @var{script}
9550@opindex T
9551@cindex linker script
9552Use @var{script} as the linker script.  This option is supported by most
9553systems using the GNU linker.  On some targets, such as bare-board
9554targets without an operating system, the @option{-T} option may be required
9555when linking to avoid references to undefined symbols.
9556
9557@item -Xlinker @var{option}
9558@opindex Xlinker
9559Pass @var{option} as an option to the linker.  You can use this to
9560supply system-specific linker options that GCC does not recognize.
9561
9562If you want to pass an option that takes a separate argument, you must use
9563@option{-Xlinker} twice, once for the option and once for the argument.
9564For example, to pass @option{-assert definitions}, you must write
9565@samp{-Xlinker -assert -Xlinker definitions}.  It does not work to write
9566@option{-Xlinker "-assert definitions"}, because this passes the entire
9567string as a single argument, which is not what the linker expects.
9568
9569When using the GNU linker, it is usually more convenient to pass
9570arguments to linker options using the @option{@var{option}=@var{value}}
9571syntax than as separate arguments.  For example, you can specify
9572@samp{-Xlinker -Map=output.map} rather than
9573@samp{-Xlinker -Map -Xlinker output.map}.  Other linkers may not support
9574this syntax for command-line options.
9575
9576@item -Wl,@var{option}
9577@opindex Wl
9578Pass @var{option} as an option to the linker.  If @var{option} contains
9579commas, it is split into multiple options at the commas.  You can use this
9580syntax to pass an argument to the option.
9581For example, @samp{-Wl,-Map,output.map} passes @samp{-Map output.map} to the
9582linker.  When using the GNU linker, you can also get the same effect with
9583@samp{-Wl,-Map=output.map}.
9584
9585@item -u @var{symbol}
9586@opindex u
9587Pretend the symbol @var{symbol} is undefined, to force linking of
9588library modules to define it.  You can use @option{-u} multiple times with
9589different symbols to force loading of additional library modules.
9590@end table
9591
9592@node Directory Options
9593@section Options for Directory Search
9594@cindex directory options
9595@cindex options, directory search
9596@cindex search path
9597
9598These options specify directories to search for header files, for
9599libraries and for parts of the compiler:
9600
9601@table @gcctabopt
9602@item -I@var{dir}
9603@opindex I
9604Add the directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of directories to be
9605searched for header files.  This can be used to override a system header
9606file, substituting your own version, since these directories are
9607searched before the system header file directories.  However, you should
9608not use this option to add directories that contain vendor-supplied
9609system header files (use @option{-isystem} for that).  If you use more than
9610one @option{-I} option, the directories are scanned in left-to-right
9611order; the standard system directories come after.
9612
9613If a standard system include directory, or a directory specified with
9614@option{-isystem}, is also specified with @option{-I}, the @option{-I}
9615option will be ignored.  The directory will still be searched but as a
9616system directory at its normal position in the system include chain.
9617This is to ensure that GCC's procedure to fix buggy system headers and
9618the ordering for the include_next directive are not inadvertently changed.
9619If you really need to change the search order for system directories,
9620use the @option{-nostdinc} and/or @option{-isystem} options.
9621
9622@item -iplugindir=@var{dir}
9623Set the directory to search for plugins that are passed
9624by @option{-fplugin=@var{name}} instead of
9625@option{-fplugin=@var{path}/@var{name}.so}.  This option is not meant
9626to be used by the user, but only passed by the driver.
9627
9628@item -iquote@var{dir}
9629@opindex iquote
9630Add the directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of directories to
9631be searched for header files only for the case of @samp{#include
9632"@var{file}"}; they are not searched for @samp{#include <@var{file}>},
9633otherwise just like @option{-I}.
9634
9635@item -L@var{dir}
9636@opindex L
9637Add directory @var{dir} to the list of directories to be searched
9638for @option{-l}.
9639
9640@item -B@var{prefix}
9641@opindex B
9642This option specifies where to find the executables, libraries,
9643include files, and data files of the compiler itself.
9644
9645The compiler driver program runs one or more of the subprograms
9646@file{cpp}, @file{cc1}, @file{as} and @file{ld}.  It tries
9647@var{prefix} as a prefix for each program it tries to run, both with and
9648without @samp{@var{machine}/@var{version}/} (@pxref{Target Options}).
9649
9650For each subprogram to be run, the compiler driver first tries the
9651@option{-B} prefix, if any.  If that name is not found, or if @option{-B}
9652was not specified, the driver tries two standard prefixes,
9653@file{/usr/lib/gcc/} and @file{/usr/local/lib/gcc/}.  If neither of
9654those results in a file name that is found, the unmodified program
9655name is searched for using the directories specified in your
9656@env{PATH} environment variable.
9657
9658The compiler will check to see if the path provided by the @option{-B}
9659refers to a directory, and if necessary it will add a directory
9660separator character at the end of the path.
9661
9662@option{-B} prefixes that effectively specify directory names also apply
9663to libraries in the linker, because the compiler translates these
9664options into @option{-L} options for the linker.  They also apply to
9665includes files in the preprocessor, because the compiler translates these
9666options into @option{-isystem} options for the preprocessor.  In this case,
9667the compiler appends @samp{include} to the prefix.
9668
9669The runtime support file @file{libgcc.a} can also be searched for using
9670the @option{-B} prefix, if needed.  If it is not found there, the two
9671standard prefixes above are tried, and that is all.  The file is left
9672out of the link if it is not found by those means.
9673
9674Another way to specify a prefix much like the @option{-B} prefix is to use
9675the environment variable @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.  @xref{Environment
9676Variables}.
9677
9678As a special kludge, if the path provided by @option{-B} is
9679@file{[dir/]stage@var{N}/}, where @var{N} is a number in the range 0 to
96809, then it will be replaced by @file{[dir/]include}.  This is to help
9681with boot-strapping the compiler.
9682
9683@item -specs=@var{file}
9684@opindex specs
9685Process @var{file} after the compiler reads in the standard @file{specs}
9686file, in order to override the defaults which the @file{gcc} driver
9687program uses when determining what switches to pass to @file{cc1},
9688@file{cc1plus}, @file{as}, @file{ld}, etc.  More than one
9689@option{-specs=@var{file}} can be specified on the command line, and they
9690are processed in order, from left to right.
9691
9692@item --sysroot=@var{dir}
9693@opindex sysroot
9694Use @var{dir} as the logical root directory for headers and libraries.
9695For example, if the compiler would normally search for headers in
9696@file{/usr/include} and libraries in @file{/usr/lib}, it will instead
9697search @file{@var{dir}/usr/include} and @file{@var{dir}/usr/lib}.
9698
9699If you use both this option and the @option{-isysroot} option, then
9700the @option{--sysroot} option will apply to libraries, but the
9701@option{-isysroot} option will apply to header files.
9702
9703The GNU linker (beginning with version 2.16) has the necessary support
9704for this option.  If your linker does not support this option, the
9705header file aspect of @option{--sysroot} will still work, but the
9706library aspect will not.
9707
9708@item -I-
9709@opindex I-
9710This option has been deprecated.  Please use @option{-iquote} instead for
9711@option{-I} directories before the @option{-I-} and remove the @option{-I-}.
9712Any directories you specify with @option{-I} options before the @option{-I-}
9713option are searched only for the case of @samp{#include "@var{file}"};
9714they are not searched for @samp{#include <@var{file}>}.
9715
9716If additional directories are specified with @option{-I} options after
9717the @option{-I-}, these directories are searched for all @samp{#include}
9718directives.  (Ordinarily @emph{all} @option{-I} directories are used
9719this way.)
9720
9721In addition, the @option{-I-} option inhibits the use of the current
9722directory (where the current input file came from) as the first search
9723directory for @samp{#include "@var{file}"}.  There is no way to
9724override this effect of @option{-I-}.  With @option{-I.} you can specify
9725searching the directory that was current when the compiler was
9726invoked.  That is not exactly the same as what the preprocessor does
9727by default, but it is often satisfactory.
9728
9729@option{-I-} does not inhibit the use of the standard system directories
9730for header files.  Thus, @option{-I-} and @option{-nostdinc} are
9731independent.
9732@end table
9733
9734@c man end
9735
9736@node Spec Files
9737@section Specifying subprocesses and the switches to pass to them
9738@cindex Spec Files
9739
9740@command{gcc} is a driver program.  It performs its job by invoking a
9741sequence of other programs to do the work of compiling, assembling and
9742linking.  GCC interprets its command-line parameters and uses these to
9743deduce which programs it should invoke, and which command-line options
9744it ought to place on their command lines.  This behavior is controlled
9745by @dfn{spec strings}.  In most cases there is one spec string for each
9746program that GCC can invoke, but a few programs have multiple spec
9747strings to control their behavior.  The spec strings built into GCC can
9748be overridden by using the @option{-specs=} command-line switch to specify
9749a spec file.
9750
9751@dfn{Spec files} are plaintext files that are used to construct spec
9752strings.  They consist of a sequence of directives separated by blank
9753lines.  The type of directive is determined by the first non-whitespace
9754character on the line, which can be one of the following:
9755
9756@table @code
9757@item %@var{command}
9758Issues a @var{command} to the spec file processor.  The commands that can
9759appear here are:
9760
9761@table @code
9762@item %include <@var{file}>
9763@cindex @code{%include}
9764Search for @var{file} and insert its text at the current point in the
9765specs file.
9766
9767@item %include_noerr <@var{file}>
9768@cindex @code{%include_noerr}
9769Just like @samp{%include}, but do not generate an error message if the include
9770file cannot be found.
9771
9772@item %rename @var{old_name} @var{new_name}
9773@cindex @code{%rename}
9774Rename the spec string @var{old_name} to @var{new_name}.
9775
9776@end table
9777
9778@item *[@var{spec_name}]:
9779This tells the compiler to create, override or delete the named spec
9780string.  All lines after this directive up to the next directive or
9781blank line are considered to be the text for the spec string.  If this
9782results in an empty string then the spec will be deleted.  (Or, if the
9783spec did not exist, then nothing will happen.)  Otherwise, if the spec
9784does not currently exist a new spec will be created.  If the spec does
9785exist then its contents will be overridden by the text of this
9786directive, unless the first character of that text is the @samp{+}
9787character, in which case the text will be appended to the spec.
9788
9789@item [@var{suffix}]:
9790Creates a new @samp{[@var{suffix}] spec} pair.  All lines after this directive
9791and up to the next directive or blank line are considered to make up the
9792spec string for the indicated suffix.  When the compiler encounters an
9793input file with the named suffix, it will processes the spec string in
9794order to work out how to compile that file.  For example:
9795
9796@smallexample
9797.ZZ:
9798z-compile -input %i
9799@end smallexample
9800
9801This says that any input file whose name ends in @samp{.ZZ} should be
9802passed to the program @samp{z-compile}, which should be invoked with the
9803command-line switch @option{-input} and with the result of performing the
9804@samp{%i} substitution.  (See below.)
9805
9806As an alternative to providing a spec string, the text that follows a
9807suffix directive can be one of the following:
9808
9809@table @code
9810@item @@@var{language}
9811This says that the suffix is an alias for a known @var{language}.  This is
9812similar to using the @option{-x} command-line switch to GCC to specify a
9813language explicitly.  For example:
9814
9815@smallexample
9816.ZZ:
9817@@c++
9818@end smallexample
9819
9820Says that .ZZ files are, in fact, C++ source files.
9821
9822@item #@var{name}
9823This causes an error messages saying:
9824
9825@smallexample
9826@var{name} compiler not installed on this system.
9827@end smallexample
9828@end table
9829
9830GCC already has an extensive list of suffixes built into it.
9831This directive will add an entry to the end of the list of suffixes, but
9832since the list is searched from the end backwards, it is effectively
9833possible to override earlier entries using this technique.
9834
9835@end table
9836
9837GCC has the following spec strings built into it.  Spec files can
9838override these strings or create their own.  Note that individual
9839targets can also add their own spec strings to this list.
9840
9841@smallexample
9842asm          Options to pass to the assembler
9843asm_final    Options to pass to the assembler post-processor
9844cpp          Options to pass to the C preprocessor
9845cc1          Options to pass to the C compiler
9846cc1plus      Options to pass to the C++ compiler
9847endfile      Object files to include at the end of the link
9848link         Options to pass to the linker
9849lib          Libraries to include on the command line to the linker
9850libgcc       Decides which GCC support library to pass to the linker
9851linker       Sets the name of the linker
9852predefines   Defines to be passed to the C preprocessor
9853signed_char  Defines to pass to CPP to say whether @code{char} is signed
9854             by default
9855startfile    Object files to include at the start of the link
9856@end smallexample
9857
9858Here is a small example of a spec file:
9859
9860@smallexample
9861%rename lib                 old_lib
9862
9863*lib:
9864--start-group -lgcc -lc -leval1 --end-group %(old_lib)
9865@end smallexample
9866
9867This example renames the spec called @samp{lib} to @samp{old_lib} and
9868then overrides the previous definition of @samp{lib} with a new one.
9869The new definition adds in some extra command-line options before
9870including the text of the old definition.
9871
9872@dfn{Spec strings} are a list of command-line options to be passed to their
9873corresponding program.  In addition, the spec strings can contain
9874@samp{%}-prefixed sequences to substitute variable text or to
9875conditionally insert text into the command line.  Using these constructs
9876it is possible to generate quite complex command lines.
9877
9878Here is a table of all defined @samp{%}-sequences for spec
9879strings.  Note that spaces are not generated automatically around the
9880results of expanding these sequences.  Therefore you can concatenate them
9881together or combine them with constant text in a single argument.
9882
9883@table @code
9884@item %%
9885Substitute one @samp{%} into the program name or argument.
9886
9887@item %i
9888Substitute the name of the input file being processed.
9889
9890@item %b
9891Substitute the basename of the input file being processed.
9892This is the substring up to (and not including) the last period
9893and not including the directory.
9894
9895@item %B
9896This is the same as @samp{%b}, but include the file suffix (text after
9897the last period).
9898
9899@item %d
9900Marks the argument containing or following the @samp{%d} as a
9901temporary file name, so that that file will be deleted if GCC exits
9902successfully.  Unlike @samp{%g}, this contributes no text to the
9903argument.
9904
9905@item %g@var{suffix}
9906Substitute a file name that has suffix @var{suffix} and is chosen
9907once per compilation, and mark the argument in the same way as
9908@samp{%d}.  To reduce exposure to denial-of-service attacks, the file
9909name is now chosen in a way that is hard to predict even when previously
9910chosen file names are known.  For example, @samp{%g.s @dots{} %g.o @dots{} %g.s}
9911might turn into @samp{ccUVUUAU.s ccXYAXZ12.o ccUVUUAU.s}.  @var{suffix} matches
9912the regexp @samp{[.A-Za-z]*} or the special string @samp{%O}, which is
9913treated exactly as if @samp{%O} had been preprocessed.  Previously, @samp{%g}
9914was simply substituted with a file name chosen once per compilation,
9915without regard to any appended suffix (which was therefore treated
9916just like ordinary text), making such attacks more likely to succeed.
9917
9918@item %u@var{suffix}
9919Like @samp{%g}, but generates a new temporary file name even if
9920@samp{%u@var{suffix}} was already seen.
9921
9922@item %U@var{suffix}
9923Substitutes the last file name generated with @samp{%u@var{suffix}}, generating a
9924new one if there is no such last file name.  In the absence of any
9925@samp{%u@var{suffix}}, this is just like @samp{%g@var{suffix}}, except they don't share
9926the same suffix @emph{space}, so @samp{%g.s @dots{} %U.s @dots{} %g.s @dots{} %U.s}
9927would involve the generation of two distinct file names, one
9928for each @samp{%g.s} and another for each @samp{%U.s}.  Previously, @samp{%U} was
9929simply substituted with a file name chosen for the previous @samp{%u},
9930without regard to any appended suffix.
9931
9932@item %j@var{suffix}
9933Substitutes the name of the @code{HOST_BIT_BUCKET}, if any, and if it is
9934writable, and if save-temps is off; otherwise, substitute the name
9935of a temporary file, just like @samp{%u}.  This temporary file is not
9936meant for communication between processes, but rather as a junk
9937disposal mechanism.
9938
9939@item %|@var{suffix}
9940@itemx %m@var{suffix}
9941Like @samp{%g}, except if @option{-pipe} is in effect.  In that case
9942@samp{%|} substitutes a single dash and @samp{%m} substitutes nothing at
9943all.  These are the two most common ways to instruct a program that it
9944should read from standard input or write to standard output.  If you
9945need something more elaborate you can use an @samp{%@{pipe:@code{X}@}}
9946construct: see for example @file{f/lang-specs.h}.
9947
9948@item %.@var{SUFFIX}
9949Substitutes @var{.SUFFIX} for the suffixes of a matched switch's args
9950when it is subsequently output with @samp{%*}.  @var{SUFFIX} is
9951terminated by the next space or %.
9952
9953@item %w
9954Marks the argument containing or following the @samp{%w} as the
9955designated output file of this compilation.  This puts the argument
9956into the sequence of arguments that @samp{%o} will substitute later.
9957
9958@item %o
9959Substitutes the names of all the output files, with spaces
9960automatically placed around them.  You should write spaces
9961around the @samp{%o} as well or the results are undefined.
9962@samp{%o} is for use in the specs for running the linker.
9963Input files whose names have no recognized suffix are not compiled
9964at all, but they are included among the output files, so they will
9965be linked.
9966
9967@item %O
9968Substitutes the suffix for object files.  Note that this is
9969handled specially when it immediately follows @samp{%g, %u, or %U},
9970because of the need for those to form complete file names.  The
9971handling is such that @samp{%O} is treated exactly as if it had already
9972been substituted, except that @samp{%g, %u, and %U} do not currently
9973support additional @var{suffix} characters following @samp{%O} as they would
9974following, for example, @samp{.o}.
9975
9976@item %p
9977Substitutes the standard macro predefinitions for the
9978current target machine.  Use this when running @code{cpp}.
9979
9980@item %P
9981Like @samp{%p}, but puts @samp{__} before and after the name of each
9982predefined macro, except for macros that start with @samp{__} or with
9983@samp{_@var{L}}, where @var{L} is an uppercase letter.  This is for ISO
9984C@.
9985
9986@item %I
9987Substitute any of @option{-iprefix} (made from @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}),
9988@option{-isysroot} (made from @env{TARGET_SYSTEM_ROOT}),
9989@option{-isystem} (made from @env{COMPILER_PATH} and @option{-B} options)
9990and @option{-imultilib} as necessary.
9991
9992@item %s
9993Current argument is the name of a library or startup file of some sort.
9994Search for that file in a standard list of directories and substitute
9995the full name found.  The current working directory is included in the
9996list of directories scanned.
9997
9998@item %T
9999Current argument is the name of a linker script.  Search for that file
10000in the current list of directories to scan for libraries. If the file
10001is located insert a @option{--script} option into the command line
10002followed by the full path name found.  If the file is not found then
10003generate an error message.  Note: the current working directory is not
10004searched.
10005
10006@item %e@var{str}
10007Print @var{str} as an error message.  @var{str} is terminated by a newline.
10008Use this when inconsistent options are detected.
10009
10010@item %(@var{name})
10011Substitute the contents of spec string @var{name} at this point.
10012
10013@item %x@{@var{option}@}
10014Accumulate an option for @samp{%X}.
10015
10016@item %X
10017Output the accumulated linker options specified by @option{-Wl} or a @samp{%x}
10018spec string.
10019
10020@item %Y
10021Output the accumulated assembler options specified by @option{-Wa}.
10022
10023@item %Z
10024Output the accumulated preprocessor options specified by @option{-Wp}.
10025
10026@item %a
10027Process the @code{asm} spec.  This is used to compute the
10028switches to be passed to the assembler.
10029
10030@item %A
10031Process the @code{asm_final} spec.  This is a spec string for
10032passing switches to an assembler post-processor, if such a program is
10033needed.
10034
10035@item %l
10036Process the @code{link} spec.  This is the spec for computing the
10037command line passed to the linker.  Typically it will make use of the
10038@samp{%L %G %S %D and %E} sequences.
10039
10040@item %D
10041Dump out a @option{-L} option for each directory that GCC believes might
10042contain startup files.  If the target supports multilibs then the
10043current multilib directory will be prepended to each of these paths.
10044
10045@item %L
10046Process the @code{lib} spec.  This is a spec string for deciding which
10047libraries should be included on the command line to the linker.
10048
10049@item %G
10050Process the @code{libgcc} spec.  This is a spec string for deciding
10051which GCC support library should be included on the command line to the linker.
10052
10053@item %S
10054Process the @code{startfile} spec.  This is a spec for deciding which
10055object files should be the first ones passed to the linker.  Typically
10056this might be a file named @file{crt0.o}.
10057
10058@item %E
10059Process the @code{endfile} spec.  This is a spec string that specifies
10060the last object files that will be passed to the linker.
10061
10062@item %C
10063Process the @code{cpp} spec.  This is used to construct the arguments
10064to be passed to the C preprocessor.
10065
10066@item %1
10067Process the @code{cc1} spec.  This is used to construct the options to be
10068passed to the actual C compiler (@samp{cc1}).
10069
10070@item %2
10071Process the @code{cc1plus} spec.  This is used to construct the options to be
10072passed to the actual C++ compiler (@samp{cc1plus}).
10073
10074@item %*
10075Substitute the variable part of a matched option.  See below.
10076Note that each comma in the substituted string is replaced by
10077a single space.
10078
10079@item %<@code{S}
10080Remove all occurrences of @code{-S} from the command line.  Note---this
10081command is position dependent.  @samp{%} commands in the spec string
10082before this one will see @code{-S}, @samp{%} commands in the spec string
10083after this one will not.
10084
10085@item %:@var{function}(@var{args})
10086Call the named function @var{function}, passing it @var{args}.
10087@var{args} is first processed as a nested spec string, then split
10088into an argument vector in the usual fashion.  The function returns
10089a string which is processed as if it had appeared literally as part
10090of the current spec.
10091
10092The following built-in spec functions are provided:
10093
10094@table @code
10095@item @code{getenv}
10096The @code{getenv} spec function takes two arguments: an environment
10097variable name and a string.  If the environment variable is not
10098defined, a fatal error is issued.  Otherwise, the return value is the
10099value of the environment variable concatenated with the string.  For
10100example, if @env{TOPDIR} is defined as @file{/path/to/top}, then:
10101
10102@smallexample
10103%:getenv(TOPDIR /include)
10104@end smallexample
10105
10106expands to @file{/path/to/top/include}.
10107
10108@item @code{if-exists}
10109The @code{if-exists} spec function takes one argument, an absolute
10110pathname to a file.  If the file exists, @code{if-exists} returns the
10111pathname.  Here is a small example of its usage:
10112
10113@smallexample
10114*startfile:
10115crt0%O%s %:if-exists(crti%O%s) crtbegin%O%s
10116@end smallexample
10117
10118@item @code{if-exists-else}
10119The @code{if-exists-else} spec function is similar to the @code{if-exists}
10120spec function, except that it takes two arguments.  The first argument is
10121an absolute pathname to a file.  If the file exists, @code{if-exists-else}
10122returns the pathname.  If it does not exist, it returns the second argument.
10123This way, @code{if-exists-else} can be used to select one file or another,
10124based on the existence of the first.  Here is a small example of its usage:
10125
10126@smallexample
10127*startfile:
10128crt0%O%s %:if-exists(crti%O%s) \
10129%:if-exists-else(crtbeginT%O%s crtbegin%O%s)
10130@end smallexample
10131
10132@item @code{replace-outfile}
10133The @code{replace-outfile} spec function takes two arguments.  It looks for the
10134first argument in the outfiles array and replaces it with the second argument.  Here
10135is a small example of its usage:
10136
10137@smallexample
10138%@{fgnu-runtime:%:replace-outfile(-lobjc -lobjc-gnu)@}
10139@end smallexample
10140
10141@item @code{remove-outfile}
10142The @code{remove-outfile} spec function takes one argument.  It looks for the
10143first argument in the outfiles array and removes it.  Here is a small example
10144its usage:
10145
10146@smallexample
10147%:remove-outfile(-lm)
10148@end smallexample
10149
10150@item @code{pass-through-libs}
10151The @code{pass-through-libs} spec function takes any number of arguments.  It
10152finds any @option{-l} options and any non-options ending in ".a" (which it
10153assumes are the names of linker input library archive files) and returns a
10154result containing all the found arguments each prepended by
10155@option{-plugin-opt=-pass-through=} and joined by spaces.  This list is
10156intended to be passed to the LTO linker plugin.
10157
10158@smallexample
10159%:pass-through-libs(%G %L %G)
10160@end smallexample
10161
10162@item @code{print-asm-header}
10163The @code{print-asm-header} function takes no arguments and simply
10164prints a banner like:
10165
10166@smallexample
10167Assembler options
10168=================
10169
10170Use "-Wa,OPTION" to pass "OPTION" to the assembler.
10171@end smallexample
10172
10173It is used to separate compiler options from assembler options
10174in the @option{--target-help} output.
10175@end table
10176
10177@item %@{@code{S}@}
10178Substitutes the @code{-S} switch, if that switch was given to GCC@.
10179If that switch was not specified, this substitutes nothing.  Note that
10180the leading dash is omitted when specifying this option, and it is
10181automatically inserted if the substitution is performed.  Thus the spec
10182string @samp{%@{foo@}} would match the command-line option @option{-foo}
10183and would output the command-line option @option{-foo}.
10184
10185@item %W@{@code{S}@}
10186Like %@{@code{S}@} but mark last argument supplied within as a file to be
10187deleted on failure.
10188
10189@item %@{@code{S}*@}
10190Substitutes all the switches specified to GCC whose names start
10191with @code{-S}, but which also take an argument.  This is used for
10192switches like @option{-o}, @option{-D}, @option{-I}, etc.
10193GCC considers @option{-o foo} as being
10194one switch whose names starts with @samp{o}.  %@{o*@} would substitute this
10195text, including the space.  Thus two arguments would be generated.
10196
10197@item %@{@code{S}*&@code{T}*@}
10198Like %@{@code{S}*@}, but preserve order of @code{S} and @code{T} options
10199(the order of @code{S} and @code{T} in the spec is not significant).
10200There can be any number of ampersand-separated variables; for each the
10201wild card is optional.  Useful for CPP as @samp{%@{D*&U*&A*@}}.
10202
10203@item %@{@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10204Substitutes @code{X}, if the @samp{-S} switch was given to GCC@.
10205
10206@item %@{!@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10207Substitutes @code{X}, if the @samp{-S} switch was @emph{not} given to GCC@.
10208
10209@item %@{@code{S}*:@code{X}@}
10210Substitutes @code{X} if one or more switches whose names start with
10211@code{-S} are specified to GCC@.  Normally @code{X} is substituted only
10212once, no matter how many such switches appeared.  However, if @code{%*}
10213appears somewhere in @code{X}, then @code{X} will be substituted once
10214for each matching switch, with the @code{%*} replaced by the part of
10215that switch that matched the @code{*}.
10216
10217@item %@{.@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10218Substitutes @code{X}, if processing a file with suffix @code{S}.
10219
10220@item %@{!.@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10221Substitutes @code{X}, if @emph{not} processing a file with suffix @code{S}.
10222
10223@item %@{,@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10224Substitutes @code{X}, if processing a file for language @code{S}.
10225
10226@item %@{!,@code{S}:@code{X}@}
10227Substitutes @code{X}, if not processing a file for language @code{S}.
10228
10229@item %@{@code{S}|@code{P}:@code{X}@}
10230Substitutes @code{X} if either @code{-S} or @code{-P} was given to
10231GCC@.  This may be combined with @samp{!}, @samp{.}, @samp{,}, and
10232@code{*} sequences as well, although they have a stronger binding than
10233the @samp{|}.  If @code{%*} appears in @code{X}, all of the
10234alternatives must be starred, and only the first matching alternative
10235is substituted.
10236
10237For example, a spec string like this:
10238
10239@smallexample
10240%@{.c:-foo@} %@{!.c:-bar@} %@{.c|d:-baz@} %@{!.c|d:-boggle@}
10241@end smallexample
10242
10243will output the following command-line options from the following input
10244command-line options:
10245
10246@smallexample
10247fred.c        -foo -baz
10248jim.d         -bar -boggle
10249-d fred.c     -foo -baz -boggle
10250-d jim.d      -bar -baz -boggle
10251@end smallexample
10252
10253@item %@{S:X; T:Y; :D@}
10254
10255If @code{S} was given to GCC, substitutes @code{X}; else if @code{T} was
10256given to GCC, substitutes @code{Y}; else substitutes @code{D}.  There can
10257be as many clauses as you need.  This may be combined with @code{.},
10258@code{,}, @code{!}, @code{|}, and @code{*} as needed.
10259
10260
10261@end table
10262
10263The conditional text @code{X} in a %@{@code{S}:@code{X}@} or similar
10264construct may contain other nested @samp{%} constructs or spaces, or
10265even newlines.  They are processed as usual, as described above.
10266Trailing white space in @code{X} is ignored.  White space may also
10267appear anywhere on the left side of the colon in these constructs,
10268except between @code{.} or @code{*} and the corresponding word.
10269
10270The @option{-O}, @option{-f}, @option{-m}, and @option{-W} switches are
10271handled specifically in these constructs.  If another value of
10272@option{-O} or the negated form of a @option{-f}, @option{-m}, or
10273@option{-W} switch is found later in the command line, the earlier
10274switch value is ignored, except with @{@code{S}*@} where @code{S} is
10275just one letter, which passes all matching options.
10276
10277The character @samp{|} at the beginning of the predicate text is used to
10278indicate that a command should be piped to the following command, but
10279only if @option{-pipe} is specified.
10280
10281It is built into GCC which switches take arguments and which do not.
10282(You might think it would be useful to generalize this to allow each
10283compiler's spec to say which switches take arguments.  But this cannot
10284be done in a consistent fashion.  GCC cannot even decide which input
10285files have been specified without knowing which switches take arguments,
10286and it must know which input files to compile in order to tell which
10287compilers to run).
10288
10289GCC also knows implicitly that arguments starting in @option{-l} are to be
10290treated as compiler output files, and passed to the linker in their
10291proper position among the other output files.
10292
10293@c man begin OPTIONS
10294
10295@node Target Options
10296@section Specifying Target Machine and Compiler Version
10297@cindex target options
10298@cindex cross compiling
10299@cindex specifying machine version
10300@cindex specifying compiler version and target machine
10301@cindex compiler version, specifying
10302@cindex target machine, specifying
10303
10304The usual way to run GCC is to run the executable called @command{gcc}, or
10305@command{@var{machine}-gcc} when cross-compiling, or
10306@command{@var{machine}-gcc-@var{version}} to run a version other than the
10307one that was installed last.
10308
10309@node Submodel Options
10310@section Hardware Models and Configurations
10311@cindex submodel options
10312@cindex specifying hardware config
10313@cindex hardware models and configurations, specifying
10314@cindex machine dependent options
10315
10316Each target machine types can have its own
10317special options, starting with @samp{-m}, to choose among various
10318hardware models or configurations---for example, 68010 vs 68020,
10319floating coprocessor or none.  A single installed version of the
10320compiler can compile for any model or configuration, according to the
10321options specified.
10322
10323Some configurations of the compiler also support additional special
10324options, usually for compatibility with other compilers on the same
10325platform.
10326
10327@c This list is ordered alphanumerically by subsection name.
10328@c It should be the same order and spelling as these options are listed
10329@c in Machine Dependent Options
10330
10331@menu
10332* Adapteva Epiphany Options::
10333* ARM Options::
10334* AVR Options::
10335* Blackfin Options::
10336* C6X Options::
10337* CRIS Options::
10338* CR16 Options::
10339* Darwin Options::
10340* DEC Alpha Options::
10341* DEC Alpha/VMS Options::
10342* FR30 Options::
10343* FRV Options::
10344* GNU/Linux Options::
10345* H8/300 Options::
10346* HPPA Options::
10347* i386 and x86-64 Options::
10348* i386 and x86-64 Windows Options::
10349* IA-64 Options::
10350* IA-64/VMS Options::
10351* LM32 Options::
10352* M32C Options::
10353* M32R/D Options::
10354* M680x0 Options::
10355* MCore Options::
10356* MeP Options::
10357* MicroBlaze Options::
10358* MIPS Options::
10359* MMIX Options::
10360* MN10300 Options::
10361* PDP-11 Options::
10362* picoChip Options::
10363* PowerPC Options::
10364* RL78 Options::
10365* RS/6000 and PowerPC Options::
10366* RX Options::
10367* S/390 and zSeries Options::
10368* Score Options::
10369* SH Options::
10370* Solaris 2 Options::
10371* SPARC Options::
10372* SPU Options::
10373* System V Options::
10374* TILE-Gx Options::
10375* TILEPro Options::
10376* V850 Options::
10377* VAX Options::
10378* VxWorks Options::
10379* x86-64 Options::
10380* Xstormy16 Options::
10381* Xtensa Options::
10382* zSeries Options::
10383@end menu
10384
10385@node Adapteva Epiphany Options
10386@subsection Adapteva Epiphany Options
10387
10388These @samp{-m} options are defined for Adapteva Epiphany:
10389
10390@table @gcctabopt
10391@item -mhalf-reg-file
10392@opindex mhalf-reg-file
10393Don't allocate any register in the range @code{r32}@dots{}@code{r63}.
10394That allows code to run on hardware variants that lack these registers.
10395
10396@item -mprefer-short-insn-regs
10397@opindex mprefer-short-insn-regs
10398Preferrentially allocate registers that allow short instruction generation.
10399This can result in increasesd instruction count, so if this reduces or
10400increases code size might vary from case to case.
10401
10402@item -mbranch-cost=@var{num}
10403@opindex mbranch-cost
10404Set the cost of branches to roughly @var{num} ``simple'' instructions.
10405This cost is only a heuristic and is not guaranteed to produce
10406consistent results across releases.
10407
10408@item -mcmove
10409@opindex mcmove
10410Enable the generation of conditional moves.
10411
10412@item -mnops=@var{num}
10413@opindex mnops
10414Emit @var{num} nops before every other generated instruction.
10415
10416@item -mno-soft-cmpsf
10417@opindex mno-soft-cmpsf
10418For single-precision floating-point comparisons, emit an fsub instruction
10419and test the flags.  This is faster than a software comparison, but can
10420get incorrect results in the presence of NaNs, or when two different small
10421numbers are compared such that their difference is calculated as zero.
10422The default is @option{-msoft-cmpsf}, which uses slower, but IEEE-compliant,
10423software comparisons.
10424
10425@item -mstack-offset=@var{num}
10426@opindex mstack-offset
10427Set the offset between the top of the stack and the stack pointer.
10428E.g., a value of 8 means that the eight bytes in the range sp+0@dots{}sp+7
10429can be used by leaf functions without stack allocation.
10430Values other than @samp{8} or @samp{16} are untested and unlikely to work.
10431Note also that this option changes the ABI, compiling a program with a
10432different stack offset than the libraries have been compiled with
10433will generally not work.
10434This option can be useful if you want to evaluate if a different stack
10435offset would give you better code, but to actually use a different stack
10436offset to build working programs, it is recommended to configure the
10437toolchain with the appropriate @samp{--with-stack-offset=@var{num}} option.
10438
10439@item -mno-round-nearest
10440@opindex mno-round-nearest
10441Make the scheduler assume that the rounding mode has been set to
10442truncating.  The default is @option{-mround-nearest}.
10443
10444@item -mlong-calls
10445@opindex mlong-calls
10446If not otherwise specified by an attribute, assume all calls might be beyond
10447the offset range of the b / bl instructions, and therefore load the
10448function address into a register before performing a (otherwise direct) call.
10449This is the default.
10450
10451@item -mshort-calls
10452@opindex short-calls
10453If not otherwise specified by an attribute, assume all direct calls are
10454in the range of the b / bl instructions, so use these instructions
10455for direct calls.  The default is @option{-mlong-calls}.
10456
10457@item -msmall16
10458@opindex msmall16
10459Assume addresses can be loaded as 16-bit unsigned values.  This does not
10460apply to function addresses for which @option{-mlong-calls} semantics
10461are in effect.
10462
10463@item -mfp-mode=@var{mode}
10464@opindex mfp-mode
10465Set the prevailing mode of the floating-point unit.
10466This determines the floating-point mode that is provided and expected
10467at function call and return time.  Making this mode match the mode you
10468predominantly need at function start can make your programs smaller and
10469faster by avoiding unnecessary mode switches.
10470
10471@var{mode} can be set to one the following values:
10472
10473@table @samp
10474@item caller
10475Any mode at function entry is valid, and retained or restored when
10476the function returns, and when it calls other functions.
10477This mode is useful for compiling libraries or other compilation units
10478you might want to incorporate into different programs with different
10479prevailing FPU modes, and the convenience of being able to use a single
10480object file outweighs the size and speed overhead for any extra
10481mode switching that might be needed, compared with what would be needed
10482with a more specific choice of prevailing FPU mode.
10483
10484@item truncate
10485This is the mode used for floating-point calculations with
10486truncating (i.e.@: round towards zero) rounding mode.  That includes
10487conversion from floating point to integer.
10488
10489@item round-nearest
10490This is the mode used for floating-point calculations with
10491round-to-nearest-or-even rounding mode.
10492
10493@item int
10494This is the mode used to perform integer calculations in the FPU, e.g.@:
10495integer multiply, or integer multiply-and-accumulate.
10496@end table
10497
10498The default is @option{-mfp-mode=caller}
10499
10500@item -mnosplit-lohi
10501@opindex mnosplit-lohi
10502@item -mno-postinc
10503@opindex mno-postinc
10504@item -mno-postmodify
10505@opindex mno-postmodify
10506Code generation tweaks that disable, respectively, splitting of 32-bit
10507loads, generation of post-increment addresses, and generation of
10508post-modify addresses.  The defaults are @option{msplit-lohi},
10509@option{-mpost-inc}, and @option{-mpost-modify}.
10510
10511@item -mnovect-double
10512@opindex mno-vect-double
10513Change the preferred SIMD mode to SImode.  The default is
10514@option{-mvect-double}, which uses DImode as preferred SIMD mode.
10515
10516@item -max-vect-align=@var{num}
10517@opindex max-vect-align
10518The maximum alignment for SIMD vector mode types.
10519@var{num} may be 4 or 8.  The default is 8.
10520Note that this is an ABI change, even though many library function
10521interfaces will be unaffected, if they don't use SIMD vector modes
10522in places where they affect size and/or alignment of relevant types.
10523
10524@item -msplit-vecmove-early
10525@opindex msplit-vecmove-early
10526Split vector moves into single word moves before reload.  In theory this
10527could give better register allocation, but so far the reverse seems to be
10528generally the case.
10529
10530@item -m1reg-@var{reg}
10531@opindex m1reg-
10532Specify a register to hold the constant @minus{}1, which makes loading small negative
10533constants and certain bitmasks faster.
10534Allowable values for reg are r43 and r63, which specify to use that register
10535as a fixed register, and none, which means that no register is used for this
10536purpose.  The default is @option{-m1reg-none}.
10537
10538@end table
10539
10540@node ARM Options
10541@subsection ARM Options
10542@cindex ARM options
10543
10544These @samp{-m} options are defined for Advanced RISC Machines (ARM)
10545architectures:
10546
10547@table @gcctabopt
10548@item -mabi=@var{name}
10549@opindex mabi
10550Generate code for the specified ABI@.  Permissible values are: @samp{apcs-gnu},
10551@samp{atpcs}, @samp{aapcs}, @samp{aapcs-linux} and @samp{iwmmxt}.
10552
10553@item -mapcs-frame
10554@opindex mapcs-frame
10555Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the ARM Procedure Call
10556Standard for all functions, even if this is not strictly necessary for
10557correct execution of the code.  Specifying @option{-fomit-frame-pointer}
10558with this option will cause the stack frames not to be generated for
10559leaf functions.  The default is @option{-mno-apcs-frame}.
10560
10561@item -mapcs
10562@opindex mapcs
10563This is a synonym for @option{-mapcs-frame}.
10564
10565@ignore
10566@c not currently implemented
10567@item -mapcs-stack-check
10568@opindex mapcs-stack-check
10569Generate code to check the amount of stack space available upon entry to
10570every function (that actually uses some stack space).  If there is
10571insufficient space available then either the function
10572@samp{__rt_stkovf_split_small} or @samp{__rt_stkovf_split_big} will be
10573called, depending upon the amount of stack space required.  The runtime
10574system is required to provide these functions.  The default is
10575@option{-mno-apcs-stack-check}, since this produces smaller code.
10576
10577@c not currently implemented
10578@item -mapcs-float
10579@opindex mapcs-float
10580Pass floating-point arguments using the floating-point registers.  This is
10581one of the variants of the APCS@.  This option is recommended if the
10582target hardware has a floating-point unit or if a lot of floating-point
10583arithmetic is going to be performed by the code.  The default is
10584@option{-mno-apcs-float}, since integer only code is slightly increased in
10585size if @option{-mapcs-float} is used.
10586
10587@c not currently implemented
10588@item -mapcs-reentrant
10589@opindex mapcs-reentrant
10590Generate reentrant, position independent code.  The default is
10591@option{-mno-apcs-reentrant}.
10592@end ignore
10593
10594@item -mthumb-interwork
10595@opindex mthumb-interwork
10596Generate code that supports calling between the ARM and Thumb
10597instruction sets.  Without this option, on pre-v5 architectures, the
10598two instruction sets cannot be reliably used inside one program.  The
10599default is @option{-mno-thumb-interwork}, since slightly larger code
10600is generated when @option{-mthumb-interwork} is specified.  In AAPCS
10601configurations this option is meaningless.
10602
10603@item -mno-sched-prolog
10604@opindex mno-sched-prolog
10605Prevent the reordering of instructions in the function prologue, or the
10606merging of those instruction with the instructions in the function's
10607body.  This means that all functions will start with a recognizable set
10608of instructions (or in fact one of a choice from a small set of
10609different function prologues), and this information can be used to
10610locate the start if functions inside an executable piece of code.  The
10611default is @option{-msched-prolog}.
10612
10613@item -mfloat-abi=@var{name}
10614@opindex mfloat-abi
10615Specifies which floating-point ABI to use.  Permissible values
10616are: @samp{soft}, @samp{softfp} and @samp{hard}.
10617
10618Specifying @samp{soft} causes GCC to generate output containing
10619library calls for floating-point operations.
10620@samp{softfp} allows the generation of code using hardware floating-point
10621instructions, but still uses the soft-float calling conventions.
10622@samp{hard} allows generation of floating-point instructions
10623and uses FPU-specific calling conventions.
10624
10625The default depends on the specific target configuration.  Note that
10626the hard-float and soft-float ABIs are not link-compatible; you must
10627compile your entire program with the same ABI, and link with a
10628compatible set of libraries.
10629
10630@item -mlittle-endian
10631@opindex mlittle-endian
10632Generate code for a processor running in little-endian mode.  This is
10633the default for all standard configurations.
10634
10635@item -mbig-endian
10636@opindex mbig-endian
10637Generate code for a processor running in big-endian mode; the default is
10638to compile code for a little-endian processor.
10639
10640@item -mwords-little-endian
10641@opindex mwords-little-endian
10642This option only applies when generating code for big-endian processors.
10643Generate code for a little-endian word order but a big-endian byte
10644order.  That is, a byte order of the form @samp{32107654}.  Note: this
10645option should only be used if you require compatibility with code for
10646big-endian ARM processors generated by versions of the compiler prior to
106472.8.  This option is now deprecated.
10648
10649@item -mcpu=@var{name}
10650@opindex mcpu
10651This specifies the name of the target ARM processor.  GCC uses this name
10652to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating
10653assembly code.  Permissible names are: @samp{arm2}, @samp{arm250},
10654@samp{arm3}, @samp{arm6}, @samp{arm60}, @samp{arm600}, @samp{arm610},
10655@samp{arm620}, @samp{arm7}, @samp{arm7m}, @samp{arm7d}, @samp{arm7dm},
10656@samp{arm7di}, @samp{arm7dmi}, @samp{arm70}, @samp{arm700},
10657@samp{arm700i}, @samp{arm710}, @samp{arm710c}, @samp{arm7100},
10658@samp{arm720},
10659@samp{arm7500}, @samp{arm7500fe}, @samp{arm7tdmi}, @samp{arm7tdmi-s},
10660@samp{arm710t}, @samp{arm720t}, @samp{arm740t},
10661@samp{strongarm}, @samp{strongarm110}, @samp{strongarm1100},
10662@samp{strongarm1110},
10663@samp{arm8}, @samp{arm810}, @samp{arm9}, @samp{arm9e}, @samp{arm920},
10664@samp{arm920t}, @samp{arm922t}, @samp{arm946e-s}, @samp{arm966e-s},
10665@samp{arm968e-s}, @samp{arm926ej-s}, @samp{arm940t}, @samp{arm9tdmi},
10666@samp{arm10tdmi}, @samp{arm1020t}, @samp{arm1026ej-s},
10667@samp{arm10e}, @samp{arm1020e}, @samp{arm1022e},
10668@samp{arm1136j-s}, @samp{arm1136jf-s}, @samp{mpcore}, @samp{mpcorenovfp},
10669@samp{arm1156t2-s}, @samp{arm1156t2f-s}, @samp{arm1176jz-s}, @samp{arm1176jzf-s},
10670@samp{cortex-a5}, @samp{cortex-a7}, @samp{cortex-a8}, @samp{cortex-a9},
10671@samp{cortex-a15}, @samp{cortex-r4}, @samp{cortex-r4f}, @samp{cortex-r5},
10672@samp{cortex-m4}, @samp{cortex-m3},
10673@samp{cortex-m1},
10674@samp{cortex-m0},
10675@samp{xscale}, @samp{iwmmxt}, @samp{iwmmxt2}, @samp{ep9312},
10676@samp{fa526}, @samp{fa626},
10677@samp{fa606te}, @samp{fa626te}, @samp{fmp626}, @samp{fa726te}.
10678
10679
10680@option{-mcpu=generic-@var{arch}} is also permissible, and is
10681equivalent to @option{-march=@var{arch} -mtune=generic-@var{arch}}.
10682See @option{-mtune} for more information.
10683
10684@option{-mcpu=native} causes the compiler to auto-detect the CPU
10685of the build computer.  At present, this feature is only supported on
10686Linux, and not all architectures are recognized.  If the auto-detect is
10687unsuccessful the option has no effect.
10688
10689@item -mtune=@var{name}
10690@opindex mtune
10691This option is very similar to the @option{-mcpu=} option, except that
10692instead of specifying the actual target processor type, and hence
10693restricting which instructions can be used, it specifies that GCC should
10694tune the performance of the code as if the target were of the type
10695specified in this option, but still choosing the instructions that it
10696will generate based on the CPU specified by a @option{-mcpu=} option.
10697For some ARM implementations better performance can be obtained by using
10698this option.
10699
10700@option{-mtune=generic-@var{arch}} specifies that GCC should tune the
10701performance for a blend of processors within architecture @var{arch}.
10702The aim is to generate code that run well on the current most popular
10703processors, balancing between optimizations that benefit some CPUs in the
10704range, and avoiding performance pitfalls of other CPUs.  The effects of
10705this option may change in future GCC versions as CPU models come and go.
10706
10707@option{-mtune=native} causes the compiler to auto-detect the CPU
10708of the build computer.  At present, this feature is only supported on
10709Linux, and not all architectures are recognized.  If the auto-detect is
10710unsuccessful the option has no effect.
10711
10712@item -march=@var{name}
10713@opindex march
10714This specifies the name of the target ARM architecture.  GCC uses this
10715name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating
10716assembly code.  This option can be used in conjunction with or instead
10717of the @option{-mcpu=} option.  Permissible names are: @samp{armv2},
10718@samp{armv2a}, @samp{armv3}, @samp{armv3m}, @samp{armv4}, @samp{armv4t},
10719@samp{armv5}, @samp{armv5t}, @samp{armv5e}, @samp{armv5te},
10720@samp{armv6}, @samp{armv6j},
10721@samp{armv6t2}, @samp{armv6z}, @samp{armv6zk}, @samp{armv6-m},
10722@samp{armv7}, @samp{armv7-a}, @samp{armv7-r}, @samp{armv7-m},
10723@samp{iwmmxt}, @samp{iwmmxt2}, @samp{ep9312}.
10724
10725@option{-march=native} causes the compiler to auto-detect the architecture
10726of the build computer.  At present, this feature is only supported on
10727Linux, and not all architectures are recognized.  If the auto-detect is
10728unsuccessful the option has no effect.
10729
10730@item -mfpu=@var{name}
10731@itemx -mfpe=@var{number}
10732@itemx -mfp=@var{number}
10733@opindex mfpu
10734@opindex mfpe
10735@opindex mfp
10736This specifies what floating-point hardware (or hardware emulation) is
10737available on the target.  Permissible names are: @samp{fpa}, @samp{fpe2},
10738@samp{fpe3}, @samp{maverick}, @samp{vfp}, @samp{vfpv3}, @samp{vfpv3-fp16},
10739@samp{vfpv3-d16}, @samp{vfpv3-d16-fp16}, @samp{vfpv3xd}, @samp{vfpv3xd-fp16},
10740@samp{neon}, @samp{neon-fp16}, @samp{vfpv4}, @samp{vfpv4-d16},
10741@samp{fpv4-sp-d16} and @samp{neon-vfpv4}.
10742@option{-mfp} and @option{-mfpe} are synonyms for
10743@option{-mfpu}=@samp{fpe}@var{number}, for compatibility with older versions
10744of GCC@.
10745
10746If @option{-msoft-float} is specified this specifies the format of
10747floating-point values.
10748
10749If the selected floating-point hardware includes the NEON extension
10750(e.g. @option{-mfpu}=@samp{neon}), note that floating-point
10751operations will not be used by GCC's auto-vectorization pass unless
10752@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} is also specified.  This is
10753because NEON hardware does not fully implement the IEEE 754 standard for
10754floating-point arithmetic (in particular denormal values are treated as
10755zero), so the use of NEON instructions may lead to a loss of precision.
10756
10757@item -mfp16-format=@var{name}
10758@opindex mfp16-format
10759Specify the format of the @code{__fp16} half-precision floating-point type.
10760Permissible names are @samp{none}, @samp{ieee}, and @samp{alternative};
10761the default is @samp{none}, in which case the @code{__fp16} type is not
10762defined.  @xref{Half-Precision}, for more information.
10763
10764@item -mstructure-size-boundary=@var{n}
10765@opindex mstructure-size-boundary
10766The size of all structures and unions will be rounded up to a multiple
10767of the number of bits set by this option.  Permissible values are 8, 32
10768and 64.  The default value varies for different toolchains.  For the COFF
10769targeted toolchain the default value is 8.  A value of 64 is only allowed
10770if the underlying ABI supports it.
10771
10772Specifying the larger number can produce faster, more efficient code, but
10773can also increase the size of the program.  Different values are potentially
10774incompatible.  Code compiled with one value cannot necessarily expect to
10775work with code or libraries compiled with another value, if they exchange
10776information using structures or unions.
10777
10778@item -mabort-on-noreturn
10779@opindex mabort-on-noreturn
10780Generate a call to the function @code{abort} at the end of a
10781@code{noreturn} function.  It will be executed if the function tries to
10782return.
10783
10784@item -mlong-calls
10785@itemx -mno-long-calls
10786@opindex mlong-calls
10787@opindex mno-long-calls
10788Tells the compiler to perform function calls by first loading the
10789address of the function into a register and then performing a subroutine
10790call on this register.  This switch is needed if the target function
10791will lie outside of the 64 megabyte addressing range of the offset based
10792version of subroutine call instruction.
10793
10794Even if this switch is enabled, not all function calls will be turned
10795into long calls.  The heuristic is that static functions, functions
10796that have the @samp{short-call} attribute, functions that are inside
10797the scope of a @samp{#pragma no_long_calls} directive and functions whose
10798definitions have already been compiled within the current compilation
10799unit, will not be turned into long calls.  The exception to this rule is
10800that weak function definitions, functions with the @samp{long-call}
10801attribute or the @samp{section} attribute, and functions that are within
10802the scope of a @samp{#pragma long_calls} directive, will always be
10803turned into long calls.
10804
10805This feature is not enabled by default.  Specifying
10806@option{-mno-long-calls} will restore the default behavior, as will
10807placing the function calls within the scope of a @samp{#pragma
10808long_calls_off} directive.  Note these switches have no effect on how
10809the compiler generates code to handle function calls via function
10810pointers.
10811
10812@item -msingle-pic-base
10813@opindex msingle-pic-base
10814Treat the register used for PIC addressing as read-only, rather than
10815loading it in the prologue for each function.  The runtime system is
10816responsible for initializing this register with an appropriate value
10817before execution begins.
10818
10819@item -mpic-register=@var{reg}
10820@opindex mpic-register
10821Specify the register to be used for PIC addressing.  The default is R10
10822unless stack-checking is enabled, when R9 is used.
10823
10824@item -mcirrus-fix-invalid-insns
10825@opindex mcirrus-fix-invalid-insns
10826@opindex mno-cirrus-fix-invalid-insns
10827Insert NOPs into the instruction stream to in order to work around
10828problems with invalid Maverick instruction combinations.  This option
10829is only valid if the @option{-mcpu=ep9312} option has been used to
10830enable generation of instructions for the Cirrus Maverick floating-point
10831co-processor.  This option is not enabled by default, since the
10832problem is only present in older Maverick implementations.  The default
10833can be re-enabled by use of the @option{-mno-cirrus-fix-invalid-insns}
10834switch.
10835
10836@item -mpoke-function-name
10837@opindex mpoke-function-name
10838Write the name of each function into the text section, directly
10839preceding the function prologue.  The generated code is similar to this:
10840
10841@smallexample
10842     t0
10843         .ascii "arm_poke_function_name", 0
10844         .align
10845     t1
10846         .word 0xff000000 + (t1 - t0)
10847     arm_poke_function_name
10848         mov     ip, sp
10849         stmfd   sp!, @{fp, ip, lr, pc@}
10850         sub     fp, ip, #4
10851@end smallexample
10852
10853When performing a stack backtrace, code can inspect the value of
10854@code{pc} stored at @code{fp + 0}.  If the trace function then looks at
10855location @code{pc - 12} and the top 8 bits are set, then we know that
10856there is a function name embedded immediately preceding this location
10857and has length @code{((pc[-3]) & 0xff000000)}.
10858
10859@item -mthumb
10860@itemx -marm
10861@opindex marm
10862@opindex mthumb
10863
10864Select between generating code that executes in ARM and Thumb
10865states.  The default for most configurations is to generate code
10866that executes in ARM state, but the default can be changed by
10867configuring GCC with the @option{--with-mode=}@var{state}
10868configure option.
10869
10870@item -mtpcs-frame
10871@opindex mtpcs-frame
10872Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the Thumb Procedure Call
10873Standard for all non-leaf functions.  (A leaf function is one that does
10874not call any other functions.)  The default is @option{-mno-tpcs-frame}.
10875
10876@item -mtpcs-leaf-frame
10877@opindex mtpcs-leaf-frame
10878Generate a stack frame that is compliant with the Thumb Procedure Call
10879Standard for all leaf functions.  (A leaf function is one that does
10880not call any other functions.)  The default is @option{-mno-apcs-leaf-frame}.
10881
10882@item -mcallee-super-interworking
10883@opindex mcallee-super-interworking
10884Gives all externally visible functions in the file being compiled an ARM
10885instruction set header which switches to Thumb mode before executing the
10886rest of the function.  This allows these functions to be called from
10887non-interworking code.  This option is not valid in AAPCS configurations
10888because interworking is enabled by default.
10889
10890@item -mcaller-super-interworking
10891@opindex mcaller-super-interworking
10892Allows calls via function pointers (including virtual functions) to
10893execute correctly regardless of whether the target code has been
10894compiled for interworking or not.  There is a small overhead in the cost
10895of executing a function pointer if this option is enabled.  This option
10896is not valid in AAPCS configurations because interworking is enabled
10897by default.
10898
10899@item -mtp=@var{name}
10900@opindex mtp
10901Specify the access model for the thread local storage pointer.  The valid
10902models are @option{soft}, which generates calls to @code{__aeabi_read_tp},
10903@option{cp15}, which fetches the thread pointer from @code{cp15} directly
10904(supported in the arm6k architecture), and @option{auto}, which uses the
10905best available method for the selected processor.  The default setting is
10906@option{auto}.
10907
10908@item -mtls-dialect=@var{dialect}
10909@opindex mtls-dialect
10910Specify the dialect to use for accessing thread local storage.  Two
10911dialects are supported --- @option{gnu} and @option{gnu2}.  The
10912@option{gnu} dialect selects the original GNU scheme for supporting
10913local and global dynamic TLS models.  The @option{gnu2} dialect
10914selects the GNU descriptor scheme, which provides better performance
10915for shared libraries.  The GNU descriptor scheme is compatible with
10916the original scheme, but does require new assembler, linker and
10917library support.  Initial and local exec TLS models are unaffected by
10918this option and always use the original scheme.
10919
10920@item -mword-relocations
10921@opindex mword-relocations
10922Only generate absolute relocations on word-sized values (i.e. R_ARM_ABS32).
10923This is enabled by default on targets (uClinux, SymbianOS) where the runtime
10924loader imposes this restriction, and when @option{-fpic} or @option{-fPIC}
10925is specified.
10926
10927@item -mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd
10928@opindex mfix-cortex-m3-ldrd
10929Some Cortex-M3 cores can cause data corruption when @code{ldrd} instructions
10930with overlapping destination and base registers are used.  This option avoids
10931generating these instructions.  This option is enabled by default when
10932@option{-mcpu=cortex-m3} is specified.
10933
10934@item -munaligned-access
10935@itemx -mno-unaligned-access
10936@opindex munaligned-access
10937@opindex mno-unaligned-access
10938Enables (or disables) reading and writing of 16- and 32- bit values
10939from addresses that are not 16- or 32- bit aligned.  By default
10940unaligned access is disabled for all pre-ARMv6 and all ARMv6-M
10941architectures, and enabled for all other architectures.  If unaligned
10942access is not enabled then words in packed data structures will be
10943accessed a byte at a time.
10944
10945The ARM attribute @code{Tag_CPU_unaligned_access} will be set in the
10946generated object file to either true or false, depending upon the
10947setting of this option.  If unaligned access is enabled then the
10948preprocessor symbol @code{__ARM_FEATURE_UNALIGNED} will also be
10949defined.
10950
10951@end table
10952
10953@node AVR Options
10954@subsection AVR Options
10955@cindex AVR Options
10956
10957@table @gcctabopt
10958@item -mmcu=@var{mcu}
10959@opindex mmcu
10960Specify Atmel AVR instruction set architectures (ISA) or MCU type.
10961
10962The default for this option is@tie{}@code{avr2}.
10963
10964GCC supports the following AVR devices and ISAs:
10965
10966@table @code
10967
10968@item avr2
10969``Classic'' devices with up to 8@tie{}KiB of program memory.
10970@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{attiny22}, @code{attiny26}, @code{at90c8534},
10971@code{at90s2313}, @code{at90s2323}, @code{at90s2333},
10972@code{at90s2343}, @code{at90s4414}, @code{at90s4433},
10973@code{at90s4434}, @code{at90s8515}, @code{at90s8535}.
10974
10975@item avr25
10976``Classic'' devices with up to 8@tie{}KiB of program memory and with
10977the @code{MOVW} instruction.
10978@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{ata6289}, @code{attiny13}, @code{attiny13a},
10979@code{attiny2313}, @code{attiny2313a}, @code{attiny24},
10980@code{attiny24a}, @code{attiny25}, @code{attiny261},
10981@code{attiny261a}, @code{attiny43u}, @code{attiny4313},
10982@code{attiny44}, @code{attiny44a}, @code{attiny45}, @code{attiny461},
10983@code{attiny461a}, @code{attiny48}, @code{attiny84}, @code{attiny84a},
10984@code{attiny85}, @code{attiny861}, @code{attiny861a}, @code{attiny87},
10985@code{attiny88}, @code{at86rf401}.
10986
10987@item avr3
10988``Classic'' devices with 16@tie{}KiB up to 64@tie{}KiB of  program memory.
10989@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{at43usb355}, @code{at76c711}.
10990
10991@item avr31
10992``Classic'' devices with 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
10993@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atmega103}, @code{at43usb320}.
10994
10995@item avr35
10996``Classic'' devices with 16@tie{}KiB up to 64@tie{}KiB of program
10997memory and with the @code{MOVW} instruction.
10998@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atmega16u2}, @code{atmega32u2},
10999@code{atmega8u2}, @code{attiny167}, @code{at90usb162},
11000@code{at90usb82}.
11001
11002@item avr4
11003``Enhanced'' devices with up to 8@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11004@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atmega48}, @code{atmega48a},
11005@code{atmega48p}, @code{atmega8}, @code{atmega8hva},
11006@code{atmega8515}, @code{atmega8535}, @code{atmega88},
11007@code{atmega88a}, @code{atmega88p}, @code{atmega88pa},
11008@code{at90pwm1}, @code{at90pwm2}, @code{at90pwm2b}, @code{at90pwm3},
11009@code{at90pwm3b}, @code{at90pwm81}.
11010
11011@item avr5
11012``Enhanced'' devices with 16@tie{}KiB up to 64@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11013@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atmega16}, @code{atmega16a},
11014@code{atmega16hva}, @code{atmega16hva2}, @code{atmega16hvb},
11015@code{atmega16m1}, @code{atmega16u4}, @code{atmega161},
11016@code{atmega162}, @code{atmega163}, @code{atmega164a},
11017@code{atmega164p}, @code{atmega165}, @code{atmega165a},
11018@code{atmega165p}, @code{atmega168}, @code{atmega168a},
11019@code{atmega168p}, @code{atmega169}, @code{atmega169a},
11020@code{atmega169p}, @code{atmega169pa}, @code{atmega32},
11021@code{atmega32c1}, @code{atmega32hvb}, @code{atmega32m1},
11022@code{atmega32u4}, @code{atmega32u6}, @code{atmega323},
11023@code{atmega324a}, @code{atmega324p}, @code{atmega324pa},
11024@code{atmega325}, @code{atmega325a}, @code{atmega325p},
11025@code{atmega3250}, @code{atmega3250a}, @code{atmega3250p},
11026@code{atmega328}, @code{atmega328p}, @code{atmega329},
11027@code{atmega329a}, @code{atmega329p}, @code{atmega329pa},
11028@code{atmega3290}, @code{atmega3290a}, @code{atmega3290p},
11029@code{atmega406}, @code{atmega64}, @code{atmega64c1},
11030@code{atmega64hve}, @code{atmega64m1}, @code{atmega640},
11031@code{atmega644}, @code{atmega644a}, @code{atmega644p},
11032@code{atmega644pa}, @code{atmega645}, @code{atmega645a},
11033@code{atmega645p}, @code{atmega6450}, @code{atmega6450a},
11034@code{atmega6450p}, @code{atmega649}, @code{atmega649a},
11035@code{atmega649p}, @code{atmega6490}, @code{at90can32},
11036@code{at90can64}, @code{at90pwm216}, @code{at90pwm316},
11037@code{at90scr100}, @code{at90usb646}, @code{at90usb647}, @code{at94k},
11038@code{m3000}.
11039
11040@item avr51
11041``Enhanced'' devices with 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11042@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atmega128}, @code{atmega128rfa1},
11043@code{atmega1280}, @code{atmega1281}, @code{atmega1284p},
11044@code{at90can128}, @code{at90usb1286}, @code{at90usb1287}.
11045
11046@item avr6
11047``Enhanced'' devices with 3-byte PC, i.e.@: with more than
11048128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11049@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atmega2560}, @code{atmega2561}.
11050
11051@item avrxmega2
11052``XMEGA'' devices with more than 8@tie{}KiB and up to 64@tie{}KiB of
11053program memory.
11054@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atxmega16a4}, @code{atxmega16d4},
11055@code{atxmega16x1}, @code{atxmega32a4}, @code{atxmega32d4},
11056@code{atxmega32x1}.
11057
11058@item avrxmega4
11059``XMEGA'' devices with more than 64@tie{}KiB and up to 128@tie{}KiB of
11060program memory.
11061@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atxmega64a3}, @code{atxmega64d3}.
11062
11063@item avrxmega5
11064``XMEGA'' devices with more than 64@tie{}KiB and up to 128@tie{}KiB of
11065program memory and more than 64@tie{}KiB of RAM.
11066@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atxmega64a1}, @code{atxmega64a1u}.
11067
11068@item avrxmega6
11069``XMEGA'' devices with more than 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11070@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atxmega128a3}, @code{atxmega128d3},
11071@code{atxmega192a3}, @code{atxmega192d3}, @code{atxmega256a3},
11072@code{atxmega256a3b}, @code{atxmega256a3bu}, @code{atxmega256d3}.
11073
11074@item avrxmega7
11075``XMEGA'' devices with more than 128@tie{}KiB of program memory and
11076more than 64@tie{}KiB of RAM.
11077@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{atxmega128a1}, @code{atxmega128a1u}.
11078
11079@item avr1
11080This ISA is implemented by the minimal AVR core and supported for
11081assembler only.
11082@*@var{mcu}@tie{}= @code{attiny11}, @code{attiny12}, @code{attiny15},
11083@code{attiny28}, @code{at90s1200}.
11084
11085@end table
11086
11087@item -maccumulate-args
11088@opindex maccumulate-args
11089Accumulate outgoing function arguments and acquire/release the needed
11090stack space for outgoing function arguments once in function
11091prologue/epilogue.  Without this option, outgoing arguments are pushed
11092before calling a function and popped afterwards.
11093
11094Popping the arguments after the function call can be expensive on
11095AVR so that accumulating the stack space might lead to smaller
11096executables because arguments need not to be removed from the
11097stack after such a function call.
11098
11099This option can lead to reduced code size for functions that perform
11100several calls to functions that get their arguments on the stack like
11101calls to printf-like functions.
11102
11103@item -mbranch-cost=@var{cost}
11104@opindex mbranch-cost
11105Set the branch costs for conditional branch instructions to
11106@var{cost}.  Reasonable values for @var{cost} are small, non-negative
11107integers. The default branch cost is 0.
11108
11109@item -mcall-prologues
11110@opindex mcall-prologues
11111Functions prologues/epilogues are expanded as calls to appropriate
11112subroutines.  Code size is smaller.
11113
11114@item -mint8
11115@opindex mint8
11116Assume @code{int} to be 8-bit integer.  This affects the sizes of all types: a
11117@code{char} is 1 byte, an @code{int} is 1 byte, a @code{long} is 2 bytes,
11118and @code{long long} is 4 bytes.  Please note that this option does not
11119conform to the C standards, but it results in smaller code
11120size.
11121
11122@item -mno-interrupts
11123@opindex mno-interrupts
11124Generated code is not compatible with hardware interrupts.
11125Code size is smaller.
11126
11127@item -mrelax
11128@opindex mrelax
11129Try to replace @code{CALL} resp.@: @code{JMP} instruction by the shorter
11130@code{RCALL} resp.@: @code{RJMP} instruction if applicable.
11131Setting @code{-mrelax} just adds the @code{--relax} option to the
11132linker command line when the linker is called.
11133
11134Jump relaxing is performed by the linker because jump offsets are not
11135known before code is located. Therefore, the assembler code generated by the
11136compiler is the same, but the instructions in the executable may
11137differ from instructions in the assembler code.
11138
11139Relaxing must be turned on if linker stubs are needed, see the
11140section on @code{EIND} and linker stubs below.
11141
11142@item -mshort-calls
11143@opindex mshort-calls
11144This option has been deprecated and will be removed in GCC 4.8.
11145See @code{-mrelax} for a replacement.
11146
11147Use @code{RCALL}/@code{RJMP} instructions even on devices with
1114816@tie{}KiB or more of program memory, i.e.@: on devices that
11149have the @code{CALL} and @code{JMP} instructions.
11150
11151@item -msp8
11152@opindex msp8
11153Treat the stack pointer register as an 8-bit register,
11154i.e.@: assume the high byte of the stack pointer is zero.
11155In general, you don't need to set this option by hand.
11156
11157This option is used internally by the compiler to select and
11158build multilibs for architectures @code{avr2} and @code{avr25}.
11159These architectures mix devices with and without @code{SPH}.
11160For any setting other than @code{-mmcu=avr2} or @code{-mmcu=avr25}
11161the compiler driver will add or remove this option from the compiler
11162proper's command line, because the compiler then knows if the device
11163or architecture has an 8-bit stack pointer and thus no @code{SPH}
11164register or not.
11165
11166@item -mstrict-X
11167@opindex mstrict-X
11168Use address register @code{X} in a way proposed by the hardware.  This means
11169that @code{X} is only used in indirect, post-increment or
11170pre-decrement addressing.
11171
11172Without this option, the @code{X} register may be used in the same way
11173as @code{Y} or @code{Z} which then is emulated by additional
11174instructions.
11175For example, loading a value with @code{X+const} addressing with a
11176small non-negative @code{const < 64} to a register @var{Rn} is
11177performed as
11178
11179@example
11180adiw r26, const   ; X += const
11181ld   @var{Rn}, X        ; @var{Rn} = *X
11182sbiw r26, const   ; X -= const
11183@end example
11184
11185@item -mtiny-stack
11186@opindex mtiny-stack
11187Only change the lower 8@tie{}bits of the stack pointer.
11188@end table
11189
11190@subsubsection @code{EIND} and Devices with more than 128 Ki Bytes of Flash
11191@cindex @code{EIND}
11192Pointers in the implementation are 16@tie{}bits wide.
11193The address of a function or label is represented as word address so
11194that indirect jumps and calls can target any code address in the
11195range of 64@tie{}Ki words.
11196
11197In order to facilitate indirect jump on devices with more than 128@tie{}Ki
11198bytes of program memory space, there is a special function register called
11199@code{EIND} that serves as most significant part of the target address
11200when @code{EICALL} or @code{EIJMP} instructions are used.
11201
11202Indirect jumps and calls on these devices are handled as follows by
11203the compiler and are subject to some limitations:
11204
11205@itemize @bullet
11206
11207@item
11208The compiler never sets @code{EIND}.
11209
11210@item
11211The compiler uses @code{EIND} implicitely in @code{EICALL}/@code{EIJMP}
11212instructions or might read @code{EIND} directly in order to emulate an
11213indirect call/jump by means of a @code{RET} instruction.
11214
11215@item
11216The compiler assumes that @code{EIND} never changes during the startup
11217code or during the application. In particular, @code{EIND} is not
11218saved/restored in function or interrupt service routine
11219prologue/epilogue.
11220
11221@item
11222For indirect calls to functions and computed goto, the linker
11223generates @emph{stubs}. Stubs are jump pads sometimes also called
11224@emph{trampolines}. Thus, the indirect call/jump jumps to such a stub.
11225The stub contains a direct jump to the desired address.
11226
11227@item
11228Linker relaxation must be turned on so that the linker will generate
11229the stubs correctly an all situaltion. See the compiler option
11230@code{-mrelax} and the linler option @code{--relax}.
11231There are corner cases where the linker is supposed to generate stubs
11232but aborts without relaxation and without a helpful error message.
11233
11234@item
11235The default linker script is arranged for code with @code{EIND = 0}.
11236If code is supposed to work for a setup with @code{EIND != 0}, a custom
11237linker script has to be used in order to place the sections whose
11238name start with @code{.trampolines} into the segment where @code{EIND}
11239points to.
11240
11241@item
11242The startup code from libgcc never sets @code{EIND}.
11243Notice that startup code is a blend of code from libgcc and AVR-LibC.
11244For the impact of AVR-LibC on @code{EIND}, see the
11245@w{@uref{http://nongnu.org/avr-libc/user-manual/,AVR-LibC user manual}}.
11246
11247@item
11248It is legitimate for user-specific startup code to set up @code{EIND}
11249early, for example by means of initialization code located in
11250section @code{.init3}. Such code runs prior to general startup code
11251that initializes RAM and calls constructors, but after the bit
11252of startup code from AVR-LibC that sets @code{EIND} to the segment
11253where the vector table is located.
11254@example
11255#include <avr/io.h>
11256
11257static void
11258__attribute__((section(".init3"),naked,used,no_instrument_function))
11259init3_set_eind (void)
11260@{
11261  __asm volatile ("ldi r24,pm_hh8(__trampolines_start)\n\t"
11262                  "out %i0,r24" :: "n" (&EIND) : "r24","memory");
11263@}
11264@end example
11265
11266@noindent
11267The @code{__trampolines_start} symbol is defined in the linker script.
11268
11269@item
11270Stubs are generated automatically by the linker if
11271the following two conditions are met:
11272@itemize @minus
11273
11274@item The address of a label is taken by means of the @code{gs} modifier
11275(short for @emph{generate stubs}) like so:
11276@example
11277LDI r24, lo8(gs(@var{func}))
11278LDI r25, hi8(gs(@var{func}))
11279@end example
11280@item The final location of that label is in a code segment
11281@emph{outside} the segment where the stubs are located.
11282@end itemize
11283
11284@item
11285The compiler emits such @code{gs} modifiers for code labels in the
11286following situations:
11287@itemize @minus
11288@item Taking address of a function or code label.
11289@item Computed goto.
11290@item If prologue-save function is used, see @option{-mcall-prologues}
11291command-line option.
11292@item Switch/case dispatch tables. If you do not want such dispatch
11293tables you can specify the @option{-fno-jump-tables} command-line option.
11294@item C and C++ constructors/destructors called during startup/shutdown.
11295@item If the tools hit a @code{gs()} modifier explained above.
11296@end itemize
11297
11298@item
11299Jumping to non-symbolic addresses like so is @emph{not} supported:
11300
11301@example
11302int main (void)
11303@{
11304    /* Call function at word address 0x2 */
11305    return ((int(*)(void)) 0x2)();
11306@}
11307@end example
11308
11309Instead, a stub has to be set up, i.e.@: the function has to be called
11310through a symbol (@code{func_4} in the example):
11311
11312@example
11313int main (void)
11314@{
11315    extern int func_4 (void);
11316
11317    /* Call function at byte address 0x4 */
11318    return func_4();
11319@}
11320@end example
11321
11322and the application be linked with @code{-Wl,--defsym,func_4=0x4}.
11323Alternatively, @code{func_4} can be defined in the linker script.
11324@end itemize
11325
11326@subsubsection Handling of the @code{RAMPD}, @code{RAMPX}, @code{RAMPY} and @code{RAMPZ} Special Function Registers
11327@cindex @code{RAMPD}
11328@cindex @code{RAMPX}
11329@cindex @code{RAMPY}
11330@cindex @code{RAMPZ}
11331Some AVR devices support memories larger than the 64@tie{}KiB range
11332that can be accessed with 16-bit pointers.  To access memory locations
11333outside this 64@tie{}KiB range, the contentent of a @code{RAMP}
11334register is used as high part of the address:
11335The @code{X}, @code{Y}, @code{Z} address register is concatenated
11336with the @code{RAMPX}, @code{RAMPY}, @code{RAMPZ} special function
11337register, respectively, to get a wide address. Similarly,
11338@code{RAMPD} is used together with direct addressing.
11339
11340@itemize
11341@item
11342The startup code initializes the @code{RAMP} special function
11343registers with zero.
11344
11345@item
11346If a @ref{AVR Named Address Spaces,named address space} other than
11347generic or @code{__flash} is used, then @code{RAMPZ} is set
11348as needed before the operation.
11349
11350@item
11351If the device supports RAM larger than 64@tie{KiB} and the compiler
11352needs to change @code{RAMPZ} to accomplish an operation, @code{RAMPZ}
11353is reset to zero after the operation.
11354
11355@item
11356If the device comes with a specific @code{RAMP} register, the ISR
11357prologue/epilogue saves/restores that SFR and initializes it with
11358zero in case the ISR code might (implicitly) use it.
11359
11360@item
11361RAM larger than 64@tie{KiB} is not supported by GCC for AVR targets.
11362If you use inline assembler to read from locations outside the
1136316-bit address range and change one of the @code{RAMP} registers,
11364you must reset it to zero after the access.
11365
11366@end itemize
11367
11368@subsubsection AVR Built-in Macros
11369
11370GCC defines several built-in macros so that the user code can test
11371for the presence or absence of features.  Almost any of the following
11372built-in macros are deduced from device capabilities and thus
11373triggered by the @code{-mmcu=} command-line option.
11374
11375For even more AVR-specific built-in macros see
11376@ref{AVR Named Address Spaces} and @ref{AVR Built-in Functions}.
11377
11378@table @code
11379
11380@item __AVR_ARCH__
11381Build-in macro that resolves to a decimal number that identifies the
11382architecture and depends on the @code{-mmcu=@var{mcu}} option.
11383Possible values are:
11384
11385@code{2}, @code{25}, @code{3}, @code{31}, @code{35},
11386@code{4}, @code{5}, @code{51}, @code{6}, @code{102}, @code{104},
11387@code{105}, @code{106}, @code{107}
11388
11389for @var{mcu}=@code{avr2}, @code{avr25}, @code{avr3},
11390@code{avr31}, @code{avr35}, @code{avr4}, @code{avr5}, @code{avr51},
11391@code{avr6}, @code{avrxmega2}, @code{avrxmega4}, @code{avrxmega5},
11392@code{avrxmega6}, @code{avrxmega7}, respectively.
11393If @var{mcu} specifies a device, this built-in macro is set
11394accordingly. For example, with @code{-mmcu=atmega8} the macro will be
11395defined to @code{4}.
11396
11397@item __AVR_@var{Device}__
11398Setting @code{-mmcu=@var{device}} defines this built-in macro which reflects
11399the device's name. For example, @code{-mmcu=atmega8} defines the
11400built-in macro @code{__AVR_ATmega8__}, @code{-mmcu=attiny261a} defines
11401@code{__AVR_ATtiny261A__}, etc.
11402
11403The built-in macros' names follow
11404the scheme @code{__AVR_@var{Device}__} where @var{Device} is
11405the device name as from the AVR user manual. The difference between
11406@var{Device} in the built-in macro and @var{device} in
11407@code{-mmcu=@var{device}} is that the latter is always lowercase.
11408
11409If @var{device} is not a device but only a core architecture like
11410@code{avr51}, this macro will not be defined.
11411
11412@item __AVR_XMEGA__
11413The device/architecture belongs to the XMEGA family of devices.
11414
11415@item __AVR_HAVE_ELPM__
11416The device has the the @code{ELPM} instruction.
11417
11418@item __AVR_HAVE_ELPMX__
11419The device has the @code{ELPM R@var{n},Z} and @code{ELPM
11420R@var{n},Z+} instructions.
11421
11422@item __AVR_HAVE_MOVW__
11423The device has the @code{MOVW} instruction to perform 16-bit
11424register-register moves.
11425
11426@item __AVR_HAVE_LPMX__
11427The device has the @code{LPM R@var{n},Z} and
11428@code{LPM R@var{n},Z+} instructions.
11429
11430@item __AVR_HAVE_MUL__
11431The device has a hardware multiplier.
11432
11433@item __AVR_HAVE_JMP_CALL__
11434The device has the @code{JMP} and @code{CALL} instructions.
11435This is the case for devices with at least 16@tie{}KiB of program
11436memory and if @code{-mshort-calls} is not set.
11437
11438@item __AVR_HAVE_EIJMP_EICALL__
11439@item __AVR_3_BYTE_PC__
11440The device has the @code{EIJMP} and @code{EICALL} instructions.
11441This is the case for devices with more than 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11442This also means that the program counter
11443(PC) is 3@tie{}bytes wide.
11444
11445@item __AVR_2_BYTE_PC__
11446The program counter (PC) is 2@tie{}bytes wide. This is the case for devices
11447with up to 128@tie{}KiB of program memory.
11448
11449@item __AVR_HAVE_8BIT_SP__
11450@item __AVR_HAVE_16BIT_SP__
11451The stack pointer (SP) register is treated as 8-bit respectively
1145216-bit register by the compiler.
11453The definition of these macros is affected by @code{-mtiny-stack}.
11454
11455@item __AVR_HAVE_SPH__
11456@item __AVR_SP8__
11457The device has the SPH (high part of stack pointer) special function
11458register or has an 8-bit stack pointer, respectively.
11459The definition of these macros is affected by @code{-mmcu=} and
11460in the cases of @code{-mmcu=avr2} and @code{-mmcu=avr25} also
11461by @code{-msp8}.
11462
11463@item __AVR_HAVE_RAMPD__
11464@item __AVR_HAVE_RAMPX__
11465@item __AVR_HAVE_RAMPY__
11466@item __AVR_HAVE_RAMPZ__
11467The device has the @code{RAMPD}, @code{RAMPX}, @code{RAMPY},
11468@code{RAMPZ} special function register, respectively.
11469
11470@item __NO_INTERRUPTS__
11471This macro reflects the @code{-mno-interrupts} command line option.
11472
11473@item __AVR_ERRATA_SKIP__
11474@item __AVR_ERRATA_SKIP_JMP_CALL__
11475Some AVR devices (AT90S8515, ATmega103) must not skip 32-bit
11476instructions because of a hardware erratum.  Skip instructions are
11477@code{SBRS}, @code{SBRC}, @code{SBIS}, @code{SBIC} and @code{CPSE}.
11478The second macro is only defined if @code{__AVR_HAVE_JMP_CALL__} is also
11479set.
11480
11481@item __AVR_SFR_OFFSET__=@var{offset}
11482Instructions that can address I/O special function registers directly
11483like @code{IN}, @code{OUT}, @code{SBI}, etc.@: may use a different
11484address as if addressed by an instruction to access RAM like @code{LD}
11485or @code{STS}. This offset depends on the device architecture and has
11486to be subtracted from the RAM address in order to get the
11487respective I/O@tie{}address.
11488
11489@item __WITH_AVRLIBC__
11490The compiler is configured to be used together with AVR-Libc.
11491See the @code{--with-avrlibc} configure option.
11492
11493@end table
11494
11495@node Blackfin Options
11496@subsection Blackfin Options
11497@cindex Blackfin Options
11498
11499@table @gcctabopt
11500@item -mcpu=@var{cpu}@r{[}-@var{sirevision}@r{]}
11501@opindex mcpu=
11502Specifies the name of the target Blackfin processor.  Currently, @var{cpu}
11503can be one of @samp{bf512}, @samp{bf514}, @samp{bf516}, @samp{bf518},
11504@samp{bf522}, @samp{bf523}, @samp{bf524}, @samp{bf525}, @samp{bf526},
11505@samp{bf527}, @samp{bf531}, @samp{bf532}, @samp{bf533},
11506@samp{bf534}, @samp{bf536}, @samp{bf537}, @samp{bf538}, @samp{bf539},
11507@samp{bf542}, @samp{bf544}, @samp{bf547}, @samp{bf548}, @samp{bf549},
11508@samp{bf542m}, @samp{bf544m}, @samp{bf547m}, @samp{bf548m}, @samp{bf549m},
11509@samp{bf561}, @samp{bf592}.
11510The optional @var{sirevision} specifies the silicon revision of the target
11511Blackfin processor.  Any workarounds available for the targeted silicon revision
11512will be enabled.  If @var{sirevision} is @samp{none}, no workarounds are enabled.
11513If @var{sirevision} is @samp{any}, all workarounds for the targeted processor
11514will be enabled.  The @code{__SILICON_REVISION__} macro is defined to two
11515hexadecimal digits representing the major and minor numbers in the silicon
11516revision.  If @var{sirevision} is @samp{none}, the @code{__SILICON_REVISION__}
11517is not defined.  If @var{sirevision} is @samp{any}, the
11518@code{__SILICON_REVISION__} is defined to be @code{0xffff}.
11519If this optional @var{sirevision} is not used, GCC assumes the latest known
11520silicon revision of the targeted Blackfin processor.
11521
11522Support for @samp{bf561} is incomplete.  For @samp{bf561},
11523Only the processor macro is defined.
11524Without this option, @samp{bf532} is used as the processor by default.
11525The corresponding predefined processor macros for @var{cpu} is to
11526be defined.  And for @samp{bfin-elf} toolchain, this causes the hardware BSP
11527provided by libgloss to be linked in if @option{-msim} is not given.
11528
11529@item -msim
11530@opindex msim
11531Specifies that the program will be run on the simulator.  This causes
11532the simulator BSP provided by libgloss to be linked in.  This option
11533has effect only for @samp{bfin-elf} toolchain.
11534Certain other options, such as @option{-mid-shared-library} and
11535@option{-mfdpic}, imply @option{-msim}.
11536
11537@item -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
11538@opindex momit-leaf-frame-pointer
11539Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions.  This
11540avoids the instructions to save, set up and restore frame pointers and
11541makes an extra register available in leaf functions.  The option
11542@option{-fomit-frame-pointer} removes the frame pointer for all functions,
11543which might make debugging harder.
11544
11545@item -mspecld-anomaly
11546@opindex mspecld-anomaly
11547When enabled, the compiler will ensure that the generated code does not
11548contain speculative loads after jump instructions. If this option is used,
11549@code{__WORKAROUND_SPECULATIVE_LOADS} is defined.
11550
11551@item -mno-specld-anomaly
11552@opindex mno-specld-anomaly
11553Don't generate extra code to prevent speculative loads from occurring.
11554
11555@item -mcsync-anomaly
11556@opindex mcsync-anomaly
11557When enabled, the compiler will ensure that the generated code does not
11558contain CSYNC or SSYNC instructions too soon after conditional branches.
11559If this option is used, @code{__WORKAROUND_SPECULATIVE_SYNCS} is defined.
11560
11561@item -mno-csync-anomaly
11562@opindex mno-csync-anomaly
11563Don't generate extra code to prevent CSYNC or SSYNC instructions from
11564occurring too soon after a conditional branch.
11565
11566@item -mlow-64k
11567@opindex mlow-64k
11568When enabled, the compiler is free to take advantage of the knowledge that
11569the entire program fits into the low 64k of memory.
11570
11571@item -mno-low-64k
11572@opindex mno-low-64k
11573Assume that the program is arbitrarily large.  This is the default.
11574
11575@item -mstack-check-l1
11576@opindex mstack-check-l1
11577Do stack checking using information placed into L1 scratchpad memory by the
11578uClinux kernel.
11579
11580@item -mid-shared-library
11581@opindex mid-shared-library
11582Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method.
11583This allows for execute in place and shared libraries in an environment
11584without virtual memory management.  This option implies @option{-fPIC}.
11585With a @samp{bfin-elf} target, this option implies @option{-msim}.
11586
11587@item -mno-id-shared-library
11588@opindex mno-id-shared-library
11589Generate code that doesn't assume ID based shared libraries are being used.
11590This is the default.
11591
11592@item -mleaf-id-shared-library
11593@opindex mleaf-id-shared-library
11594Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method,
11595but assumes that this library or executable won't link against any other
11596ID shared libraries.  That allows the compiler to use faster code for jumps
11597and calls.
11598
11599@item -mno-leaf-id-shared-library
11600@opindex mno-leaf-id-shared-library
11601Do not assume that the code being compiled won't link against any ID shared
11602libraries.  Slower code will be generated for jump and call insns.
11603
11604@item -mshared-library-id=n
11605@opindex mshared-library-id
11606Specified the identification number of the ID based shared library being
11607compiled.  Specifying a value of 0 will generate more compact code, specifying
11608other values will force the allocation of that number to the current
11609library but is no more space or time efficient than omitting this option.
11610
11611@item -msep-data
11612@opindex msep-data
11613Generate code that allows the data segment to be located in a different
11614area of memory from the text segment.  This allows for execute in place in
11615an environment without virtual memory management by eliminating relocations
11616against the text section.
11617
11618@item -mno-sep-data
11619@opindex mno-sep-data
11620Generate code that assumes that the data segment follows the text segment.
11621This is the default.
11622
11623@item -mlong-calls
11624@itemx -mno-long-calls
11625@opindex mlong-calls
11626@opindex mno-long-calls
11627Tells the compiler to perform function calls by first loading the
11628address of the function into a register and then performing a subroutine
11629call on this register.  This switch is needed if the target function
11630lies outside of the 24-bit addressing range of the offset-based
11631version of subroutine call instruction.
11632
11633This feature is not enabled by default.  Specifying
11634@option{-mno-long-calls} will restore the default behavior.  Note these
11635switches have no effect on how the compiler generates code to handle
11636function calls via function pointers.
11637
11638@item -mfast-fp
11639@opindex mfast-fp
11640Link with the fast floating-point library. This library relaxes some of
11641the IEEE floating-point standard's rules for checking inputs against
11642Not-a-Number (NAN), in the interest of performance.
11643
11644@item -minline-plt
11645@opindex minline-plt
11646Enable inlining of PLT entries in function calls to functions that are
11647not known to bind locally.  It has no effect without @option{-mfdpic}.
11648
11649@item -mmulticore
11650@opindex mmulticore
11651Build standalone application for multicore Blackfin processor. Proper
11652start files and link scripts will be used to support multicore.
11653This option defines @code{__BFIN_MULTICORE}. It can only be used with
11654@option{-mcpu=bf561@r{[}-@var{sirevision}@r{]}}. It can be used with
11655@option{-mcorea} or @option{-mcoreb}. If it's used without
11656@option{-mcorea} or @option{-mcoreb}, single application/dual core
11657programming model is used. In this model, the main function of Core B
11658should be named as coreb_main. If it's used with @option{-mcorea} or
11659@option{-mcoreb}, one application per core programming model is used.
11660If this option is not used, single core application programming
11661model is used.
11662
11663@item -mcorea
11664@opindex mcorea
11665Build standalone application for Core A of BF561 when using
11666one application per core programming model. Proper start files
11667and link scripts will be used to support Core A. This option
11668defines @code{__BFIN_COREA}. It must be used with @option{-mmulticore}.
11669
11670@item -mcoreb
11671@opindex mcoreb
11672Build standalone application for Core B of BF561 when using
11673one application per core programming model. Proper start files
11674and link scripts will be used to support Core B. This option
11675defines @code{__BFIN_COREB}. When this option is used, coreb_main
11676should be used instead of main. It must be used with
11677@option{-mmulticore}.
11678
11679@item -msdram
11680@opindex msdram
11681Build standalone application for SDRAM. Proper start files and
11682link scripts will be used to put the application into SDRAM.
11683Loader should initialize SDRAM before loading the application
11684into SDRAM. This option defines @code{__BFIN_SDRAM}.
11685
11686@item -micplb
11687@opindex micplb
11688Assume that ICPLBs are enabled at run time.  This has an effect on certain
11689anomaly workarounds.  For Linux targets, the default is to assume ICPLBs
11690are enabled; for standalone applications the default is off.
11691@end table
11692
11693@node C6X Options
11694@subsection C6X Options
11695@cindex C6X Options
11696
11697@table @gcctabopt
11698@item -march=@var{name}
11699@opindex march
11700This specifies the name of the target architecture.  GCC uses this
11701name to determine what kind of instructions it can emit when generating
11702assembly code.  Permissible names are: @samp{c62x},
11703@samp{c64x}, @samp{c64x+}, @samp{c67x}, @samp{c67x+}, @samp{c674x}.
11704
11705@item -mbig-endian
11706@opindex mbig-endian
11707Generate code for a big-endian target.
11708
11709@item -mlittle-endian
11710@opindex mlittle-endian
11711Generate code for a little-endian target.  This is the default.
11712
11713@item -msim
11714@opindex msim
11715Choose startup files and linker script suitable for the simulator.
11716
11717@item -msdata=default
11718@opindex msdata=default
11719Put small global and static data in the @samp{.neardata} section,
11720which is pointed to by register @code{B14}.  Put small uninitialized
11721global and static data in the @samp{.bss} section, which is adjacent
11722to the @samp{.neardata} section.  Put small read-only data into the
11723@samp{.rodata} section.  The corresponding sections used for large
11724pieces of data are @samp{.fardata}, @samp{.far} and @samp{.const}.
11725
11726@item -msdata=all
11727@opindex msdata=all
11728Put all data, not just small objets, into the sections reserved for
11729small data, and use addressing relative to the @code{B14} register to
11730access them.
11731
11732@item -msdata=none
11733@opindex msdata=none
11734Make no use of the sections reserved for small data, and use absolute
11735addresses to access all data.  Put all initialized global and static
11736data in the @samp{.fardata} section, and all uninitialized data in the
11737@samp{.far} section.  Put all constant data into the @samp{.const}
11738section.
11739@end table
11740
11741@node CRIS Options
11742@subsection CRIS Options
11743@cindex CRIS Options
11744
11745These options are defined specifically for the CRIS ports.
11746
11747@table @gcctabopt
11748@item -march=@var{architecture-type}
11749@itemx -mcpu=@var{architecture-type}
11750@opindex march
11751@opindex mcpu
11752Generate code for the specified architecture.  The choices for
11753@var{architecture-type} are @samp{v3}, @samp{v8} and @samp{v10} for
11754respectively ETRAX@w{ }4, ETRAX@w{ }100, and ETRAX@w{ }100@w{ }LX@.
11755Default is @samp{v0} except for cris-axis-linux-gnu, where the default is
11756@samp{v10}.
11757
11758@item -mtune=@var{architecture-type}
11759@opindex mtune
11760Tune to @var{architecture-type} everything applicable about the generated
11761code, except for the ABI and the set of available instructions.  The
11762choices for @var{architecture-type} are the same as for
11763@option{-march=@var{architecture-type}}.
11764
11765@item -mmax-stack-frame=@var{n}
11766@opindex mmax-stack-frame
11767Warn when the stack frame of a function exceeds @var{n} bytes.
11768
11769@item -metrax4
11770@itemx -metrax100
11771@opindex metrax4
11772@opindex metrax100
11773The options @option{-metrax4} and @option{-metrax100} are synonyms for
11774@option{-march=v3} and @option{-march=v8} respectively.
11775
11776@item -mmul-bug-workaround
11777@itemx -mno-mul-bug-workaround
11778@opindex mmul-bug-workaround
11779@opindex mno-mul-bug-workaround
11780Work around a bug in the @code{muls} and @code{mulu} instructions for CPU
11781models where it applies.  This option is active by default.
11782
11783@item -mpdebug
11784@opindex mpdebug
11785Enable CRIS-specific verbose debug-related information in the assembly
11786code.  This option also has the effect to turn off the @samp{#NO_APP}
11787formatted-code indicator to the assembler at the beginning of the
11788assembly file.
11789
11790@item -mcc-init
11791@opindex mcc-init
11792Do not use condition-code results from previous instruction; always emit
11793compare and test instructions before use of condition codes.
11794
11795@item -mno-side-effects
11796@opindex mno-side-effects
11797Do not emit instructions with side-effects in addressing modes other than
11798post-increment.
11799
11800@item -mstack-align
11801@itemx -mno-stack-align
11802@itemx -mdata-align
11803@itemx -mno-data-align
11804@itemx -mconst-align
11805@itemx -mno-const-align
11806@opindex mstack-align
11807@opindex mno-stack-align
11808@opindex mdata-align
11809@opindex mno-data-align
11810@opindex mconst-align
11811@opindex mno-const-align
11812These options (no-options) arranges (eliminate arrangements) for the
11813stack-frame, individual data and constants to be aligned for the maximum
11814single data access size for the chosen CPU model.  The default is to
11815arrange for 32-bit alignment.  ABI details such as structure layout are
11816not affected by these options.
11817
11818@item -m32-bit
11819@itemx -m16-bit
11820@itemx -m8-bit
11821@opindex m32-bit
11822@opindex m16-bit
11823@opindex m8-bit
11824Similar to the stack- data- and const-align options above, these options
11825arrange for stack-frame, writable data and constants to all be 32-bit,
1182616-bit or 8-bit aligned.  The default is 32-bit alignment.
11827
11828@item -mno-prologue-epilogue
11829@itemx -mprologue-epilogue
11830@opindex mno-prologue-epilogue
11831@opindex mprologue-epilogue
11832With @option{-mno-prologue-epilogue}, the normal function prologue and
11833epilogue which set up the stack frame are omitted and no return
11834instructions or return sequences are generated in the code.  Use this
11835option only together with visual inspection of the compiled code: no
11836warnings or errors are generated when call-saved registers must be saved,
11837or storage for local variable needs to be allocated.
11838
11839@item -mno-gotplt
11840@itemx -mgotplt
11841@opindex mno-gotplt
11842@opindex mgotplt
11843With @option{-fpic} and @option{-fPIC}, don't generate (do generate)
11844instruction sequences that load addresses for functions from the PLT part
11845of the GOT rather than (traditional on other architectures) calls to the
11846PLT@.  The default is @option{-mgotplt}.
11847
11848@item -melf
11849@opindex melf
11850Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-elf and
11851cris-axis-linux-gnu targets.
11852
11853@item -mlinux
11854@opindex mlinux
11855Legacy no-op option only recognized with the cris-axis-linux-gnu target.
11856
11857@item -sim
11858@opindex sim
11859This option, recognized for the cris-axis-elf arranges
11860to link with input-output functions from a simulator library.  Code,
11861initialized data and zero-initialized data are allocated consecutively.
11862
11863@item -sim2
11864@opindex sim2
11865Like @option{-sim}, but pass linker options to locate initialized data at
118660x40000000 and zero-initialized data at 0x80000000.
11867@end table
11868
11869@node CR16 Options
11870@subsection CR16 Options
11871@cindex CR16 Options
11872
11873These options are defined specifically for the CR16 ports.
11874
11875@table @gcctabopt
11876
11877@item -mmac
11878@opindex mmac
11879Enable the use of multiply-accumulate instructions. Disabled by default.
11880
11881@item -mcr16cplus
11882@itemx -mcr16c
11883@opindex mcr16cplus
11884@opindex mcr16c
11885Generate code for CR16C or CR16C+ architecture. CR16C+ architecture
11886is default.
11887
11888@item -msim
11889@opindex msim
11890Links the library libsim.a which is in compatible with simulator. Applicable
11891to elf compiler only.
11892
11893@item -mint32
11894@opindex mint32
11895Choose integer type as 32-bit wide.
11896
11897@item -mbit-ops
11898@opindex mbit-ops
11899Generates sbit/cbit instructions for bit manipulations.
11900
11901@item -mdata-model=@var{model}
11902@opindex mdata-model
11903Choose a data model. The choices for @var{model} are @samp{near},
11904@samp{far} or @samp{medium}. @samp{medium} is default.
11905However, @samp{far} is not valid when -mcr16c option is chosen as
11906CR16C architecture does not support far data model.
11907@end table
11908
11909@node Darwin Options
11910@subsection Darwin Options
11911@cindex Darwin options
11912
11913These options are defined for all architectures running the Darwin operating
11914system.
11915
11916FSF GCC on Darwin does not create ``fat'' object files; it will create
11917an object file for the single architecture that it was built to
11918target.  Apple's GCC on Darwin does create ``fat'' files if multiple
11919@option{-arch} options are used; it does so by running the compiler or
11920linker multiple times and joining the results together with
11921@file{lipo}.
11922
11923The subtype of the file created (like @samp{ppc7400} or @samp{ppc970} or
11924@samp{i686}) is determined by the flags that specify the ISA
11925that GCC is targetting, like @option{-mcpu} or @option{-march}.  The
11926@option{-force_cpusubtype_ALL} option can be used to override this.
11927
11928The Darwin tools vary in their behavior when presented with an ISA
11929mismatch.  The assembler, @file{as}, will only permit instructions to
11930be used that are valid for the subtype of the file it is generating,
11931so you cannot put 64-bit instructions in a @samp{ppc750} object file.
11932The linker for shared libraries, @file{/usr/bin/libtool}, will fail
11933and print an error if asked to create a shared library with a less
11934restrictive subtype than its input files (for instance, trying to put
11935a @samp{ppc970} object file in a @samp{ppc7400} library).  The linker
11936for executables, @file{ld}, will quietly give the executable the most
11937restrictive subtype of any of its input files.
11938
11939@table @gcctabopt
11940@item -F@var{dir}
11941@opindex F
11942Add the framework directory @var{dir} to the head of the list of
11943directories to be searched for header files.  These directories are
11944interleaved with those specified by @option{-I} options and are
11945scanned in a left-to-right order.
11946
11947A framework directory is a directory with frameworks in it.  A
11948framework is a directory with a @samp{"Headers"} and/or
11949@samp{"PrivateHeaders"} directory contained directly in it that ends
11950in @samp{".framework"}.  The name of a framework is the name of this
11951directory excluding the @samp{".framework"}.  Headers associated with
11952the framework are found in one of those two directories, with
11953@samp{"Headers"} being searched first.  A subframework is a framework
11954directory that is in a framework's @samp{"Frameworks"} directory.
11955Includes of subframework headers can only appear in a header of a
11956framework that contains the subframework, or in a sibling subframework
11957header.  Two subframeworks are siblings if they occur in the same
11958framework.  A subframework should not have the same name as a
11959framework, a warning will be issued if this is violated.  Currently a
11960subframework cannot have subframeworks, in the future, the mechanism
11961may be extended to support this.  The standard frameworks can be found
11962in @samp{"/System/Library/Frameworks"} and
11963@samp{"/Library/Frameworks"}.  An example include looks like
11964@code{#include <Framework/header.h>}, where @samp{Framework} denotes
11965the name of the framework and header.h is found in the
11966@samp{"PrivateHeaders"} or @samp{"Headers"} directory.
11967
11968@item -iframework@var{dir}
11969@opindex iframework
11970Like @option{-F} except the directory is a treated as a system
11971directory.  The main difference between this @option{-iframework} and
11972@option{-F} is that with @option{-iframework} the compiler does not
11973warn about constructs contained within header files found via
11974@var{dir}.  This option is valid only for the C family of languages.
11975
11976@item -gused
11977@opindex gused
11978Emit debugging information for symbols that are used.  For STABS
11979debugging format, this enables @option{-feliminate-unused-debug-symbols}.
11980This is by default ON@.
11981
11982@item -gfull
11983@opindex gfull
11984Emit debugging information for all symbols and types.
11985
11986@item -mmacosx-version-min=@var{version}
11987The earliest version of MacOS X that this executable will run on
11988is @var{version}.  Typical values of @var{version} include @code{10.1},
11989@code{10.2}, and @code{10.3.9}.
11990
11991If the compiler was built to use the system's headers by default,
11992then the default for this option is the system version on which the
11993compiler is running, otherwise the default is to make choices that
11994are compatible with as many systems and code bases as possible.
11995
11996@item -mkernel
11997@opindex mkernel
11998Enable kernel development mode.  The @option{-mkernel} option sets
11999@option{-static}, @option{-fno-common}, @option{-fno-cxa-atexit},
12000@option{-fno-exceptions}, @option{-fno-non-call-exceptions},
12001@option{-fapple-kext}, @option{-fno-weak} and @option{-fno-rtti} where
12002applicable.  This mode also sets @option{-mno-altivec},
12003@option{-msoft-float}, @option{-fno-builtin} and
12004@option{-mlong-branch} for PowerPC targets.
12005
12006@item -mone-byte-bool
12007@opindex mone-byte-bool
12008Override the defaults for @samp{bool} so that @samp{sizeof(bool)==1}.
12009By default @samp{sizeof(bool)} is @samp{4} when compiling for
12010Darwin/PowerPC and @samp{1} when compiling for Darwin/x86, so this
12011option has no effect on x86.
12012
12013@strong{Warning:} The @option{-mone-byte-bool} switch causes GCC
12014to generate code that is not binary compatible with code generated
12015without that switch.  Using this switch may require recompiling all
12016other modules in a program, including system libraries.  Use this
12017switch to conform to a non-default data model.
12018
12019@item -mfix-and-continue
12020@itemx -ffix-and-continue
12021@itemx -findirect-data
12022@opindex mfix-and-continue
12023@opindex ffix-and-continue
12024@opindex findirect-data
12025Generate code suitable for fast turn around development.  Needed to
12026enable gdb to dynamically load @code{.o} files into already running
12027programs.  @option{-findirect-data} and @option{-ffix-and-continue}
12028are provided for backwards compatibility.
12029
12030@item -all_load
12031@opindex all_load
12032Loads all members of static archive libraries.
12033See man ld(1) for more information.
12034
12035@item -arch_errors_fatal
12036@opindex arch_errors_fatal
12037Cause the errors having to do with files that have the wrong architecture
12038to be fatal.
12039
12040@item -bind_at_load
12041@opindex bind_at_load
12042Causes the output file to be marked such that the dynamic linker will
12043bind all undefined references when the file is loaded or launched.
12044
12045@item -bundle
12046@opindex bundle
12047Produce a Mach-o bundle format file.
12048See man ld(1) for more information.
12049
12050@item -bundle_loader @var{executable}
12051@opindex bundle_loader
12052This option specifies the @var{executable} that will be loading the build
12053output file being linked.  See man ld(1) for more information.
12054
12055@item -dynamiclib
12056@opindex dynamiclib
12057When passed this option, GCC will produce a dynamic library instead of
12058an executable when linking, using the Darwin @file{libtool} command.
12059
12060@item -force_cpusubtype_ALL
12061@opindex force_cpusubtype_ALL
12062This causes GCC's output file to have the @var{ALL} subtype, instead of
12063one controlled by the @option{-mcpu} or @option{-march} option.
12064
12065@item -allowable_client  @var{client_name}
12066@itemx -client_name
12067@itemx -compatibility_version
12068@itemx -current_version
12069@itemx -dead_strip
12070@itemx -dependency-file
12071@itemx -dylib_file
12072@itemx -dylinker_install_name
12073@itemx -dynamic
12074@itemx -exported_symbols_list
12075@itemx -filelist
12076@need 800
12077@itemx -flat_namespace
12078@itemx -force_flat_namespace
12079@itemx -headerpad_max_install_names
12080@itemx -image_base
12081@itemx -init
12082@itemx -install_name
12083@itemx -keep_private_externs
12084@itemx -multi_module
12085@itemx -multiply_defined
12086@itemx -multiply_defined_unused
12087@need 800
12088@itemx -noall_load
12089@itemx -no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms
12090@itemx -nofixprebinding
12091@itemx -nomultidefs
12092@itemx -noprebind
12093@itemx -noseglinkedit
12094@itemx -pagezero_size
12095@itemx -prebind
12096@itemx -prebind_all_twolevel_modules
12097@itemx -private_bundle
12098@need 800
12099@itemx -read_only_relocs
12100@itemx -sectalign
12101@itemx -sectobjectsymbols
12102@itemx -whyload
12103@itemx -seg1addr
12104@itemx -sectcreate
12105@itemx -sectobjectsymbols
12106@itemx -sectorder
12107@itemx -segaddr
12108@itemx -segs_read_only_addr
12109@need 800
12110@itemx -segs_read_write_addr
12111@itemx -seg_addr_table
12112@itemx -seg_addr_table_filename
12113@itemx -seglinkedit
12114@itemx -segprot
12115@itemx -segs_read_only_addr
12116@itemx -segs_read_write_addr
12117@itemx -single_module
12118@itemx -static
12119@itemx -sub_library
12120@need 800
12121@itemx -sub_umbrella
12122@itemx -twolevel_namespace
12123@itemx -umbrella
12124@itemx -undefined
12125@itemx -unexported_symbols_list
12126@itemx -weak_reference_mismatches
12127@itemx -whatsloaded
12128@opindex allowable_client
12129@opindex client_name
12130@opindex compatibility_version
12131@opindex current_version
12132@opindex dead_strip
12133@opindex dependency-file
12134@opindex dylib_file
12135@opindex dylinker_install_name
12136@opindex dynamic
12137@opindex exported_symbols_list
12138@opindex filelist
12139@opindex flat_namespace
12140@opindex force_flat_namespace
12141@opindex headerpad_max_install_names
12142@opindex image_base
12143@opindex init
12144@opindex install_name
12145@opindex keep_private_externs
12146@opindex multi_module
12147@opindex multiply_defined
12148@opindex multiply_defined_unused
12149@opindex noall_load
12150@opindex no_dead_strip_inits_and_terms
12151@opindex nofixprebinding
12152@opindex nomultidefs
12153@opindex noprebind
12154@opindex noseglinkedit
12155@opindex pagezero_size
12156@opindex prebind
12157@opindex prebind_all_twolevel_modules
12158@opindex private_bundle
12159@opindex read_only_relocs
12160@opindex sectalign
12161@opindex sectobjectsymbols
12162@opindex whyload
12163@opindex seg1addr
12164@opindex sectcreate
12165@opindex sectobjectsymbols
12166@opindex sectorder
12167@opindex segaddr
12168@opindex segs_read_only_addr
12169@opindex segs_read_write_addr
12170@opindex seg_addr_table
12171@opindex seg_addr_table_filename
12172@opindex seglinkedit
12173@opindex segprot
12174@opindex segs_read_only_addr
12175@opindex segs_read_write_addr
12176@opindex single_module
12177@opindex static
12178@opindex sub_library
12179@opindex sub_umbrella
12180@opindex twolevel_namespace
12181@opindex umbrella
12182@opindex undefined
12183@opindex unexported_symbols_list
12184@opindex weak_reference_mismatches
12185@opindex whatsloaded
12186These options are passed to the Darwin linker.  The Darwin linker man page
12187describes them in detail.
12188@end table
12189
12190@node DEC Alpha Options
12191@subsection DEC Alpha Options
12192
12193These @samp{-m} options are defined for the DEC Alpha implementations:
12194
12195@table @gcctabopt
12196@item -mno-soft-float
12197@itemx -msoft-float
12198@opindex mno-soft-float
12199@opindex msoft-float
12200Use (do not use) the hardware floating-point instructions for
12201floating-point operations.  When @option{-msoft-float} is specified,
12202functions in @file{libgcc.a} will be used to perform floating-point
12203operations.  Unless they are replaced by routines that emulate the
12204floating-point operations, or compiled in such a way as to call such
12205emulations routines, these routines will issue floating-point
12206operations.   If you are compiling for an Alpha without floating-point
12207operations, you must ensure that the library is built so as not to call
12208them.
12209
12210Note that Alpha implementations without floating-point operations are
12211required to have floating-point registers.
12212
12213@item -mfp-reg
12214@itemx -mno-fp-regs
12215@opindex mfp-reg
12216@opindex mno-fp-regs
12217Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point register set.
12218@option{-mno-fp-regs} implies @option{-msoft-float}.  If the floating-point
12219register set is not used, floating-point operands are passed in integer
12220registers as if they were integers and floating-point results are passed
12221in @code{$0} instead of @code{$f0}.  This is a non-standard calling sequence,
12222so any function with a floating-point argument or return value called by code
12223compiled with @option{-mno-fp-regs} must also be compiled with that
12224option.
12225
12226A typical use of this option is building a kernel that does not use,
12227and hence need not save and restore, any floating-point registers.
12228
12229@item -mieee
12230@opindex mieee
12231The Alpha architecture implements floating-point hardware optimized for
12232maximum performance.  It is mostly compliant with the IEEE floating-point
12233standard.  However, for full compliance, software assistance is
12234required.  This option generates code fully IEEE-compliant code
12235@emph{except} that the @var{inexact-flag} is not maintained (see below).
12236If this option is turned on, the preprocessor macro @code{_IEEE_FP} is
12237defined during compilation.  The resulting code is less efficient but is
12238able to correctly support denormalized numbers and exceptional IEEE
12239values such as not-a-number and plus/minus infinity.  Other Alpha
12240compilers call this option @option{-ieee_with_no_inexact}.
12241
12242@item -mieee-with-inexact
12243@opindex mieee-with-inexact
12244This is like @option{-mieee} except the generated code also maintains
12245the IEEE @var{inexact-flag}.  Turning on this option causes the
12246generated code to implement fully-compliant IEEE math.  In addition to
12247@code{_IEEE_FP}, @code{_IEEE_FP_EXACT} is defined as a preprocessor
12248macro.  On some Alpha implementations the resulting code may execute
12249significantly slower than the code generated by default.  Since there is
12250very little code that depends on the @var{inexact-flag}, you should
12251normally not specify this option.  Other Alpha compilers call this
12252option @option{-ieee_with_inexact}.
12253
12254@item -mfp-trap-mode=@var{trap-mode}
12255@opindex mfp-trap-mode
12256This option controls what floating-point related traps are enabled.
12257Other Alpha compilers call this option @option{-fptm @var{trap-mode}}.
12258The trap mode can be set to one of four values:
12259
12260@table @samp
12261@item n
12262This is the default (normal) setting.  The only traps that are enabled
12263are the ones that cannot be disabled in software (e.g., division by zero
12264trap).
12265
12266@item u
12267In addition to the traps enabled by @samp{n}, underflow traps are enabled
12268as well.
12269
12270@item su
12271Like @samp{u}, but the instructions are marked to be safe for software
12272completion (see Alpha architecture manual for details).
12273
12274@item sui
12275Like @samp{su}, but inexact traps are enabled as well.
12276@end table
12277
12278@item -mfp-rounding-mode=@var{rounding-mode}
12279@opindex mfp-rounding-mode
12280Selects the IEEE rounding mode.  Other Alpha compilers call this option
12281@option{-fprm @var{rounding-mode}}.  The @var{rounding-mode} can be one
12282of:
12283
12284@table @samp
12285@item n
12286Normal IEEE rounding mode.  Floating-point numbers are rounded towards
12287the nearest machine number or towards the even machine number in case
12288of a tie.
12289
12290@item m
12291Round towards minus infinity.
12292
12293@item c
12294Chopped rounding mode.  Floating-point numbers are rounded towards zero.
12295
12296@item d
12297Dynamic rounding mode.  A field in the floating-point control register
12298(@var{fpcr}, see Alpha architecture reference manual) controls the
12299rounding mode in effect.  The C library initializes this register for
12300rounding towards plus infinity.  Thus, unless your program modifies the
12301@var{fpcr}, @samp{d} corresponds to round towards plus infinity.
12302@end table
12303
12304@item -mtrap-precision=@var{trap-precision}
12305@opindex mtrap-precision
12306In the Alpha architecture, floating-point traps are imprecise.  This
12307means without software assistance it is impossible to recover from a
12308floating trap and program execution normally needs to be terminated.
12309GCC can generate code that can assist operating system trap handlers
12310in determining the exact location that caused a floating-point trap.
12311Depending on the requirements of an application, different levels of
12312precisions can be selected:
12313
12314@table @samp
12315@item p
12316Program precision.  This option is the default and means a trap handler
12317can only identify which program caused a floating-point exception.
12318
12319@item f
12320Function precision.  The trap handler can determine the function that
12321caused a floating-point exception.
12322
12323@item i
12324Instruction precision.  The trap handler can determine the exact
12325instruction that caused a floating-point exception.
12326@end table
12327
12328Other Alpha compilers provide the equivalent options called
12329@option{-scope_safe} and @option{-resumption_safe}.
12330
12331@item -mieee-conformant
12332@opindex mieee-conformant
12333This option marks the generated code as IEEE conformant.  You must not
12334use this option unless you also specify @option{-mtrap-precision=i} and either
12335@option{-mfp-trap-mode=su} or @option{-mfp-trap-mode=sui}.  Its only effect
12336is to emit the line @samp{.eflag 48} in the function prologue of the
12337generated assembly file.  Under DEC Unix, this has the effect that
12338IEEE-conformant math library routines will be linked in.
12339
12340@item -mbuild-constants
12341@opindex mbuild-constants
12342Normally GCC examines a 32- or 64-bit integer constant to
12343see if it can construct it from smaller constants in two or three
12344instructions.  If it cannot, it will output the constant as a literal and
12345generate code to load it from the data segment at run time.
12346
12347Use this option to require GCC to construct @emph{all} integer constants
12348using code, even if it takes more instructions (the maximum is six).
12349
12350You would typically use this option to build a shared library dynamic
12351loader.  Itself a shared library, it must relocate itself in memory
12352before it can find the variables and constants in its own data segment.
12353
12354@item -malpha-as
12355@itemx -mgas
12356@opindex malpha-as
12357@opindex mgas
12358Select whether to generate code to be assembled by the vendor-supplied
12359assembler (@option{-malpha-as}) or by the GNU assembler @option{-mgas}.
12360
12361@item -mbwx
12362@itemx -mno-bwx
12363@itemx -mcix
12364@itemx -mno-cix
12365@itemx -mfix
12366@itemx -mno-fix
12367@itemx -mmax
12368@itemx -mno-max
12369@opindex mbwx
12370@opindex mno-bwx
12371@opindex mcix
12372@opindex mno-cix
12373@opindex mfix
12374@opindex mno-fix
12375@opindex mmax
12376@opindex mno-max
12377Indicate whether GCC should generate code to use the optional BWX,
12378CIX, FIX and MAX instruction sets.  The default is to use the instruction
12379sets supported by the CPU type specified via @option{-mcpu=} option or that
12380of the CPU on which GCC was built if none was specified.
12381
12382@item -mfloat-vax
12383@itemx -mfloat-ieee
12384@opindex mfloat-vax
12385@opindex mfloat-ieee
12386Generate code that uses (does not use) VAX F and G floating-point
12387arithmetic instead of IEEE single and double precision.
12388
12389@item -mexplicit-relocs
12390@itemx -mno-explicit-relocs
12391@opindex mexplicit-relocs
12392@opindex mno-explicit-relocs
12393Older Alpha assemblers provided no way to generate symbol relocations
12394except via assembler macros.  Use of these macros does not allow
12395optimal instruction scheduling.  GNU binutils as of version 2.12
12396supports a new syntax that allows the compiler to explicitly mark
12397which relocations should apply to which instructions.  This option
12398is mostly useful for debugging, as GCC detects the capabilities of
12399the assembler when it is built and sets the default accordingly.
12400
12401@item -msmall-data
12402@itemx -mlarge-data
12403@opindex msmall-data
12404@opindex mlarge-data
12405When @option{-mexplicit-relocs} is in effect, static data is
12406accessed via @dfn{gp-relative} relocations.  When @option{-msmall-data}
12407is used, objects 8 bytes long or smaller are placed in a @dfn{small data area}
12408(the @code{.sdata} and @code{.sbss} sections) and are accessed via
1240916-bit relocations off of the @code{$gp} register.  This limits the
12410size of the small data area to 64KB, but allows the variables to be
12411directly accessed via a single instruction.
12412
12413The default is @option{-mlarge-data}.  With this option the data area
12414is limited to just below 2GB@.  Programs that require more than 2GB of
12415data must use @code{malloc} or @code{mmap} to allocate the data in the
12416heap instead of in the program's data segment.
12417
12418When generating code for shared libraries, @option{-fpic} implies
12419@option{-msmall-data} and @option{-fPIC} implies @option{-mlarge-data}.
12420
12421@item -msmall-text
12422@itemx -mlarge-text
12423@opindex msmall-text
12424@opindex mlarge-text
12425When @option{-msmall-text} is used, the compiler assumes that the
12426code of the entire program (or shared library) fits in 4MB, and is
12427thus reachable with a branch instruction.  When @option{-msmall-data}
12428is used, the compiler can assume that all local symbols share the
12429same @code{$gp} value, and thus reduce the number of instructions
12430required for a function call from 4 to 1.
12431
12432The default is @option{-mlarge-text}.
12433
12434@item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
12435@opindex mcpu
12436Set the instruction set and instruction scheduling parameters for
12437machine type @var{cpu_type}.  You can specify either the @samp{EV}
12438style name or the corresponding chip number.  GCC supports scheduling
12439parameters for the EV4, EV5 and EV6 family of processors and will
12440choose the default values for the instruction set from the processor
12441you specify.  If you do not specify a processor type, GCC will default
12442to the processor on which the compiler was built.
12443
12444Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are
12445
12446@table @samp
12447@item ev4
12448@itemx ev45
12449@itemx 21064
12450Schedules as an EV4 and has no instruction set extensions.
12451
12452@item ev5
12453@itemx 21164
12454Schedules as an EV5 and has no instruction set extensions.
12455
12456@item ev56
12457@itemx 21164a
12458Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX extension.
12459
12460@item pca56
12461@itemx 21164pc
12462@itemx 21164PC
12463Schedules as an EV5 and supports the BWX and MAX extensions.
12464
12465@item ev6
12466@itemx 21264
12467Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, FIX, and MAX extensions.
12468
12469@item ev67
12470@itemx 21264a
12471Schedules as an EV6 and supports the BWX, CIX, FIX, and MAX extensions.
12472@end table
12473
12474Native toolchains also support the value @samp{native},
12475which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
12476@option{-mcpu=native} has no effect if GCC does not recognize
12477the processor.
12478
12479@item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
12480@opindex mtune
12481Set only the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
12482@var{cpu_type}.  The instruction set is not changed.
12483
12484Native toolchains also support the value @samp{native},
12485which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
12486@option{-mtune=native} has no effect if GCC does not recognize
12487the processor.
12488
12489@item -mmemory-latency=@var{time}
12490@opindex mmemory-latency
12491Sets the latency the scheduler should assume for typical memory
12492references as seen by the application.  This number is highly
12493dependent on the memory access patterns used by the application
12494and the size of the external cache on the machine.
12495
12496Valid options for @var{time} are
12497
12498@table @samp
12499@item @var{number}
12500A decimal number representing clock cycles.
12501
12502@item L1
12503@itemx L2
12504@itemx L3
12505@itemx main
12506The compiler contains estimates of the number of clock cycles for
12507``typical'' EV4 & EV5 hardware for the Level 1, 2 & 3 caches
12508(also called Dcache, Scache, and Bcache), as well as to main memory.
12509Note that L3 is only valid for EV5.
12510
12511@end table
12512@end table
12513
12514@node DEC Alpha/VMS Options
12515@subsection DEC Alpha/VMS Options
12516
12517These @samp{-m} options are defined for the DEC Alpha/VMS implementations:
12518
12519@table @gcctabopt
12520@item -mvms-return-codes
12521@opindex mvms-return-codes
12522Return VMS condition codes from main.  The default is to return POSIX
12523style condition (e.g.@: error) codes.
12524
12525@item -mdebug-main=@var{prefix}
12526@opindex mdebug-main=@var{prefix}
12527Flag the first routine whose name starts with @var{prefix} as the main
12528routine for the debugger.
12529
12530@item -mmalloc64
12531@opindex mmalloc64
12532Default to 64-bit memory allocation routines.
12533@end table
12534
12535@node FR30 Options
12536@subsection FR30 Options
12537@cindex FR30 Options
12538
12539These options are defined specifically for the FR30 port.
12540
12541@table @gcctabopt
12542
12543@item -msmall-model
12544@opindex msmall-model
12545Use the small address space model.  This can produce smaller code, but
12546it does assume that all symbolic values and addresses will fit into a
1254720-bit range.
12548
12549@item -mno-lsim
12550@opindex mno-lsim
12551Assume that runtime support has been provided and so there is no need
12552to include the simulator library (@file{libsim.a}) on the linker
12553command line.
12554
12555@end table
12556
12557@node FRV Options
12558@subsection FRV Options
12559@cindex FRV Options
12560
12561@table @gcctabopt
12562@item -mgpr-32
12563@opindex mgpr-32
12564
12565Only use the first 32 general-purpose registers.
12566
12567@item -mgpr-64
12568@opindex mgpr-64
12569
12570Use all 64 general-purpose registers.
12571
12572@item -mfpr-32
12573@opindex mfpr-32
12574
12575Use only the first 32 floating-point registers.
12576
12577@item -mfpr-64
12578@opindex mfpr-64
12579
12580Use all 64 floating-point registers.
12581
12582@item -mhard-float
12583@opindex mhard-float
12584
12585Use hardware instructions for floating-point operations.
12586
12587@item -msoft-float
12588@opindex msoft-float
12589
12590Use library routines for floating-point operations.
12591
12592@item -malloc-cc
12593@opindex malloc-cc
12594
12595Dynamically allocate condition code registers.
12596
12597@item -mfixed-cc
12598@opindex mfixed-cc
12599
12600Do not try to dynamically allocate condition code registers, only
12601use @code{icc0} and @code{fcc0}.
12602
12603@item -mdword
12604@opindex mdword
12605
12606Change ABI to use double word insns.
12607
12608@item -mno-dword
12609@opindex mno-dword
12610
12611Do not use double word instructions.
12612
12613@item -mdouble
12614@opindex mdouble
12615
12616Use floating-point double instructions.
12617
12618@item -mno-double
12619@opindex mno-double
12620
12621Do not use floating-point double instructions.
12622
12623@item -mmedia
12624@opindex mmedia
12625
12626Use media instructions.
12627
12628@item -mno-media
12629@opindex mno-media
12630
12631Do not use media instructions.
12632
12633@item -mmuladd
12634@opindex mmuladd
12635
12636Use multiply and add/subtract instructions.
12637
12638@item -mno-muladd
12639@opindex mno-muladd
12640
12641Do not use multiply and add/subtract instructions.
12642
12643@item -mfdpic
12644@opindex mfdpic
12645
12646Select the FDPIC ABI, which uses function descriptors to represent
12647pointers to functions.  Without any PIC/PIE-related options, it
12648implies @option{-fPIE}.  With @option{-fpic} or @option{-fpie}, it
12649assumes GOT entries and small data are within a 12-bit range from the
12650GOT base address; with @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIE}, GOT offsets
12651are computed with 32 bits.
12652With a @samp{bfin-elf} target, this option implies @option{-msim}.
12653
12654@item -minline-plt
12655@opindex minline-plt
12656
12657Enable inlining of PLT entries in function calls to functions that are
12658not known to bind locally.  It has no effect without @option{-mfdpic}.
12659It's enabled by default if optimizing for speed and compiling for
12660shared libraries (i.e., @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fpic}), or when an
12661optimization option such as @option{-O3} or above is present in the
12662command line.
12663
12664@item -mTLS
12665@opindex mTLS
12666
12667Assume a large TLS segment when generating thread-local code.
12668
12669@item -mtls
12670@opindex mtls
12671
12672Do not assume a large TLS segment when generating thread-local code.
12673
12674@item -mgprel-ro
12675@opindex mgprel-ro
12676
12677Enable the use of @code{GPREL} relocations in the FDPIC ABI for data
12678that is known to be in read-only sections.  It's enabled by default,
12679except for @option{-fpic} or @option{-fpie}: even though it may help
12680make the global offset table smaller, it trades 1 instruction for 4.
12681With @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIE}, it trades 3 instructions for 4,
12682one of which may be shared by multiple symbols, and it avoids the need
12683for a GOT entry for the referenced symbol, so it's more likely to be a
12684win.  If it is not, @option{-mno-gprel-ro} can be used to disable it.
12685
12686@item -multilib-library-pic
12687@opindex multilib-library-pic
12688
12689Link with the (library, not FD) pic libraries.  It's implied by
12690@option{-mlibrary-pic}, as well as by @option{-fPIC} and
12691@option{-fpic} without @option{-mfdpic}.  You should never have to use
12692it explicitly.
12693
12694@item -mlinked-fp
12695@opindex mlinked-fp
12696
12697Follow the EABI requirement of always creating a frame pointer whenever
12698a stack frame is allocated.  This option is enabled by default and can
12699be disabled with @option{-mno-linked-fp}.
12700
12701@item -mlong-calls
12702@opindex mlong-calls
12703
12704Use indirect addressing to call functions outside the current
12705compilation unit.  This allows the functions to be placed anywhere
12706within the 32-bit address space.
12707
12708@item -malign-labels
12709@opindex malign-labels
12710
12711Try to align labels to an 8-byte boundary by inserting nops into the
12712previous packet.  This option only has an effect when VLIW packing
12713is enabled.  It doesn't create new packets; it merely adds nops to
12714existing ones.
12715
12716@item -mlibrary-pic
12717@opindex mlibrary-pic
12718
12719Generate position-independent EABI code.
12720
12721@item -macc-4
12722@opindex macc-4
12723
12724Use only the first four media accumulator registers.
12725
12726@item -macc-8
12727@opindex macc-8
12728
12729Use all eight media accumulator registers.
12730
12731@item -mpack
12732@opindex mpack
12733
12734Pack VLIW instructions.
12735
12736@item -mno-pack
12737@opindex mno-pack
12738
12739Do not pack VLIW instructions.
12740
12741@item -mno-eflags
12742@opindex mno-eflags
12743
12744Do not mark ABI switches in e_flags.
12745
12746@item -mcond-move
12747@opindex mcond-move
12748
12749Enable the use of conditional-move instructions (default).
12750
12751This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12752in a future version.
12753
12754@item -mno-cond-move
12755@opindex mno-cond-move
12756
12757Disable the use of conditional-move instructions.
12758
12759This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12760in a future version.
12761
12762@item -mscc
12763@opindex mscc
12764
12765Enable the use of conditional set instructions (default).
12766
12767This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12768in a future version.
12769
12770@item -mno-scc
12771@opindex mno-scc
12772
12773Disable the use of conditional set instructions.
12774
12775This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12776in a future version.
12777
12778@item -mcond-exec
12779@opindex mcond-exec
12780
12781Enable the use of conditional execution (default).
12782
12783This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12784in a future version.
12785
12786@item -mno-cond-exec
12787@opindex mno-cond-exec
12788
12789Disable the use of conditional execution.
12790
12791This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12792in a future version.
12793
12794@item -mvliw-branch
12795@opindex mvliw-branch
12796
12797Run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions (default).
12798
12799This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12800in a future version.
12801
12802@item -mno-vliw-branch
12803@opindex mno-vliw-branch
12804
12805Do not run a pass to pack branches into VLIW instructions.
12806
12807This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12808in a future version.
12809
12810@item -mmulti-cond-exec
12811@opindex mmulti-cond-exec
12812
12813Enable optimization of @code{&&} and @code{||} in conditional execution
12814(default).
12815
12816This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12817in a future version.
12818
12819@item -mno-multi-cond-exec
12820@opindex mno-multi-cond-exec
12821
12822Disable optimization of @code{&&} and @code{||} in conditional execution.
12823
12824This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12825in a future version.
12826
12827@item -mnested-cond-exec
12828@opindex mnested-cond-exec
12829
12830Enable nested conditional execution optimizations (default).
12831
12832This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12833in a future version.
12834
12835@item -mno-nested-cond-exec
12836@opindex mno-nested-cond-exec
12837
12838Disable nested conditional execution optimizations.
12839
12840This switch is mainly for debugging the compiler and will likely be removed
12841in a future version.
12842
12843@item -moptimize-membar
12844@opindex moptimize-membar
12845
12846This switch removes redundant @code{membar} instructions from the
12847compiler generated code.  It is enabled by default.
12848
12849@item -mno-optimize-membar
12850@opindex mno-optimize-membar
12851
12852This switch disables the automatic removal of redundant @code{membar}
12853instructions from the generated code.
12854
12855@item -mtomcat-stats
12856@opindex mtomcat-stats
12857
12858Cause gas to print out tomcat statistics.
12859
12860@item -mcpu=@var{cpu}
12861@opindex mcpu
12862
12863Select the processor type for which to generate code.  Possible values are
12864@samp{frv}, @samp{fr550}, @samp{tomcat}, @samp{fr500}, @samp{fr450},
12865@samp{fr405}, @samp{fr400}, @samp{fr300} and @samp{simple}.
12866
12867@end table
12868
12869@node GNU/Linux Options
12870@subsection GNU/Linux Options
12871
12872These @samp{-m} options are defined for GNU/Linux targets:
12873
12874@table @gcctabopt
12875@item -mglibc
12876@opindex mglibc
12877Use the GNU C library.  This is the default except
12878on @samp{*-*-linux-*uclibc*} and @samp{*-*-linux-*android*} targets.
12879
12880@item -muclibc
12881@opindex muclibc
12882Use uClibc C library.  This is the default on
12883@samp{*-*-linux-*uclibc*} targets.
12884
12885@item -mbionic
12886@opindex mbionic
12887Use Bionic C library.  This is the default on
12888@samp{*-*-linux-*android*} targets.
12889
12890@item -mandroid
12891@opindex mandroid
12892Compile code compatible with Android platform.  This is the default on
12893@samp{*-*-linux-*android*} targets.
12894
12895When compiling, this option enables @option{-mbionic}, @option{-fPIC},
12896@option{-fno-exceptions} and @option{-fno-rtti} by default.  When linking,
12897this option makes the GCC driver pass Android-specific options to the linker.
12898Finally, this option causes the preprocessor macro @code{__ANDROID__}
12899to be defined.
12900
12901@item -tno-android-cc
12902@opindex tno-android-cc
12903Disable compilation effects of @option{-mandroid}, i.e., do not enable
12904@option{-mbionic}, @option{-fPIC}, @option{-fno-exceptions} and
12905@option{-fno-rtti} by default.
12906
12907@item -tno-android-ld
12908@opindex tno-android-ld
12909Disable linking effects of @option{-mandroid}, i.e., pass standard Linux
12910linking options to the linker.
12911
12912@end table
12913
12914@node H8/300 Options
12915@subsection H8/300 Options
12916
12917These @samp{-m} options are defined for the H8/300 implementations:
12918
12919@table @gcctabopt
12920@item -mrelax
12921@opindex mrelax
12922Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses the
12923linker option @option{-relax}.  @xref{H8/300,, @code{ld} and the H8/300,
12924ld, Using ld}, for a fuller description.
12925
12926@item -mh
12927@opindex mh
12928Generate code for the H8/300H@.
12929
12930@item -ms
12931@opindex ms
12932Generate code for the H8S@.
12933
12934@item -mn
12935@opindex mn
12936Generate code for the H8S and H8/300H in the normal mode.  This switch
12937must be used either with @option{-mh} or @option{-ms}.
12938
12939@item -ms2600
12940@opindex ms2600
12941Generate code for the H8S/2600.  This switch must be used with @option{-ms}.
12942
12943@item -mint32
12944@opindex mint32
12945Make @code{int} data 32 bits by default.
12946
12947@item -malign-300
12948@opindex malign-300
12949On the H8/300H and H8S, use the same alignment rules as for the H8/300.
12950The default for the H8/300H and H8S is to align longs and floats on
129514-byte boundaries.
12952@option{-malign-300} causes them to be aligned on 2-byte boundaries.
12953This option has no effect on the H8/300.
12954@end table
12955
12956@node HPPA Options
12957@subsection HPPA Options
12958@cindex HPPA Options
12959
12960These @samp{-m} options are defined for the HPPA family of computers:
12961
12962@table @gcctabopt
12963@item -march=@var{architecture-type}
12964@opindex march
12965Generate code for the specified architecture.  The choices for
12966@var{architecture-type} are @samp{1.0} for PA 1.0, @samp{1.1} for PA
129671.1, and @samp{2.0} for PA 2.0 processors.  Refer to
12968@file{/usr/lib/sched.models} on an HP-UX system to determine the proper
12969architecture option for your machine.  Code compiled for lower numbered
12970architectures will run on higher numbered architectures, but not the
12971other way around.
12972
12973@item -mpa-risc-1-0
12974@itemx -mpa-risc-1-1
12975@itemx -mpa-risc-2-0
12976@opindex mpa-risc-1-0
12977@opindex mpa-risc-1-1
12978@opindex mpa-risc-2-0
12979Synonyms for @option{-march=1.0}, @option{-march=1.1}, and @option{-march=2.0} respectively.
12980
12981@item -mbig-switch
12982@opindex mbig-switch
12983Generate code suitable for big switch tables.  Use this option only if
12984the assembler/linker complain about out of range branches within a switch
12985table.
12986
12987@item -mjump-in-delay
12988@opindex mjump-in-delay
12989Fill delay slots of function calls with unconditional jump instructions
12990by modifying the return pointer for the function call to be the target
12991of the conditional jump.
12992
12993@item -mdisable-fpregs
12994@opindex mdisable-fpregs
12995Prevent floating-point registers from being used in any manner.  This is
12996necessary for compiling kernels that perform lazy context switching of
12997floating-point registers.  If you use this option and attempt to perform
12998floating-point operations, the compiler aborts.
12999
13000@item -mdisable-indexing
13001@opindex mdisable-indexing
13002Prevent the compiler from using indexing address modes.  This avoids some
13003rather obscure problems when compiling MIG generated code under MACH@.
13004
13005@item -mno-space-regs
13006@opindex mno-space-regs
13007Generate code that assumes the target has no space registers.  This allows
13008GCC to generate faster indirect calls and use unscaled index address modes.
13009
13010Such code is suitable for level 0 PA systems and kernels.
13011
13012@item -mfast-indirect-calls
13013@opindex mfast-indirect-calls
13014Generate code that assumes calls never cross space boundaries.  This
13015allows GCC to emit code that performs faster indirect calls.
13016
13017This option will not work in the presence of shared libraries or nested
13018functions.
13019
13020@item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
13021@opindex mfixed-range
13022Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
13023A fixed register is one that the register allocator can not use.  This is
13024useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is specified as
13025two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be
13026specified separated by a comma.
13027
13028@item -mlong-load-store
13029@opindex mlong-load-store
13030Generate 3-instruction load and store sequences as sometimes required by
13031the HP-UX 10 linker.  This is equivalent to the @samp{+k} option to
13032the HP compilers.
13033
13034@item -mportable-runtime
13035@opindex mportable-runtime
13036Use the portable calling conventions proposed by HP for ELF systems.
13037
13038@item -mgas
13039@opindex mgas
13040Enable the use of assembler directives only GAS understands.
13041
13042@item -mschedule=@var{cpu-type}
13043@opindex mschedule
13044Schedule code according to the constraints for the machine type
13045@var{cpu-type}.  The choices for @var{cpu-type} are @samp{700}
13046@samp{7100}, @samp{7100LC}, @samp{7200}, @samp{7300} and @samp{8000}.  Refer
13047to @file{/usr/lib/sched.models} on an HP-UX system to determine the
13048proper scheduling option for your machine.  The default scheduling is
13049@samp{8000}.
13050
13051@item -mlinker-opt
13052@opindex mlinker-opt
13053Enable the optimization pass in the HP-UX linker.  Note this makes symbolic
13054debugging impossible.  It also triggers a bug in the HP-UX 8 and HP-UX 9
13055linkers in which they give bogus error messages when linking some programs.
13056
13057@item -msoft-float
13058@opindex msoft-float
13059Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
13060@strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not available for all HPPA
13061targets.  Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
13062used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make
13063your own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
13064cross-compilation.
13065
13066@option{-msoft-float} changes the calling convention in the output file;
13067therefore, it is only useful if you compile @emph{all} of a program with
13068this option.  In particular, you need to compile @file{libgcc.a}, the
13069library that comes with GCC, with @option{-msoft-float} in order for
13070this to work.
13071
13072@item -msio
13073@opindex msio
13074Generate the predefine, @code{_SIO}, for server IO@.  The default is
13075@option{-mwsio}.  This generates the predefines, @code{__hp9000s700},
13076@code{__hp9000s700__} and @code{_WSIO}, for workstation IO@.  These
13077options are available under HP-UX and HI-UX@.
13078
13079@item -mgnu-ld
13080@opindex mgnu-ld
13081Use GNU ld specific options.  This passes @option{-shared} to ld when
13082building a shared library.  It is the default when GCC is configured,
13083explicitly or implicitly, with the GNU linker.  This option does not
13084have any affect on which ld is called, it only changes what parameters
13085are passed to that ld.  The ld that is called is determined by the
13086@option{--with-ld} configure option, GCC's program search path, and
13087finally by the user's @env{PATH}.  The linker used by GCC can be printed
13088using @samp{which `gcc -print-prog-name=ld`}.  This option is only available
13089on the 64-bit HP-UX GCC, i.e.@: configured with @samp{hppa*64*-*-hpux*}.
13090
13091@item -mhp-ld
13092@opindex mhp-ld
13093Use HP ld specific options.  This passes @option{-b} to ld when building
13094a shared library and passes @option{+Accept TypeMismatch} to ld on all
13095links.  It is the default when GCC is configured, explicitly or
13096implicitly, with the HP linker.  This option does not have any affect on
13097which ld is called, it only changes what parameters are passed to that
13098ld.  The ld that is called is determined by the @option{--with-ld}
13099configure option, GCC's program search path, and finally by the user's
13100@env{PATH}.  The linker used by GCC can be printed using @samp{which
13101`gcc -print-prog-name=ld`}.  This option is only available on the 64-bit
13102HP-UX GCC, i.e.@: configured with @samp{hppa*64*-*-hpux*}.
13103
13104@item -mlong-calls
13105@opindex mno-long-calls
13106Generate code that uses long call sequences.  This ensures that a call
13107is always able to reach linker generated stubs.  The default is to generate
13108long calls only when the distance from the call site to the beginning
13109of the function or translation unit, as the case may be, exceeds a
13110predefined limit set by the branch type being used.  The limits for
13111normal calls are 7,600,000 and 240,000 bytes, respectively for the
13112PA 2.0 and PA 1.X architectures.  Sibcalls are always limited at
13113240,000 bytes.
13114
13115Distances are measured from the beginning of functions when using the
13116@option{-ffunction-sections} option, or when using the @option{-mgas}
13117and @option{-mno-portable-runtime} options together under HP-UX with
13118the SOM linker.
13119
13120It is normally not desirable to use this option as it will degrade
13121performance.  However, it may be useful in large applications,
13122particularly when partial linking is used to build the application.
13123
13124The types of long calls used depends on the capabilities of the
13125assembler and linker, and the type of code being generated.  The
13126impact on systems that support long absolute calls, and long pic
13127symbol-difference or pc-relative calls should be relatively small.
13128However, an indirect call is used on 32-bit ELF systems in pic code
13129and it is quite long.
13130
13131@item -munix=@var{unix-std}
13132@opindex march
13133Generate compiler predefines and select a startfile for the specified
13134UNIX standard.  The choices for @var{unix-std} are @samp{93}, @samp{95}
13135and @samp{98}.  @samp{93} is supported on all HP-UX versions.  @samp{95}
13136is available on HP-UX 10.10 and later.  @samp{98} is available on HP-UX
1313711.11 and later.  The default values are @samp{93} for HP-UX 10.00,
13138@samp{95} for HP-UX 10.10 though to 11.00, and @samp{98} for HP-UX 11.11
13139and later.
13140
13141@option{-munix=93} provides the same predefines as GCC 3.3 and 3.4.
13142@option{-munix=95} provides additional predefines for @code{XOPEN_UNIX}
13143and @code{_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED}, and the startfile @file{unix95.o}.
13144@option{-munix=98} provides additional predefines for @code{_XOPEN_UNIX},
13145@code{_XOPEN_SOURCE_EXTENDED}, @code{_INCLUDE__STDC_A1_SOURCE} and
13146@code{_INCLUDE_XOPEN_SOURCE_500}, and the startfile @file{unix98.o}.
13147
13148It is @emph{important} to note that this option changes the interfaces
13149for various library routines.  It also affects the operational behavior
13150of the C library.  Thus, @emph{extreme} care is needed in using this
13151option.
13152
13153Library code that is intended to operate with more than one UNIX
13154standard must test, set and restore the variable @var{__xpg4_extended_mask}
13155as appropriate.  Most GNU software doesn't provide this capability.
13156
13157@item -nolibdld
13158@opindex nolibdld
13159Suppress the generation of link options to search libdld.sl when the
13160@option{-static} option is specified on HP-UX 10 and later.
13161
13162@item -static
13163@opindex static
13164The HP-UX implementation of setlocale in libc has a dependency on
13165libdld.sl.  There isn't an archive version of libdld.sl.  Thus,
13166when the @option{-static} option is specified, special link options
13167are needed to resolve this dependency.
13168
13169On HP-UX 10 and later, the GCC driver adds the necessary options to
13170link with libdld.sl when the @option{-static} option is specified.
13171This causes the resulting binary to be dynamic.  On the 64-bit port,
13172the linkers generate dynamic binaries by default in any case.  The
13173@option{-nolibdld} option can be used to prevent the GCC driver from
13174adding these link options.
13175
13176@item -threads
13177@opindex threads
13178Add support for multithreading with the @dfn{dce thread} library
13179under HP-UX@.  This option sets flags for both the preprocessor and
13180linker.
13181@end table
13182
13183@node i386 and x86-64 Options
13184@subsection Intel 386 and AMD x86-64 Options
13185@cindex i386 Options
13186@cindex x86-64 Options
13187@cindex Intel 386 Options
13188@cindex AMD x86-64 Options
13189
13190These @samp{-m} options are defined for the i386 and x86-64 family of
13191computers:
13192
13193@table @gcctabopt
13194@item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
13195@opindex mtune
13196Tune to @var{cpu-type} everything applicable about the generated code, except
13197for the ABI and the set of available instructions.  The choices for
13198@var{cpu-type} are:
13199@table @emph
13200@item generic
13201Produce code optimized for the most common IA32/@/AMD64/@/EM64T processors.
13202If you know the CPU on which your code will run, then you should use
13203the corresponding @option{-mtune} option instead of
13204@option{-mtune=generic}.  But, if you do not know exactly what CPU users
13205of your application will have, then you should use this option.
13206
13207As new processors are deployed in the marketplace, the behavior of this
13208option will change.  Therefore, if you upgrade to a newer version of
13209GCC, the code generated option will change to reflect the processors
13210that were most common when that version of GCC was released.
13211
13212There is no @option{-march=generic} option because @option{-march}
13213indicates the instruction set the compiler can use, and there is no
13214generic instruction set applicable to all processors.  In contrast,
13215@option{-mtune} indicates the processor (or, in this case, collection of
13216processors) for which the code is optimized.
13217@item native
13218This selects the CPU to tune for at compilation time by determining
13219the processor type of the compiling machine.  Using @option{-mtune=native}
13220will produce code optimized for the local machine under the constraints
13221of the selected instruction set.  Using @option{-march=native} will
13222enable all instruction subsets supported by the local machine (hence
13223the result might not run on different machines).
13224@item i386
13225Original Intel's i386 CPU@.
13226@item i486
13227Intel's i486 CPU@.  (No scheduling is implemented for this chip.)
13228@item i586, pentium
13229Intel Pentium CPU with no MMX support.
13230@item pentium-mmx
13231Intel PentiumMMX CPU based on Pentium core with MMX instruction set support.
13232@item pentiumpro
13233Intel PentiumPro CPU@.
13234@item i686
13235Same as @code{generic}, but when used as @code{march} option, PentiumPro
13236instruction set will be used, so the code will run on all i686 family chips.
13237@item pentium2
13238Intel Pentium2 CPU based on PentiumPro core with MMX instruction set support.
13239@item pentium3, pentium3m
13240Intel Pentium3 CPU based on PentiumPro core with MMX and SSE instruction set
13241support.
13242@item pentium-m
13243Low power version of Intel Pentium3 CPU with MMX, SSE and SSE2 instruction set
13244support.  Used by Centrino notebooks.
13245@item pentium4, pentium4m
13246Intel Pentium4 CPU with MMX, SSE and SSE2 instruction set support.
13247@item prescott
13248Improved version of Intel Pentium4 CPU with MMX, SSE, SSE2 and SSE3 instruction
13249set support.
13250@item nocona
13251Improved version of Intel Pentium4 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE,
13252SSE2 and SSE3 instruction set support.
13253@item core2
13254Intel Core2 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3 and SSSE3
13255instruction set support.
13256@item corei7
13257Intel Core i7 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1
13258and SSE4.2 instruction set support.
13259@item corei7-avx
13260Intel Core i7 CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3,
13261SSE4.1, SSE4.2, AVX, AES and PCLMUL instruction set support.
13262@item core-avx-i
13263Intel Core CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3,
13264SSE4.1, SSE4.2, AVX, AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND and F16C instruction
13265set support.
13266@item atom
13267Intel Atom CPU with 64-bit extensions, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3 and SSSE3
13268instruction set support.
13269@item k6
13270AMD K6 CPU with MMX instruction set support.
13271@item k6-2, k6-3
13272Improved versions of AMD K6 CPU with MMX and 3DNow!@: instruction set support.
13273@item athlon, athlon-tbird
13274AMD Athlon CPU with MMX, 3dNOW!, enhanced 3DNow!@: and SSE prefetch instructions
13275support.
13276@item athlon-4, athlon-xp, athlon-mp
13277Improved AMD Athlon CPU with MMX, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow!@: and full SSE
13278instruction set support.
13279@item k8, opteron, athlon64, athlon-fx
13280AMD K8 core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This supersets
13281MMX, SSE, SSE2, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow!@: and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)
13282@item k8-sse3, opteron-sse3, athlon64-sse3
13283Improved versions of k8, opteron and athlon64 with SSE3 instruction set support.
13284@item amdfam10, barcelona
13285AMD Family 10h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This
13286supersets MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, 3DNow!, enhanced 3DNow!, ABM and 64-bit
13287instruction set extensions.)
13288@item bdver1
13289AMD Family 15h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This
13290supersets FMA4, AVX, XOP, LWP, AES, PCL_MUL, CX16, MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A,
13291SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM and 64-bit instruction set extensions.)
13292@item bdver2
13293AMD Family 15h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This
13294supersets BMI, TBM, F16C, FMA, AVX, XOP, LWP, AES, PCL_MUL, CX16, MMX, SSE,
13295SSE2, SSE3, SSE4A, SSSE3, SSE4.1, SSE4.2, ABM and 64-bit instruction set
13296extensions.)
13297@item btver1
13298AMD Family 14h core based CPUs with x86-64 instruction set support.  (This
13299supersets MMX, SSE, SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4A, CX16, ABM and 64-bit
13300instruction set extensions.)
13301@item winchip-c6
13302IDT Winchip C6 CPU, dealt in same way as i486 with additional MMX instruction
13303set support.
13304@item winchip2
13305IDT Winchip2 CPU, dealt in same way as i486 with additional MMX and 3DNow!@:
13306instruction set support.
13307@item c3
13308Via C3 CPU with MMX and 3DNow!@: instruction set support.  (No scheduling is
13309implemented for this chip.)
13310@item c3-2
13311Via C3-2 CPU with MMX and SSE instruction set support.  (No scheduling is
13312implemented for this chip.)
13313@item geode
13314Embedded AMD CPU with MMX and 3DNow!@: instruction set support.
13315@end table
13316
13317While picking a specific @var{cpu-type} will schedule things appropriately
13318for that particular chip, the compiler will not generate any code that
13319does not run on the default machine type without the @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}}
13320option being used. For example, if GCC is configured for i686-pc-linux-gnu
13321then @option{-mtune=pentium4} will generate code that is tuned for Pentium4
13322but will still run on i686 machines.
13323
13324@item -march=@var{cpu-type}
13325@opindex march
13326Generate instructions for the machine type @var{cpu-type}.  The choices
13327for @var{cpu-type} are the same as for @option{-mtune}.  Moreover,
13328specifying @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}} implies @option{-mtune=@var{cpu-type}}.
13329
13330@item -mcpu=@var{cpu-type}
13331@opindex mcpu
13332A deprecated synonym for @option{-mtune}.
13333
13334@item -mfpmath=@var{unit}
13335@opindex mfpmath
13336Generate floating-point arithmetic for selected unit @var{unit}.  The choices
13337for @var{unit} are:
13338
13339@table @samp
13340@item 387
13341Use the standard 387 floating-point coprocessor present on the majority of chips and
13342emulated otherwise.  Code compiled with this option runs almost everywhere.
13343The temporary results are computed in 80-bit precision instead of the precision
13344specified by the type, resulting in slightly different results compared to most
13345of other chips.  See @option{-ffloat-store} for more detailed description.
13346
13347This is the default choice for i386 compiler.
13348
13349@item sse
13350Use scalar floating-point instructions present in the SSE instruction set.
13351This instruction set is supported by Pentium3 and newer chips, in the AMD line
13352by Athlon-4, Athlon-xp and Athlon-mp chips.  The earlier version of SSE
13353instruction set supports only single-precision arithmetic, thus the double and
13354extended-precision arithmetic are still done using 387.  A later version, present
13355only in Pentium4 and the future AMD x86-64 chips, supports double-precision
13356arithmetic too.
13357
13358For the i386 compiler, you need to use @option{-march=@var{cpu-type}}, @option{-msse}
13359or @option{-msse2} switches to enable SSE extensions and make this option
13360effective.  For the x86-64 compiler, these extensions are enabled by default.
13361
13362The resulting code should be considerably faster in the majority of cases and avoid
13363the numerical instability problems of 387 code, but may break some existing
13364code that expects temporaries to be 80 bits.
13365
13366This is the default choice for the x86-64 compiler.
13367
13368@item sse,387
13369@itemx sse+387
13370@itemx both
13371Attempt to utilize both instruction sets at once.  This effectively double the
13372amount of available registers and on chips with separate execution units for
13373387 and SSE the execution resources too.  Use this option with care, as it is
13374still experimental, because the GCC register allocator does not model separate
13375functional units well resulting in instable performance.
13376@end table
13377
13378@item -masm=@var{dialect}
13379@opindex masm=@var{dialect}
13380Output asm instructions using selected @var{dialect}.  Supported
13381choices are @samp{intel} or @samp{att} (the default one).  Darwin does
13382not support @samp{intel}.
13383
13384@item -mieee-fp
13385@itemx -mno-ieee-fp
13386@opindex mieee-fp
13387@opindex mno-ieee-fp
13388Control whether or not the compiler uses IEEE floating-point
13389comparisons.  These handle correctly the case where the result of a
13390comparison is unordered.
13391
13392@item -msoft-float
13393@opindex msoft-float
13394Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
13395@strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not part of GCC@.
13396Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are used, but
13397this can't be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make your
13398own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
13399cross-compilation.
13400
13401On machines where a function returns floating-point results in the 80387
13402register stack, some floating-point opcodes may be emitted even if
13403@option{-msoft-float} is used.
13404
13405@item -mno-fp-ret-in-387
13406@opindex mno-fp-ret-in-387
13407Do not use the FPU registers for return values of functions.
13408
13409The usual calling convention has functions return values of types
13410@code{float} and @code{double} in an FPU register, even if there
13411is no FPU@.  The idea is that the operating system should emulate
13412an FPU@.
13413
13414The option @option{-mno-fp-ret-in-387} causes such values to be returned
13415in ordinary CPU registers instead.
13416
13417@item -mno-fancy-math-387
13418@opindex mno-fancy-math-387
13419Some 387 emulators do not support the @code{sin}, @code{cos} and
13420@code{sqrt} instructions for the 387.  Specify this option to avoid
13421generating those instructions.  This option is the default on FreeBSD,
13422OpenBSD and NetBSD@.  This option is overridden when @option{-march}
13423indicates that the target CPU will always have an FPU and so the
13424instruction will not need emulation.  As of revision 2.6.1, these
13425instructions are not generated unless you also use the
13426@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} switch.
13427
13428@item -malign-double
13429@itemx -mno-align-double
13430@opindex malign-double
13431@opindex mno-align-double
13432Control whether GCC aligns @code{double}, @code{long double}, and
13433@code{long long} variables on a two-word boundary or a one-word
13434boundary.  Aligning @code{double} variables on a two-word boundary
13435produces code that runs somewhat faster on a @samp{Pentium} at the
13436expense of more memory.
13437
13438On x86-64, @option{-malign-double} is enabled by default.
13439
13440@strong{Warning:} if you use the @option{-malign-double} switch,
13441structures containing the above types will be aligned differently than
13442the published application binary interface specifications for the 386
13443and will not be binary compatible with structures in code compiled
13444without that switch.
13445
13446@item -m96bit-long-double
13447@itemx -m128bit-long-double
13448@opindex m96bit-long-double
13449@opindex m128bit-long-double
13450These switches control the size of @code{long double} type.  The i386
13451application binary interface specifies the size to be 96 bits,
13452so @option{-m96bit-long-double} is the default in 32-bit mode.
13453
13454Modern architectures (Pentium and newer) prefer @code{long double}
13455to be aligned to an 8- or 16-byte boundary.  In arrays or structures
13456conforming to the ABI, this is not possible.  So specifying
13457@option{-m128bit-long-double} aligns @code{long double}
13458to a 16-byte boundary by padding the @code{long double} with an additional
1345932-bit zero.
13460
13461In the x86-64 compiler, @option{-m128bit-long-double} is the default choice as
13462its ABI specifies that @code{long double} is to be aligned on 16-byte boundary.
13463
13464Notice that neither of these options enable any extra precision over the x87
13465standard of 80 bits for a @code{long double}.
13466
13467@strong{Warning:} if you override the default value for your target ABI, the
13468structures and arrays containing @code{long double} variables will change
13469their size as well as function calling convention for function taking
13470@code{long double} will be modified.  Hence they will not be binary
13471compatible with arrays or structures in code compiled without that switch.
13472
13473@item -mlarge-data-threshold=@var{number}
13474@opindex mlarge-data-threshold=@var{number}
13475When @option{-mcmodel=medium} is specified, the data greater than
13476@var{threshold} are placed in large data section.  This value must be the
13477same across all object linked into the binary and defaults to 65535.
13478
13479@item -mrtd
13480@opindex mrtd
13481Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions that
13482take a fixed number of arguments return with the @code{ret} @var{num}
13483instruction, which pops their arguments while returning.  This saves one
13484instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop the arguments
13485there.
13486
13487You can specify that an individual function is called with this calling
13488sequence with the function attribute @samp{stdcall}.  You can also
13489override the @option{-mrtd} option by using the function attribute
13490@samp{cdecl}.  @xref{Function Attributes}.
13491
13492@strong{Warning:} this calling convention is incompatible with the one
13493normally used on Unix, so you cannot use it if you need to call
13494libraries compiled with the Unix compiler.
13495
13496Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that
13497take variable numbers of arguments (including @code{printf});
13498otherwise incorrect code will be generated for calls to those
13499functions.
13500
13501In addition, seriously incorrect code will result if you call a
13502function with too many arguments.  (Normally, extra arguments are
13503harmlessly ignored.)
13504
13505@item -mregparm=@var{num}
13506@opindex mregparm
13507Control how many registers are used to pass integer arguments.  By
13508default, no registers are used to pass arguments, and at most 3
13509registers can be used.  You can control this behavior for a specific
13510function by using the function attribute @samp{regparm}.
13511@xref{Function Attributes}.
13512
13513@strong{Warning:} if you use this switch, and
13514@var{num} is nonzero, then you must build all modules with the same
13515value, including any libraries.  This includes the system libraries and
13516startup modules.
13517
13518@item -msseregparm
13519@opindex msseregparm
13520Use SSE register passing conventions for float and double arguments
13521and return values.  You can control this behavior for a specific
13522function by using the function attribute @samp{sseregparm}.
13523@xref{Function Attributes}.
13524
13525@strong{Warning:} if you use this switch then you must build all
13526modules with the same value, including any libraries.  This includes
13527the system libraries and startup modules.
13528
13529@item -mvect8-ret-in-mem
13530@opindex mvect8-ret-in-mem
13531Return 8-byte vectors in memory instead of MMX registers.  This is the
13532default on Solaris@tie{}8 and 9 and VxWorks to match the ABI of the Sun
13533Studio compilers until version 12.  Later compiler versions (starting
13534with Studio 12 Update@tie{}1) follow the ABI used by other x86 targets, which
13535is the default on Solaris@tie{}10 and later.  @emph{Only} use this option if
13536you need to remain compatible with existing code produced by those
13537previous compiler versions or older versions of GCC.
13538
13539@item -mpc32
13540@itemx -mpc64
13541@itemx -mpc80
13542@opindex mpc32
13543@opindex mpc64
13544@opindex mpc80
13545
13546Set 80387 floating-point precision to 32, 64 or 80 bits.  When @option{-mpc32}
13547is specified, the significands of results of floating-point operations are
13548rounded to 24 bits (single precision); @option{-mpc64} rounds the
13549significands of results of floating-point operations to 53 bits (double
13550precision) and @option{-mpc80} rounds the significands of results of
13551floating-point operations to 64 bits (extended double precision), which is
13552the default.  When this option is used, floating-point operations in higher
13553precisions are not available to the programmer without setting the FPU
13554control word explicitly.
13555
13556Setting the rounding of floating-point operations to less than the default
1355780 bits can speed some programs by 2% or more.  Note that some mathematical
13558libraries assume that extended-precision (80-bit) floating-point operations
13559are enabled by default; routines in such libraries could suffer significant
13560loss of accuracy, typically through so-called "catastrophic cancellation",
13561when this option is used to set the precision to less than extended precision.
13562
13563@item -mstackrealign
13564@opindex mstackrealign
13565Realign the stack at entry.  On the Intel x86, the @option{-mstackrealign}
13566option will generate an alternate prologue and epilogue that realigns the
13567run-time stack if necessary.  This supports mixing legacy codes that keep
13568a 4-byte aligned stack with modern codes that keep a 16-byte stack for
13569SSE compatibility.  See also the attribute @code{force_align_arg_pointer},
13570applicable to individual functions.
13571
13572@item -mpreferred-stack-boundary=@var{num}
13573@opindex mpreferred-stack-boundary
13574Attempt to keep the stack boundary aligned to a 2 raised to @var{num}
13575byte boundary.  If @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary} is not specified,
13576the default is 4 (16 bytes or 128 bits).
13577
13578@item -mincoming-stack-boundary=@var{num}
13579@opindex mincoming-stack-boundary
13580Assume the incoming stack is aligned to a 2 raised to @var{num} byte
13581boundary.  If @option{-mincoming-stack-boundary} is not specified,
13582the one specified by @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary} will be used.
13583
13584On Pentium and PentiumPro, @code{double} and @code{long double} values
13585should be aligned to an 8-byte boundary (see @option{-malign-double}) or
13586suffer significant run time performance penalties.  On Pentium III, the
13587Streaming SIMD Extension (SSE) data type @code{__m128} may not work
13588properly if it is not 16-byte aligned.
13589
13590To ensure proper alignment of this values on the stack, the stack boundary
13591must be as aligned as that required by any value stored on the stack.
13592Further, every function must be generated such that it keeps the stack
13593aligned.  Thus calling a function compiled with a higher preferred
13594stack boundary from a function compiled with a lower preferred stack
13595boundary will most likely misalign the stack.  It is recommended that
13596libraries that use callbacks always use the default setting.
13597
13598This extra alignment does consume extra stack space, and generally
13599increases code size.  Code that is sensitive to stack space usage, such
13600as embedded systems and operating system kernels, may want to reduce the
13601preferred alignment to @option{-mpreferred-stack-boundary=2}.
13602
13603@item -mmmx
13604@itemx -mno-mmx
13605@itemx -msse
13606@itemx -mno-sse
13607@itemx -msse2
13608@itemx -mno-sse2
13609@itemx -msse3
13610@itemx -mno-sse3
13611@itemx -mssse3
13612@itemx -mno-ssse3
13613@itemx -msse4.1
13614@need 800
13615@itemx -mno-sse4.1
13616@itemx -msse4.2
13617@itemx -mno-sse4.2
13618@itemx -msse4
13619@itemx -mno-sse4
13620@itemx -mavx
13621@itemx -mno-avx
13622@itemx -mavx2
13623@itemx -mno-avx2
13624@itemx -maes
13625@itemx -mno-aes
13626@itemx -mpclmul
13627@need 800
13628@itemx -mno-pclmul
13629@itemx -mfsgsbase
13630@itemx -mno-fsgsbase
13631@itemx -mrdrnd
13632@itemx -mno-rdrnd
13633@itemx -mf16c
13634@itemx -mno-f16c
13635@itemx -mfma
13636@itemx -mno-fma
13637@itemx -msse4a
13638@itemx -mno-sse4a
13639@itemx -mfma4
13640@need 800
13641@itemx -mno-fma4
13642@itemx -mxop
13643@itemx -mno-xop
13644@itemx -mlwp
13645@itemx -mno-lwp
13646@itemx -m3dnow
13647@itemx -mno-3dnow
13648@itemx -mpopcnt
13649@itemx -mno-popcnt
13650@itemx -mabm
13651@itemx -mno-abm
13652@itemx -mbmi
13653@itemx -mbmi2
13654@itemx -mno-bmi
13655@itemx -mno-bmi2
13656@itemx -mlzcnt
13657@itemx -mno-lzcnt
13658@itemx -mtbm
13659@itemx -mno-tbm
13660@opindex mmmx
13661@opindex mno-mmx
13662@opindex msse
13663@opindex mno-sse
13664@opindex m3dnow
13665@opindex mno-3dnow
13666These switches enable or disable the use of instructions in the MMX, SSE,
13667SSE2, SSE3, SSSE3, SSE4.1, AVX, AVX2, AES, PCLMUL, FSGSBASE, RDRND, F16C,
13668FMA, SSE4A, FMA4, XOP, LWP, ABM, BMI, BMI2, LZCNT or 3DNow!
13669@: extended instruction sets.
13670These extensions are also available as built-in functions: see
13671@ref{X86 Built-in Functions}, for details of the functions enabled and
13672disabled by these switches.
13673
13674To have SSE/SSE2 instructions generated automatically from floating-point
13675code (as opposed to 387 instructions), see @option{-mfpmath=sse}.
13676
13677GCC depresses SSEx instructions when @option{-mavx} is used. Instead, it
13678generates new AVX instructions or AVX equivalence for all SSEx instructions
13679when needed.
13680
13681These options will enable GCC to use these extended instructions in
13682generated code, even without @option{-mfpmath=sse}.  Applications that
13683perform run-time CPU detection must compile separate files for each
13684supported architecture, using the appropriate flags.  In particular,
13685the file containing the CPU detection code should be compiled without
13686these options.
13687
13688@item -mcld
13689@opindex mcld
13690This option instructs GCC to emit a @code{cld} instruction in the prologue
13691of functions that use string instructions.  String instructions depend on
13692the DF flag to select between autoincrement or autodecrement mode.  While the
13693ABI specifies the DF flag to be cleared on function entry, some operating
13694systems violate this specification by not clearing the DF flag in their
13695exception dispatchers.  The exception handler can be invoked with the DF flag
13696set, which leads to wrong direction mode when string instructions are used.
13697This option can be enabled by default on 32-bit x86 targets by configuring
13698GCC with the @option{--enable-cld} configure option.  Generation of @code{cld}
13699instructions can be suppressed with the @option{-mno-cld} compiler option
13700in this case.
13701
13702@item -mvzeroupper
13703@opindex mvzeroupper
13704This option instructs GCC to emit a @code{vzeroupper} instruction
13705before a transfer of control flow out of the function to minimize
13706AVX to SSE transition penalty as well as remove unnecessary zeroupper
13707intrinsics.
13708
13709@item -mprefer-avx128
13710@opindex mprefer-avx128
13711This option instructs GCC to use 128-bit AVX instructions instead of
13712256-bit AVX instructions in the auto-vectorizer.
13713
13714@item -mcx16
13715@opindex mcx16
13716This option will enable GCC to use CMPXCHG16B instruction in generated code.
13717CMPXCHG16B allows for atomic operations on 128-bit double quadword (or oword)
13718data types.  This is useful for high resolution counters that could be updated
13719by multiple processors (or cores).  This instruction is generated as part of
13720atomic built-in functions: see @ref{__sync Builtins} or
13721@ref{__atomic Builtins} for details.
13722
13723@item -msahf
13724@opindex msahf
13725This option will enable GCC to use SAHF instruction in generated 64-bit code.
13726Early Intel CPUs with Intel 64 lacked LAHF and SAHF instructions supported
13727by AMD64 until introduction of Pentium 4 G1 step in December 2005.  LAHF and
13728SAHF are load and store instructions, respectively, for certain status flags.
13729In 64-bit mode, SAHF instruction is used to optimize @code{fmod}, @code{drem}
13730or @code{remainder} built-in functions: see @ref{Other Builtins} for details.
13731
13732@item -mmovbe
13733@opindex mmovbe
13734This option will enable GCC to use movbe instruction to implement
13735@code{__builtin_bswap32} and @code{__builtin_bswap64}.
13736
13737@item -mcrc32
13738@opindex mcrc32
13739This option will enable built-in functions, @code{__builtin_ia32_crc32qi},
13740@code{__builtin_ia32_crc32hi}. @code{__builtin_ia32_crc32si} and
13741@code{__builtin_ia32_crc32di} to generate the crc32 machine instruction.
13742
13743@item -mrecip
13744@opindex mrecip
13745This option will enable GCC to use RCPSS and RSQRTSS instructions (and their
13746vectorized variants RCPPS and RSQRTPS) with an additional Newton-Raphson step
13747to increase precision instead of DIVSS and SQRTSS (and their vectorized
13748variants) for single-precision floating-point arguments.  These instructions
13749are generated only when @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} is enabled
13750together with @option{-finite-math-only} and @option{-fno-trapping-math}.
13751Note that while the throughput of the sequence is higher than the throughput
13752of the non-reciprocal instruction, the precision of the sequence can be
13753decreased by up to 2 ulp (i.e. the inverse of 1.0 equals 0.99999994).
13754
13755Note that GCC implements @code{1.0f/sqrtf(@var{x})} in terms of RSQRTSS
13756(or RSQRTPS) already with @option{-ffast-math} (or the above option
13757combination), and doesn't need @option{-mrecip}.
13758
13759Also note that GCC emits the above sequence with additional Newton-Raphson step
13760for vectorized single-float division and vectorized @code{sqrtf(@var{x})}
13761already with @option{-ffast-math} (or the above option combination), and
13762doesn't need @option{-mrecip}.
13763
13764@item -mrecip=@var{opt}
13765@opindex mrecip=opt
13766This option allows to control which reciprocal estimate instructions
13767may be used.  @var{opt} is a comma separated list of options, which may
13768be preceded by a @code{!} to invert the option:
13769@code{all}: enable all estimate instructions,
13770@code{default}: enable the default instructions, equivalent to @option{-mrecip},
13771@code{none}: disable all estimate instructions, equivalent to @option{-mno-recip},
13772@code{div}: enable the approximation for scalar division,
13773@code{vec-div}: enable the approximation for vectorized division,
13774@code{sqrt}: enable the approximation for scalar square root,
13775@code{vec-sqrt}: enable the approximation for vectorized square root.
13776
13777So for example, @option{-mrecip=all,!sqrt} would enable
13778all of the reciprocal approximations, except for square root.
13779
13780@item -mveclibabi=@var{type}
13781@opindex mveclibabi
13782Specifies the ABI type to use for vectorizing intrinsics using an
13783external library.  Supported types are @code{svml} for the Intel short
13784vector math library and @code{acml} for the AMD math core library style
13785of interfacing.  GCC will currently emit calls to @code{vmldExp2},
13786@code{vmldLn2}, @code{vmldLog102}, @code{vmldLog102}, @code{vmldPow2},
13787@code{vmldTanh2}, @code{vmldTan2}, @code{vmldAtan2}, @code{vmldAtanh2},
13788@code{vmldCbrt2}, @code{vmldSinh2}, @code{vmldSin2}, @code{vmldAsinh2},
13789@code{vmldAsin2}, @code{vmldCosh2}, @code{vmldCos2}, @code{vmldAcosh2},
13790@code{vmldAcos2}, @code{vmlsExp4}, @code{vmlsLn4}, @code{vmlsLog104},
13791@code{vmlsLog104}, @code{vmlsPow4}, @code{vmlsTanh4}, @code{vmlsTan4},
13792@code{vmlsAtan4}, @code{vmlsAtanh4}, @code{vmlsCbrt4}, @code{vmlsSinh4},
13793@code{vmlsSin4}, @code{vmlsAsinh4}, @code{vmlsAsin4}, @code{vmlsCosh4},
13794@code{vmlsCos4}, @code{vmlsAcosh4} and @code{vmlsAcos4} for corresponding
13795function type when @option{-mveclibabi=svml} is used and @code{__vrd2_sin},
13796@code{__vrd2_cos}, @code{__vrd2_exp}, @code{__vrd2_log}, @code{__vrd2_log2},
13797@code{__vrd2_log10}, @code{__vrs4_sinf}, @code{__vrs4_cosf},
13798@code{__vrs4_expf}, @code{__vrs4_logf}, @code{__vrs4_log2f},
13799@code{__vrs4_log10f} and @code{__vrs4_powf} for corresponding function type
13800when @option{-mveclibabi=acml} is used. Both @option{-ftree-vectorize} and
13801@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} have to be enabled. A SVML or ACML ABI
13802compatible library will have to be specified at link time.
13803
13804@item -mabi=@var{name}
13805@opindex mabi
13806Generate code for the specified calling convention.  Permissible values
13807are: @samp{sysv} for the ABI used on GNU/Linux and other systems and
13808@samp{ms} for the Microsoft ABI.  The default is to use the Microsoft
13809ABI when targeting Windows.  On all other systems, the default is the
13810SYSV ABI.  You can control this behavior for a specific function by
13811using the function attribute @samp{ms_abi}/@samp{sysv_abi}.
13812@xref{Function Attributes}.
13813
13814@item -mtls-dialect=@var{type}
13815@opindex mtls-dialect
13816Generate code to access thread-local storage using the @samp{gnu} or
13817@samp{gnu2} conventions.  @samp{gnu} is the conservative default;
13818@samp{gnu2} is more efficient, but it may add compile- and run-time
13819requirements that cannot be satisfied on all systems.
13820
13821@item -mpush-args
13822@itemx -mno-push-args
13823@opindex mpush-args
13824@opindex mno-push-args
13825Use PUSH operations to store outgoing parameters.  This method is shorter
13826and usually equally fast as method using SUB/MOV operations and is enabled
13827by default.  In some cases disabling it may improve performance because of
13828improved scheduling and reduced dependencies.
13829
13830@item -maccumulate-outgoing-args
13831@opindex maccumulate-outgoing-args
13832If enabled, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments will be
13833computed in the function prologue.  This is faster on most modern CPUs
13834because of reduced dependencies, improved scheduling and reduced stack usage
13835when preferred stack boundary is not equal to 2.  The drawback is a notable
13836increase in code size.  This switch implies @option{-mno-push-args}.
13837
13838@item -mthreads
13839@opindex mthreads
13840Support thread-safe exception handling on @samp{Mingw32}.  Code that relies
13841on thread-safe exception handling must compile and link all code with the
13842@option{-mthreads} option.  When compiling, @option{-mthreads} defines
13843@option{-D_MT}; when linking, it links in a special thread helper library
13844@option{-lmingwthrd} which cleans up per thread exception handling data.
13845
13846@item -mno-align-stringops
13847@opindex mno-align-stringops
13848Do not align destination of inlined string operations.  This switch reduces
13849code size and improves performance in case the destination is already aligned,
13850but GCC doesn't know about it.
13851
13852@item -minline-all-stringops
13853@opindex minline-all-stringops
13854By default GCC inlines string operations only when the destination is
13855known to be aligned to least a 4-byte boundary.
13856This enables more inlining, increase code
13857size, but may improve performance of code that depends on fast memcpy, strlen
13858and memset for short lengths.
13859
13860@item -minline-stringops-dynamically
13861@opindex minline-stringops-dynamically
13862For string operations of unknown size, use run-time checks with
13863inline code for small blocks and a library call for large blocks.
13864
13865@item -mstringop-strategy=@var{alg}
13866@opindex mstringop-strategy=@var{alg}
13867Overwrite internal decision heuristic about particular algorithm to inline
13868string operation with.  The allowed values are @code{rep_byte},
13869@code{rep_4byte}, @code{rep_8byte} for expanding using i386 @code{rep} prefix
13870of specified size, @code{byte_loop}, @code{loop}, @code{unrolled_loop} for
13871expanding inline loop, @code{libcall} for always expanding library call.
13872
13873@item -momit-leaf-frame-pointer
13874@opindex momit-leaf-frame-pointer
13875Don't keep the frame pointer in a register for leaf functions.  This
13876avoids the instructions to save, set up and restore frame pointers and
13877makes an extra register available in leaf functions.  The option
13878@option{-fomit-frame-pointer} removes the frame pointer for all functions,
13879which might make debugging harder.
13880
13881@item -mtls-direct-seg-refs
13882@itemx -mno-tls-direct-seg-refs
13883@opindex mtls-direct-seg-refs
13884Controls whether TLS variables may be accessed with offsets from the
13885TLS segment register (@code{%gs} for 32-bit, @code{%fs} for 64-bit),
13886or whether the thread base pointer must be added.  Whether or not this
13887is legal depends on the operating system, and whether it maps the
13888segment to cover the entire TLS area.
13889
13890For systems that use GNU libc, the default is on.
13891
13892@item -msse2avx
13893@itemx -mno-sse2avx
13894@opindex msse2avx
13895Specify that the assembler should encode SSE instructions with VEX
13896prefix.  The option @option{-mavx} turns this on by default.
13897
13898@item -mfentry
13899@itemx -mno-fentry
13900@opindex mfentry
13901If profiling is active @option{-pg} put the profiling
13902counter call before prologue.
13903Note: On x86 architectures the attribute @code{ms_hook_prologue}
13904isn't possible at the moment for @option{-mfentry} and @option{-pg}.
13905
13906@item -m8bit-idiv
13907@itemx -mno-8bit-idiv
13908@opindex 8bit-idiv
13909On some processors, like Intel Atom, 8-bit unsigned integer divide is
13910much faster than 32-bit/64-bit integer divide.  This option generates a
13911run-time check.  If both dividend and divisor are within range of 0
13912to 255, 8-bit unsigned integer divide is used instead of
1391332-bit/64-bit integer divide.
13914
13915@item -mavx256-split-unaligned-load
13916@item -mavx256-split-unaligned-store
13917@opindex avx256-split-unaligned-load
13918@opindex avx256-split-unaligned-store
13919Split 32-byte AVX unaligned load and store.
13920
13921@end table
13922
13923These @samp{-m} switches are supported in addition to the above
13924on AMD x86-64 processors in 64-bit environments.
13925
13926@table @gcctabopt
13927@item -m32
13928@itemx -m64
13929@itemx -mx32
13930@opindex m32
13931@opindex m64
13932@opindex mx32
13933Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
13934The @option{-m32} option sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits and
13935generates code that runs on any i386 system.
13936The @option{-m64} option sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer
13937to 64 bits and generates code for AMD's x86-64 architecture.
13938The @option{-mx32} option sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits and
13939generates code for AMD's x86-64 architecture.
13940For darwin only the @option{-m64} option turns off the @option{-fno-pic}
13941and @option{-mdynamic-no-pic} options.
13942
13943@item -mno-red-zone
13944@opindex mno-red-zone
13945Do not use a so called red zone for x86-64 code.  The red zone is mandated
13946by the x86-64 ABI, it is a 128-byte area beyond the location of the
13947stack pointer that will not be modified by signal or interrupt handlers
13948and therefore can be used for temporary data without adjusting the stack
13949pointer.  The flag @option{-mno-red-zone} disables this red zone.
13950
13951@item -mcmodel=small
13952@opindex mcmodel=small
13953Generate code for the small code model: the program and its symbols must
13954be linked in the lower 2 GB of the address space.  Pointers are 64 bits.
13955Programs can be statically or dynamically linked.  This is the default
13956code model.
13957
13958@item -mcmodel=kernel
13959@opindex mcmodel=kernel
13960Generate code for the kernel code model.  The kernel runs in the
13961negative 2 GB of the address space.
13962This model has to be used for Linux kernel code.
13963
13964@item -mcmodel=medium
13965@opindex mcmodel=medium
13966Generate code for the medium model: The program is linked in the lower 2
13967GB of the address space.  Small symbols are also placed there.  Symbols
13968with sizes larger than @option{-mlarge-data-threshold} are put into
13969large data or bss sections and can be located above 2GB.  Programs can
13970be statically or dynamically linked.
13971
13972@item -mcmodel=large
13973@opindex mcmodel=large
13974Generate code for the large model: This model makes no assumptions
13975about addresses and sizes of sections.
13976@end table
13977
13978@node i386 and x86-64 Windows Options
13979@subsection i386 and x86-64 Windows Options
13980@cindex i386 and x86-64 Windows Options
13981
13982These additional options are available for Windows targets:
13983
13984@table @gcctabopt
13985@item -mconsole
13986@opindex mconsole
13987This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
13988specifies that a console application is to be generated, by
13989instructing the linker to set the PE header subsystem type
13990required for console applications.
13991This is the default behavior for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
13992
13993@item -mdll
13994@opindex mdll
13995This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
13996specifies that a DLL - a dynamic link library - is to be
13997generated, enabling the selection of the required runtime
13998startup object and entry point.
13999
14000@item -mnop-fun-dllimport
14001@opindex mnop-fun-dllimport
14002This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
14003specifies that the dllimport attribute should be ignored.
14004
14005@item -mthread
14006@opindex mthread
14007This option is available for MinGW targets. It specifies
14008that MinGW-specific thread support is to be used.
14009
14010@item -municode
14011@opindex municode
14012This option is available for mingw-w64 targets.  It specifies
14013that the UNICODE macro is getting pre-defined and that the
14014unicode capable runtime startup code is chosen.
14015
14016@item -mwin32
14017@opindex mwin32
14018This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
14019specifies that the typical Windows pre-defined macros are to
14020be set in the pre-processor, but does not influence the choice
14021of runtime library/startup code.
14022
14023@item -mwindows
14024@opindex mwindows
14025This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
14026specifies that a GUI application is to be generated by
14027instructing the linker to set the PE header subsystem type
14028appropriately.
14029
14030@item -fno-set-stack-executable
14031@opindex fno-set-stack-executable
14032This option is available for MinGW targets. It specifies that
14033the executable flag for stack used by nested functions isn't
14034set. This is necessary for binaries running in kernel mode of
14035Windows, as there the user32 API, which is used to set executable
14036privileges, isn't available.
14037
14038@item -mpe-aligned-commons
14039@opindex mpe-aligned-commons
14040This option is available for Cygwin and MinGW targets.  It
14041specifies that the GNU extension to the PE file format that
14042permits the correct alignment of COMMON variables should be
14043used when generating code.  It will be enabled by default if
14044GCC detects that the target assembler found during configuration
14045supports the feature.
14046@end table
14047
14048See also under @ref{i386 and x86-64 Options} for standard options.
14049
14050@node IA-64 Options
14051@subsection IA-64 Options
14052@cindex IA-64 Options
14053
14054These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the Intel IA-64 architecture.
14055
14056@table @gcctabopt
14057@item -mbig-endian
14058@opindex mbig-endian
14059Generate code for a big-endian target.  This is the default for HP-UX@.
14060
14061@item -mlittle-endian
14062@opindex mlittle-endian
14063Generate code for a little-endian target.  This is the default for AIX5
14064and GNU/Linux.
14065
14066@item -mgnu-as
14067@itemx -mno-gnu-as
14068@opindex mgnu-as
14069@opindex mno-gnu-as
14070Generate (or don't) code for the GNU assembler.  This is the default.
14071@c Also, this is the default if the configure option @option{--with-gnu-as}
14072@c is used.
14073
14074@item -mgnu-ld
14075@itemx -mno-gnu-ld
14076@opindex mgnu-ld
14077@opindex mno-gnu-ld
14078Generate (or don't) code for the GNU linker.  This is the default.
14079@c Also, this is the default if the configure option @option{--with-gnu-ld}
14080@c is used.
14081
14082@item -mno-pic
14083@opindex mno-pic
14084Generate code that does not use a global pointer register.  The result
14085is not position independent code, and violates the IA-64 ABI@.
14086
14087@item -mvolatile-asm-stop
14088@itemx -mno-volatile-asm-stop
14089@opindex mvolatile-asm-stop
14090@opindex mno-volatile-asm-stop
14091Generate (or don't) a stop bit immediately before and after volatile asm
14092statements.
14093
14094@item -mregister-names
14095@itemx -mno-register-names
14096@opindex mregister-names
14097@opindex mno-register-names
14098Generate (or don't) @samp{in}, @samp{loc}, and @samp{out} register names for
14099the stacked registers.  This may make assembler output more readable.
14100
14101@item -mno-sdata
14102@itemx -msdata
14103@opindex mno-sdata
14104@opindex msdata
14105Disable (or enable) optimizations that use the small data section.  This may
14106be useful for working around optimizer bugs.
14107
14108@item -mconstant-gp
14109@opindex mconstant-gp
14110Generate code that uses a single constant global pointer value.  This is
14111useful when compiling kernel code.
14112
14113@item -mauto-pic
14114@opindex mauto-pic
14115Generate code that is self-relocatable.  This implies @option{-mconstant-gp}.
14116This is useful when compiling firmware code.
14117
14118@item -minline-float-divide-min-latency
14119@opindex minline-float-divide-min-latency
14120Generate code for inline divides of floating-point values
14121using the minimum latency algorithm.
14122
14123@item -minline-float-divide-max-throughput
14124@opindex minline-float-divide-max-throughput
14125Generate code for inline divides of floating-point values
14126using the maximum throughput algorithm.
14127
14128@item -mno-inline-float-divide
14129@opindex mno-inline-float-divide
14130Do not generate inline code for divides of floating-point values.
14131
14132@item -minline-int-divide-min-latency
14133@opindex minline-int-divide-min-latency
14134Generate code for inline divides of integer values
14135using the minimum latency algorithm.
14136
14137@item -minline-int-divide-max-throughput
14138@opindex minline-int-divide-max-throughput
14139Generate code for inline divides of integer values
14140using the maximum throughput algorithm.
14141
14142@item -mno-inline-int-divide
14143@opindex mno-inline-int-divide
14144Do not generate inline code for divides of integer values.
14145
14146@item -minline-sqrt-min-latency
14147@opindex minline-sqrt-min-latency
14148Generate code for inline square roots
14149using the minimum latency algorithm.
14150
14151@item -minline-sqrt-max-throughput
14152@opindex minline-sqrt-max-throughput
14153Generate code for inline square roots
14154using the maximum throughput algorithm.
14155
14156@item -mno-inline-sqrt
14157@opindex mno-inline-sqrt
14158Do not generate inline code for sqrt.
14159
14160@item -mfused-madd
14161@itemx -mno-fused-madd
14162@opindex mfused-madd
14163@opindex mno-fused-madd
14164Do (don't) generate code that uses the fused multiply/add or multiply/subtract
14165instructions.  The default is to use these instructions.
14166
14167@item -mno-dwarf2-asm
14168@itemx -mdwarf2-asm
14169@opindex mno-dwarf2-asm
14170@opindex mdwarf2-asm
14171Don't (or do) generate assembler code for the DWARF2 line number debugging
14172info.  This may be useful when not using the GNU assembler.
14173
14174@item -mearly-stop-bits
14175@itemx -mno-early-stop-bits
14176@opindex mearly-stop-bits
14177@opindex mno-early-stop-bits
14178Allow stop bits to be placed earlier than immediately preceding the
14179instruction that triggered the stop bit.  This can improve instruction
14180scheduling, but does not always do so.
14181
14182@item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
14183@opindex mfixed-range
14184Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
14185A fixed register is one that the register allocator can not use.  This is
14186useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is specified as
14187two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be
14188specified separated by a comma.
14189
14190@item -mtls-size=@var{tls-size}
14191@opindex mtls-size
14192Specify bit size of immediate TLS offsets.  Valid values are 14, 22, and
1419364.
14194
14195@item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
14196@opindex mtune
14197Tune the instruction scheduling for a particular CPU, Valid values are
14198itanium, itanium1, merced, itanium2, and mckinley.
14199
14200@item -milp32
14201@itemx -mlp64
14202@opindex milp32
14203@opindex mlp64
14204Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
14205The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits.
14206The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer
14207to 64 bits.  These are HP-UX specific flags.
14208
14209@item -mno-sched-br-data-spec
14210@itemx -msched-br-data-spec
14211@opindex mno-sched-br-data-spec
14212@opindex msched-br-data-spec
14213(Dis/En)able data speculative scheduling before reload.
14214This will result in generation of the ld.a instructions and
14215the corresponding check instructions (ld.c / chk.a).
14216The default is 'disable'.
14217
14218@item -msched-ar-data-spec
14219@itemx -mno-sched-ar-data-spec
14220@opindex msched-ar-data-spec
14221@opindex mno-sched-ar-data-spec
14222(En/Dis)able data speculative scheduling after reload.
14223This will result in generation of the ld.a instructions and
14224the corresponding check instructions (ld.c / chk.a).
14225The default is 'enable'.
14226
14227@item -mno-sched-control-spec
14228@itemx -msched-control-spec
14229@opindex mno-sched-control-spec
14230@opindex msched-control-spec
14231(Dis/En)able control speculative scheduling.  This feature is
14232available only during region scheduling (i.e.@: before reload).
14233This will result in generation of the ld.s instructions and
14234the corresponding check instructions chk.s .
14235The default is 'disable'.
14236
14237@item -msched-br-in-data-spec
14238@itemx -mno-sched-br-in-data-spec
14239@opindex msched-br-in-data-spec
14240@opindex mno-sched-br-in-data-spec
14241(En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that
14242are dependent on the data speculative loads before reload.
14243This is effective only with @option{-msched-br-data-spec} enabled.
14244The default is 'enable'.
14245
14246@item -msched-ar-in-data-spec
14247@itemx -mno-sched-ar-in-data-spec
14248@opindex msched-ar-in-data-spec
14249@opindex mno-sched-ar-in-data-spec
14250(En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that
14251are dependent on the data speculative loads after reload.
14252This is effective only with @option{-msched-ar-data-spec} enabled.
14253The default is 'enable'.
14254
14255@item -msched-in-control-spec
14256@itemx -mno-sched-in-control-spec
14257@opindex msched-in-control-spec
14258@opindex mno-sched-in-control-spec
14259(En/Dis)able speculative scheduling of the instructions that
14260are dependent on the control speculative loads.
14261This is effective only with @option{-msched-control-spec} enabled.
14262The default is 'enable'.
14263
14264@item -mno-sched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
14265@itemx -msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
14266@opindex mno-sched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
14267@opindex msched-prefer-non-data-spec-insns
14268If enabled, data speculative instructions will be chosen for schedule
14269only if there are no other choices at the moment.  This will make
14270the use of the data speculation much more conservative.
14271The default is 'disable'.
14272
14273@item -mno-sched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
14274@itemx -msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
14275@opindex mno-sched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
14276@opindex msched-prefer-non-control-spec-insns
14277If enabled, control speculative instructions will be chosen for schedule
14278only if there are no other choices at the moment.  This will make
14279the use of the control speculation much more conservative.
14280The default is 'disable'.
14281
14282@item -mno-sched-count-spec-in-critical-path
14283@itemx -msched-count-spec-in-critical-path
14284@opindex mno-sched-count-spec-in-critical-path
14285@opindex msched-count-spec-in-critical-path
14286If enabled, speculative dependencies will be considered during
14287computation of the instructions priorities.  This will make the use of the
14288speculation a bit more conservative.
14289The default is 'disable'.
14290
14291@item -msched-spec-ldc
14292@opindex msched-spec-ldc
14293Use a simple data speculation check.  This option is on by default.
14294
14295@item -msched-control-spec-ldc
14296@opindex msched-spec-ldc
14297Use a simple check for control speculation.  This option is on by default.
14298
14299@item -msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle
14300@opindex msched-stop-bits-after-every-cycle
14301Place a stop bit after every cycle when scheduling.  This option is on
14302by default.
14303
14304@item -msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost
14305@opindex msched-fp-mem-deps-zero-cost
14306Assume that floating-point stores and loads are not likely to cause a conflict
14307when placed into the same instruction group.  This option is disabled by
14308default.
14309
14310@item -msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec
14311@opindex msel-sched-dont-check-control-spec
14312Generate checks for control speculation in selective scheduling.
14313This flag is disabled by default.
14314
14315@item -msched-max-memory-insns=@var{max-insns}
14316@opindex msched-max-memory-insns
14317Limit on the number of memory insns per instruction group, giving lower
14318priority to subsequent memory insns attempting to schedule in the same
14319instruction group. Frequently useful to prevent cache bank conflicts.
14320The default value is 1.
14321
14322@item -msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit
14323@opindex msched-max-memory-insns-hard-limit
14324Disallow more than `msched-max-memory-insns' in instruction group.
14325Otherwise, limit is `soft' meaning that we would prefer non-memory operations
14326when limit is reached but may still schedule memory operations.
14327
14328@end table
14329
14330@node IA-64/VMS Options
14331@subsection IA-64/VMS Options
14332
14333These @samp{-m} options are defined for the IA-64/VMS implementations:
14334
14335@table @gcctabopt
14336@item -mvms-return-codes
14337@opindex mvms-return-codes
14338Return VMS condition codes from main. The default is to return POSIX
14339style condition (e.g.@ error) codes.
14340
14341@item -mdebug-main=@var{prefix}
14342@opindex mdebug-main=@var{prefix}
14343Flag the first routine whose name starts with @var{prefix} as the main
14344routine for the debugger.
14345
14346@item -mmalloc64
14347@opindex mmalloc64
14348Default to 64-bit memory allocation routines.
14349@end table
14350
14351@node LM32 Options
14352@subsection LM32 Options
14353@cindex LM32 options
14354
14355These @option{-m} options are defined for the Lattice Mico32 architecture:
14356
14357@table @gcctabopt
14358@item -mbarrel-shift-enabled
14359@opindex mbarrel-shift-enabled
14360Enable barrel-shift instructions.
14361
14362@item -mdivide-enabled
14363@opindex mdivide-enabled
14364Enable divide and modulus instructions.
14365
14366@item -mmultiply-enabled
14367@opindex multiply-enabled
14368Enable multiply instructions.
14369
14370@item -msign-extend-enabled
14371@opindex msign-extend-enabled
14372Enable sign extend instructions.
14373
14374@item -muser-enabled
14375@opindex muser-enabled
14376Enable user-defined instructions.
14377
14378@end table
14379
14380@node M32C Options
14381@subsection M32C Options
14382@cindex M32C options
14383
14384@table @gcctabopt
14385@item -mcpu=@var{name}
14386@opindex mcpu=
14387Select the CPU for which code is generated.  @var{name} may be one of
14388@samp{r8c} for the R8C/Tiny series, @samp{m16c} for the M16C (up to
14389/60) series, @samp{m32cm} for the M16C/80 series, or @samp{m32c} for
14390the M32C/80 series.
14391
14392@item -msim
14393@opindex msim
14394Specifies that the program will be run on the simulator.  This causes
14395an alternate runtime library to be linked in which supports, for
14396example, file I/O@.  You must not use this option when generating
14397programs that will run on real hardware; you must provide your own
14398runtime library for whatever I/O functions are needed.
14399
14400@item -memregs=@var{number}
14401@opindex memregs=
14402Specifies the number of memory-based pseudo-registers GCC will use
14403during code generation.  These pseudo-registers will be used like real
14404registers, so there is a tradeoff between GCC's ability to fit the
14405code into available registers, and the performance penalty of using
14406memory instead of registers.  Note that all modules in a program must
14407be compiled with the same value for this option.  Because of that, you
14408must not use this option with the default runtime libraries gcc
14409builds.
14410
14411@end table
14412
14413@node M32R/D Options
14414@subsection M32R/D Options
14415@cindex M32R/D options
14416
14417These @option{-m} options are defined for Renesas M32R/D architectures:
14418
14419@table @gcctabopt
14420@item -m32r2
14421@opindex m32r2
14422Generate code for the M32R/2@.
14423
14424@item -m32rx
14425@opindex m32rx
14426Generate code for the M32R/X@.
14427
14428@item -m32r
14429@opindex m32r
14430Generate code for the M32R@.  This is the default.
14431
14432@item -mmodel=small
14433@opindex mmodel=small
14434Assume all objects live in the lower 16MB of memory (so that their addresses
14435can be loaded with the @code{ld24} instruction), and assume all subroutines
14436are reachable with the @code{bl} instruction.
14437This is the default.
14438
14439The addressability of a particular object can be set with the
14440@code{model} attribute.
14441
14442@item -mmodel=medium
14443@opindex mmodel=medium
14444Assume objects may be anywhere in the 32-bit address space (the compiler
14445will generate @code{seth/add3} instructions to load their addresses), and
14446assume all subroutines are reachable with the @code{bl} instruction.
14447
14448@item -mmodel=large
14449@opindex mmodel=large
14450Assume objects may be anywhere in the 32-bit address space (the compiler
14451will generate @code{seth/add3} instructions to load their addresses), and
14452assume subroutines may not be reachable with the @code{bl} instruction
14453(the compiler will generate the much slower @code{seth/add3/jl}
14454instruction sequence).
14455
14456@item -msdata=none
14457@opindex msdata=none
14458Disable use of the small data area.  Variables will be put into
14459one of @samp{.data}, @samp{bss}, or @samp{.rodata} (unless the
14460@code{section} attribute has been specified).
14461This is the default.
14462
14463The small data area consists of sections @samp{.sdata} and @samp{.sbss}.
14464Objects may be explicitly put in the small data area with the
14465@code{section} attribute using one of these sections.
14466
14467@item -msdata=sdata
14468@opindex msdata=sdata
14469Put small global and static data in the small data area, but do not
14470generate special code to reference them.
14471
14472@item -msdata=use
14473@opindex msdata=use
14474Put small global and static data in the small data area, and generate
14475special instructions to reference them.
14476
14477@item -G @var{num}
14478@opindex G
14479@cindex smaller data references
14480Put global and static objects less than or equal to @var{num} bytes
14481into the small data or bss sections instead of the normal data or bss
14482sections.  The default value of @var{num} is 8.
14483The @option{-msdata} option must be set to one of @samp{sdata} or @samp{use}
14484for this option to have any effect.
14485
14486All modules should be compiled with the same @option{-G @var{num}} value.
14487Compiling with different values of @var{num} may or may not work; if it
14488doesn't the linker will give an error message---incorrect code will not be
14489generated.
14490
14491@item -mdebug
14492@opindex mdebug
14493Makes the M32R specific code in the compiler display some statistics
14494that might help in debugging programs.
14495
14496@item -malign-loops
14497@opindex malign-loops
14498Align all loops to a 32-byte boundary.
14499
14500@item -mno-align-loops
14501@opindex mno-align-loops
14502Do not enforce a 32-byte alignment for loops.  This is the default.
14503
14504@item -missue-rate=@var{number}
14505@opindex missue-rate=@var{number}
14506Issue @var{number} instructions per cycle.  @var{number} can only be 1
14507or 2.
14508
14509@item -mbranch-cost=@var{number}
14510@opindex mbranch-cost=@var{number}
14511@var{number} can only be 1 or 2.  If it is 1 then branches will be
14512preferred over conditional code, if it is 2, then the opposite will
14513apply.
14514
14515@item -mflush-trap=@var{number}
14516@opindex mflush-trap=@var{number}
14517Specifies the trap number to use to flush the cache.  The default is
1451812.  Valid numbers are between 0 and 15 inclusive.
14519
14520@item -mno-flush-trap
14521@opindex mno-flush-trap
14522Specifies that the cache cannot be flushed by using a trap.
14523
14524@item -mflush-func=@var{name}
14525@opindex mflush-func=@var{name}
14526Specifies the name of the operating system function to call to flush
14527the cache.  The default is @emph{_flush_cache}, but a function call
14528will only be used if a trap is not available.
14529
14530@item -mno-flush-func
14531@opindex mno-flush-func
14532Indicates that there is no OS function for flushing the cache.
14533
14534@end table
14535
14536@node M680x0 Options
14537@subsection M680x0 Options
14538@cindex M680x0 options
14539
14540These are the @samp{-m} options defined for M680x0 and ColdFire processors.
14541The default settings depend on which architecture was selected when
14542the compiler was configured; the defaults for the most common choices
14543are given below.
14544
14545@table @gcctabopt
14546@item -march=@var{arch}
14547@opindex march
14548Generate code for a specific M680x0 or ColdFire instruction set
14549architecture.  Permissible values of @var{arch} for M680x0
14550architectures are: @samp{68000}, @samp{68010}, @samp{68020},
14551@samp{68030}, @samp{68040}, @samp{68060} and @samp{cpu32}.  ColdFire
14552architectures are selected according to Freescale's ISA classification
14553and the permissible values are: @samp{isaa}, @samp{isaaplus},
14554@samp{isab} and @samp{isac}.
14555
14556gcc defines a macro @samp{__mcf@var{arch}__} whenever it is generating
14557code for a ColdFire target.  The @var{arch} in this macro is one of the
14558@option{-march} arguments given above.
14559
14560When used together, @option{-march} and @option{-mtune} select code
14561that runs on a family of similar processors but that is optimized
14562for a particular microarchitecture.
14563
14564@item -mcpu=@var{cpu}
14565@opindex mcpu
14566Generate code for a specific M680x0 or ColdFire processor.
14567The M680x0 @var{cpu}s are: @samp{68000}, @samp{68010}, @samp{68020},
14568@samp{68030}, @samp{68040}, @samp{68060}, @samp{68302}, @samp{68332}
14569and @samp{cpu32}.  The ColdFire @var{cpu}s are given by the table
14570below, which also classifies the CPUs into families:
14571
14572@multitable @columnfractions 0.20 0.80
14573@item @strong{Family} @tab @strong{@samp{-mcpu} arguments}
14574@item @samp{51} @tab @samp{51} @samp{51ac} @samp{51cn} @samp{51em} @samp{51qe}
14575@item @samp{5206} @tab @samp{5202} @samp{5204} @samp{5206}
14576@item @samp{5206e} @tab @samp{5206e}
14577@item @samp{5208} @tab @samp{5207} @samp{5208}
14578@item @samp{5211a} @tab @samp{5210a} @samp{5211a}
14579@item @samp{5213} @tab @samp{5211} @samp{5212} @samp{5213}
14580@item @samp{5216} @tab @samp{5214} @samp{5216}
14581@item @samp{52235} @tab @samp{52230} @samp{52231} @samp{52232} @samp{52233} @samp{52234} @samp{52235}
14582@item @samp{5225} @tab @samp{5224} @samp{5225}
14583@item @samp{52259} @tab @samp{52252} @samp{52254} @samp{52255} @samp{52256} @samp{52258} @samp{52259}
14584@item @samp{5235} @tab @samp{5232} @samp{5233} @samp{5234} @samp{5235} @samp{523x}
14585@item @samp{5249} @tab @samp{5249}
14586@item @samp{5250} @tab @samp{5250}
14587@item @samp{5271} @tab @samp{5270} @samp{5271}
14588@item @samp{5272} @tab @samp{5272}
14589@item @samp{5275} @tab @samp{5274} @samp{5275}
14590@item @samp{5282} @tab @samp{5280} @samp{5281} @samp{5282} @samp{528x}
14591@item @samp{53017} @tab @samp{53011} @samp{53012} @samp{53013} @samp{53014} @samp{53015} @samp{53016} @samp{53017}
14592@item @samp{5307} @tab @samp{5307}
14593@item @samp{5329} @tab @samp{5327} @samp{5328} @samp{5329} @samp{532x}
14594@item @samp{5373} @tab @samp{5372} @samp{5373} @samp{537x}
14595@item @samp{5407} @tab @samp{5407}
14596@item @samp{5475} @tab @samp{5470} @samp{5471} @samp{5472} @samp{5473} @samp{5474} @samp{5475} @samp{547x} @samp{5480} @samp{5481} @samp{5482} @samp{5483} @samp{5484} @samp{5485}
14597@end multitable
14598
14599@option{-mcpu=@var{cpu}} overrides @option{-march=@var{arch}} if
14600@var{arch} is compatible with @var{cpu}.  Other combinations of
14601@option{-mcpu} and @option{-march} are rejected.
14602
14603gcc defines the macro @samp{__mcf_cpu_@var{cpu}} when ColdFire target
14604@var{cpu} is selected.  It also defines @samp{__mcf_family_@var{family}},
14605where the value of @var{family} is given by the table above.
14606
14607@item -mtune=@var{tune}
14608@opindex mtune
14609Tune the code for a particular microarchitecture, within the
14610constraints set by @option{-march} and @option{-mcpu}.
14611The M680x0 microarchitectures are: @samp{68000}, @samp{68010},
14612@samp{68020}, @samp{68030}, @samp{68040}, @samp{68060}
14613and @samp{cpu32}.  The ColdFire microarchitectures
14614are: @samp{cfv1}, @samp{cfv2}, @samp{cfv3}, @samp{cfv4} and @samp{cfv4e}.
14615
14616You can also use @option{-mtune=68020-40} for code that needs
14617to run relatively well on 68020, 68030 and 68040 targets.
14618@option{-mtune=68020-60} is similar but includes 68060 targets
14619as well.  These two options select the same tuning decisions as
14620@option{-m68020-40} and @option{-m68020-60} respectively.
14621
14622gcc defines the macros @samp{__mc@var{arch}} and @samp{__mc@var{arch}__}
14623when tuning for 680x0 architecture @var{arch}.  It also defines
14624@samp{mc@var{arch}} unless either @option{-ansi} or a non-GNU @option{-std}
14625option is used.  If gcc is tuning for a range of architectures,
14626as selected by @option{-mtune=68020-40} or @option{-mtune=68020-60},
14627it defines the macros for every architecture in the range.
14628
14629gcc also defines the macro @samp{__m@var{uarch}__} when tuning for
14630ColdFire microarchitecture @var{uarch}, where @var{uarch} is one
14631of the arguments given above.
14632
14633@item -m68000
14634@itemx -mc68000
14635@opindex m68000
14636@opindex mc68000
14637Generate output for a 68000.  This is the default
14638when the compiler is configured for 68000-based systems.
14639It is equivalent to @option{-march=68000}.
14640
14641Use this option for microcontrollers with a 68000 or EC000 core,
14642including the 68008, 68302, 68306, 68307, 68322, 68328 and 68356.
14643
14644@item -m68010
14645@opindex m68010
14646Generate output for a 68010.  This is the default
14647when the compiler is configured for 68010-based systems.
14648It is equivalent to @option{-march=68010}.
14649
14650@item -m68020
14651@itemx -mc68020
14652@opindex m68020
14653@opindex mc68020
14654Generate output for a 68020.  This is the default
14655when the compiler is configured for 68020-based systems.
14656It is equivalent to @option{-march=68020}.
14657
14658@item -m68030
14659@opindex m68030
14660Generate output for a 68030.  This is the default when the compiler is
14661configured for 68030-based systems.  It is equivalent to
14662@option{-march=68030}.
14663
14664@item -m68040
14665@opindex m68040
14666Generate output for a 68040.  This is the default when the compiler is
14667configured for 68040-based systems.  It is equivalent to
14668@option{-march=68040}.
14669
14670This option inhibits the use of 68881/68882 instructions that have to be
14671emulated by software on the 68040.  Use this option if your 68040 does not
14672have code to emulate those instructions.
14673
14674@item -m68060
14675@opindex m68060
14676Generate output for a 68060.  This is the default when the compiler is
14677configured for 68060-based systems.  It is equivalent to
14678@option{-march=68060}.
14679
14680This option inhibits the use of 68020 and 68881/68882 instructions that
14681have to be emulated by software on the 68060.  Use this option if your 68060
14682does not have code to emulate those instructions.
14683
14684@item -mcpu32
14685@opindex mcpu32
14686Generate output for a CPU32.  This is the default
14687when the compiler is configured for CPU32-based systems.
14688It is equivalent to @option{-march=cpu32}.
14689
14690Use this option for microcontrollers with a
14691CPU32 or CPU32+ core, including the 68330, 68331, 68332, 68333, 68334,
1469268336, 68340, 68341, 68349 and 68360.
14693
14694@item -m5200
14695@opindex m5200
14696Generate output for a 520X ColdFire CPU@.  This is the default
14697when the compiler is configured for 520X-based systems.
14698It is equivalent to @option{-mcpu=5206}, and is now deprecated
14699in favor of that option.
14700
14701Use this option for microcontroller with a 5200 core, including
14702the MCF5202, MCF5203, MCF5204 and MCF5206.
14703
14704@item -m5206e
14705@opindex m5206e
14706Generate output for a 5206e ColdFire CPU@.  The option is now
14707deprecated in favor of the equivalent @option{-mcpu=5206e}.
14708
14709@item -m528x
14710@opindex m528x
14711Generate output for a member of the ColdFire 528X family.
14712The option is now deprecated in favor of the equivalent
14713@option{-mcpu=528x}.
14714
14715@item -m5307
14716@opindex m5307
14717Generate output for a ColdFire 5307 CPU@.  The option is now deprecated
14718in favor of the equivalent @option{-mcpu=5307}.
14719
14720@item -m5407
14721@opindex m5407
14722Generate output for a ColdFire 5407 CPU@.  The option is now deprecated
14723in favor of the equivalent @option{-mcpu=5407}.
14724
14725@item -mcfv4e
14726@opindex mcfv4e
14727Generate output for a ColdFire V4e family CPU (e.g.@: 547x/548x).
14728This includes use of hardware floating-point instructions.
14729The option is equivalent to @option{-mcpu=547x}, and is now
14730deprecated in favor of that option.
14731
14732@item -m68020-40
14733@opindex m68020-40
14734Generate output for a 68040, without using any of the new instructions.
14735This results in code that can run relatively efficiently on either a
1473668020/68881 or a 68030 or a 68040.  The generated code does use the
1473768881 instructions that are emulated on the 68040.
14738
14739The option is equivalent to @option{-march=68020} @option{-mtune=68020-40}.
14740
14741@item -m68020-60
14742@opindex m68020-60
14743Generate output for a 68060, without using any of the new instructions.
14744This results in code that can run relatively efficiently on either a
1474568020/68881 or a 68030 or a 68040.  The generated code does use the
1474668881 instructions that are emulated on the 68060.
14747
14748The option is equivalent to @option{-march=68020} @option{-mtune=68020-60}.
14749
14750@item -mhard-float
14751@itemx -m68881
14752@opindex mhard-float
14753@opindex m68881
14754Generate floating-point instructions.  This is the default for 68020
14755and above, and for ColdFire devices that have an FPU@.  It defines the
14756macro @samp{__HAVE_68881__} on M680x0 targets and @samp{__mcffpu__}
14757on ColdFire targets.
14758
14759@item -msoft-float
14760@opindex msoft-float
14761Do not generate floating-point instructions; use library calls instead.
14762This is the default for 68000, 68010, and 68832 targets.  It is also
14763the default for ColdFire devices that have no FPU.
14764
14765@item -mdiv
14766@itemx -mno-div
14767@opindex mdiv
14768@opindex mno-div
14769Generate (do not generate) ColdFire hardware divide and remainder
14770instructions.  If @option{-march} is used without @option{-mcpu},
14771the default is ``on'' for ColdFire architectures and ``off'' for M680x0
14772architectures.  Otherwise, the default is taken from the target CPU
14773(either the default CPU, or the one specified by @option{-mcpu}).  For
14774example, the default is ``off'' for @option{-mcpu=5206} and ``on'' for
14775@option{-mcpu=5206e}.
14776
14777gcc defines the macro @samp{__mcfhwdiv__} when this option is enabled.
14778
14779@item -mshort
14780@opindex mshort
14781Consider type @code{int} to be 16 bits wide, like @code{short int}.
14782Additionally, parameters passed on the stack are also aligned to a
1478316-bit boundary even on targets whose API mandates promotion to 32-bit.
14784
14785@item -mno-short
14786@opindex mno-short
14787Do not consider type @code{int} to be 16 bits wide.  This is the default.
14788
14789@item -mnobitfield
14790@itemx -mno-bitfield
14791@opindex mnobitfield
14792@opindex mno-bitfield
14793Do not use the bit-field instructions.  The @option{-m68000}, @option{-mcpu32}
14794and @option{-m5200} options imply @w{@option{-mnobitfield}}.
14795
14796@item -mbitfield
14797@opindex mbitfield
14798Do use the bit-field instructions.  The @option{-m68020} option implies
14799@option{-mbitfield}.  This is the default if you use a configuration
14800designed for a 68020.
14801
14802@item -mrtd
14803@opindex mrtd
14804Use a different function-calling convention, in which functions
14805that take a fixed number of arguments return with the @code{rtd}
14806instruction, which pops their arguments while returning.  This
14807saves one instruction in the caller since there is no need to pop
14808the arguments there.
14809
14810This calling convention is incompatible with the one normally
14811used on Unix, so you cannot use it if you need to call libraries
14812compiled with the Unix compiler.
14813
14814Also, you must provide function prototypes for all functions that
14815take variable numbers of arguments (including @code{printf});
14816otherwise incorrect code will be generated for calls to those
14817functions.
14818
14819In addition, seriously incorrect code will result if you call a
14820function with too many arguments.  (Normally, extra arguments are
14821harmlessly ignored.)
14822
14823The @code{rtd} instruction is supported by the 68010, 68020, 68030,
1482468040, 68060 and CPU32 processors, but not by the 68000 or 5200.
14825
14826@item -mno-rtd
14827@opindex mno-rtd
14828Do not use the calling conventions selected by @option{-mrtd}.
14829This is the default.
14830
14831@item -malign-int
14832@itemx -mno-align-int
14833@opindex malign-int
14834@opindex mno-align-int
14835Control whether GCC aligns @code{int}, @code{long}, @code{long long},
14836@code{float}, @code{double}, and @code{long double} variables on a 32-bit
14837boundary (@option{-malign-int}) or a 16-bit boundary (@option{-mno-align-int}).
14838Aligning variables on 32-bit boundaries produces code that runs somewhat
14839faster on processors with 32-bit busses at the expense of more memory.
14840
14841@strong{Warning:} if you use the @option{-malign-int} switch, GCC will
14842align structures containing the above types  differently than
14843most published application binary interface specifications for the m68k.
14844
14845@item -mpcrel
14846@opindex mpcrel
14847Use the pc-relative addressing mode of the 68000 directly, instead of
14848using a global offset table.  At present, this option implies @option{-fpic},
14849allowing at most a 16-bit offset for pc-relative addressing.  @option{-fPIC} is
14850not presently supported with @option{-mpcrel}, though this could be supported for
1485168020 and higher processors.
14852
14853@item -mno-strict-align
14854@itemx -mstrict-align
14855@opindex mno-strict-align
14856@opindex mstrict-align
14857Do not (do) assume that unaligned memory references will be handled by
14858the system.
14859
14860@item -msep-data
14861Generate code that allows the data segment to be located in a different
14862area of memory from the text segment.  This allows for execute in place in
14863an environment without virtual memory management.  This option implies
14864@option{-fPIC}.
14865
14866@item -mno-sep-data
14867Generate code that assumes that the data segment follows the text segment.
14868This is the default.
14869
14870@item -mid-shared-library
14871Generate code that supports shared libraries via the library ID method.
14872This allows for execute in place and shared libraries in an environment
14873without virtual memory management.  This option implies @option{-fPIC}.
14874
14875@item -mno-id-shared-library
14876Generate code that doesn't assume ID based shared libraries are being used.
14877This is the default.
14878
14879@item -mshared-library-id=n
14880Specified the identification number of the ID based shared library being
14881compiled.  Specifying a value of 0 will generate more compact code, specifying
14882other values will force the allocation of that number to the current
14883library but is no more space or time efficient than omitting this option.
14884
14885@item -mxgot
14886@itemx -mno-xgot
14887@opindex mxgot
14888@opindex mno-xgot
14889When generating position-independent code for ColdFire, generate code
14890that works if the GOT has more than 8192 entries.  This code is
14891larger and slower than code generated without this option.  On M680x0
14892processors, this option is not needed; @option{-fPIC} suffices.
14893
14894GCC normally uses a single instruction to load values from the GOT@.
14895While this is relatively efficient, it only works if the GOT
14896is smaller than about 64k.  Anything larger causes the linker
14897to report an error such as:
14898
14899@cindex relocation truncated to fit (ColdFire)
14900@smallexample
14901relocation truncated to fit: R_68K_GOT16O foobar
14902@end smallexample
14903
14904If this happens, you should recompile your code with @option{-mxgot}.
14905It should then work with very large GOTs.  However, code generated with
14906@option{-mxgot} is less efficient, since it takes 4 instructions to fetch
14907the value of a global symbol.
14908
14909Note that some linkers, including newer versions of the GNU linker,
14910can create multiple GOTs and sort GOT entries.  If you have such a linker,
14911you should only need to use @option{-mxgot} when compiling a single
14912object file that accesses more than 8192 GOT entries.  Very few do.
14913
14914These options have no effect unless GCC is generating
14915position-independent code.
14916
14917@end table
14918
14919@node MCore Options
14920@subsection MCore Options
14921@cindex MCore options
14922
14923These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the Motorola M*Core
14924processors.
14925
14926@table @gcctabopt
14927
14928@item -mhardlit
14929@itemx -mno-hardlit
14930@opindex mhardlit
14931@opindex mno-hardlit
14932Inline constants into the code stream if it can be done in two
14933instructions or less.
14934
14935@item -mdiv
14936@itemx -mno-div
14937@opindex mdiv
14938@opindex mno-div
14939Use the divide instruction.  (Enabled by default).
14940
14941@item -mrelax-immediate
14942@itemx -mno-relax-immediate
14943@opindex mrelax-immediate
14944@opindex mno-relax-immediate
14945Allow arbitrary sized immediates in bit operations.
14946
14947@item -mwide-bitfields
14948@itemx -mno-wide-bitfields
14949@opindex mwide-bitfields
14950@opindex mno-wide-bitfields
14951Always treat bit-fields as int-sized.
14952
14953@item -m4byte-functions
14954@itemx -mno-4byte-functions
14955@opindex m4byte-functions
14956@opindex mno-4byte-functions
14957Force all functions to be aligned to a 4-byte boundary.
14958
14959@item -mcallgraph-data
14960@itemx -mno-callgraph-data
14961@opindex mcallgraph-data
14962@opindex mno-callgraph-data
14963Emit callgraph information.
14964
14965@item -mslow-bytes
14966@itemx -mno-slow-bytes
14967@opindex mslow-bytes
14968@opindex mno-slow-bytes
14969Prefer word access when reading byte quantities.
14970
14971@item -mlittle-endian
14972@itemx -mbig-endian
14973@opindex mlittle-endian
14974@opindex mbig-endian
14975Generate code for a little-endian target.
14976
14977@item -m210
14978@itemx -m340
14979@opindex m210
14980@opindex m340
14981Generate code for the 210 processor.
14982
14983@item -mno-lsim
14984@opindex mno-lsim
14985Assume that runtime support has been provided and so omit the
14986simulator library (@file{libsim.a)} from the linker command line.
14987
14988@item -mstack-increment=@var{size}
14989@opindex mstack-increment
14990Set the maximum amount for a single stack increment operation.  Large
14991values can increase the speed of programs that contain functions
14992that need a large amount of stack space, but they can also trigger a
14993segmentation fault if the stack is extended too much.  The default
14994value is 0x1000.
14995
14996@end table
14997
14998@node MeP Options
14999@subsection MeP Options
15000@cindex MeP options
15001
15002@table @gcctabopt
15003
15004@item -mabsdiff
15005@opindex mabsdiff
15006Enables the @code{abs} instruction, which is the absolute difference
15007between two registers.
15008
15009@item -mall-opts
15010@opindex mall-opts
15011Enables all the optional instructions - average, multiply, divide, bit
15012operations, leading zero, absolute difference, min/max, clip, and
15013saturation.
15014
15015
15016@item -maverage
15017@opindex maverage
15018Enables the @code{ave} instruction, which computes the average of two
15019registers.
15020
15021@item -mbased=@var{n}
15022@opindex mbased=
15023Variables of size @var{n} bytes or smaller will be placed in the
15024@code{.based} section by default.  Based variables use the @code{$tp}
15025register as a base register, and there is a 128-byte limit to the
15026@code{.based} section.
15027
15028@item -mbitops
15029@opindex mbitops
15030Enables the bit operation instructions - bit test (@code{btstm}), set
15031(@code{bsetm}), clear (@code{bclrm}), invert (@code{bnotm}), and
15032test-and-set (@code{tas}).
15033
15034@item -mc=@var{name}
15035@opindex mc=
15036Selects which section constant data will be placed in.  @var{name} may
15037be @code{tiny}, @code{near}, or @code{far}.
15038
15039@item -mclip
15040@opindex mclip
15041Enables the @code{clip} instruction.  Note that @code{-mclip} is not
15042useful unless you also provide @code{-mminmax}.
15043
15044@item -mconfig=@var{name}
15045@opindex mconfig=
15046Selects one of the build-in core configurations.  Each MeP chip has
15047one or more modules in it; each module has a core CPU and a variety of
15048coprocessors, optional instructions, and peripherals.  The
15049@code{MeP-Integrator} tool, not part of GCC, provides these
15050configurations through this option; using this option is the same as
15051using all the corresponding command-line options.  The default
15052configuration is @code{default}.
15053
15054@item -mcop
15055@opindex mcop
15056Enables the coprocessor instructions.  By default, this is a 32-bit
15057coprocessor.  Note that the coprocessor is normally enabled via the
15058@code{-mconfig=} option.
15059
15060@item -mcop32
15061@opindex mcop32
15062Enables the 32-bit coprocessor's instructions.
15063
15064@item -mcop64
15065@opindex mcop64
15066Enables the 64-bit coprocessor's instructions.
15067
15068@item -mivc2
15069@opindex mivc2
15070Enables IVC2 scheduling.  IVC2 is a 64-bit VLIW coprocessor.
15071
15072@item -mdc
15073@opindex mdc
15074Causes constant variables to be placed in the @code{.near} section.
15075
15076@item -mdiv
15077@opindex mdiv
15078Enables the @code{div} and @code{divu} instructions.
15079
15080@item -meb
15081@opindex meb
15082Generate big-endian code.
15083
15084@item -mel
15085@opindex mel
15086Generate little-endian code.
15087
15088@item -mio-volatile
15089@opindex mio-volatile
15090Tells the compiler that any variable marked with the @code{io}
15091attribute is to be considered volatile.
15092
15093@item -ml
15094@opindex ml
15095Causes variables to be assigned to the @code{.far} section by default.
15096
15097@item -mleadz
15098@opindex mleadz
15099Enables the @code{leadz} (leading zero) instruction.
15100
15101@item -mm
15102@opindex mm
15103Causes variables to be assigned to the @code{.near} section by default.
15104
15105@item -mminmax
15106@opindex mminmax
15107Enables the @code{min} and @code{max} instructions.
15108
15109@item -mmult
15110@opindex mmult
15111Enables the multiplication and multiply-accumulate instructions.
15112
15113@item -mno-opts
15114@opindex mno-opts
15115Disables all the optional instructions enabled by @code{-mall-opts}.
15116
15117@item -mrepeat
15118@opindex mrepeat
15119Enables the @code{repeat} and @code{erepeat} instructions, used for
15120low-overhead looping.
15121
15122@item -ms
15123@opindex ms
15124Causes all variables to default to the @code{.tiny} section.  Note
15125that there is a 65536-byte limit to this section.  Accesses to these
15126variables use the @code{%gp} base register.
15127
15128@item -msatur
15129@opindex msatur
15130Enables the saturation instructions.  Note that the compiler does not
15131currently generate these itself, but this option is included for
15132compatibility with other tools, like @code{as}.
15133
15134@item -msdram
15135@opindex msdram
15136Link the SDRAM-based runtime instead of the default ROM-based runtime.
15137
15138@item -msim
15139@opindex msim
15140Link the simulator runtime libraries.
15141
15142@item -msimnovec
15143@opindex msimnovec
15144Link the simulator runtime libraries, excluding built-in support
15145for reset and exception vectors and tables.
15146
15147@item -mtf
15148@opindex mtf
15149Causes all functions to default to the @code{.far} section.  Without
15150this option, functions default to the @code{.near} section.
15151
15152@item -mtiny=@var{n}
15153@opindex mtiny=
15154Variables that are @var{n} bytes or smaller will be allocated to the
15155@code{.tiny} section.  These variables use the @code{$gp} base
15156register.  The default for this option is 4, but note that there's a
1515765536-byte limit to the @code{.tiny} section.
15158
15159@end table
15160
15161@node MicroBlaze Options
15162@subsection MicroBlaze Options
15163@cindex MicroBlaze Options
15164
15165@table @gcctabopt
15166
15167@item -msoft-float
15168@opindex msoft-float
15169Use software emulation for floating point (default).
15170
15171@item -mhard-float
15172@opindex mhard-float
15173Use hardware floating-point instructions.
15174
15175@item -mmemcpy
15176@opindex mmemcpy
15177Do not optimize block moves, use @code{memcpy}.
15178
15179@item -mno-clearbss
15180@opindex mno-clearbss
15181This option is deprecated.  Use @option{-fno-zero-initialized-in-bss} instead.
15182
15183@item -mcpu=@var{cpu-type}
15184@opindex mcpu=
15185Use features of and schedule code for given CPU.
15186Supported values are in the format @samp{v@var{X}.@var{YY}.@var{Z}},
15187where @var{X} is a major version, @var{YY} is the minor version, and
15188@var{Z} is compatibility code.  Example values are @samp{v3.00.a},
15189@samp{v4.00.b}, @samp{v5.00.a}, @samp{v5.00.b}, @samp{v5.00.b}, @samp{v6.00.a}.
15190
15191@item -mxl-soft-mul
15192@opindex mxl-soft-mul
15193Use software multiply emulation (default).
15194
15195@item -mxl-soft-div
15196@opindex mxl-soft-div
15197Use software emulation for divides (default).
15198
15199@item -mxl-barrel-shift
15200@opindex mxl-barrel-shift
15201Use the hardware barrel shifter.
15202
15203@item -mxl-pattern-compare
15204@opindex mxl-pattern-compare
15205Use pattern compare instructions.
15206
15207@item -msmall-divides
15208@opindex msmall-divides
15209Use table lookup optimization for small signed integer divisions.
15210
15211@item -mxl-stack-check
15212@opindex mxl-stack-check
15213This option is deprecated.  Use -fstack-check instead.
15214
15215@item -mxl-gp-opt
15216@opindex mxl-gp-opt
15217Use GP relative sdata/sbss sections.
15218
15219@item -mxl-multiply-high
15220@opindex mxl-multiply-high
15221Use multiply high instructions for high part of 32x32 multiply.
15222
15223@item -mxl-float-convert
15224@opindex mxl-float-convert
15225Use hardware floating-point conversion instructions.
15226
15227@item -mxl-float-sqrt
15228@opindex mxl-float-sqrt
15229Use hardware floating-point square root instruction.
15230
15231@item -mxl-mode-@var{app-model}
15232Select application model @var{app-model}.  Valid models are
15233@table @samp
15234@item executable
15235normal executable (default), uses startup code @file{crt0.o}.
15236
15237@item xmdstub
15238for use with Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) based
15239software intrusive debug agent called xmdstub. This uses startup file
15240@file{crt1.o} and sets the start address of the program to be 0x800.
15241
15242@item bootstrap
15243for applications that are loaded using a bootloader.
15244This model uses startup file @file{crt2.o} which does not contain a processor
15245reset vector handler. This is suitable for transferring control on a
15246processor reset to the bootloader rather than the application.
15247
15248@item novectors
15249for applications that do not require any of the
15250MicroBlaze vectors. This option may be useful for applications running
15251within a monitoring application. This model uses @file{crt3.o} as a startup file.
15252@end table
15253
15254Option @option{-xl-mode-@var{app-model}} is a deprecated alias for
15255@option{-mxl-mode-@var{app-model}}.
15256
15257@end table
15258
15259@node MIPS Options
15260@subsection MIPS Options
15261@cindex MIPS options
15262
15263@table @gcctabopt
15264
15265@item -EB
15266@opindex EB
15267Generate big-endian code.
15268
15269@item -EL
15270@opindex EL
15271Generate little-endian code.  This is the default for @samp{mips*el-*-*}
15272configurations.
15273
15274@item -march=@var{arch}
15275@opindex march
15276Generate code that will run on @var{arch}, which can be the name of a
15277generic MIPS ISA, or the name of a particular processor.
15278The ISA names are:
15279@samp{mips1}, @samp{mips2}, @samp{mips3}, @samp{mips4},
15280@samp{mips32}, @samp{mips32r2}, @samp{mips64} and @samp{mips64r2}.
15281The processor names are:
15282@samp{4kc}, @samp{4km}, @samp{4kp}, @samp{4ksc},
15283@samp{4kec}, @samp{4kem}, @samp{4kep}, @samp{4ksd},
15284@samp{5kc}, @samp{5kf},
15285@samp{20kc},
15286@samp{24kc}, @samp{24kf2_1}, @samp{24kf1_1},
15287@samp{24kec}, @samp{24kef2_1}, @samp{24kef1_1},
15288@samp{34kc}, @samp{34kf2_1}, @samp{34kf1_1},
15289@samp{74kc}, @samp{74kf2_1}, @samp{74kf1_1}, @samp{74kf3_2},
15290@samp{1004kc}, @samp{1004kf2_1}, @samp{1004kf1_1},
15291@samp{loongson2e}, @samp{loongson2f}, @samp{loongson3a},
15292@samp{m4k},
15293@samp{octeon}, @samp{octeon+}, @samp{octeon2},
15294@samp{orion},
15295@samp{r2000}, @samp{r3000}, @samp{r3900}, @samp{r4000}, @samp{r4400},
15296@samp{r4600}, @samp{r4650}, @samp{r6000}, @samp{r8000},
15297@samp{rm7000}, @samp{rm9000},
15298@samp{r10000}, @samp{r12000}, @samp{r14000}, @samp{r16000},
15299@samp{sb1},
15300@samp{sr71000},
15301@samp{vr4100}, @samp{vr4111}, @samp{vr4120}, @samp{vr4130}, @samp{vr4300},
15302@samp{vr5000}, @samp{vr5400}, @samp{vr5500}
15303and @samp{xlr}.
15304The special value @samp{from-abi} selects the
15305most compatible architecture for the selected ABI (that is,
15306@samp{mips1} for 32-bit ABIs and @samp{mips3} for 64-bit ABIs)@.
15307
15308Native Linux/GNU and IRIX toolchains also support the value @samp{native},
15309which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
15310@option{-march=native} has no effect if GCC does not recognize
15311the processor.
15312
15313In processor names, a final @samp{000} can be abbreviated as @samp{k}
15314(for example, @samp{-march=r2k}).  Prefixes are optional, and
15315@samp{vr} may be written @samp{r}.
15316
15317Names of the form @samp{@var{n}f2_1} refer to processors with
15318FPUs clocked at half the rate of the core, names of the form
15319@samp{@var{n}f1_1} refer to processors with FPUs clocked at the same
15320rate as the core, and names of the form @samp{@var{n}f3_2} refer to
15321processors with FPUs clocked a ratio of 3:2 with respect to the core.
15322For compatibility reasons, @samp{@var{n}f} is accepted as a synonym
15323for @samp{@var{n}f2_1} while @samp{@var{n}x} and @samp{@var{b}fx} are
15324accepted as synonyms for @samp{@var{n}f1_1}.
15325
15326GCC defines two macros based on the value of this option.  The first
15327is @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}, which gives the name of target architecture, as
15328a string.  The second has the form @samp{_MIPS_ARCH_@var{foo}},
15329where @var{foo} is the capitalized value of @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}@.
15330For example, @samp{-march=r2000} will set @samp{_MIPS_ARCH}
15331to @samp{"r2000"} and define the macro @samp{_MIPS_ARCH_R2000}.
15332
15333Note that the @samp{_MIPS_ARCH} macro uses the processor names given
15334above.  In other words, it will have the full prefix and will not
15335abbreviate @samp{000} as @samp{k}.  In the case of @samp{from-abi},
15336the macro names the resolved architecture (either @samp{"mips1"} or
15337@samp{"mips3"}).  It names the default architecture when no
15338@option{-march} option is given.
15339
15340@item -mtune=@var{arch}
15341@opindex mtune
15342Optimize for @var{arch}.  Among other things, this option controls
15343the way instructions are scheduled, and the perceived cost of arithmetic
15344operations.  The list of @var{arch} values is the same as for
15345@option{-march}.
15346
15347When this option is not used, GCC will optimize for the processor
15348specified by @option{-march}.  By using @option{-march} and
15349@option{-mtune} together, it is possible to generate code that will
15350run on a family of processors, but optimize the code for one
15351particular member of that family.
15352
15353@samp{-mtune} defines the macros @samp{_MIPS_TUNE} and
15354@samp{_MIPS_TUNE_@var{foo}}, which work in the same way as the
15355@samp{-march} ones described above.
15356
15357@item -mips1
15358@opindex mips1
15359Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips1}.
15360
15361@item -mips2
15362@opindex mips2
15363Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips2}.
15364
15365@item -mips3
15366@opindex mips3
15367Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips3}.
15368
15369@item -mips4
15370@opindex mips4
15371Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips4}.
15372
15373@item -mips32
15374@opindex mips32
15375Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips32}.
15376
15377@item -mips32r2
15378@opindex mips32r2
15379Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips32r2}.
15380
15381@item -mips64
15382@opindex mips64
15383Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips64}.
15384
15385@item -mips64r2
15386@opindex mips64r2
15387Equivalent to @samp{-march=mips64r2}.
15388
15389@item -mips16
15390@itemx -mno-mips16
15391@opindex mips16
15392@opindex mno-mips16
15393Generate (do not generate) MIPS16 code.  If GCC is targetting a
15394MIPS32 or MIPS64 architecture, it will make use of the MIPS16e ASE@.
15395
15396MIPS16 code generation can also be controlled on a per-function basis
15397by means of @code{mips16} and @code{nomips16} attributes.
15398@xref{Function Attributes}, for more information.
15399
15400@item -mflip-mips16
15401@opindex mflip-mips16
15402Generate MIPS16 code on alternating functions.  This option is provided
15403for regression testing of mixed MIPS16/non-MIPS16 code generation, and is
15404not intended for ordinary use in compiling user code.
15405
15406@item -minterlink-mips16
15407@itemx -mno-interlink-mips16
15408@opindex minterlink-mips16
15409@opindex mno-interlink-mips16
15410Require (do not require) that non-MIPS16 code be link-compatible with
15411MIPS16 code.
15412
15413For example, non-MIPS16 code cannot jump directly to MIPS16 code;
15414it must either use a call or an indirect jump.  @option{-minterlink-mips16}
15415therefore disables direct jumps unless GCC knows that the target of the
15416jump is not MIPS16.
15417
15418@item -mabi=32
15419@itemx -mabi=o64
15420@itemx -mabi=n32
15421@itemx -mabi=64
15422@itemx -mabi=eabi
15423@opindex mabi=32
15424@opindex mabi=o64
15425@opindex mabi=n32
15426@opindex mabi=64
15427@opindex mabi=eabi
15428Generate code for the given ABI@.
15429
15430Note that the EABI has a 32-bit and a 64-bit variant.  GCC normally
15431generates 64-bit code when you select a 64-bit architecture, but you
15432can use @option{-mgp32} to get 32-bit code instead.
15433
15434For information about the O64 ABI, see
15435@uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/@/projects/@/mipso64-abi.html}.
15436
15437GCC supports a variant of the o32 ABI in which floating-point registers
15438are 64 rather than 32 bits wide.  You can select this combination with
15439@option{-mabi=32} @option{-mfp64}.  This ABI relies on the @samp{mthc1}
15440and @samp{mfhc1} instructions and is therefore only supported for
15441MIPS32R2 processors.
15442
15443The register assignments for arguments and return values remain the
15444same, but each scalar value is passed in a single 64-bit register
15445rather than a pair of 32-bit registers.  For example, scalar
15446floating-point values are returned in @samp{$f0} only, not a
15447@samp{$f0}/@samp{$f1} pair.  The set of call-saved registers also
15448remains the same, but all 64 bits are saved.
15449
15450@item -mabicalls
15451@itemx -mno-abicalls
15452@opindex mabicalls
15453@opindex mno-abicalls
15454Generate (do not generate) code that is suitable for SVR4-style
15455dynamic objects.  @option{-mabicalls} is the default for SVR4-based
15456systems.
15457
15458@item -mshared
15459@itemx -mno-shared
15460Generate (do not generate) code that is fully position-independent,
15461and that can therefore be linked into shared libraries.  This option
15462only affects @option{-mabicalls}.
15463
15464All @option{-mabicalls} code has traditionally been position-independent,
15465regardless of options like @option{-fPIC} and @option{-fpic}.  However,
15466as an extension, the GNU toolchain allows executables to use absolute
15467accesses for locally-binding symbols.  It can also use shorter GP
15468initialization sequences and generate direct calls to locally-defined
15469functions.  This mode is selected by @option{-mno-shared}.
15470
15471@option{-mno-shared} depends on binutils 2.16 or higher and generates
15472objects that can only be linked by the GNU linker.  However, the option
15473does not affect the ABI of the final executable; it only affects the ABI
15474of relocatable objects.  Using @option{-mno-shared} will generally make
15475executables both smaller and quicker.
15476
15477@option{-mshared} is the default.
15478
15479@item -mplt
15480@itemx -mno-plt
15481@opindex mplt
15482@opindex mno-plt
15483Assume (do not assume) that the static and dynamic linkers
15484support PLTs and copy relocations.  This option only affects
15485@samp{-mno-shared -mabicalls}.  For the n64 ABI, this option
15486has no effect without @samp{-msym32}.
15487
15488You can make @option{-mplt} the default by configuring
15489GCC with @option{--with-mips-plt}.  The default is
15490@option{-mno-plt} otherwise.
15491
15492@item -mxgot
15493@itemx -mno-xgot
15494@opindex mxgot
15495@opindex mno-xgot
15496Lift (do not lift) the usual restrictions on the size of the global
15497offset table.
15498
15499GCC normally uses a single instruction to load values from the GOT@.
15500While this is relatively efficient, it will only work if the GOT
15501is smaller than about 64k.  Anything larger will cause the linker
15502to report an error such as:
15503
15504@cindex relocation truncated to fit (MIPS)
15505@smallexample
15506relocation truncated to fit: R_MIPS_GOT16 foobar
15507@end smallexample
15508
15509If this happens, you should recompile your code with @option{-mxgot}.
15510It should then work with very large GOTs, although it will also be
15511less efficient, since it will take three instructions to fetch the
15512value of a global symbol.
15513
15514Note that some linkers can create multiple GOTs.  If you have such a
15515linker, you should only need to use @option{-mxgot} when a single object
15516file accesses more than 64k's worth of GOT entries.  Very few do.
15517
15518These options have no effect unless GCC is generating position
15519independent code.
15520
15521@item -mgp32
15522@opindex mgp32
15523Assume that general-purpose registers are 32 bits wide.
15524
15525@item -mgp64
15526@opindex mgp64
15527Assume that general-purpose registers are 64 bits wide.
15528
15529@item -mfp32
15530@opindex mfp32
15531Assume that floating-point registers are 32 bits wide.
15532
15533@item -mfp64
15534@opindex mfp64
15535Assume that floating-point registers are 64 bits wide.
15536
15537@item -mhard-float
15538@opindex mhard-float
15539Use floating-point coprocessor instructions.
15540
15541@item -msoft-float
15542@opindex msoft-float
15543Do not use floating-point coprocessor instructions.  Implement
15544floating-point calculations using library calls instead.
15545
15546@item -msingle-float
15547@opindex msingle-float
15548Assume that the floating-point coprocessor only supports single-precision
15549operations.
15550
15551@item -mdouble-float
15552@opindex mdouble-float
15553Assume that the floating-point coprocessor supports double-precision
15554operations.  This is the default.
15555
15556@item -mllsc
15557@itemx -mno-llsc
15558@opindex mllsc
15559@opindex mno-llsc
15560Use (do not use) @samp{ll}, @samp{sc}, and @samp{sync} instructions to
15561implement atomic memory built-in functions.  When neither option is
15562specified, GCC will use the instructions if the target architecture
15563supports them.
15564
15565@option{-mllsc} is useful if the runtime environment can emulate the
15566instructions and @option{-mno-llsc} can be useful when compiling for
15567nonstandard ISAs.  You can make either option the default by
15568configuring GCC with @option{--with-llsc} and @option{--without-llsc}
15569respectively.  @option{--with-llsc} is the default for some
15570configurations; see the installation documentation for details.
15571
15572@item -mdsp
15573@itemx -mno-dsp
15574@opindex mdsp
15575@opindex mno-dsp
15576Use (do not use) revision 1 of the MIPS DSP ASE@.
15577@xref{MIPS DSP Built-in Functions}.  This option defines the
15578preprocessor macro @samp{__mips_dsp}.  It also defines
15579@samp{__mips_dsp_rev} to 1.
15580
15581@item -mdspr2
15582@itemx -mno-dspr2
15583@opindex mdspr2
15584@opindex mno-dspr2
15585Use (do not use) revision 2 of the MIPS DSP ASE@.
15586@xref{MIPS DSP Built-in Functions}.  This option defines the
15587preprocessor macros @samp{__mips_dsp} and @samp{__mips_dspr2}.
15588It also defines @samp{__mips_dsp_rev} to 2.
15589
15590@item -msmartmips
15591@itemx -mno-smartmips
15592@opindex msmartmips
15593@opindex mno-smartmips
15594Use (do not use) the MIPS SmartMIPS ASE.
15595
15596@item -mpaired-single
15597@itemx -mno-paired-single
15598@opindex mpaired-single
15599@opindex mno-paired-single
15600Use (do not use) paired-single floating-point instructions.
15601@xref{MIPS Paired-Single Support}.  This option requires
15602hardware floating-point support to be enabled.
15603
15604@item -mdmx
15605@itemx -mno-mdmx
15606@opindex mdmx
15607@opindex mno-mdmx
15608Use (do not use) MIPS Digital Media Extension instructions.
15609This option can only be used when generating 64-bit code and requires
15610hardware floating-point support to be enabled.
15611
15612@item -mips3d
15613@itemx -mno-mips3d
15614@opindex mips3d
15615@opindex mno-mips3d
15616Use (do not use) the MIPS-3D ASE@.  @xref{MIPS-3D Built-in Functions}.
15617The option @option{-mips3d} implies @option{-mpaired-single}.
15618
15619@item -mmt
15620@itemx -mno-mt
15621@opindex mmt
15622@opindex mno-mt
15623Use (do not use) MT Multithreading instructions.
15624
15625@item -mlong64
15626@opindex mlong64
15627Force @code{long} types to be 64 bits wide.  See @option{-mlong32} for
15628an explanation of the default and the way that the pointer size is
15629determined.
15630
15631@item -mlong32
15632@opindex mlong32
15633Force @code{long}, @code{int}, and pointer types to be 32 bits wide.
15634
15635The default size of @code{int}s, @code{long}s and pointers depends on
15636the ABI@.  All the supported ABIs use 32-bit @code{int}s.  The n64 ABI
15637uses 64-bit @code{long}s, as does the 64-bit EABI; the others use
1563832-bit @code{long}s.  Pointers are the same size as @code{long}s,
15639or the same size as integer registers, whichever is smaller.
15640
15641@item -msym32
15642@itemx -mno-sym32
15643@opindex msym32
15644@opindex mno-sym32
15645Assume (do not assume) that all symbols have 32-bit values, regardless
15646of the selected ABI@.  This option is useful in combination with
15647@option{-mabi=64} and @option{-mno-abicalls} because it allows GCC
15648to generate shorter and faster references to symbolic addresses.
15649
15650@item -G @var{num}
15651@opindex G
15652Put definitions of externally-visible data in a small data section
15653if that data is no bigger than @var{num} bytes.  GCC can then access
15654the data more efficiently; see @option{-mgpopt} for details.
15655
15656The default @option{-G} option depends on the configuration.
15657
15658@item -mlocal-sdata
15659@itemx -mno-local-sdata
15660@opindex mlocal-sdata
15661@opindex mno-local-sdata
15662Extend (do not extend) the @option{-G} behavior to local data too,
15663such as to static variables in C@.  @option{-mlocal-sdata} is the
15664default for all configurations.
15665
15666If the linker complains that an application is using too much small data,
15667you might want to try rebuilding the less performance-critical parts with
15668@option{-mno-local-sdata}.  You might also want to build large
15669libraries with @option{-mno-local-sdata}, so that the libraries leave
15670more room for the main program.
15671
15672@item -mextern-sdata
15673@itemx -mno-extern-sdata
15674@opindex mextern-sdata
15675@opindex mno-extern-sdata
15676Assume (do not assume) that externally-defined data will be in
15677a small data section if that data is within the @option{-G} limit.
15678@option{-mextern-sdata} is the default for all configurations.
15679
15680If you compile a module @var{Mod} with @option{-mextern-sdata} @option{-G
15681@var{num}} @option{-mgpopt}, and @var{Mod} references a variable @var{Var}
15682that is no bigger than @var{num} bytes, you must make sure that @var{Var}
15683is placed in a small data section.  If @var{Var} is defined by another
15684module, you must either compile that module with a high-enough
15685@option{-G} setting or attach a @code{section} attribute to @var{Var}'s
15686definition.  If @var{Var} is common, you must link the application
15687with a high-enough @option{-G} setting.
15688
15689The easiest way of satisfying these restrictions is to compile
15690and link every module with the same @option{-G} option.  However,
15691you may wish to build a library that supports several different
15692small data limits.  You can do this by compiling the library with
15693the highest supported @option{-G} setting and additionally using
15694@option{-mno-extern-sdata} to stop the library from making assumptions
15695about externally-defined data.
15696
15697@item -mgpopt
15698@itemx -mno-gpopt
15699@opindex mgpopt
15700@opindex mno-gpopt
15701Use (do not use) GP-relative accesses for symbols that are known to be
15702in a small data section; see @option{-G}, @option{-mlocal-sdata} and
15703@option{-mextern-sdata}.  @option{-mgpopt} is the default for all
15704configurations.
15705
15706@option{-mno-gpopt} is useful for cases where the @code{$gp} register
15707might not hold the value of @code{_gp}.  For example, if the code is
15708part of a library that might be used in a boot monitor, programs that
15709call boot monitor routines will pass an unknown value in @code{$gp}.
15710(In such situations, the boot monitor itself would usually be compiled
15711with @option{-G0}.)
15712
15713@option{-mno-gpopt} implies @option{-mno-local-sdata} and
15714@option{-mno-extern-sdata}.
15715
15716@item -membedded-data
15717@itemx -mno-embedded-data
15718@opindex membedded-data
15719@opindex mno-embedded-data
15720Allocate variables to the read-only data section first if possible, then
15721next in the small data section if possible, otherwise in data.  This gives
15722slightly slower code than the default, but reduces the amount of RAM required
15723when executing, and thus may be preferred for some embedded systems.
15724
15725@item -muninit-const-in-rodata
15726@itemx -mno-uninit-const-in-rodata
15727@opindex muninit-const-in-rodata
15728@opindex mno-uninit-const-in-rodata
15729Put uninitialized @code{const} variables in the read-only data section.
15730This option is only meaningful in conjunction with @option{-membedded-data}.
15731
15732@item -mcode-readable=@var{setting}
15733@opindex mcode-readable
15734Specify whether GCC may generate code that reads from executable sections.
15735There are three possible settings:
15736
15737@table @gcctabopt
15738@item -mcode-readable=yes
15739Instructions may freely access executable sections.  This is the
15740default setting.
15741
15742@item -mcode-readable=pcrel
15743MIPS16 PC-relative load instructions can access executable sections,
15744but other instructions must not do so.  This option is useful on 4KSc
15745and 4KSd processors when the code TLBs have the Read Inhibit bit set.
15746It is also useful on processors that can be configured to have a dual
15747instruction/data SRAM interface and that, like the M4K, automatically
15748redirect PC-relative loads to the instruction RAM.
15749
15750@item -mcode-readable=no
15751Instructions must not access executable sections.  This option can be
15752useful on targets that are configured to have a dual instruction/data
15753SRAM interface but that (unlike the M4K) do not automatically redirect
15754PC-relative loads to the instruction RAM.
15755@end table
15756
15757@item -msplit-addresses
15758@itemx -mno-split-addresses
15759@opindex msplit-addresses
15760@opindex mno-split-addresses
15761Enable (disable) use of the @code{%hi()} and @code{%lo()} assembler
15762relocation operators.  This option has been superseded by
15763@option{-mexplicit-relocs} but is retained for backwards compatibility.
15764
15765@item -mexplicit-relocs
15766@itemx -mno-explicit-relocs
15767@opindex mexplicit-relocs
15768@opindex mno-explicit-relocs
15769Use (do not use) assembler relocation operators when dealing with symbolic
15770addresses.  The alternative, selected by @option{-mno-explicit-relocs},
15771is to use assembler macros instead.
15772
15773@option{-mexplicit-relocs} is the default if GCC was configured
15774to use an assembler that supports relocation operators.
15775
15776@item -mcheck-zero-division
15777@itemx -mno-check-zero-division
15778@opindex mcheck-zero-division
15779@opindex mno-check-zero-division
15780Trap (do not trap) on integer division by zero.
15781
15782The default is @option{-mcheck-zero-division}.
15783
15784@item -mdivide-traps
15785@itemx -mdivide-breaks
15786@opindex mdivide-traps
15787@opindex mdivide-breaks
15788MIPS systems check for division by zero by generating either a
15789conditional trap or a break instruction.  Using traps results in
15790smaller code, but is only supported on MIPS II and later.  Also, some
15791versions of the Linux kernel have a bug that prevents trap from
15792generating the proper signal (@code{SIGFPE}).  Use @option{-mdivide-traps} to
15793allow conditional traps on architectures that support them and
15794@option{-mdivide-breaks} to force the use of breaks.
15795
15796The default is usually @option{-mdivide-traps}, but this can be
15797overridden at configure time using @option{--with-divide=breaks}.
15798Divide-by-zero checks can be completely disabled using
15799@option{-mno-check-zero-division}.
15800
15801@item -mmemcpy
15802@itemx -mno-memcpy
15803@opindex mmemcpy
15804@opindex mno-memcpy
15805Force (do not force) the use of @code{memcpy()} for non-trivial block
15806moves.  The default is @option{-mno-memcpy}, which allows GCC to inline
15807most constant-sized copies.
15808
15809@item -mlong-calls
15810@itemx -mno-long-calls
15811@opindex mlong-calls
15812@opindex mno-long-calls
15813Disable (do not disable) use of the @code{jal} instruction.  Calling
15814functions using @code{jal} is more efficient but requires the caller
15815and callee to be in the same 256 megabyte segment.
15816
15817This option has no effect on abicalls code.  The default is
15818@option{-mno-long-calls}.
15819
15820@item -mmad
15821@itemx -mno-mad
15822@opindex mmad
15823@opindex mno-mad
15824Enable (disable) use of the @code{mad}, @code{madu} and @code{mul}
15825instructions, as provided by the R4650 ISA@.
15826
15827@item -mfused-madd
15828@itemx -mno-fused-madd
15829@opindex mfused-madd
15830@opindex mno-fused-madd
15831Enable (disable) use of the floating-point multiply-accumulate
15832instructions, when they are available.  The default is
15833@option{-mfused-madd}.
15834
15835When multiply-accumulate instructions are used, the intermediate
15836product is calculated to infinite precision and is not subject to
15837the FCSR Flush to Zero bit.  This may be undesirable in some
15838circumstances.
15839
15840@item -nocpp
15841@opindex nocpp
15842Tell the MIPS assembler to not run its preprocessor over user
15843assembler files (with a @samp{.s} suffix) when assembling them.
15844
15845@item -mfix-24k
15846@item -mno-fix-24k
15847@opindex mfix-24k
15848@opindex mno-fix-24k
15849Work around the 24K E48 (lost data on stores during refill) errata.
15850The workarounds are implemented by the assembler rather than by GCC.
15851
15852@item -mfix-r4000
15853@itemx -mno-fix-r4000
15854@opindex mfix-r4000
15855@opindex mno-fix-r4000
15856Work around certain R4000 CPU errata:
15857@itemize @minus
15858@item
15859A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result if executed
15860immediately after starting an integer division.
15861@item
15862A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result if executed
15863while an integer multiplication is in progress.
15864@item
15865An integer division may give an incorrect result if started in a delay slot
15866of a taken branch or a jump.
15867@end itemize
15868
15869@item -mfix-r4400
15870@itemx -mno-fix-r4400
15871@opindex mfix-r4400
15872@opindex mno-fix-r4400
15873Work around certain R4400 CPU errata:
15874@itemize @minus
15875@item
15876A double-word or a variable shift may give an incorrect result if executed
15877immediately after starting an integer division.
15878@end itemize
15879
15880@item -mfix-r10000
15881@itemx -mno-fix-r10000
15882@opindex mfix-r10000
15883@opindex mno-fix-r10000
15884Work around certain R10000 errata:
15885@itemize @minus
15886@item
15887@code{ll}/@code{sc} sequences may not behave atomically on revisions
15888prior to 3.0.  They may deadlock on revisions 2.6 and earlier.
15889@end itemize
15890
15891This option can only be used if the target architecture supports
15892branch-likely instructions.  @option{-mfix-r10000} is the default when
15893@option{-march=r10000} is used; @option{-mno-fix-r10000} is the default
15894otherwise.
15895
15896@item -mfix-vr4120
15897@itemx -mno-fix-vr4120
15898@opindex mfix-vr4120
15899Work around certain VR4120 errata:
15900@itemize @minus
15901@item
15902@code{dmultu} does not always produce the correct result.
15903@item
15904@code{div} and @code{ddiv} do not always produce the correct result if one
15905of the operands is negative.
15906@end itemize
15907The workarounds for the division errata rely on special functions in
15908@file{libgcc.a}.  At present, these functions are only provided by
15909the @code{mips64vr*-elf} configurations.
15910
15911Other VR4120 errata require a nop to be inserted between certain pairs of
15912instructions.  These errata are handled by the assembler, not by GCC itself.
15913
15914@item -mfix-vr4130
15915@opindex mfix-vr4130
15916Work around the VR4130 @code{mflo}/@code{mfhi} errata.  The
15917workarounds are implemented by the assembler rather than by GCC,
15918although GCC will avoid using @code{mflo} and @code{mfhi} if the
15919VR4130 @code{macc}, @code{macchi}, @code{dmacc} and @code{dmacchi}
15920instructions are available instead.
15921
15922@item -mfix-sb1
15923@itemx -mno-fix-sb1
15924@opindex mfix-sb1
15925Work around certain SB-1 CPU core errata.
15926(This flag currently works around the SB-1 revision 2
15927``F1'' and ``F2'' floating-point errata.)
15928
15929@item -mr10k-cache-barrier=@var{setting}
15930@opindex mr10k-cache-barrier
15931Specify whether GCC should insert cache barriers to avoid the
15932side-effects of speculation on R10K processors.
15933
15934In common with many processors, the R10K tries to predict the outcome
15935of a conditional branch and speculatively executes instructions from
15936the ``taken'' branch.  It later aborts these instructions if the
15937predicted outcome was wrong.  However, on the R10K, even aborted
15938instructions can have side effects.
15939
15940This problem only affects kernel stores and, depending on the system,
15941kernel loads.  As an example, a speculatively-executed store may load
15942the target memory into cache and mark the cache line as dirty, even if
15943the store itself is later aborted.  If a DMA operation writes to the
15944same area of memory before the ``dirty'' line is flushed, the cached
15945data will overwrite the DMA-ed data.  See the R10K processor manual
15946for a full description, including other potential problems.
15947
15948One workaround is to insert cache barrier instructions before every memory
15949access that might be speculatively executed and that might have side
15950effects even if aborted.  @option{-mr10k-cache-barrier=@var{setting}}
15951controls GCC's implementation of this workaround.  It assumes that
15952aborted accesses to any byte in the following regions will not have
15953side effects:
15954
15955@enumerate
15956@item
15957the memory occupied by the current function's stack frame;
15958
15959@item
15960the memory occupied by an incoming stack argument;
15961
15962@item
15963the memory occupied by an object with a link-time-constant address.
15964@end enumerate
15965
15966It is the kernel's responsibility to ensure that speculative
15967accesses to these regions are indeed safe.
15968
15969If the input program contains a function declaration such as:
15970
15971@smallexample
15972void foo (void);
15973@end smallexample
15974
15975then the implementation of @code{foo} must allow @code{j foo} and
15976@code{jal foo} to be executed speculatively.  GCC honors this
15977restriction for functions it compiles itself.  It expects non-GCC
15978functions (such as hand-written assembly code) to do the same.
15979
15980The option has three forms:
15981
15982@table @gcctabopt
15983@item -mr10k-cache-barrier=load-store
15984Insert a cache barrier before a load or store that might be
15985speculatively executed and that might have side effects even
15986if aborted.
15987
15988@item -mr10k-cache-barrier=store
15989Insert a cache barrier before a store that might be speculatively
15990executed and that might have side effects even if aborted.
15991
15992@item -mr10k-cache-barrier=none
15993Disable the insertion of cache barriers.  This is the default setting.
15994@end table
15995
15996@item -mflush-func=@var{func}
15997@itemx -mno-flush-func
15998@opindex mflush-func
15999Specifies the function to call to flush the I and D caches, or to not
16000call any such function.  If called, the function must take the same
16001arguments as the common @code{_flush_func()}, that is, the address of the
16002memory range for which the cache is being flushed, the size of the
16003memory range, and the number 3 (to flush both caches).  The default
16004depends on the target GCC was configured for, but commonly is either
16005@samp{_flush_func} or @samp{__cpu_flush}.
16006
16007@item mbranch-cost=@var{num}
16008@opindex mbranch-cost
16009Set the cost of branches to roughly @var{num} ``simple'' instructions.
16010This cost is only a heuristic and is not guaranteed to produce
16011consistent results across releases.  A zero cost redundantly selects
16012the default, which is based on the @option{-mtune} setting.
16013
16014@item -mbranch-likely
16015@itemx -mno-branch-likely
16016@opindex mbranch-likely
16017@opindex mno-branch-likely
16018Enable or disable use of Branch Likely instructions, regardless of the
16019default for the selected architecture.  By default, Branch Likely
16020instructions may be generated if they are supported by the selected
16021architecture.  An exception is for the MIPS32 and MIPS64 architectures
16022and processors that implement those architectures; for those, Branch
16023Likely instructions will not be generated by default because the MIPS32
16024and MIPS64 architectures specifically deprecate their use.
16025
16026@item -mfp-exceptions
16027@itemx -mno-fp-exceptions
16028@opindex mfp-exceptions
16029Specifies whether FP exceptions are enabled.  This affects how we schedule
16030FP instructions for some processors.  The default is that FP exceptions are
16031enabled.
16032
16033For instance, on the SB-1, if FP exceptions are disabled, and we are emitting
1603464-bit code, then we can use both FP pipes.  Otherwise, we can only use one
16035FP pipe.
16036
16037@item -mvr4130-align
16038@itemx -mno-vr4130-align
16039@opindex mvr4130-align
16040The VR4130 pipeline is two-way superscalar, but can only issue two
16041instructions together if the first one is 8-byte aligned.  When this
16042option is enabled, GCC will align pairs of instructions that it
16043thinks should execute in parallel.
16044
16045This option only has an effect when optimizing for the VR4130.
16046It normally makes code faster, but at the expense of making it bigger.
16047It is enabled by default at optimization level @option{-O3}.
16048
16049@item -msynci
16050@itemx -mno-synci
16051@opindex msynci
16052Enable (disable) generation of @code{synci} instructions on
16053architectures that support it.  The @code{synci} instructions (if
16054enabled) will be generated when @code{__builtin___clear_cache()} is
16055compiled.
16056
16057This option defaults to @code{-mno-synci}, but the default can be
16058overridden by configuring with @code{--with-synci}.
16059
16060When compiling code for single processor systems, it is generally safe
16061to use @code{synci}.  However, on many multi-core (SMP) systems, it
16062will not invalidate the instruction caches on all cores and may lead
16063to undefined behavior.
16064
16065@item -mrelax-pic-calls
16066@itemx -mno-relax-pic-calls
16067@opindex mrelax-pic-calls
16068Try to turn PIC calls that are normally dispatched via register
16069@code{$25} into direct calls.  This is only possible if the linker can
16070resolve the destination at link-time and if the destination is within
16071range for a direct call.
16072
16073@option{-mrelax-pic-calls} is the default if GCC was configured to use
16074an assembler and a linker that supports the @code{.reloc} assembly
16075directive and @code{-mexplicit-relocs} is in effect.  With
16076@code{-mno-explicit-relocs}, this optimization can be performed by the
16077assembler and the linker alone without help from the compiler.
16078
16079@item -mmcount-ra-address
16080@itemx -mno-mcount-ra-address
16081@opindex mmcount-ra-address
16082@opindex mno-mcount-ra-address
16083Emit (do not emit) code that allows @code{_mcount} to modify the
16084calling function's return address.  When enabled, this option extends
16085the usual @code{_mcount} interface with a new @var{ra-address}
16086parameter, which has type @code{intptr_t *} and is passed in register
16087@code{$12}.  @code{_mcount} can then modify the return address by
16088doing both of the following:
16089@itemize
16090@item
16091Returning the new address in register @code{$31}.
16092@item
16093Storing the new address in @code{*@var{ra-address}},
16094if @var{ra-address} is nonnull.
16095@end itemize
16096
16097The default is @option{-mno-mcount-ra-address}.
16098
16099@end table
16100
16101@node MMIX Options
16102@subsection MMIX Options
16103@cindex MMIX Options
16104
16105These options are defined for the MMIX:
16106
16107@table @gcctabopt
16108@item -mlibfuncs
16109@itemx -mno-libfuncs
16110@opindex mlibfuncs
16111@opindex mno-libfuncs
16112Specify that intrinsic library functions are being compiled, passing all
16113values in registers, no matter the size.
16114
16115@item -mepsilon
16116@itemx -mno-epsilon
16117@opindex mepsilon
16118@opindex mno-epsilon
16119Generate floating-point comparison instructions that compare with respect
16120to the @code{rE} epsilon register.
16121
16122@item -mabi=mmixware
16123@itemx -mabi=gnu
16124@opindex mabi=mmixware
16125@opindex mabi=gnu
16126Generate code that passes function parameters and return values that (in
16127the called function) are seen as registers @code{$0} and up, as opposed to
16128the GNU ABI which uses global registers @code{$231} and up.
16129
16130@item -mzero-extend
16131@itemx -mno-zero-extend
16132@opindex mzero-extend
16133@opindex mno-zero-extend
16134When reading data from memory in sizes shorter than 64 bits, use (do not
16135use) zero-extending load instructions by default, rather than
16136sign-extending ones.
16137
16138@item -mknuthdiv
16139@itemx -mno-knuthdiv
16140@opindex mknuthdiv
16141@opindex mno-knuthdiv
16142Make the result of a division yielding a remainder have the same sign as
16143the divisor.  With the default, @option{-mno-knuthdiv}, the sign of the
16144remainder follows the sign of the dividend.  Both methods are
16145arithmetically valid, the latter being almost exclusively used.
16146
16147@item -mtoplevel-symbols
16148@itemx -mno-toplevel-symbols
16149@opindex mtoplevel-symbols
16150@opindex mno-toplevel-symbols
16151Prepend (do not prepend) a @samp{:} to all global symbols, so the assembly
16152code can be used with the @code{PREFIX} assembly directive.
16153
16154@item -melf
16155@opindex melf
16156Generate an executable in the ELF format, rather than the default
16157@samp{mmo} format used by the @command{mmix} simulator.
16158
16159@item -mbranch-predict
16160@itemx -mno-branch-predict
16161@opindex mbranch-predict
16162@opindex mno-branch-predict
16163Use (do not use) the probable-branch instructions, when static branch
16164prediction indicates a probable branch.
16165
16166@item -mbase-addresses
16167@itemx -mno-base-addresses
16168@opindex mbase-addresses
16169@opindex mno-base-addresses
16170Generate (do not generate) code that uses @emph{base addresses}.  Using a
16171base address automatically generates a request (handled by the assembler
16172and the linker) for a constant to be set up in a global register.  The
16173register is used for one or more base address requests within the range 0
16174to 255 from the value held in the register.  The generally leads to short
16175and fast code, but the number of different data items that can be
16176addressed is limited.  This means that a program that uses lots of static
16177data may require @option{-mno-base-addresses}.
16178
16179@item -msingle-exit
16180@itemx -mno-single-exit
16181@opindex msingle-exit
16182@opindex mno-single-exit
16183Force (do not force) generated code to have a single exit point in each
16184function.
16185@end table
16186
16187@node MN10300 Options
16188@subsection MN10300 Options
16189@cindex MN10300 options
16190
16191These @option{-m} options are defined for Matsushita MN10300 architectures:
16192
16193@table @gcctabopt
16194@item -mmult-bug
16195@opindex mmult-bug
16196Generate code to avoid bugs in the multiply instructions for the MN10300
16197processors.  This is the default.
16198
16199@item -mno-mult-bug
16200@opindex mno-mult-bug
16201Do not generate code to avoid bugs in the multiply instructions for the
16202MN10300 processors.
16203
16204@item -mam33
16205@opindex mam33
16206Generate code using features specific to the AM33 processor.
16207
16208@item -mno-am33
16209@opindex mno-am33
16210Do not generate code using features specific to the AM33 processor.  This
16211is the default.
16212
16213@item -mam33-2
16214@opindex mam33-2
16215Generate code using features specific to the AM33/2.0 processor.
16216
16217@item -mam34
16218@opindex mam34
16219Generate code using features specific to the AM34 processor.
16220
16221@item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
16222@opindex mtune
16223Use the timing characteristics of the indicated CPU type when
16224scheduling instructions.  This does not change the targeted processor
16225type.  The CPU type must be one of @samp{mn10300}, @samp{am33},
16226@samp{am33-2} or @samp{am34}.
16227
16228@item -mreturn-pointer-on-d0
16229@opindex mreturn-pointer-on-d0
16230When generating a function that returns a pointer, return the pointer
16231in both @code{a0} and @code{d0}.  Otherwise, the pointer is returned
16232only in a0, and attempts to call such functions without a prototype
16233would result in errors.  Note that this option is on by default; use
16234@option{-mno-return-pointer-on-d0} to disable it.
16235
16236@item -mno-crt0
16237@opindex mno-crt0
16238Do not link in the C run-time initialization object file.
16239
16240@item -mrelax
16241@opindex mrelax
16242Indicate to the linker that it should perform a relaxation optimization pass
16243to shorten branches, calls and absolute memory addresses.  This option only
16244has an effect when used on the command line for the final link step.
16245
16246This option makes symbolic debugging impossible.
16247
16248@item -mliw
16249@opindex mliw
16250Allow the compiler to generate @emph{Long Instruction Word}
16251instructions if the target is the @samp{AM33} or later.  This is the
16252default.  This option defines the preprocessor macro @samp{__LIW__}.
16253
16254@item -mnoliw
16255@opindex mnoliw
16256Do not allow the compiler to generate @emph{Long Instruction Word}
16257instructions.  This option defines the preprocessor macro
16258@samp{__NO_LIW__}.
16259
16260@item -msetlb
16261@opindex msetlb
16262Allow the compiler to generate the @emph{SETLB} and @emph{Lcc}
16263instructions if the target is the @samp{AM33} or later.  This is the
16264default.  This option defines the preprocessor macro @samp{__SETLB__}.
16265
16266@item -mnosetlb
16267@opindex mnosetlb
16268Do not allow the compiler to generate @emph{SETLB} or @emph{Lcc}
16269instructions.  This option defines the preprocessor macro
16270@samp{__NO_SETLB__}.
16271
16272@end table
16273
16274@node PDP-11 Options
16275@subsection PDP-11 Options
16276@cindex PDP-11 Options
16277
16278These options are defined for the PDP-11:
16279
16280@table @gcctabopt
16281@item -mfpu
16282@opindex mfpu
16283Use hardware FPP floating point.  This is the default.  (FIS floating
16284point on the PDP-11/40 is not supported.)
16285
16286@item -msoft-float
16287@opindex msoft-float
16288Do not use hardware floating point.
16289
16290@item -mac0
16291@opindex mac0
16292Return floating-point results in ac0 (fr0 in Unix assembler syntax).
16293
16294@item -mno-ac0
16295@opindex mno-ac0
16296Return floating-point results in memory.  This is the default.
16297
16298@item -m40
16299@opindex m40
16300Generate code for a PDP-11/40.
16301
16302@item -m45
16303@opindex m45
16304Generate code for a PDP-11/45.  This is the default.
16305
16306@item -m10
16307@opindex m10
16308Generate code for a PDP-11/10.
16309
16310@item -mbcopy-builtin
16311@opindex mbcopy-builtin
16312Use inline @code{movmemhi} patterns for copying memory.  This is the
16313default.
16314
16315@item -mbcopy
16316@opindex mbcopy
16317Do not use inline @code{movmemhi} patterns for copying memory.
16318
16319@item -mint16
16320@itemx -mno-int32
16321@opindex mint16
16322@opindex mno-int32
16323Use 16-bit @code{int}.  This is the default.
16324
16325@item -mint32
16326@itemx -mno-int16
16327@opindex mint32
16328@opindex mno-int16
16329Use 32-bit @code{int}.
16330
16331@item -mfloat64
16332@itemx -mno-float32
16333@opindex mfloat64
16334@opindex mno-float32
16335Use 64-bit @code{float}.  This is the default.
16336
16337@item -mfloat32
16338@itemx -mno-float64
16339@opindex mfloat32
16340@opindex mno-float64
16341Use 32-bit @code{float}.
16342
16343@item -mabshi
16344@opindex mabshi
16345Use @code{abshi2} pattern.  This is the default.
16346
16347@item -mno-abshi
16348@opindex mno-abshi
16349Do not use @code{abshi2} pattern.
16350
16351@item -mbranch-expensive
16352@opindex mbranch-expensive
16353Pretend that branches are expensive.  This is for experimenting with
16354code generation only.
16355
16356@item -mbranch-cheap
16357@opindex mbranch-cheap
16358Do not pretend that branches are expensive.  This is the default.
16359
16360@item -munix-asm
16361@opindex munix-asm
16362Use Unix assembler syntax.  This is the default when configured for
16363@samp{pdp11-*-bsd}.
16364
16365@item -mdec-asm
16366@opindex mdec-asm
16367Use DEC assembler syntax.  This is the default when configured for any
16368PDP-11 target other than @samp{pdp11-*-bsd}.
16369@end table
16370
16371@node picoChip Options
16372@subsection picoChip Options
16373@cindex picoChip options
16374
16375These @samp{-m} options are defined for picoChip implementations:
16376
16377@table @gcctabopt
16378
16379@item -mae=@var{ae_type}
16380@opindex mcpu
16381Set the instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling
16382parameters for array element type @var{ae_type}.  Supported values
16383for @var{ae_type} are @samp{ANY}, @samp{MUL}, and @samp{MAC}.
16384
16385@option{-mae=ANY} selects a completely generic AE type.  Code
16386generated with this option will run on any of the other AE types.  The
16387code will not be as efficient as it would be if compiled for a specific
16388AE type, and some types of operation (e.g., multiplication) will not
16389work properly on all types of AE.
16390
16391@option{-mae=MUL} selects a MUL AE type.  This is the most useful AE type
16392for compiled code, and is the default.
16393
16394@option{-mae=MAC} selects a DSP-style MAC AE.  Code compiled with this
16395option may suffer from poor performance of byte (char) manipulation,
16396since the DSP AE does not provide hardware support for byte load/stores.
16397
16398@item -msymbol-as-address
16399Enable the compiler to directly use a symbol name as an address in a
16400load/store instruction, without first loading it into a
16401register.  Typically, the use of this option will generate larger
16402programs, which run faster than when the option isn't used.  However, the
16403results vary from program to program, so it is left as a user option,
16404rather than being permanently enabled.
16405
16406@item -mno-inefficient-warnings
16407Disables warnings about the generation of inefficient code.  These
16408warnings can be generated, for example, when compiling code that
16409performs byte-level memory operations on the MAC AE type.  The MAC AE has
16410no hardware support for byte-level memory operations, so all byte
16411load/stores must be synthesized from word load/store operations.  This is
16412inefficient and a warning will be generated indicating to the programmer
16413that they should rewrite the code to avoid byte operations, or to target
16414an AE type that has the necessary hardware support.  This option enables
16415the warning to be turned off.
16416
16417@end table
16418
16419@node PowerPC Options
16420@subsection PowerPC Options
16421@cindex PowerPC options
16422
16423These are listed under @xref{RS/6000 and PowerPC Options}.
16424
16425@node RL78 Options
16426@subsection RL78 Options
16427@cindex RL78 Options
16428
16429@table @gcctabopt
16430
16431@item -msim
16432@opindex msim
16433Links in additional target libraries to support operation within a
16434simulator.
16435
16436@item -mmul=none
16437@itemx -mmul=g13
16438@itemx -mmul=rl78
16439@opindex mmul
16440Specifies the type of hardware multiplication support to be used.  The
16441default is @code{none}, which uses software multiplication functions.
16442The @code{g13} option is for the hardware multiply/divide peripheral
16443only on the RL78/G13 targets.  The @code{rl78} option is for the
16444standard hardware multiplication defined in the RL78 software manual.
16445
16446@end table
16447
16448@node RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
16449@subsection IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
16450@cindex RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
16451@cindex IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC Options
16452
16453These @samp{-m} options are defined for the IBM RS/6000 and PowerPC:
16454@table @gcctabopt
16455@item -mpower
16456@itemx -mno-power
16457@itemx -mpower2
16458@itemx -mno-power2
16459@itemx -mpowerpc
16460@itemx -mno-powerpc
16461@itemx -mpowerpc-gpopt
16462@itemx -mno-powerpc-gpopt
16463@itemx -mpowerpc-gfxopt
16464@itemx -mno-powerpc-gfxopt
16465@need 800
16466@itemx -mpowerpc64
16467@itemx -mno-powerpc64
16468@itemx -mmfcrf
16469@itemx -mno-mfcrf
16470@itemx -mpopcntb
16471@itemx -mno-popcntb
16472@itemx -mpopcntd
16473@itemx -mno-popcntd
16474@itemx -mfprnd
16475@itemx -mno-fprnd
16476@need 800
16477@itemx -mcmpb
16478@itemx -mno-cmpb
16479@itemx -mmfpgpr
16480@itemx -mno-mfpgpr
16481@itemx -mhard-dfp
16482@itemx -mno-hard-dfp
16483@opindex mpower
16484@opindex mno-power
16485@opindex mpower2
16486@opindex mno-power2
16487@opindex mpowerpc
16488@opindex mno-powerpc
16489@opindex mpowerpc-gpopt
16490@opindex mno-powerpc-gpopt
16491@opindex mpowerpc-gfxopt
16492@opindex mno-powerpc-gfxopt
16493@opindex mpowerpc64
16494@opindex mno-powerpc64
16495@opindex mmfcrf
16496@opindex mno-mfcrf
16497@opindex mpopcntb
16498@opindex mno-popcntb
16499@opindex mpopcntd
16500@opindex mno-popcntd
16501@opindex mfprnd
16502@opindex mno-fprnd
16503@opindex mcmpb
16504@opindex mno-cmpb
16505@opindex mmfpgpr
16506@opindex mno-mfpgpr
16507@opindex mhard-dfp
16508@opindex mno-hard-dfp
16509GCC supports two related instruction set architectures for the
16510RS/6000 and PowerPC@.  The @dfn{POWER} instruction set are those
16511instructions supported by the @samp{rios} chip set used in the original
16512RS/6000 systems and the @dfn{PowerPC} instruction set is the
16513architecture of the Freescale MPC5xx, MPC6xx, MPC8xx microprocessors, and
16514the IBM 4xx, 6xx, and follow-on microprocessors.
16515
16516Neither architecture is a subset of the other.  However there is a
16517large common subset of instructions supported by both.  An MQ
16518register is included in processors supporting the POWER architecture.
16519
16520You use these options to specify which instructions are available on the
16521processor you are using.  The default value of these options is
16522determined when configuring GCC@.  Specifying the
16523@option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} overrides the specification of these
16524options.  We recommend you use the @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} option
16525rather than the options listed above.
16526
16527The @option{-mpower} option allows GCC to generate instructions that
16528are found only in the POWER architecture and to use the MQ register.
16529Specifying @option{-mpower2} implies @option{-power} and also allows GCC
16530to generate instructions that are present in the POWER2 architecture but
16531not the original POWER architecture.
16532
16533The @option{-mpowerpc} option allows GCC to generate instructions that
16534are found only in the 32-bit subset of the PowerPC architecture.
16535Specifying @option{-mpowerpc-gpopt} implies @option{-mpowerpc} and also allows
16536GCC to use the optional PowerPC architecture instructions in the
16537General Purpose group, including floating-point square root.  Specifying
16538@option{-mpowerpc-gfxopt} implies @option{-mpowerpc} and also allows GCC to
16539use the optional PowerPC architecture instructions in the Graphics
16540group, including floating-point select.
16541
16542The @option{-mmfcrf} option allows GCC to generate the move from
16543condition register field instruction implemented on the POWER4
16544processor and other processors that support the PowerPC V2.01
16545architecture.
16546The @option{-mpopcntb} option allows GCC to generate the popcount and
16547double-precision FP reciprocal estimate instruction implemented on the
16548POWER5 processor and other processors that support the PowerPC V2.02
16549architecture.
16550The @option{-mpopcntd} option allows GCC to generate the popcount
16551instruction implemented on the POWER7 processor and other processors
16552that support the PowerPC V2.06 architecture.
16553The @option{-mfprnd} option allows GCC to generate the FP round to
16554integer instructions implemented on the POWER5+ processor and other
16555processors that support the PowerPC V2.03 architecture.
16556The @option{-mcmpb} option allows GCC to generate the compare bytes
16557instruction implemented on the POWER6 processor and other processors
16558that support the PowerPC V2.05 architecture.
16559The @option{-mmfpgpr} option allows GCC to generate the FP move to/from
16560general-purpose register instructions implemented on the POWER6X
16561processor and other processors that support the extended PowerPC V2.05
16562architecture.
16563The @option{-mhard-dfp} option allows GCC to generate the decimal
16564floating-point instructions implemented on some POWER processors.
16565
16566The @option{-mpowerpc64} option allows GCC to generate the additional
1656764-bit instructions that are found in the full PowerPC64 architecture
16568and to treat GPRs as 64-bit, doubleword quantities.  GCC defaults to
16569@option{-mno-powerpc64}.
16570
16571If you specify both @option{-mno-power} and @option{-mno-powerpc}, GCC
16572will use only the instructions in the common subset of both
16573architectures plus some special AIX common-mode calls, and will not use
16574the MQ register.  Specifying both @option{-mpower} and @option{-mpowerpc}
16575permits GCC to use any instruction from either architecture and to
16576allow use of the MQ register; specify this for the Motorola MPC601.
16577
16578@item -mnew-mnemonics
16579@itemx -mold-mnemonics
16580@opindex mnew-mnemonics
16581@opindex mold-mnemonics
16582Select which mnemonics to use in the generated assembler code.  With
16583@option{-mnew-mnemonics}, GCC uses the assembler mnemonics defined for
16584the PowerPC architecture.  With @option{-mold-mnemonics} it uses the
16585assembler mnemonics defined for the POWER architecture.  Instructions
16586defined in only one architecture have only one mnemonic; GCC uses that
16587mnemonic irrespective of which of these options is specified.
16588
16589GCC defaults to the mnemonics appropriate for the architecture in
16590use.  Specifying @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} sometimes overrides the
16591value of these option.  Unless you are building a cross-compiler, you
16592should normally not specify either @option{-mnew-mnemonics} or
16593@option{-mold-mnemonics}, but should instead accept the default.
16594
16595@item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
16596@opindex mcpu
16597Set architecture type, register usage, choice of mnemonics, and
16598instruction scheduling parameters for machine type @var{cpu_type}.
16599Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are @samp{401}, @samp{403},
16600@samp{405}, @samp{405fp}, @samp{440}, @samp{440fp}, @samp{464}, @samp{464fp},
16601@samp{476}, @samp{476fp}, @samp{505}, @samp{601}, @samp{602}, @samp{603},
16602@samp{603e}, @samp{604}, @samp{604e}, @samp{620}, @samp{630}, @samp{740},
16603@samp{7400}, @samp{7450}, @samp{750}, @samp{801}, @samp{821}, @samp{823},
16604@samp{860}, @samp{970}, @samp{8540}, @samp{a2}, @samp{e300c2},
16605@samp{e300c3}, @samp{e500mc}, @samp{e500mc64}, @samp{ec603e}, @samp{G3},
16606@samp{G4}, @samp{G5}, @samp{titan}, @samp{power}, @samp{power2}, @samp{power3},
16607@samp{power4}, @samp{power5}, @samp{power5+}, @samp{power6}, @samp{power6x},
16608@samp{power7}, @samp{common}, @samp{powerpc}, @samp{powerpc64}, @samp{rios},
16609@samp{rios1}, @samp{rios2}, @samp{rsc}, and @samp{rs64}.
16610
16611@option{-mcpu=common} selects a completely generic processor.  Code
16612generated under this option will run on any POWER or PowerPC processor.
16613GCC will use only the instructions in the common subset of both
16614architectures, and will not use the MQ register.  GCC assumes a generic
16615processor model for scheduling purposes.
16616
16617@option{-mcpu=power}, @option{-mcpu=power2}, @option{-mcpu=powerpc}, and
16618@option{-mcpu=powerpc64} specify generic POWER, POWER2, pure 32-bit
16619PowerPC (i.e., not MPC601), and 64-bit PowerPC architecture machine
16620types, with an appropriate, generic processor model assumed for
16621scheduling purposes.
16622
16623The other options specify a specific processor.  Code generated under
16624those options will run best on that processor, and may not run at all on
16625others.
16626
16627The @option{-mcpu} options automatically enable or disable the
16628following options:
16629
16630@gccoptlist{-maltivec  -mfprnd  -mhard-float  -mmfcrf  -mmultiple @gol
16631-mnew-mnemonics  -mpopcntb -mpopcntd  -mpower  -mpower2  -mpowerpc64 @gol
16632-mpowerpc-gpopt  -mpowerpc-gfxopt  -msingle-float -mdouble-float @gol
16633-msimple-fpu -mstring  -mmulhw  -mdlmzb  -mmfpgpr -mvsx}
16634
16635The particular options set for any particular CPU will vary between
16636compiler versions, depending on what setting seems to produce optimal
16637code for that CPU; it doesn't necessarily reflect the actual hardware's
16638capabilities.  If you wish to set an individual option to a particular
16639value, you may specify it after the @option{-mcpu} option, like
16640@samp{-mcpu=970 -mno-altivec}.
16641
16642On AIX, the @option{-maltivec} and @option{-mpowerpc64} options are
16643not enabled or disabled by the @option{-mcpu} option at present because
16644AIX does not have full support for these options.  You may still
16645enable or disable them individually if you're sure it'll work in your
16646environment.
16647
16648@item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
16649@opindex mtune
16650Set the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
16651@var{cpu_type}, but do not set the architecture type, register usage, or
16652choice of mnemonics, as @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} would.  The same
16653values for @var{cpu_type} are used for @option{-mtune} as for
16654@option{-mcpu}.  If both are specified, the code generated will use the
16655architecture, registers, and mnemonics set by @option{-mcpu}, but the
16656scheduling parameters set by @option{-mtune}.
16657
16658@item -mcmodel=small
16659@opindex mcmodel=small
16660Generate PowerPC64 code for the small model: The TOC is limited to
1666164k.
16662
16663@item -mcmodel=medium
16664@opindex mcmodel=medium
16665Generate PowerPC64 code for the medium model: The TOC and other static
16666data may be up to a total of 4G in size.
16667
16668@item -mcmodel=large
16669@opindex mcmodel=large
16670Generate PowerPC64 code for the large model: The TOC may be up to 4G
16671in size.  Other data and code is only limited by the 64-bit address
16672space.
16673
16674@item -maltivec
16675@itemx -mno-altivec
16676@opindex maltivec
16677@opindex mno-altivec
16678Generate code that uses (does not use) AltiVec instructions, and also
16679enable the use of built-in functions that allow more direct access to
16680the AltiVec instruction set.  You may also need to set
16681@option{-mabi=altivec} to adjust the current ABI with AltiVec ABI
16682enhancements.
16683
16684@item -mvrsave
16685@itemx -mno-vrsave
16686@opindex mvrsave
16687@opindex mno-vrsave
16688Generate VRSAVE instructions when generating AltiVec code.
16689
16690@item -mgen-cell-microcode
16691@opindex mgen-cell-microcode
16692Generate Cell microcode instructions
16693
16694@item -mwarn-cell-microcode
16695@opindex mwarn-cell-microcode
16696Warning when a Cell microcode instruction is going to emitted.  An example
16697of a Cell microcode instruction is a variable shift.
16698
16699@item -msecure-plt
16700@opindex msecure-plt
16701Generate code that allows ld and ld.so to build executables and shared
16702libraries with non-exec .plt and .got sections.  This is a PowerPC
1670332-bit SYSV ABI option.
16704
16705@item -mbss-plt
16706@opindex mbss-plt
16707Generate code that uses a BSS .plt section that ld.so fills in, and
16708requires .plt and .got sections that are both writable and executable.
16709This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI option.
16710
16711@item -misel
16712@itemx -mno-isel
16713@opindex misel
16714@opindex mno-isel
16715This switch enables or disables the generation of ISEL instructions.
16716
16717@item -misel=@var{yes/no}
16718This switch has been deprecated.  Use @option{-misel} and
16719@option{-mno-isel} instead.
16720
16721@item -mspe
16722@itemx -mno-spe
16723@opindex mspe
16724@opindex mno-spe
16725This switch enables or disables the generation of SPE simd
16726instructions.
16727
16728@item -mpaired
16729@itemx -mno-paired
16730@opindex mpaired
16731@opindex mno-paired
16732This switch enables or disables the generation of PAIRED simd
16733instructions.
16734
16735@item -mspe=@var{yes/no}
16736This option has been deprecated.  Use @option{-mspe} and
16737@option{-mno-spe} instead.
16738
16739@item -mvsx
16740@itemx -mno-vsx
16741@opindex mvsx
16742@opindex mno-vsx
16743Generate code that uses (does not use) vector/scalar (VSX)
16744instructions, and also enable the use of built-in functions that allow
16745more direct access to the VSX instruction set.
16746
16747@item -mfloat-gprs=@var{yes/single/double/no}
16748@itemx -mfloat-gprs
16749@opindex mfloat-gprs
16750This switch enables or disables the generation of floating-point
16751operations on the general-purpose registers for architectures that
16752support it.
16753
16754The argument @var{yes} or @var{single} enables the use of
16755single-precision floating-point operations.
16756
16757The argument @var{double} enables the use of single and
16758double-precision floating-point operations.
16759
16760The argument @var{no} disables floating-point operations on the
16761general-purpose registers.
16762
16763This option is currently only available on the MPC854x.
16764
16765@item -m32
16766@itemx -m64
16767@opindex m32
16768@opindex m64
16769Generate code for 32-bit or 64-bit environments of Darwin and SVR4
16770targets (including GNU/Linux).  The 32-bit environment sets int, long
16771and pointer to 32 bits and generates code that runs on any PowerPC
16772variant.  The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and
16773pointer to 64 bits, and generates code for PowerPC64, as for
16774@option{-mpowerpc64}.
16775
16776@item -mfull-toc
16777@itemx -mno-fp-in-toc
16778@itemx -mno-sum-in-toc
16779@itemx -mminimal-toc
16780@opindex mfull-toc
16781@opindex mno-fp-in-toc
16782@opindex mno-sum-in-toc
16783@opindex mminimal-toc
16784Modify generation of the TOC (Table Of Contents), which is created for
16785every executable file.  The @option{-mfull-toc} option is selected by
16786default.  In that case, GCC will allocate at least one TOC entry for
16787each unique non-automatic variable reference in your program.  GCC
16788will also place floating-point constants in the TOC@.  However, only
1678916,384 entries are available in the TOC@.
16790
16791If you receive a linker error message that saying you have overflowed
16792the available TOC space, you can reduce the amount of TOC space used
16793with the @option{-mno-fp-in-toc} and @option{-mno-sum-in-toc} options.
16794@option{-mno-fp-in-toc} prevents GCC from putting floating-point
16795constants in the TOC and @option{-mno-sum-in-toc} forces GCC to
16796generate code to calculate the sum of an address and a constant at
16797run time instead of putting that sum into the TOC@.  You may specify one
16798or both of these options.  Each causes GCC to produce very slightly
16799slower and larger code at the expense of conserving TOC space.
16800
16801If you still run out of space in the TOC even when you specify both of
16802these options, specify @option{-mminimal-toc} instead.  This option causes
16803GCC to make only one TOC entry for every file.  When you specify this
16804option, GCC will produce code that is slower and larger but which
16805uses extremely little TOC space.  You may wish to use this option
16806only on files that contain less frequently executed code.
16807
16808@item -maix64
16809@itemx -maix32
16810@opindex maix64
16811@opindex maix32
16812Enable 64-bit AIX ABI and calling convention: 64-bit pointers, 64-bit
16813@code{long} type, and the infrastructure needed to support them.
16814Specifying @option{-maix64} implies @option{-mpowerpc64} and
16815@option{-mpowerpc}, while @option{-maix32} disables the 64-bit ABI and
16816implies @option{-mno-powerpc64}.  GCC defaults to @option{-maix32}.
16817
16818@item -mxl-compat
16819@itemx -mno-xl-compat
16820@opindex mxl-compat
16821@opindex mno-xl-compat
16822Produce code that conforms more closely to IBM XL compiler semantics
16823when using AIX-compatible ABI@.  Pass floating-point arguments to
16824prototyped functions beyond the register save area (RSA) on the stack
16825in addition to argument FPRs.  Do not assume that most significant
16826double in 128-bit long double value is properly rounded when comparing
16827values and converting to double.  Use XL symbol names for long double
16828support routines.
16829
16830The AIX calling convention was extended but not initially documented to
16831handle an obscure K&R C case of calling a function that takes the
16832address of its arguments with fewer arguments than declared.  IBM XL
16833compilers access floating-point arguments that do not fit in the
16834RSA from the stack when a subroutine is compiled without
16835optimization.  Because always storing floating-point arguments on the
16836stack is inefficient and rarely needed, this option is not enabled by
16837default and only is necessary when calling subroutines compiled by IBM
16838XL compilers without optimization.
16839
16840@item -mpe
16841@opindex mpe
16842Support @dfn{IBM RS/6000 SP} @dfn{Parallel Environment} (PE)@.  Link an
16843application written to use message passing with special startup code to
16844enable the application to run.  The system must have PE installed in the
16845standard location (@file{/usr/lpp/ppe.poe/}), or the @file{specs} file
16846must be overridden with the @option{-specs=} option to specify the
16847appropriate directory location.  The Parallel Environment does not
16848support threads, so the @option{-mpe} option and the @option{-pthread}
16849option are incompatible.
16850
16851@item -malign-natural
16852@itemx -malign-power
16853@opindex malign-natural
16854@opindex malign-power
16855On AIX, 32-bit Darwin, and 64-bit PowerPC GNU/Linux, the option
16856@option{-malign-natural} overrides the ABI-defined alignment of larger
16857types, such as floating-point doubles, on their natural size-based boundary.
16858The option @option{-malign-power} instructs GCC to follow the ABI-specified
16859alignment rules.  GCC defaults to the standard alignment defined in the ABI@.
16860
16861On 64-bit Darwin, natural alignment is the default, and @option{-malign-power}
16862is not supported.
16863
16864@item -msoft-float
16865@itemx -mhard-float
16866@opindex msoft-float
16867@opindex mhard-float
16868Generate code that does not use (uses) the floating-point register set.
16869Software floating-point emulation is provided if you use the
16870@option{-msoft-float} option, and pass the option to GCC when linking.
16871
16872@item -msingle-float
16873@itemx -mdouble-float
16874@opindex msingle-float
16875@opindex mdouble-float
16876Generate code for single- or double-precision floating-point operations.
16877@option{-mdouble-float} implies @option{-msingle-float}.
16878
16879@item -msimple-fpu
16880@opindex msimple-fpu
16881Do not generate sqrt and div instructions for hardware floating-point unit.
16882
16883@item -mfpu
16884@opindex mfpu
16885Specify type of floating-point unit.  Valid values are @var{sp_lite}
16886(equivalent to -msingle-float -msimple-fpu), @var{dp_lite} (equivalent
16887to -mdouble-float -msimple-fpu), @var{sp_full} (equivalent to -msingle-float),
16888and @var{dp_full} (equivalent to -mdouble-float).
16889
16890@item -mxilinx-fpu
16891@opindex mxilinx-fpu
16892Perform optimizations for the floating-point unit on Xilinx PPC 405/440.
16893
16894@item -mmultiple
16895@itemx -mno-multiple
16896@opindex mmultiple
16897@opindex mno-multiple
16898Generate code that uses (does not use) the load multiple word
16899instructions and the store multiple word instructions.  These
16900instructions are generated by default on POWER systems, and not
16901generated on PowerPC systems.  Do not use @option{-mmultiple} on little-endian
16902PowerPC systems, since those instructions do not work when the
16903processor is in little-endian mode.  The exceptions are PPC740 and
16904PPC750 which permit these instructions in little-endian mode.
16905
16906@item -mstring
16907@itemx -mno-string
16908@opindex mstring
16909@opindex mno-string
16910Generate code that uses (does not use) the load string instructions
16911and the store string word instructions to save multiple registers and
16912do small block moves.  These instructions are generated by default on
16913POWER systems, and not generated on PowerPC systems.  Do not use
16914@option{-mstring} on little-endian PowerPC systems, since those
16915instructions do not work when the processor is in little-endian mode.
16916The exceptions are PPC740 and PPC750 which permit these instructions
16917in little-endian mode.
16918
16919@item -mupdate
16920@itemx -mno-update
16921@opindex mupdate
16922@opindex mno-update
16923Generate code that uses (does not use) the load or store instructions
16924that update the base register to the address of the calculated memory
16925location.  These instructions are generated by default.  If you use
16926@option{-mno-update}, there is a small window between the time that the
16927stack pointer is updated and the address of the previous frame is
16928stored, which means code that walks the stack frame across interrupts or
16929signals may get corrupted data.
16930
16931@item -mavoid-indexed-addresses
16932@itemx -mno-avoid-indexed-addresses
16933@opindex mavoid-indexed-addresses
16934@opindex mno-avoid-indexed-addresses
16935Generate code that tries to avoid (not avoid) the use of indexed load
16936or store instructions. These instructions can incur a performance
16937penalty on Power6 processors in certain situations, such as when
16938stepping through large arrays that cross a 16M boundary.  This option
16939is enabled by default when targetting Power6 and disabled otherwise.
16940
16941@item -mfused-madd
16942@itemx -mno-fused-madd
16943@opindex mfused-madd
16944@opindex mno-fused-madd
16945Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point multiply and
16946accumulate instructions.  These instructions are generated by default
16947if hardware floating point is used.  The machine-dependent
16948@option{-mfused-madd} option is now mapped to the machine-independent
16949@option{-ffp-contract=fast} option, and @option{-mno-fused-madd} is
16950mapped to @option{-ffp-contract=off}.
16951
16952@item -mmulhw
16953@itemx -mno-mulhw
16954@opindex mmulhw
16955@opindex mno-mulhw
16956Generate code that uses (does not use) the half-word multiply and
16957multiply-accumulate instructions on the IBM 405, 440, 464 and 476 processors.
16958These instructions are generated by default when targetting those
16959processors.
16960
16961@item -mdlmzb
16962@itemx -mno-dlmzb
16963@opindex mdlmzb
16964@opindex mno-dlmzb
16965Generate code that uses (does not use) the string-search @samp{dlmzb}
16966instruction on the IBM 405, 440, 464 and 476 processors.  This instruction is
16967generated by default when targetting those processors.
16968
16969@item -mno-bit-align
16970@itemx -mbit-align
16971@opindex mno-bit-align
16972@opindex mbit-align
16973On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) force structures
16974and unions that contain bit-fields to be aligned to the base type of the
16975bit-field.
16976
16977For example, by default a structure containing nothing but 8
16978@code{unsigned} bit-fields of length 1 is aligned to a 4-byte
16979boundary and has a size of 4 bytes.  By using @option{-mno-bit-align},
16980the structure is aligned to a 1-byte boundary and is 1 byte in
16981size.
16982
16983@item -mno-strict-align
16984@itemx -mstrict-align
16985@opindex mno-strict-align
16986@opindex mstrict-align
16987On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that
16988unaligned memory references will be handled by the system.
16989
16990@item -mrelocatable
16991@itemx -mno-relocatable
16992@opindex mrelocatable
16993@opindex mno-relocatable
16994Generate code that allows (does not allow) a static executable to be
16995relocated to a different address at run time.  A simple embedded
16996PowerPC system loader should relocate the entire contents of
16997@code{.got2} and 4-byte locations listed in the @code{.fixup} section,
16998a table of 32-bit addresses generated by this option.  For this to
16999work, all objects linked together must be compiled with
17000@option{-mrelocatable} or @option{-mrelocatable-lib}.
17001@option{-mrelocatable} code aligns the stack to an 8-byte boundary.
17002
17003@item -mrelocatable-lib
17004@itemx -mno-relocatable-lib
17005@opindex mrelocatable-lib
17006@opindex mno-relocatable-lib
17007Like @option{-mrelocatable}, @option{-mrelocatable-lib} generates a
17008@code{.fixup} section to allow static executables to be relocated at
17009run time, but @option{-mrelocatable-lib} does not use the smaller stack
17010alignment of @option{-mrelocatable}.  Objects compiled with
17011@option{-mrelocatable-lib} may be linked with objects compiled with
17012any combination of the @option{-mrelocatable} options.
17013
17014@item -mno-toc
17015@itemx -mtoc
17016@opindex mno-toc
17017@opindex mtoc
17018On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do not (do) assume that
17019register 2 contains a pointer to a global area pointing to the addresses
17020used in the program.
17021
17022@item -mlittle
17023@itemx -mlittle-endian
17024@opindex mlittle
17025@opindex mlittle-endian
17026On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17027processor in little-endian mode.  The @option{-mlittle-endian} option is
17028the same as @option{-mlittle}.
17029
17030@item -mbig
17031@itemx -mbig-endian
17032@opindex mbig
17033@opindex mbig-endian
17034On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17035processor in big-endian mode.  The @option{-mbig-endian} option is
17036the same as @option{-mbig}.
17037
17038@item -mdynamic-no-pic
17039@opindex mdynamic-no-pic
17040On Darwin and Mac OS X systems, compile code so that it is not
17041relocatable, but that its external references are relocatable.  The
17042resulting code is suitable for applications, but not shared
17043libraries.
17044
17045@item -msingle-pic-base
17046@opindex msingle-pic-base
17047Treat the register used for PIC addressing as read-only, rather than
17048loading it in the prologue for each function.  The runtime system is
17049responsible for initializing this register with an appropriate value
17050before execution begins.
17051
17052@item -mprioritize-restricted-insns=@var{priority}
17053@opindex mprioritize-restricted-insns
17054This option controls the priority that is assigned to
17055dispatch-slot restricted instructions during the second scheduling
17056pass.  The argument @var{priority} takes the value @var{0/1/2} to assign
17057@var{no/highest/second-highest} priority to dispatch slot restricted
17058instructions.
17059
17060@item -msched-costly-dep=@var{dependence_type}
17061@opindex msched-costly-dep
17062This option controls which dependences are considered costly
17063by the target during instruction scheduling.  The argument
17064@var{dependence_type} takes one of the following values:
17065@var{no}: no dependence is costly,
17066@var{all}: all dependences are costly,
17067@var{true_store_to_load}: a true dependence from store to load is costly,
17068@var{store_to_load}: any dependence from store to load is costly,
17069@var{number}: any dependence for which latency >= @var{number} is costly.
17070
17071@item -minsert-sched-nops=@var{scheme}
17072@opindex minsert-sched-nops
17073This option controls which nop insertion scheme will be used during
17074the second scheduling pass.  The argument @var{scheme} takes one of the
17075following values:
17076@var{no}: Don't insert nops.
17077@var{pad}: Pad with nops any dispatch group that has vacant issue slots,
17078according to the scheduler's grouping.
17079@var{regroup_exact}: Insert nops to force costly dependent insns into
17080separate groups.  Insert exactly as many nops as needed to force an insn
17081to a new group, according to the estimated processor grouping.
17082@var{number}: Insert nops to force costly dependent insns into
17083separate groups.  Insert @var{number} nops to force an insn to a new group.
17084
17085@item -mcall-sysv
17086@opindex mcall-sysv
17087On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code using calling
17088conventions that adheres to the March 1995 draft of the System V
17089Application Binary Interface, PowerPC processor supplement.  This is the
17090default unless you configured GCC using @samp{powerpc-*-eabiaix}.
17091
17092@item -mcall-sysv-eabi
17093@itemx -mcall-eabi
17094@opindex mcall-sysv-eabi
17095@opindex mcall-eabi
17096Specify both @option{-mcall-sysv} and @option{-meabi} options.
17097
17098@item -mcall-sysv-noeabi
17099@opindex mcall-sysv-noeabi
17100Specify both @option{-mcall-sysv} and @option{-mno-eabi} options.
17101
17102@item -mcall-aixdesc
17103@opindex m
17104On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the AIX
17105operating system.
17106
17107@item -mcall-linux
17108@opindex mcall-linux
17109On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17110Linux-based GNU system.
17111
17112@item -mcall-freebsd
17113@opindex mcall-freebsd
17114On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17115FreeBSD operating system.
17116
17117@item -mcall-netbsd
17118@opindex mcall-netbsd
17119On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17120NetBSD operating system.
17121
17122@item -mcall-openbsd
17123@opindex mcall-netbsd
17124On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems compile code for the
17125OpenBSD operating system.
17126
17127@item -maix-struct-return
17128@opindex maix-struct-return
17129Return all structures in memory (as specified by the AIX ABI)@.
17130
17131@item -msvr4-struct-return
17132@opindex msvr4-struct-return
17133Return structures smaller than 8 bytes in registers (as specified by the
17134SVR4 ABI)@.
17135
17136@item -mabi=@var{abi-type}
17137@opindex mabi
17138Extend the current ABI with a particular extension, or remove such extension.
17139Valid values are @var{altivec}, @var{no-altivec}, @var{spe},
17140@var{no-spe}, @var{ibmlongdouble}, @var{ieeelongdouble}@.
17141
17142@item -mabi=spe
17143@opindex mabi=spe
17144Extend the current ABI with SPE ABI extensions.  This does not change
17145the default ABI, instead it adds the SPE ABI extensions to the current
17146ABI@.
17147
17148@item -mabi=no-spe
17149@opindex mabi=no-spe
17150Disable Booke SPE ABI extensions for the current ABI@.
17151
17152@item -mabi=ibmlongdouble
17153@opindex mabi=ibmlongdouble
17154Change the current ABI to use IBM extended-precision long double.
17155This is a PowerPC 32-bit SYSV ABI option.
17156
17157@item -mabi=ieeelongdouble
17158@opindex mabi=ieeelongdouble
17159Change the current ABI to use IEEE extended-precision long double.
17160This is a PowerPC 32-bit Linux ABI option.
17161
17162@item -mprototype
17163@itemx -mno-prototype
17164@opindex mprototype
17165@opindex mno-prototype
17166On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems assume that all calls to
17167variable argument functions are properly prototyped.  Otherwise, the
17168compiler must insert an instruction before every non prototyped call to
17169set or clear bit 6 of the condition code register (@var{CR}) to
17170indicate whether floating-point values were passed in the floating-point
17171registers in case the function takes variable arguments.  With
17172@option{-mprototype}, only calls to prototyped variable argument functions
17173will set or clear the bit.
17174
17175@item -msim
17176@opindex msim
17177On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
17178@file{sim-crt0.o} and that the standard C libraries are @file{libsim.a} and
17179@file{libc.a}.  This is the default for @samp{powerpc-*-eabisim}
17180configurations.
17181
17182@item -mmvme
17183@opindex mmvme
17184On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
17185@file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libmvme.a} and
17186@file{libc.a}.
17187
17188@item -mads
17189@opindex mads
17190On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
17191@file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libads.a} and
17192@file{libc.a}.
17193
17194@item -myellowknife
17195@opindex myellowknife
17196On embedded PowerPC systems, assume that the startup module is called
17197@file{crt0.o} and the standard C libraries are @file{libyk.a} and
17198@file{libc.a}.
17199
17200@item -mvxworks
17201@opindex mvxworks
17202On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, specify that you are
17203compiling for a VxWorks system.
17204
17205@item -memb
17206@opindex memb
17207On embedded PowerPC systems, set the @var{PPC_EMB} bit in the ELF flags
17208header to indicate that @samp{eabi} extended relocations are used.
17209
17210@item -meabi
17211@itemx -mno-eabi
17212@opindex meabi
17213@opindex mno-eabi
17214On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) adhere to the
17215Embedded Applications Binary Interface (eabi) which is a set of
17216modifications to the System V.4 specifications.  Selecting @option{-meabi}
17217means that the stack is aligned to an 8-byte boundary, a function
17218@code{__eabi} is called to from @code{main} to set up the eabi
17219environment, and the @option{-msdata} option can use both @code{r2} and
17220@code{r13} to point to two separate small data areas.  Selecting
17221@option{-mno-eabi} means that the stack is aligned to a 16-byte boundary,
17222do not call an initialization function from @code{main}, and the
17223@option{-msdata} option will only use @code{r13} to point to a single
17224small data area.  The @option{-meabi} option is on by default if you
17225configured GCC using one of the @samp{powerpc*-*-eabi*} options.
17226
17227@item -msdata=eabi
17228@opindex msdata=eabi
17229On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small initialized
17230@code{const} global and static data in the @samp{.sdata2} section, which
17231is pointed to by register @code{r2}.  Put small initialized
17232non-@code{const} global and static data in the @samp{.sdata} section,
17233which is pointed to by register @code{r13}.  Put small uninitialized
17234global and static data in the @samp{.sbss} section, which is adjacent to
17235the @samp{.sdata} section.  The @option{-msdata=eabi} option is
17236incompatible with the @option{-mrelocatable} option.  The
17237@option{-msdata=eabi} option also sets the @option{-memb} option.
17238
17239@item -msdata=sysv
17240@opindex msdata=sysv
17241On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global and static
17242data in the @samp{.sdata} section, which is pointed to by register
17243@code{r13}.  Put small uninitialized global and static data in the
17244@samp{.sbss} section, which is adjacent to the @samp{.sdata} section.
17245The @option{-msdata=sysv} option is incompatible with the
17246@option{-mrelocatable} option.
17247
17248@item -msdata=default
17249@itemx -msdata
17250@opindex msdata=default
17251@opindex msdata
17252On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, if @option{-meabi} is used,
17253compile code the same as @option{-msdata=eabi}, otherwise compile code the
17254same as @option{-msdata=sysv}.
17255
17256@item -msdata=data
17257@opindex msdata=data
17258On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems, put small global
17259data in the @samp{.sdata} section.  Put small uninitialized global
17260data in the @samp{.sbss} section.  Do not use register @code{r13}
17261to address small data however.  This is the default behavior unless
17262other @option{-msdata} options are used.
17263
17264@item -msdata=none
17265@itemx -mno-sdata
17266@opindex msdata=none
17267@opindex mno-sdata
17268On embedded PowerPC systems, put all initialized global and static data
17269in the @samp{.data} section, and all uninitialized data in the
17270@samp{.bss} section.
17271
17272@item -mblock-move-inline-limit=@var{num}
17273@opindex mblock-move-inline-limit
17274Inline all block moves (such as calls to @code{memcpy} or structure
17275copies) less than or equal to @var{num} bytes.  The minimum value for
17276@var{num} is 32 bytes on 32-bit targets and 64 bytes on 64-bit
17277targets.  The default value is target-specific.
17278
17279@item -G @var{num}
17280@opindex G
17281@cindex smaller data references (PowerPC)
17282@cindex .sdata/.sdata2 references (PowerPC)
17283On embedded PowerPC systems, put global and static items less than or
17284equal to @var{num} bytes into the small data or bss sections instead of
17285the normal data or bss section.  By default, @var{num} is 8.  The
17286@option{-G @var{num}} switch is also passed to the linker.
17287All modules should be compiled with the same @option{-G @var{num}} value.
17288
17289@item -mregnames
17290@itemx -mno-regnames
17291@opindex mregnames
17292@opindex mno-regnames
17293On System V.4 and embedded PowerPC systems do (do not) emit register
17294names in the assembly language output using symbolic forms.
17295
17296@item -mlongcall
17297@itemx -mno-longcall
17298@opindex mlongcall
17299@opindex mno-longcall
17300By default assume that all calls are far away so that a longer more
17301expensive calling sequence is required.  This is required for calls
17302further than 32 megabytes (33,554,432 bytes) from the current location.
17303A short call will be generated if the compiler knows
17304the call cannot be that far away.  This setting can be overridden by
17305the @code{shortcall} function attribute, or by @code{#pragma
17306longcall(0)}.
17307
17308Some linkers are capable of detecting out-of-range calls and generating
17309glue code on the fly.  On these systems, long calls are unnecessary and
17310generate slower code.  As of this writing, the AIX linker can do this,
17311as can the GNU linker for PowerPC/64.  It is planned to add this feature
17312to the GNU linker for 32-bit PowerPC systems as well.
17313
17314On Darwin/PPC systems, @code{#pragma longcall} will generate ``jbsr
17315callee, L42'', plus a ``branch island'' (glue code).  The two target
17316addresses represent the callee and the ``branch island''.  The
17317Darwin/PPC linker will prefer the first address and generate a ``bl
17318callee'' if the PPC ``bl'' instruction will reach the callee directly;
17319otherwise, the linker will generate ``bl L42'' to call the ``branch
17320island''.  The ``branch island'' is appended to the body of the
17321calling function; it computes the full 32-bit address of the callee
17322and jumps to it.
17323
17324On Mach-O (Darwin) systems, this option directs the compiler emit to
17325the glue for every direct call, and the Darwin linker decides whether
17326to use or discard it.
17327
17328In the future, we may cause GCC to ignore all longcall specifications
17329when the linker is known to generate glue.
17330
17331@item -mtls-markers
17332@itemx -mno-tls-markers
17333@opindex mtls-markers
17334@opindex mno-tls-markers
17335Mark (do not mark) calls to @code{__tls_get_addr} with a relocation
17336specifying the function argument.  The relocation allows ld to
17337reliably associate function call with argument setup instructions for
17338TLS optimization, which in turn allows gcc to better schedule the
17339sequence.
17340
17341@item -pthread
17342@opindex pthread
17343Adds support for multithreading with the @dfn{pthreads} library.
17344This option sets flags for both the preprocessor and linker.
17345
17346@item -mrecip
17347@itemx -mno-recip
17348@opindex mrecip
17349This option will enable GCC to use the reciprocal estimate and
17350reciprocal square root estimate instructions with additional
17351Newton-Raphson steps to increase precision instead of doing a divide or
17352square root and divide for floating-point arguments.  You should use
17353the @option{-ffast-math} option when using @option{-mrecip} (or at
17354least @option{-funsafe-math-optimizations},
17355@option{-finite-math-only}, @option{-freciprocal-math} and
17356@option{-fno-trapping-math}).  Note that while the throughput of the
17357sequence is generally higher than the throughput of the non-reciprocal
17358instruction, the precision of the sequence can be decreased by up to 2
17359ulp (i.e. the inverse of 1.0 equals 0.99999994) for reciprocal square
17360roots.
17361
17362@item -mrecip=@var{opt}
17363@opindex mrecip=opt
17364This option allows to control which reciprocal estimate instructions
17365may be used.  @var{opt} is a comma separated list of options, which may
17366be preceded by a @code{!} to invert the option:
17367@code{all}: enable all estimate instructions,
17368@code{default}: enable the default instructions, equivalent to @option{-mrecip},
17369@code{none}: disable all estimate instructions, equivalent to @option{-mno-recip};
17370@code{div}: enable the reciprocal approximation instructions for both single and double precision;
17371@code{divf}: enable the single-precision reciprocal approximation instructions;
17372@code{divd}: enable the double-precision reciprocal approximation instructions;
17373@code{rsqrt}: enable the reciprocal square root approximation instructions for both single and double precision;
17374@code{rsqrtf}: enable the single-precision reciprocal square root approximation instructions;
17375@code{rsqrtd}: enable the double-precision reciprocal square root approximation instructions;
17376
17377So for example, @option{-mrecip=all,!rsqrtd} would enable the
17378all of the reciprocal estimate instructions, except for the
17379@code{FRSQRTE}, @code{XSRSQRTEDP}, and @code{XVRSQRTEDP} instructions
17380which handle the double-precision reciprocal square root calculations.
17381
17382@item -mrecip-precision
17383@itemx -mno-recip-precision
17384@opindex mrecip-precision
17385Assume (do not assume) that the reciprocal estimate instructions
17386provide higher-precision estimates than is mandated by the PowerPC
17387ABI.  Selecting @option{-mcpu=power6} or @option{-mcpu=power7}
17388automatically selects @option{-mrecip-precision}.  The double-precision
17389square root estimate instructions are not generated by
17390default on low-precision machines, since they do not provide an
17391estimate that converges after three steps.
17392
17393@item -mveclibabi=@var{type}
17394@opindex mveclibabi
17395Specifies the ABI type to use for vectorizing intrinsics using an
17396external library.  The only type supported at present is @code{mass},
17397which specifies to use IBM's Mathematical Acceleration Subsystem
17398(MASS) libraries for vectorizing intrinsics using external libraries.
17399GCC will currently emit calls to @code{acosd2}, @code{acosf4},
17400@code{acoshd2}, @code{acoshf4}, @code{asind2}, @code{asinf4},
17401@code{asinhd2}, @code{asinhf4}, @code{atan2d2}, @code{atan2f4},
17402@code{atand2}, @code{atanf4}, @code{atanhd2}, @code{atanhf4},
17403@code{cbrtd2}, @code{cbrtf4}, @code{cosd2}, @code{cosf4},
17404@code{coshd2}, @code{coshf4}, @code{erfcd2}, @code{erfcf4},
17405@code{erfd2}, @code{erff4}, @code{exp2d2}, @code{exp2f4},
17406@code{expd2}, @code{expf4}, @code{expm1d2}, @code{expm1f4},
17407@code{hypotd2}, @code{hypotf4}, @code{lgammad2}, @code{lgammaf4},
17408@code{log10d2}, @code{log10f4}, @code{log1pd2}, @code{log1pf4},
17409@code{log2d2}, @code{log2f4}, @code{logd2}, @code{logf4},
17410@code{powd2}, @code{powf4}, @code{sind2}, @code{sinf4}, @code{sinhd2},
17411@code{sinhf4}, @code{sqrtd2}, @code{sqrtf4}, @code{tand2},
17412@code{tanf4}, @code{tanhd2}, and @code{tanhf4} when generating code
17413for power7.  Both @option{-ftree-vectorize} and
17414@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} have to be enabled.  The MASS
17415libraries will have to be specified at link time.
17416
17417@item -mfriz
17418@itemx -mno-friz
17419@opindex mfriz
17420Generate (do not generate) the @code{friz} instruction when the
17421@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} option is used to optimize
17422rounding of floating-point values to 64-bit integer and back to floating
17423point.  The @code{friz} instruction does not return the same value if
17424the floating-point number is too large to fit in an integer.
17425
17426@item -mpointers-to-nested-functions
17427@itemx -mno-pointers-to-nested-functions
17428@opindex mpointers-to-nested-functions
17429Generate (do not generate) code to load up the static chain register
17430(@var{r11}) when calling through a pointer on AIX and 64-bit Linux
17431systems where a function pointer points to a 3-word descriptor giving
17432the function address, TOC value to be loaded in register @var{r2}, and
17433static chain value to be loaded in register @var{r11}.  The
17434@option{-mpointers-to-nested-functions} is on by default.  You will
17435not be able to call through pointers to nested functions or pointers
17436to functions compiled in other languages that use the static chain if
17437you use the @option{-mno-pointers-to-nested-functions}.
17438
17439@item -msave-toc-indirect
17440@itemx -mno-save-toc-indirect
17441@opindex msave-toc-indirect
17442Generate (do not generate) code to save the TOC value in the reserved
17443stack location in the function prologue if the function calls through
17444a pointer on AIX and 64-bit Linux systems.  If the TOC value is not
17445saved in the prologue, it is saved just before the call through the
17446pointer.  The @option{-mno-save-toc-indirect} option is the default.
17447@end table
17448
17449@node RX Options
17450@subsection RX Options
17451@cindex RX Options
17452
17453These command-line options are defined for RX targets:
17454
17455@table @gcctabopt
17456@item -m64bit-doubles
17457@itemx -m32bit-doubles
17458@opindex m64bit-doubles
17459@opindex m32bit-doubles
17460Make the @code{double} data type be 64 bits (@option{-m64bit-doubles})
17461or 32 bits (@option{-m32bit-doubles}) in size.  The default is
17462@option{-m32bit-doubles}.  @emph{Note} RX floating-point hardware only
17463works on 32-bit values, which is why the default is
17464@option{-m32bit-doubles}.
17465
17466@item -fpu
17467@itemx -nofpu
17468@opindex fpu
17469@opindex nofpu
17470Enables (@option{-fpu}) or disables (@option{-nofpu}) the use of RX
17471floating-point hardware.  The default is enabled for the @var{RX600}
17472series and disabled for the @var{RX200} series.
17473
17474Floating-point instructions will only be generated for 32-bit floating-point
17475values however, so if the @option{-m64bit-doubles} option is in
17476use then the FPU hardware will not be used for doubles.
17477
17478@emph{Note} If the @option{-fpu} option is enabled then
17479@option{-funsafe-math-optimizations} is also enabled automatically.
17480This is because the RX FPU instructions are themselves unsafe.
17481
17482@item -mcpu=@var{name}
17483@opindex -mcpu
17484Selects the type of RX CPU to be targeted.  Currently three types are
17485supported, the generic @var{RX600} and @var{RX200} series hardware and
17486the specific @var{RX610} CPU.  The default is @var{RX600}.
17487
17488The only difference between @var{RX600} and @var{RX610} is that the
17489@var{RX610} does not support the @code{MVTIPL} instruction.
17490
17491The @var{RX200} series does not have a hardware floating-point unit
17492and so @option{-nofpu} is enabled by default when this type is
17493selected.
17494
17495@item -mbig-endian-data
17496@itemx -mlittle-endian-data
17497@opindex mbig-endian-data
17498@opindex mlittle-endian-data
17499Store data (but not code) in the big-endian format.  The default is
17500@option{-mlittle-endian-data}, i.e.@: to store data in the little-endian
17501format.
17502
17503@item -msmall-data-limit=@var{N}
17504@opindex msmall-data-limit
17505Specifies the maximum size in bytes of global and static variables
17506which can be placed into the small data area.  Using the small data
17507area can lead to smaller and faster code, but the size of area is
17508limited and it is up to the programmer to ensure that the area does
17509not overflow.  Also when the small data area is used one of the RX's
17510registers (usually @code{r13}) is reserved for use pointing to this
17511area, so it is no longer available for use by the compiler.  This
17512could result in slower and/or larger code if variables which once
17513could have been held in the reserved register are now pushed onto the
17514stack.
17515
17516Note, common variables (variables that have not been initialized) and
17517constants are not placed into the small data area as they are assigned
17518to other sections in the output executable.
17519
17520The default value is zero, which disables this feature.  Note, this
17521feature is not enabled by default with higher optimization levels
17522(@option{-O2} etc) because of the potentially detrimental effects of
17523reserving a register.  It is up to the programmer to experiment and
17524discover whether this feature is of benefit to their program.  See the
17525description of the @option{-mpid} option for a description of how the
17526actual register to hold the small data area pointer is chosen.
17527
17528@item -msim
17529@itemx -mno-sim
17530@opindex msim
17531@opindex mno-sim
17532Use the simulator runtime.  The default is to use the libgloss board
17533specific runtime.
17534
17535@item -mas100-syntax
17536@itemx -mno-as100-syntax
17537@opindex mas100-syntax
17538@opindex mno-as100-syntax
17539When generating assembler output use a syntax that is compatible with
17540Renesas's AS100 assembler.  This syntax can also be handled by the GAS
17541assembler but it has some restrictions so generating it is not the
17542default option.
17543
17544@item -mmax-constant-size=@var{N}
17545@opindex mmax-constant-size
17546Specifies the maximum size, in bytes, of a constant that can be used as
17547an operand in a RX instruction.  Although the RX instruction set does
17548allow constants of up to 4 bytes in length to be used in instructions,
17549a longer value equates to a longer instruction.  Thus in some
17550circumstances it can be beneficial to restrict the size of constants
17551that are used in instructions.  Constants that are too big are instead
17552placed into a constant pool and referenced via register indirection.
17553
17554The value @var{N} can be between 0 and 4.  A value of 0 (the default)
17555or 4 means that constants of any size are allowed.
17556
17557@item -mrelax
17558@opindex mrelax
17559Enable linker relaxation.  Linker relaxation is a process whereby the
17560linker will attempt to reduce the size of a program by finding shorter
17561versions of various instructions.  Disabled by default.
17562
17563@item -mint-register=@var{N}
17564@opindex mint-register
17565Specify the number of registers to reserve for fast interrupt handler
17566functions.  The value @var{N} can be between 0 and 4.  A value of 1
17567means that register @code{r13} will be reserved for the exclusive use
17568of fast interrupt handlers.  A value of 2 reserves @code{r13} and
17569@code{r12}.  A value of 3 reserves @code{r13}, @code{r12} and
17570@code{r11}, and a value of 4 reserves @code{r13} through @code{r10}.
17571A value of 0, the default, does not reserve any registers.
17572
17573@item -msave-acc-in-interrupts
17574@opindex msave-acc-in-interrupts
17575Specifies that interrupt handler functions should preserve the
17576accumulator register.  This is only necessary if normal code might use
17577the accumulator register, for example because it performs 64-bit
17578multiplications.  The default is to ignore the accumulator as this
17579makes the interrupt handlers faster.
17580
17581@item -mpid
17582@itemx -mno-pid
17583@opindex mpid
17584@opindex mno-pid
17585Enables the generation of position independent data.  When enabled any
17586access to constant data will done via an offset from a base address
17587held in a register.  This allows the location of constant data to be
17588determined at run time without requiring the executable to be
17589relocated, which is a benefit to embedded applications with tight
17590memory constraints.  Data that can be modified is not affected by this
17591option.
17592
17593Note, using this feature reserves a register, usually @code{r13}, for
17594the constant data base address.  This can result in slower and/or
17595larger code, especially in complicated functions.
17596
17597The actual register chosen to hold the constant data base address
17598depends upon whether the @option{-msmall-data-limit} and/or the
17599@option{-mint-register} command-line options are enabled.  Starting
17600with register @code{r13} and proceeding downwards, registers are
17601allocated first to satisfy the requirements of @option{-mint-register},
17602then @option{-mpid} and finally @option{-msmall-data-limit}.  Thus it
17603is possible for the small data area register to be @code{r8} if both
17604@option{-mint-register=4} and @option{-mpid} are specified on the
17605command line.
17606
17607By default this feature is not enabled.  The default can be restored
17608via the @option{-mno-pid} command-line option.
17609
17610@end table
17611
17612@emph{Note:} The generic GCC command-line option @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}}
17613has special significance to the RX port when used with the
17614@code{interrupt} function attribute.  This attribute indicates a
17615function intended to process fast interrupts.  GCC will will ensure
17616that it only uses the registers @code{r10}, @code{r11}, @code{r12}
17617and/or @code{r13} and only provided that the normal use of the
17618corresponding registers have been restricted via the
17619@option{-ffixed-@var{reg}} or @option{-mint-register} command-line
17620options.
17621
17622@node S/390 and zSeries Options
17623@subsection S/390 and zSeries Options
17624@cindex S/390 and zSeries Options
17625
17626These are the @samp{-m} options defined for the S/390 and zSeries architecture.
17627
17628@table @gcctabopt
17629@item -mhard-float
17630@itemx -msoft-float
17631@opindex mhard-float
17632@opindex msoft-float
17633Use (do not use) the hardware floating-point instructions and registers
17634for floating-point operations.  When @option{-msoft-float} is specified,
17635functions in @file{libgcc.a} will be used to perform floating-point
17636operations.  When @option{-mhard-float} is specified, the compiler
17637generates IEEE floating-point instructions.  This is the default.
17638
17639@item -mhard-dfp
17640@itemx -mno-hard-dfp
17641@opindex mhard-dfp
17642@opindex mno-hard-dfp
17643Use (do not use) the hardware decimal-floating-point instructions for
17644decimal-floating-point operations.  When @option{-mno-hard-dfp} is
17645specified, functions in @file{libgcc.a} will be used to perform
17646decimal-floating-point operations.  When @option{-mhard-dfp} is
17647specified, the compiler generates decimal-floating-point hardware
17648instructions.  This is the default for @option{-march=z9-ec} or higher.
17649
17650@item -mlong-double-64
17651@itemx -mlong-double-128
17652@opindex mlong-double-64
17653@opindex mlong-double-128
17654These switches control the size of @code{long double} type. A size
17655of 64 bits makes the @code{long double} type equivalent to the @code{double}
17656type. This is the default.
17657
17658@item -mbackchain
17659@itemx -mno-backchain
17660@opindex mbackchain
17661@opindex mno-backchain
17662Store (do not store) the address of the caller's frame as backchain pointer
17663into the callee's stack frame.
17664A backchain may be needed to allow debugging using tools that do not understand
17665DWARF-2 call frame information.
17666When @option{-mno-packed-stack} is in effect, the backchain pointer is stored
17667at the bottom of the stack frame; when @option{-mpacked-stack} is in effect,
17668the backchain is placed into the topmost word of the 96/160 byte register
17669save area.
17670
17671In general, code compiled with @option{-mbackchain} is call-compatible with
17672code compiled with @option{-mmo-backchain}; however, use of the backchain
17673for debugging purposes usually requires that the whole binary is built with
17674@option{-mbackchain}.  Note that the combination of @option{-mbackchain},
17675@option{-mpacked-stack} and @option{-mhard-float} is not supported.  In order
17676to build a linux kernel use @option{-msoft-float}.
17677
17678The default is to not maintain the backchain.
17679
17680@item -mpacked-stack
17681@itemx -mno-packed-stack
17682@opindex mpacked-stack
17683@opindex mno-packed-stack
17684Use (do not use) the packed stack layout.  When @option{-mno-packed-stack} is
17685specified, the compiler uses the all fields of the 96/160 byte register save
17686area only for their default purpose; unused fields still take up stack space.
17687When @option{-mpacked-stack} is specified, register save slots are densely
17688packed at the top of the register save area; unused space is reused for other
17689purposes, allowing for more efficient use of the available stack space.
17690However, when @option{-mbackchain} is also in effect, the topmost word of
17691the save area is always used to store the backchain, and the return address
17692register is always saved two words below the backchain.
17693
17694As long as the stack frame backchain is not used, code generated with
17695@option{-mpacked-stack} is call-compatible with code generated with
17696@option{-mno-packed-stack}.  Note that some non-FSF releases of GCC 2.95 for
17697S/390 or zSeries generated code that uses the stack frame backchain at run
17698time, not just for debugging purposes.  Such code is not call-compatible
17699with code compiled with @option{-mpacked-stack}.  Also, note that the
17700combination of @option{-mbackchain},
17701@option{-mpacked-stack} and @option{-mhard-float} is not supported.  In order
17702to build a linux kernel use @option{-msoft-float}.
17703
17704The default is to not use the packed stack layout.
17705
17706@item -msmall-exec
17707@itemx -mno-small-exec
17708@opindex msmall-exec
17709@opindex mno-small-exec
17710Generate (or do not generate) code using the @code{bras} instruction
17711to do subroutine calls.
17712This only works reliably if the total executable size does not
17713exceed 64k.  The default is to use the @code{basr} instruction instead,
17714which does not have this limitation.
17715
17716@item -m64
17717@itemx -m31
17718@opindex m64
17719@opindex m31
17720When @option{-m31} is specified, generate code compliant to the
17721GNU/Linux for S/390 ABI@.  When @option{-m64} is specified, generate
17722code compliant to the GNU/Linux for zSeries ABI@.  This allows GCC in
17723particular to generate 64-bit instructions.  For the @samp{s390}
17724targets, the default is @option{-m31}, while the @samp{s390x}
17725targets default to @option{-m64}.
17726
17727@item -mzarch
17728@itemx -mesa
17729@opindex mzarch
17730@opindex mesa
17731When @option{-mzarch} is specified, generate code using the
17732instructions available on z/Architecture.
17733When @option{-mesa} is specified, generate code using the
17734instructions available on ESA/390.  Note that @option{-mesa} is
17735not possible with @option{-m64}.
17736When generating code compliant to the GNU/Linux for S/390 ABI,
17737the default is @option{-mesa}.  When generating code compliant
17738to the GNU/Linux for zSeries ABI, the default is @option{-mzarch}.
17739
17740@item -mmvcle
17741@itemx -mno-mvcle
17742@opindex mmvcle
17743@opindex mno-mvcle
17744Generate (or do not generate) code using the @code{mvcle} instruction
17745to perform block moves.  When @option{-mno-mvcle} is specified,
17746use a @code{mvc} loop instead.  This is the default unless optimizing for
17747size.
17748
17749@item -mdebug
17750@itemx -mno-debug
17751@opindex mdebug
17752@opindex mno-debug
17753Print (or do not print) additional debug information when compiling.
17754The default is to not print debug information.
17755
17756@item -march=@var{cpu-type}
17757@opindex march
17758Generate code that will run on @var{cpu-type}, which is the name of a system
17759representing a certain processor type.  Possible values for
17760@var{cpu-type} are @samp{g5}, @samp{g6}, @samp{z900}, @samp{z990},
17761@samp{z9-109}, @samp{z9-ec} and @samp{z10}.
17762When generating code using the instructions available on z/Architecture,
17763the default is @option{-march=z900}.  Otherwise, the default is
17764@option{-march=g5}.
17765
17766@item -mtune=@var{cpu-type}
17767@opindex mtune
17768Tune to @var{cpu-type} everything applicable about the generated code,
17769except for the ABI and the set of available instructions.
17770The list of @var{cpu-type} values is the same as for @option{-march}.
17771The default is the value used for @option{-march}.
17772
17773@item -mtpf-trace
17774@itemx -mno-tpf-trace
17775@opindex mtpf-trace
17776@opindex mno-tpf-trace
17777Generate code that adds (does not add) in TPF OS specific branches to trace
17778routines in the operating system.  This option is off by default, even
17779when compiling for the TPF OS@.
17780
17781@item -mfused-madd
17782@itemx -mno-fused-madd
17783@opindex mfused-madd
17784@opindex mno-fused-madd
17785Generate code that uses (does not use) the floating-point multiply and
17786accumulate instructions.  These instructions are generated by default if
17787hardware floating point is used.
17788
17789@item -mwarn-framesize=@var{framesize}
17790@opindex mwarn-framesize
17791Emit a warning if the current function exceeds the given frame size.  Because
17792this is a compile-time check it doesn't need to be a real problem when the program
17793runs.  It is intended to identify functions that most probably cause
17794a stack overflow.  It is useful to be used in an environment with limited stack
17795size e.g.@: the linux kernel.
17796
17797@item -mwarn-dynamicstack
17798@opindex mwarn-dynamicstack
17799Emit a warning if the function calls alloca or uses dynamically
17800sized arrays.  This is generally a bad idea with a limited stack size.
17801
17802@item -mstack-guard=@var{stack-guard}
17803@itemx -mstack-size=@var{stack-size}
17804@opindex mstack-guard
17805@opindex mstack-size
17806If these options are provided the s390 back end emits additional instructions in
17807the function prologue which trigger a trap if the stack size is @var{stack-guard}
17808bytes above the @var{stack-size} (remember that the stack on s390 grows downward).
17809If the @var{stack-guard} option is omitted the smallest power of 2 larger than
17810the frame size of the compiled function is chosen.
17811These options are intended to be used to help debugging stack overflow problems.
17812The additionally emitted code causes only little overhead and hence can also be
17813used in production like systems without greater performance degradation.  The given
17814values have to be exact powers of 2 and @var{stack-size} has to be greater than
17815@var{stack-guard} without exceeding 64k.
17816In order to be efficient the extra code makes the assumption that the stack starts
17817at an address aligned to the value given by @var{stack-size}.
17818The @var{stack-guard} option can only be used in conjunction with @var{stack-size}.
17819@end table
17820
17821@node Score Options
17822@subsection Score Options
17823@cindex Score Options
17824
17825These options are defined for Score implementations:
17826
17827@table @gcctabopt
17828@item -meb
17829@opindex meb
17830Compile code for big-endian mode.  This is the default.
17831
17832@item -mel
17833@opindex mel
17834Compile code for little-endian mode.
17835
17836@item -mnhwloop
17837@opindex mnhwloop
17838Disable generate bcnz instruction.
17839
17840@item -muls
17841@opindex muls
17842Enable generate unaligned load and store instruction.
17843
17844@item -mmac
17845@opindex mmac
17846Enable the use of multiply-accumulate instructions. Disabled by default.
17847
17848@item -mscore5
17849@opindex mscore5
17850Specify the SCORE5 as the target architecture.
17851
17852@item -mscore5u
17853@opindex mscore5u
17854Specify the SCORE5U of the target architecture.
17855
17856@item -mscore7
17857@opindex mscore7
17858Specify the SCORE7 as the target architecture. This is the default.
17859
17860@item -mscore7d
17861@opindex mscore7d
17862Specify the SCORE7D as the target architecture.
17863@end table
17864
17865@node SH Options
17866@subsection SH Options
17867
17868These @samp{-m} options are defined for the SH implementations:
17869
17870@table @gcctabopt
17871@item -m1
17872@opindex m1
17873Generate code for the SH1.
17874
17875@item -m2
17876@opindex m2
17877Generate code for the SH2.
17878
17879@item -m2e
17880Generate code for the SH2e.
17881
17882@item -m2a-nofpu
17883@opindex m2a-nofpu
17884Generate code for the SH2a without FPU, or for a SH2a-FPU in such a way
17885that the floating-point unit is not used.
17886
17887@item -m2a-single-only
17888@opindex m2a-single-only
17889Generate code for the SH2a-FPU, in such a way that no double-precision
17890floating-point operations are used.
17891
17892@item -m2a-single
17893@opindex m2a-single
17894Generate code for the SH2a-FPU assuming the floating-point unit is in
17895single-precision mode by default.
17896
17897@item -m2a
17898@opindex m2a
17899Generate code for the SH2a-FPU assuming the floating-point unit is in
17900double-precision mode by default.
17901
17902@item -m3
17903@opindex m3
17904Generate code for the SH3.
17905
17906@item -m3e
17907@opindex m3e
17908Generate code for the SH3e.
17909
17910@item -m4-nofpu
17911@opindex m4-nofpu
17912Generate code for the SH4 without a floating-point unit.
17913
17914@item -m4-single-only
17915@opindex m4-single-only
17916Generate code for the SH4 with a floating-point unit that only
17917supports single-precision arithmetic.
17918
17919@item -m4-single
17920@opindex m4-single
17921Generate code for the SH4 assuming the floating-point unit is in
17922single-precision mode by default.
17923
17924@item -m4
17925@opindex m4
17926Generate code for the SH4.
17927
17928@item -m4a-nofpu
17929@opindex m4a-nofpu
17930Generate code for the SH4al-dsp, or for a SH4a in such a way that the
17931floating-point unit is not used.
17932
17933@item -m4a-single-only
17934@opindex m4a-single-only
17935Generate code for the SH4a, in such a way that no double-precision
17936floating-point operations are used.
17937
17938@item -m4a-single
17939@opindex m4a-single
17940Generate code for the SH4a assuming the floating-point unit is in
17941single-precision mode by default.
17942
17943@item -m4a
17944@opindex m4a
17945Generate code for the SH4a.
17946
17947@item -m4al
17948@opindex m4al
17949Same as @option{-m4a-nofpu}, except that it implicitly passes
17950@option{-dsp} to the assembler.  GCC doesn't generate any DSP
17951instructions at the moment.
17952
17953@item -mb
17954@opindex mb
17955Compile code for the processor in big-endian mode.
17956
17957@item -ml
17958@opindex ml
17959Compile code for the processor in little-endian mode.
17960
17961@item -mdalign
17962@opindex mdalign
17963Align doubles at 64-bit boundaries.  Note that this changes the calling
17964conventions, and thus some functions from the standard C library will
17965not work unless you recompile it first with @option{-mdalign}.
17966
17967@item -mrelax
17968@opindex mrelax
17969Shorten some address references at link time, when possible; uses the
17970linker option @option{-relax}.
17971
17972@item -mbigtable
17973@opindex mbigtable
17974Use 32-bit offsets in @code{switch} tables.  The default is to use
1797516-bit offsets.
17976
17977@item -mbitops
17978@opindex mbitops
17979Enable the use of bit manipulation instructions on SH2A.
17980
17981@item -mfmovd
17982@opindex mfmovd
17983Enable the use of the instruction @code{fmovd}.  Check @option{-mdalign} for
17984alignment constraints.
17985
17986@item -mhitachi
17987@opindex mhitachi
17988Comply with the calling conventions defined by Renesas.
17989
17990@item -mrenesas
17991@opindex mhitachi
17992Comply with the calling conventions defined by Renesas.
17993
17994@item -mno-renesas
17995@opindex mhitachi
17996Comply with the calling conventions defined for GCC before the Renesas
17997conventions were available.  This option is the default for all
17998targets of the SH toolchain.
17999
18000@item -mnomacsave
18001@opindex mnomacsave
18002Mark the @code{MAC} register as call-clobbered, even if
18003@option{-mhitachi} is given.
18004
18005@item -mieee
18006@item -mno-ieee
18007@opindex mieee
18008@opindex mnoieee
18009Control the IEEE compliance of floating-point comparisons, which affects the
18010handling of cases where the result of a comparison is unordered.  By default
18011@option{-mieee} is implicitly enabled.  If @option{-ffinite-math-only} is
18012enabled @option{-mno-ieee} is implicitly set, which results in faster
18013floating-point greater-equal and less-equal comparisons.  The implcit settings
18014can be overridden by specifying either @option{-mieee} or @option{-mno-ieee}.
18015
18016@item -minline-ic_invalidate
18017@opindex minline-ic_invalidate
18018Inline code to invalidate instruction cache entries after setting up
18019nested function trampolines.
18020This option has no effect if -musermode is in effect and the selected
18021code generation option (e.g. -m4) does not allow the use of the icbi
18022instruction.
18023If the selected code generation option does not allow the use of the icbi
18024instruction, and -musermode is not in effect, the inlined code will
18025manipulate the instruction cache address array directly with an associative
18026write.  This not only requires privileged mode, but it will also
18027fail if the cache line had been mapped via the TLB and has become unmapped.
18028
18029@item -misize
18030@opindex misize
18031Dump instruction size and location in the assembly code.
18032
18033@item -mpadstruct
18034@opindex mpadstruct
18035This option is deprecated.  It pads structures to multiple of 4 bytes,
18036which is incompatible with the SH ABI@.
18037
18038@item -msoft-atomic
18039@opindex msoft-atomic
18040Generate GNU/Linux compatible gUSA software atomic sequences for the atomic
18041built-in functions.  The generated atomic sequences require support from the
18042interrupt / exception handling code of the system and are only suitable for
18043single-core systems.  They will not perform correctly on multi-core systems.
18044This option is enabled by default when the target is @code{sh-*-linux*}.
18045For details on the atomic built-in functions see @ref{__atomic Builtins}.
18046
18047@item -mspace
18048@opindex mspace
18049Optimize for space instead of speed.  Implied by @option{-Os}.
18050
18051@item -mprefergot
18052@opindex mprefergot
18053When generating position-independent code, emit function calls using
18054the Global Offset Table instead of the Procedure Linkage Table.
18055
18056@item -musermode
18057@opindex musermode
18058Don't generate privileged mode only code; implies -mno-inline-ic_invalidate
18059if the inlined code would not work in user mode.
18060This is the default when the target is @code{sh-*-linux*}.
18061
18062@item -multcost=@var{number}
18063@opindex multcost=@var{number}
18064Set the cost to assume for a multiply insn.
18065
18066@item -mdiv=@var{strategy}
18067@opindex mdiv=@var{strategy}
18068Set the division strategy to be used for integer division operations.
18069For SHmedia @var{strategy} can be one of:
18070
18071@table @samp
18072
18073@item fp
18074Performs the operation in floating point.  This has a very high latency,
18075but needs only a few instructions, so it might be a good choice if
18076your code has enough easily-exploitable ILP to allow the compiler to
18077schedule the floating-point instructions together with other instructions.
18078Division by zero causes a floating-point exception.
18079
18080@item inv
18081Uses integer operations to calculate the inverse of the divisor,
18082and then multiplies the dividend with the inverse.  This strategy allows
18083CSE and hoisting of the inverse calculation.  Division by zero calculates
18084an unspecified result, but does not trap.
18085
18086@item inv:minlat
18087A variant of @samp{inv} where, if no CSE or hoisting opportunities
18088have been found, or if the entire operation has been hoisted to the same
18089place, the last stages of the inverse calculation are intertwined with the
18090final multiply to reduce the overall latency, at the expense of using a few
18091more instructions, and thus offering fewer scheduling opportunities with
18092other code.
18093
18094@item call
18095Calls a library function that usually implements the @samp{inv:minlat}
18096strategy.
18097This gives high code density for @code{m5-*media-nofpu} compilations.
18098
18099@item call2
18100Uses a different entry point of the same library function, where it
18101assumes that a pointer to a lookup table has already been set up, which
18102exposes the pointer load to CSE and code hoisting optimizations.
18103
18104@item inv:call
18105@itemx inv:call2
18106@itemx inv:fp
18107Use the @samp{inv} algorithm for initial
18108code generation, but if the code stays unoptimized, revert to the @samp{call},
18109@samp{call2}, or @samp{fp} strategies, respectively.  Note that the
18110potentially-trapping side effect of division by zero is carried by a
18111separate instruction, so it is possible that all the integer instructions
18112are hoisted out, but the marker for the side effect stays where it is.
18113A recombination to floating-point operations or a call is not possible
18114in that case.
18115
18116@item inv20u
18117@itemx inv20l
18118Variants of the @samp{inv:minlat} strategy.  In the case
18119that the inverse calculation is not separated from the multiply, they speed
18120up division where the dividend fits into 20 bits (plus sign where applicable)
18121by inserting a test to skip a number of operations in this case; this test
18122slows down the case of larger dividends.  @samp{inv20u} assumes the case of a such
18123a small dividend to be unlikely, and @samp{inv20l} assumes it to be likely.
18124
18125@end table
18126
18127For targets other than SHmedia @var{strategy} can be one of:
18128
18129@table @samp
18130
18131@item call-div1
18132Calls a library function that uses the single-step division instruction
18133@code{div1} to perform the operation.  Division by zero calculates an
18134unspecified result and does not trap.  This is the default except for SH4,
18135SH2A and SHcompact.
18136
18137@item call-fp
18138Calls a library function that performs the operation in double precision
18139floating point.  Division by zero causes a floating-point exception.  This is
18140the default for SHcompact with FPU.  Specifying this for targets that do not
18141have a double precision FPU will default to @code{call-div1}.
18142
18143@item call-table
18144Calls a library function that uses a lookup table for small divisors and
18145the @code{div1} instruction with case distinction for larger divisors.  Division
18146by zero calculates an unspecified result and does not trap.  This is the default
18147for SH4.  Specifying this for targets that do not have dynamic shift
18148instructions will default to @code{call-div1}.
18149
18150@end table
18151
18152When a division strategy has not been specified the default strategy will be
18153selected based on the current target.  For SH2A the default strategy is to
18154use the @code{divs} and @code{divu} instructions instead of library function
18155calls.
18156
18157@item -maccumulate-outgoing-args
18158@opindex maccumulate-outgoing-args
18159Reserve space once for outgoing arguments in the function prologue rather
18160than around each call.  Generally beneficial for performance and size.  Also
18161needed for unwinding to avoid changing the stack frame around conditional code.
18162
18163@item -mdivsi3_libfunc=@var{name}
18164@opindex mdivsi3_libfunc=@var{name}
18165Set the name of the library function used for 32-bit signed division to
18166@var{name}.  This only affect the name used in the call and inv:call
18167division strategies, and the compiler will still expect the same
18168sets of input/output/clobbered registers as if this option was not present.
18169
18170@item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
18171@opindex mfixed-range
18172Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
18173A fixed register is one that the register allocator can not use.  This is
18174useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is specified as
18175two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be
18176specified separated by a comma.
18177
18178@item -madjust-unroll
18179@opindex madjust-unroll
18180Throttle unrolling to avoid thrashing target registers.
18181This option only has an effect if the gcc code base supports the
18182TARGET_ADJUST_UNROLL_MAX target hook.
18183
18184@item -mindexed-addressing
18185@opindex mindexed-addressing
18186Enable the use of the indexed addressing mode for SHmedia32/SHcompact.
18187This is only safe if the hardware and/or OS implement 32-bit wrap-around
18188semantics for the indexed addressing mode.  The architecture allows the
18189implementation of processors with 64-bit MMU, which the OS could use to
18190get 32-bit addressing, but since no current hardware implementation supports
18191this or any other way to make the indexed addressing mode safe to use in
18192the 32-bit ABI, the default is @option{-mno-indexed-addressing}.
18193
18194@item -mgettrcost=@var{number}
18195@opindex mgettrcost=@var{number}
18196Set the cost assumed for the gettr instruction to @var{number}.
18197The default is 2 if @option{-mpt-fixed} is in effect, 100 otherwise.
18198
18199@item -mpt-fixed
18200@opindex mpt-fixed
18201Assume pt* instructions won't trap.  This will generally generate better
18202scheduled code, but is unsafe on current hardware.  The current architecture
18203definition says that ptabs and ptrel trap when the target anded with 3 is 3.
18204This has the unintentional effect of making it unsafe to schedule ptabs /
18205ptrel before a branch, or hoist it out of a loop.  For example,
18206__do_global_ctors, a part of libgcc that runs constructors at program
18207startup, calls functions in a list which is delimited by @minus{}1.  With the
18208-mpt-fixed option, the ptabs will be done before testing against @minus{}1.
18209That means that all the constructors will be run a bit quicker, but when
18210the loop comes to the end of the list, the program crashes because ptabs
18211loads @minus{}1 into a target register.  Since this option is unsafe for any
18212hardware implementing the current architecture specification, the default
18213is -mno-pt-fixed.  Unless the user specifies a specific cost with
18214@option{-mgettrcost}, -mno-pt-fixed also implies @option{-mgettrcost=100};
18215this deters register allocation using target registers for storing
18216ordinary integers.
18217
18218@item -minvalid-symbols
18219@opindex minvalid-symbols
18220Assume symbols might be invalid.  Ordinary function symbols generated by
18221the compiler will always be valid to load with movi/shori/ptabs or
18222movi/shori/ptrel, but with assembler and/or linker tricks it is possible
18223to generate symbols that will cause ptabs / ptrel to trap.
18224This option is only meaningful when @option{-mno-pt-fixed} is in effect.
18225It will then prevent cross-basic-block cse, hoisting and most scheduling
18226of symbol loads.  The default is @option{-mno-invalid-symbols}.
18227
18228@item -mbranch-cost=@var{num}
18229@opindex mbranch-cost=@var{num}
18230Assume @var{num} to be the cost for a branch instruction.  Higher numbers
18231will make the compiler try to generate more branch-free code if possible.
18232If not specified the value is selected depending on the processor type that
18233is being compiled for.
18234
18235@item -mcbranchdi
18236@opindex mcbranchdi
18237Enable the @code{cbranchdi4} instruction pattern.
18238
18239@item -mcmpeqdi
18240@opindex mcmpeqdi
18241Emit the @code{cmpeqdi_t} instruction pattern even when @option{-mcbranchdi}
18242is in effect.
18243
18244@item -mfused-madd
18245@opindex mfused-madd
18246Allow the usage of the @code{fmac} instruction (floating-point
18247multiply-accumulate) if the processor type supports it.  Enabling this
18248option might generate code that produces different numeric floating-point
18249results compared to strict IEEE 754 arithmetic.
18250
18251@item -mpretend-cmove
18252@opindex mpretend-cmove
18253Prefer zero-displacement conditional branches for conditional move instruction
18254patterns.  This can result in faster code on the SH4 processor.
18255
18256@end table
18257
18258@node Solaris 2 Options
18259@subsection Solaris 2 Options
18260@cindex Solaris 2 options
18261
18262These @samp{-m} options are supported on Solaris 2:
18263
18264@table @gcctabopt
18265@item -mimpure-text
18266@opindex mimpure-text
18267@option{-mimpure-text}, used in addition to @option{-shared}, tells
18268the compiler to not pass @option{-z text} to the linker when linking a
18269shared object.  Using this option, you can link position-dependent
18270code into a shared object.
18271
18272@option{-mimpure-text} suppresses the ``relocations remain against
18273allocatable but non-writable sections'' linker error message.
18274However, the necessary relocations will trigger copy-on-write, and the
18275shared object is not actually shared across processes.  Instead of
18276using @option{-mimpure-text}, you should compile all source code with
18277@option{-fpic} or @option{-fPIC}.
18278
18279@end table
18280
18281These switches are supported in addition to the above on Solaris 2:
18282
18283@table @gcctabopt
18284@item -pthreads
18285@opindex pthreads
18286Add support for multithreading using the POSIX threads library.  This
18287option sets flags for both the preprocessor and linker.  This option does
18288not affect the thread safety of object code produced  by the compiler or
18289that of libraries supplied with it.
18290
18291@item -pthread
18292@opindex pthread
18293This is a synonym for @option{-pthreads}.
18294@end table
18295
18296@node SPARC Options
18297@subsection SPARC Options
18298@cindex SPARC options
18299
18300These @samp{-m} options are supported on the SPARC:
18301
18302@table @gcctabopt
18303@item -mno-app-regs
18304@itemx -mapp-regs
18305@opindex mno-app-regs
18306@opindex mapp-regs
18307Specify @option{-mapp-regs} to generate output using the global registers
183082 through 4, which the SPARC SVR4 ABI reserves for applications.  This
18309is the default.
18310
18311To be fully SVR4 ABI compliant at the cost of some performance loss,
18312specify @option{-mno-app-regs}.  You should compile libraries and system
18313software with this option.
18314
18315@item -mflat
18316@itemx -mno-flat
18317@opindex mflat
18318@opindex mno-flat
18319With @option{-mflat}, the compiler does not generate save/restore instructions
18320and uses a ``flat'' or single register window model.  This model is compatible
18321with the regular register window model.  The local registers and the input
18322registers (0--5) are still treated as ``call-saved'' registers and will be
18323saved on the stack as needed.
18324
18325With @option{-mno-flat} (the default), the compiler generates save/restore
18326instructions (except for leaf functions).  This is the normal operating mode.
18327
18328@item -mfpu
18329@itemx -mhard-float
18330@opindex mfpu
18331@opindex mhard-float
18332Generate output containing floating-point instructions.  This is the
18333default.
18334
18335@item -mno-fpu
18336@itemx -msoft-float
18337@opindex mno-fpu
18338@opindex msoft-float
18339Generate output containing library calls for floating point.
18340@strong{Warning:} the requisite libraries are not available for all SPARC
18341targets.  Normally the facilities of the machine's usual C compiler are
18342used, but this cannot be done directly in cross-compilation.  You must make
18343your own arrangements to provide suitable library functions for
18344cross-compilation.  The embedded targets @samp{sparc-*-aout} and
18345@samp{sparclite-*-*} do provide software floating-point support.
18346
18347@option{-msoft-float} changes the calling convention in the output file;
18348therefore, it is only useful if you compile @emph{all} of a program with
18349this option.  In particular, you need to compile @file{libgcc.a}, the
18350library that comes with GCC, with @option{-msoft-float} in order for
18351this to work.
18352
18353@item -mhard-quad-float
18354@opindex mhard-quad-float
18355Generate output containing quad-word (long double) floating-point
18356instructions.
18357
18358@item -msoft-quad-float
18359@opindex msoft-quad-float
18360Generate output containing library calls for quad-word (long double)
18361floating-point instructions.  The functions called are those specified
18362in the SPARC ABI@.  This is the default.
18363
18364As of this writing, there are no SPARC implementations that have hardware
18365support for the quad-word floating-point instructions.  They all invoke
18366a trap handler for one of these instructions, and then the trap handler
18367emulates the effect of the instruction.  Because of the trap handler overhead,
18368this is much slower than calling the ABI library routines.  Thus the
18369@option{-msoft-quad-float} option is the default.
18370
18371@item -mno-unaligned-doubles
18372@itemx -munaligned-doubles
18373@opindex mno-unaligned-doubles
18374@opindex munaligned-doubles
18375Assume that doubles have 8-byte alignment.  This is the default.
18376
18377With @option{-munaligned-doubles}, GCC assumes that doubles have 8-byte
18378alignment only if they are contained in another type, or if they have an
18379absolute address.  Otherwise, it assumes they have 4-byte alignment.
18380Specifying this option avoids some rare compatibility problems with code
18381generated by other compilers.  It is not the default because it results
18382in a performance loss, especially for floating-point code.
18383
18384@item -mno-faster-structs
18385@itemx -mfaster-structs
18386@opindex mno-faster-structs
18387@opindex mfaster-structs
18388With @option{-mfaster-structs}, the compiler assumes that structures
18389should have 8-byte alignment.  This enables the use of pairs of
18390@code{ldd} and @code{std} instructions for copies in structure
18391assignment, in place of twice as many @code{ld} and @code{st} pairs.
18392However, the use of this changed alignment directly violates the SPARC
18393ABI@.  Thus, it's intended only for use on targets where the developer
18394acknowledges that their resulting code will not be directly in line with
18395the rules of the ABI@.
18396
18397@item -mcpu=@var{cpu_type}
18398@opindex mcpu
18399Set the instruction set, register set, and instruction scheduling parameters
18400for machine type @var{cpu_type}.  Supported values for @var{cpu_type} are
18401@samp{v7}, @samp{cypress}, @samp{v8}, @samp{supersparc}, @samp{hypersparc},
18402@samp{leon}, @samp{sparclite}, @samp{f930}, @samp{f934}, @samp{sparclite86x},
18403@samp{sparclet}, @samp{tsc701}, @samp{v9}, @samp{ultrasparc},
18404@samp{ultrasparc3}, @samp{niagara}, @samp{niagara2}, @samp{niagara3},
18405and @samp{niagara4}.
18406
18407Native Solaris and GNU/Linux toolchains also support the value @samp{native},
18408which selects the best architecture option for the host processor.
18409@option{-mcpu=native} has no effect if GCC does not recognize
18410the processor.
18411
18412Default instruction scheduling parameters are used for values that select
18413an architecture and not an implementation.  These are @samp{v7}, @samp{v8},
18414@samp{sparclite}, @samp{sparclet}, @samp{v9}.
18415
18416Here is a list of each supported architecture and their supported
18417implementations.
18418
18419@table @asis
18420@item v7
18421cypress
18422
18423@item v8
18424supersparc, hypersparc, leon
18425
18426@item sparclite
18427f930, f934, sparclite86x
18428
18429@item sparclet
18430tsc701
18431
18432@item v9
18433ultrasparc, ultrasparc3, niagara, niagara2, niagara3, niagara4
18434@end table
18435
18436By default (unless configured otherwise), GCC generates code for the V7
18437variant of the SPARC architecture.  With @option{-mcpu=cypress}, the compiler
18438additionally optimizes it for the Cypress CY7C602 chip, as used in the
18439SPARCStation/SPARCServer 3xx series.  This is also appropriate for the older
18440SPARCStation 1, 2, IPX etc.
18441
18442With @option{-mcpu=v8}, GCC generates code for the V8 variant of the SPARC
18443architecture.  The only difference from V7 code is that the compiler emits
18444the integer multiply and integer divide instructions which exist in SPARC-V8
18445but not in SPARC-V7.  With @option{-mcpu=supersparc}, the compiler additionally
18446optimizes it for the SuperSPARC chip, as used in the SPARCStation 10, 1000 and
184472000 series.
18448
18449With @option{-mcpu=sparclite}, GCC generates code for the SPARClite variant of
18450the SPARC architecture.  This adds the integer multiply, integer divide step
18451and scan (@code{ffs}) instructions which exist in SPARClite but not in SPARC-V7.
18452With @option{-mcpu=f930}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the
18453Fujitsu MB86930 chip, which is the original SPARClite, with no FPU@.  With
18454@option{-mcpu=f934}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the Fujitsu
18455MB86934 chip, which is the more recent SPARClite with FPU@.
18456
18457With @option{-mcpu=sparclet}, GCC generates code for the SPARClet variant of
18458the SPARC architecture.  This adds the integer multiply, multiply/accumulate,
18459integer divide step and scan (@code{ffs}) instructions which exist in SPARClet
18460but not in SPARC-V7.  With @option{-mcpu=tsc701}, the compiler additionally
18461optimizes it for the TEMIC SPARClet chip.
18462
18463With @option{-mcpu=v9}, GCC generates code for the V9 variant of the SPARC
18464architecture.  This adds 64-bit integer and floating-point move instructions,
184653 additional floating-point condition code registers and conditional move
18466instructions.  With @option{-mcpu=ultrasparc}, the compiler additionally
18467optimizes it for the Sun UltraSPARC I/II/IIi chips.  With
18468@option{-mcpu=ultrasparc3}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for the
18469Sun UltraSPARC III/III+/IIIi/IIIi+/IV/IV+ chips.  With
18470@option{-mcpu=niagara}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for
18471Sun UltraSPARC T1 chips.  With @option{-mcpu=niagara2}, the compiler
18472additionally optimizes it for Sun UltraSPARC T2 chips. With
18473@option{-mcpu=niagara3}, the compiler additionally optimizes it for Sun
18474UltraSPARC T3 chips.  With @option{-mcpu=niagara4}, the compiler
18475additionally optimizes it for Sun UltraSPARC T4 chips.
18476
18477@item -mtune=@var{cpu_type}
18478@opindex mtune
18479Set the instruction scheduling parameters for machine type
18480@var{cpu_type}, but do not set the instruction set or register set that the
18481option @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} would.
18482
18483The same values for @option{-mcpu=@var{cpu_type}} can be used for
18484@option{-mtune=@var{cpu_type}}, but the only useful values are those
18485that select a particular CPU implementation.  Those are @samp{cypress},
18486@samp{supersparc}, @samp{hypersparc}, @samp{leon}, @samp{f930}, @samp{f934},
18487@samp{sparclite86x}, @samp{tsc701}, @samp{ultrasparc}, @samp{ultrasparc3},
18488@samp{niagara}, @samp{niagara2}, @samp{niagara3} and @samp{niagara4}.  With
18489native Solaris and GNU/Linux toolchains, @samp{native} can also be used.
18490
18491@item -mv8plus
18492@itemx -mno-v8plus
18493@opindex mv8plus
18494@opindex mno-v8plus
18495With @option{-mv8plus}, GCC generates code for the SPARC-V8+ ABI@.  The
18496difference from the V8 ABI is that the global and out registers are
18497considered 64 bits wide.  This is enabled by default on Solaris in 32-bit
18498mode for all SPARC-V9 processors.
18499
18500@item -mvis
18501@itemx -mno-vis
18502@opindex mvis
18503@opindex mno-vis
18504With @option{-mvis}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the UltraSPARC
18505Visual Instruction Set extensions.  The default is @option{-mno-vis}.
18506
18507@item -mvis2
18508@itemx -mno-vis2
18509@opindex mvis2
18510@opindex mno-vis2
18511With @option{-mvis2}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of
18512version 2.0 of the UltraSPARC Visual Instruction Set extensions.  The
18513default is @option{-mvis2} when targetting a cpu that supports such
18514instructions, such as UltraSPARC-III and later.  Setting @option{-mvis2}
18515also sets @option{-mvis}.
18516
18517@item -mvis3
18518@itemx -mno-vis3
18519@opindex mvis3
18520@opindex mno-vis3
18521With @option{-mvis3}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of
18522version 3.0 of the UltraSPARC Visual Instruction Set extensions.  The
18523default is @option{-mvis3} when targetting a cpu that supports such
18524instructions, such as niagara-3 and later.  Setting @option{-mvis3}
18525also sets @option{-mvis2} and @option{-mvis}.
18526
18527@item -mpopc
18528@itemx -mno-popc
18529@opindex mpopc
18530@opindex mno-popc
18531With @option{-mpopc}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the UltraSPARC
18532population count instruction.  The default is @option{-mpopc}
18533when targetting a cpu that supports such instructions, such as Niagara-2 and
18534later.
18535
18536@item -mfmaf
18537@itemx -mno-fmaf
18538@opindex mfmaf
18539@opindex mno-fmaf
18540With @option{-mfmaf}, GCC generates code that takes advantage of the UltraSPARC
18541Fused Multiply-Add Floating-point extensions.  The default is @option{-mfmaf}
18542when targetting a cpu that supports such instructions, such as Niagara-3 and
18543later.
18544
18545@item -mfix-at697f
18546@opindex mfix-at697f
18547Enable the documented workaround for the single erratum of the Atmel AT697F
18548processor (which corresponds to erratum #13 of the AT697E processor).
18549@end table
18550
18551These @samp{-m} options are supported in addition to the above
18552on SPARC-V9 processors in 64-bit environments:
18553
18554@table @gcctabopt
18555@item -m32
18556@itemx -m64
18557@opindex m32
18558@opindex m64
18559Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.
18560The 32-bit environment sets int, long and pointer to 32 bits.
18561The 64-bit environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer
18562to 64 bits.
18563
18564@item -mcmodel=@var{which}
18565@opindex mcmodel
18566Set the code model to one of
18567
18568@table @samp
18569@item medlow
18570The Medium/Low code model: 64-bit addresses, programs
18571must be linked in the low 32 bits of memory.  Programs can be statically
18572or dynamically linked.
18573
18574@item medmid
18575The Medium/Middle code model: 64-bit addresses, programs
18576must be linked in the low 44 bits of memory, the text and data segments must
18577be less than 2GB in size and the data segment must be located within 2GB of
18578the text segment.
18579
18580@item medany
18581The Medium/Anywhere code model: 64-bit addresses, programs
18582may be linked anywhere in memory, the text and data segments must be less
18583than 2GB in size and the data segment must be located within 2GB of the
18584text segment.
18585
18586@item embmedany
18587The Medium/Anywhere code model for embedded systems:
1858864-bit addresses, the text and data segments must be less than 2GB in
18589size, both starting anywhere in memory (determined at link time).  The
18590global register %g4 points to the base of the data segment.  Programs
18591are statically linked and PIC is not supported.
18592@end table
18593
18594@item -mmemory-model=@var{mem-model}
18595@opindex mmemory-model
18596Set the memory model in force on the processor to one of
18597
18598@table @samp
18599@item default
18600The default memory model for the processor and operating system.
18601
18602@item rmo
18603Relaxed Memory Order
18604
18605@item pso
18606Partial Store Order
18607
18608@item tso
18609Total Store Order
18610
18611@item sc
18612Sequential Consistency
18613@end table
18614
18615These memory models are formally defined in Appendix D of the Sparc V9
18616architecture manual, as set in the processor's @code{PSTATE.MM} field.
18617
18618@item -mstack-bias
18619@itemx -mno-stack-bias
18620@opindex mstack-bias
18621@opindex mno-stack-bias
18622With @option{-mstack-bias}, GCC assumes that the stack pointer, and
18623frame pointer if present, are offset by @minus{}2047 which must be added back
18624when making stack frame references.  This is the default in 64-bit mode.
18625Otherwise, assume no such offset is present.
18626@end table
18627
18628@node SPU Options
18629@subsection SPU Options
18630@cindex SPU options
18631
18632These @samp{-m} options are supported on the SPU:
18633
18634@table @gcctabopt
18635@item -mwarn-reloc
18636@itemx -merror-reloc
18637@opindex mwarn-reloc
18638@opindex merror-reloc
18639
18640The loader for SPU does not handle dynamic relocations.  By default, GCC
18641will give an error when it generates code that requires a dynamic
18642relocation.  @option{-mno-error-reloc} disables the error,
18643@option{-mwarn-reloc} will generate a warning instead.
18644
18645@item -msafe-dma
18646@itemx -munsafe-dma
18647@opindex msafe-dma
18648@opindex munsafe-dma
18649
18650Instructions that initiate or test completion of DMA must not be
18651reordered with respect to loads and stores of the memory that is being
18652accessed.  Users typically address this problem using the volatile
18653keyword, but that can lead to inefficient code in places where the
18654memory is known to not change.  Rather than mark the memory as volatile
18655we treat the DMA instructions as potentially effecting all memory.  With
18656@option{-munsafe-dma} users must use the volatile keyword to protect
18657memory accesses.
18658
18659@item -mbranch-hints
18660@opindex mbranch-hints
18661
18662By default, GCC will generate a branch hint instruction to avoid
18663pipeline stalls for always taken or probably taken branches.  A hint
18664will not be generated closer than 8 instructions away from its branch.
18665There is little reason to disable them, except for debugging purposes,
18666or to make an object a little bit smaller.
18667
18668@item -msmall-mem
18669@itemx -mlarge-mem
18670@opindex msmall-mem
18671@opindex mlarge-mem
18672
18673By default, GCC generates code assuming that addresses are never larger
18674than 18 bits.  With @option{-mlarge-mem} code is generated that assumes
18675a full 32-bit address.
18676
18677@item -mstdmain
18678@opindex mstdmain
18679
18680By default, GCC links against startup code that assumes the SPU-style
18681main function interface (which has an unconventional parameter list).
18682With @option{-mstdmain}, GCC will link your program against startup
18683code that assumes a C99-style interface to @code{main}, including a
18684local copy of @code{argv} strings.
18685
18686@item -mfixed-range=@var{register-range}
18687@opindex mfixed-range
18688Generate code treating the given register range as fixed registers.
18689A fixed register is one that the register allocator can not use.  This is
18690useful when compiling kernel code.  A register range is specified as
18691two registers separated by a dash.  Multiple register ranges can be
18692specified separated by a comma.
18693
18694@item -mea32
18695@itemx -mea64
18696@opindex mea32
18697@opindex mea64
18698Compile code assuming that pointers to the PPU address space accessed
18699via the @code{__ea} named address space qualifier are either 32 or 64
18700bits wide.  The default is 32 bits.  As this is an ABI changing option,
18701all object code in an executable must be compiled with the same setting.
18702
18703@item -maddress-space-conversion
18704@itemx -mno-address-space-conversion
18705@opindex maddress-space-conversion
18706@opindex mno-address-space-conversion
18707Allow/disallow treating the @code{__ea} address space as superset
18708of the generic address space.  This enables explicit type casts
18709between @code{__ea} and generic pointer as well as implicit
18710conversions of generic pointers to @code{__ea} pointers.  The
18711default is to allow address space pointer conversions.
18712
18713@item -mcache-size=@var{cache-size}
18714@opindex mcache-size
18715This option controls the version of libgcc that the compiler links to an
18716executable and selects a software-managed cache for accessing variables
18717in the @code{__ea} address space with a particular cache size.  Possible
18718options for @var{cache-size} are @samp{8}, @samp{16}, @samp{32}, @samp{64}
18719and @samp{128}.  The default cache size is 64KB.
18720
18721@item -matomic-updates
18722@itemx -mno-atomic-updates
18723@opindex matomic-updates
18724@opindex mno-atomic-updates
18725This option controls the version of libgcc that the compiler links to an
18726executable and selects whether atomic updates to the software-managed
18727cache of PPU-side variables are used.  If you use atomic updates, changes
18728to a PPU variable from SPU code using the @code{__ea} named address space
18729qualifier will not interfere with changes to other PPU variables residing
18730in the same cache line from PPU code.  If you do not use atomic updates,
18731such interference may occur; however, writing back cache lines will be
18732more efficient.  The default behavior is to use atomic updates.
18733
18734@item -mdual-nops
18735@itemx -mdual-nops=@var{n}
18736@opindex mdual-nops
18737By default, GCC will insert nops to increase dual issue when it expects
18738it to increase performance.  @var{n} can be a value from 0 to 10.  A
18739smaller @var{n} will insert fewer nops.  10 is the default, 0 is the
18740same as @option{-mno-dual-nops}.  Disabled with @option{-Os}.
18741
18742@item -mhint-max-nops=@var{n}
18743@opindex mhint-max-nops
18744Maximum number of nops to insert for a branch hint.  A branch hint must
18745be at least 8 instructions away from the branch it is effecting.  GCC
18746will insert up to @var{n} nops to enforce this, otherwise it will not
18747generate the branch hint.
18748
18749@item -mhint-max-distance=@var{n}
18750@opindex mhint-max-distance
18751The encoding of the branch hint instruction limits the hint to be within
18752256 instructions of the branch it is effecting.  By default, GCC makes
18753sure it is within 125.
18754
18755@item -msafe-hints
18756@opindex msafe-hints
18757Work around a hardware bug that causes the SPU to stall indefinitely.
18758By default, GCC will insert the @code{hbrp} instruction to make sure
18759this stall won't happen.
18760
18761@end table
18762
18763@node System V Options
18764@subsection Options for System V
18765
18766These additional options are available on System V Release 4 for
18767compatibility with other compilers on those systems:
18768
18769@table @gcctabopt
18770@item -G
18771@opindex G
18772Create a shared object.
18773It is recommended that @option{-symbolic} or @option{-shared} be used instead.
18774
18775@item -Qy
18776@opindex Qy
18777Identify the versions of each tool used by the compiler, in a
18778@code{.ident} assembler directive in the output.
18779
18780@item -Qn
18781@opindex Qn
18782Refrain from adding @code{.ident} directives to the output file (this is
18783the default).
18784
18785@item -YP,@var{dirs}
18786@opindex YP
18787Search the directories @var{dirs}, and no others, for libraries
18788specified with @option{-l}.
18789
18790@item -Ym,@var{dir}
18791@opindex Ym
18792Look in the directory @var{dir} to find the M4 preprocessor.
18793The assembler uses this option.
18794@c This is supposed to go with a -Yd for predefined M4 macro files, but
18795@c the generic assembler that comes with Solaris takes just -Ym.
18796@end table
18797
18798@node TILE-Gx Options
18799@subsection TILE-Gx Options
18800@cindex TILE-Gx options
18801
18802These @samp{-m} options are supported on the TILE-Gx:
18803
18804@table @gcctabopt
18805@item -mcpu=@var{name}
18806@opindex mcpu
18807Selects the type of CPU to be targeted.  Currently the only supported
18808type is @samp{tilegx}.
18809
18810@item -m32
18811@itemx -m64
18812@opindex m32
18813@opindex m64
18814Generate code for a 32-bit or 64-bit environment.  The 32-bit
18815environment sets int, long, and pointer to 32 bits.  The 64-bit
18816environment sets int to 32 bits and long and pointer to 64 bits.
18817@end table
18818
18819@node TILEPro Options
18820@subsection TILEPro Options
18821@cindex TILEPro options
18822
18823These @samp{-m} options are supported on the TILEPro:
18824
18825@table @gcctabopt
18826@item -mcpu=@var{name}
18827@opindex mcpu
18828Selects the type of CPU to be targeted.  Currently the only supported
18829type is @samp{tilepro}.
18830
18831@item -m32
18832@opindex m32
18833Generate code for a 32-bit environment, which sets int, long, and
18834pointer to 32 bits.  This is the only supported behavior so the flag
18835is essentially ignored.
18836@end table
18837
18838@node V850 Options
18839@subsection V850 Options
18840@cindex V850 Options
18841
18842These @samp{-m} options are defined for V850 implementations:
18843
18844@table @gcctabopt
18845@item -mlong-calls
18846@itemx -mno-long-calls
18847@opindex mlong-calls
18848@opindex mno-long-calls
18849Treat all calls as being far away (near).  If calls are assumed to be
18850far away, the compiler will always load the functions address up into a
18851register, and call indirect through the pointer.
18852
18853@item -mno-ep
18854@itemx -mep
18855@opindex mno-ep
18856@opindex mep
18857Do not optimize (do optimize) basic blocks that use the same index
18858pointer 4 or more times to copy pointer into the @code{ep} register, and
18859use the shorter @code{sld} and @code{sst} instructions.  The @option{-mep}
18860option is on by default if you optimize.
18861
18862@item -mno-prolog-function
18863@itemx -mprolog-function
18864@opindex mno-prolog-function
18865@opindex mprolog-function
18866Do not use (do use) external functions to save and restore registers
18867at the prologue and epilogue of a function.  The external functions
18868are slower, but use less code space if more than one function saves
18869the same number of registers.  The @option{-mprolog-function} option
18870is on by default if you optimize.
18871
18872@item -mspace
18873@opindex mspace
18874Try to make the code as small as possible.  At present, this just turns
18875on the @option{-mep} and @option{-mprolog-function} options.
18876
18877@item -mtda=@var{n}
18878@opindex mtda
18879Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
18880the tiny data area that register @code{ep} points to.  The tiny data
18881area can hold up to 256 bytes in total (128 bytes for byte references).
18882
18883@item -msda=@var{n}
18884@opindex msda
18885Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
18886the small data area that register @code{gp} points to.  The small data
18887area can hold up to 64 kilobytes.
18888
18889@item -mzda=@var{n}
18890@opindex mzda
18891Put static or global variables whose size is @var{n} bytes or less into
18892the first 32 kilobytes of memory.
18893
18894@item -mv850
18895@opindex mv850
18896Specify that the target processor is the V850.
18897
18898@item -mbig-switch
18899@opindex mbig-switch
18900Generate code suitable for big switch tables.  Use this option only if
18901the assembler/linker complain about out of range branches within a switch
18902table.
18903
18904@item -mapp-regs
18905@opindex mapp-regs
18906This option will cause r2 and r5 to be used in the code generated by
18907the compiler.  This setting is the default.
18908
18909@item -mno-app-regs
18910@opindex mno-app-regs
18911This option will cause r2 and r5 to be treated as fixed registers.
18912
18913@item -mv850e2v3
18914@opindex mv850e2v3
18915Specify that the target processor is the V850E2V3.  The preprocessor
18916constants @samp{__v850e2v3__} will be defined if
18917this option is used.
18918
18919@item -mv850e2
18920@opindex mv850e2
18921Specify that the target processor is the V850E2.  The preprocessor
18922constants @samp{__v850e2__} will be defined if this option is used.
18923
18924@item -mv850e1
18925@opindex mv850e1
18926Specify that the target processor is the V850E1.  The preprocessor
18927constants @samp{__v850e1__} and @samp{__v850e__} will be defined if
18928this option is used.
18929
18930@item -mv850es
18931@opindex mv850es
18932Specify that the target processor is the V850ES.  This is an alias for
18933the @option{-mv850e1} option.
18934
18935@item -mv850e
18936@opindex mv850e
18937Specify that the target processor is the V850E@.  The preprocessor
18938constant @samp{__v850e__} will be defined if this option is used.
18939
18940If neither @option{-mv850} nor @option{-mv850e} nor @option{-mv850e1}
18941nor @option{-mv850e2} nor @option{-mv850e2v3}
18942are defined then a default target processor will be chosen and the
18943relevant @samp{__v850*__} preprocessor constant will be defined.
18944
18945The preprocessor constants @samp{__v850} and @samp{__v851__} are always
18946defined, regardless of which processor variant is the target.
18947
18948@item -mdisable-callt
18949@opindex mdisable-callt
18950This option will suppress generation of the CALLT instruction for the
18951v850e, v850e1, v850e2 and v850e2v3 flavors of the v850 architecture.  The default is
18952@option{-mno-disable-callt} which allows the CALLT instruction to be used.
18953
18954@end table
18955
18956@node VAX Options
18957@subsection VAX Options
18958@cindex VAX options
18959
18960These @samp{-m} options are defined for the VAX:
18961
18962@table @gcctabopt
18963@item -munix
18964@opindex munix
18965Do not output certain jump instructions (@code{aobleq} and so on)
18966that the Unix assembler for the VAX cannot handle across long
18967ranges.
18968
18969@item -mgnu
18970@opindex mgnu
18971Do output those jump instructions, on the assumption that you
18972will assemble with the GNU assembler.
18973
18974@item -mg
18975@opindex mg
18976Output code for G-format floating-point numbers instead of D-format.
18977@end table
18978
18979@node VxWorks Options
18980@subsection VxWorks Options
18981@cindex VxWorks Options
18982
18983The options in this section are defined for all VxWorks targets.
18984Options specific to the target hardware are listed with the other
18985options for that target.
18986
18987@table @gcctabopt
18988@item -mrtp
18989@opindex mrtp
18990GCC can generate code for both VxWorks kernels and real time processes
18991(RTPs).  This option switches from the former to the latter.  It also
18992defines the preprocessor macro @code{__RTP__}.
18993
18994@item -non-static
18995@opindex non-static
18996Link an RTP executable against shared libraries rather than static
18997libraries.  The options @option{-static} and @option{-shared} can
18998also be used for RTPs (@pxref{Link Options}); @option{-static}
18999is the default.
19000
19001@item -Bstatic
19002@itemx -Bdynamic
19003@opindex Bstatic
19004@opindex Bdynamic
19005These options are passed down to the linker.  They are defined for
19006compatibility with Diab.
19007
19008@item -Xbind-lazy
19009@opindex Xbind-lazy
19010Enable lazy binding of function calls.  This option is equivalent to
19011@option{-Wl,-z,now} and is defined for compatibility with Diab.
19012
19013@item -Xbind-now
19014@opindex Xbind-now
19015Disable lazy binding of function calls.  This option is the default and
19016is defined for compatibility with Diab.
19017@end table
19018
19019@node x86-64 Options
19020@subsection x86-64 Options
19021@cindex x86-64 options
19022
19023These are listed under @xref{i386 and x86-64 Options}.
19024
19025@node Xstormy16 Options
19026@subsection Xstormy16 Options
19027@cindex Xstormy16 Options
19028
19029These options are defined for Xstormy16:
19030
19031@table @gcctabopt
19032@item -msim
19033@opindex msim
19034Choose startup files and linker script suitable for the simulator.
19035@end table
19036
19037@node Xtensa Options
19038@subsection Xtensa Options
19039@cindex Xtensa Options
19040
19041These options are supported for Xtensa targets:
19042
19043@table @gcctabopt
19044@item -mconst16
19045@itemx -mno-const16
19046@opindex mconst16
19047@opindex mno-const16
19048Enable or disable use of @code{CONST16} instructions for loading
19049constant values.  The @code{CONST16} instruction is currently not a
19050standard option from Tensilica.  When enabled, @code{CONST16}
19051instructions are always used in place of the standard @code{L32R}
19052instructions.  The use of @code{CONST16} is enabled by default only if
19053the @code{L32R} instruction is not available.
19054
19055@item -mfused-madd
19056@itemx -mno-fused-madd
19057@opindex mfused-madd
19058@opindex mno-fused-madd
19059Enable or disable use of fused multiply/add and multiply/subtract
19060instructions in the floating-point option.  This has no effect if the
19061floating-point option is not also enabled.  Disabling fused multiply/add
19062and multiply/subtract instructions forces the compiler to use separate
19063instructions for the multiply and add/subtract operations.  This may be
19064desirable in some cases where strict IEEE 754-compliant results are
19065required: the fused multiply add/subtract instructions do not round the
19066intermediate result, thereby producing results with @emph{more} bits of
19067precision than specified by the IEEE standard.  Disabling fused multiply
19068add/subtract instructions also ensures that the program output is not
19069sensitive to the compiler's ability to combine multiply and add/subtract
19070operations.
19071
19072@item -mserialize-volatile
19073@itemx -mno-serialize-volatile
19074@opindex mserialize-volatile
19075@opindex mno-serialize-volatile
19076When this option is enabled, GCC inserts @code{MEMW} instructions before
19077@code{volatile} memory references to guarantee sequential consistency.
19078The default is @option{-mserialize-volatile}.  Use
19079@option{-mno-serialize-volatile} to omit the @code{MEMW} instructions.
19080
19081@item -mforce-no-pic
19082@opindex mforce-no-pic
19083For targets, like GNU/Linux, where all user-mode Xtensa code must be
19084position-independent code (PIC), this option disables PIC for compiling
19085kernel code.
19086
19087@item -mtext-section-literals
19088@itemx -mno-text-section-literals
19089@opindex mtext-section-literals
19090@opindex mno-text-section-literals
19091Control the treatment of literal pools.  The default is
19092@option{-mno-text-section-literals}, which places literals in a separate
19093section in the output file.  This allows the literal pool to be placed
19094in a data RAM/ROM, and it also allows the linker to combine literal
19095pools from separate object files to remove redundant literals and
19096improve code size.  With @option{-mtext-section-literals}, the literals
19097are interspersed in the text section in order to keep them as close as
19098possible to their references.  This may be necessary for large assembly
19099files.
19100
19101@item -mtarget-align
19102@itemx -mno-target-align
19103@opindex mtarget-align
19104@opindex mno-target-align
19105When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the assembler to
19106automatically align instructions to reduce branch penalties at the
19107expense of some code density.  The assembler attempts to widen density
19108instructions to align branch targets and the instructions following call
19109instructions.  If there are not enough preceding safe density
19110instructions to align a target, no widening will be performed.  The
19111default is @option{-mtarget-align}.  These options do not affect the
19112treatment of auto-aligned instructions like @code{LOOP}, which the
19113assembler will always align, either by widening density instructions or
19114by inserting no-op instructions.
19115
19116@item -mlongcalls
19117@itemx -mno-longcalls
19118@opindex mlongcalls
19119@opindex mno-longcalls
19120When this option is enabled, GCC instructs the assembler to translate
19121direct calls to indirect calls unless it can determine that the target
19122of a direct call is in the range allowed by the call instruction.  This
19123translation typically occurs for calls to functions in other source
19124files.  Specifically, the assembler translates a direct @code{CALL}
19125instruction into an @code{L32R} followed by a @code{CALLX} instruction.
19126The default is @option{-mno-longcalls}.  This option should be used in
19127programs where the call target can potentially be out of range.  This
19128option is implemented in the assembler, not the compiler, so the
19129assembly code generated by GCC will still show direct call
19130instructions---look at the disassembled object code to see the actual
19131instructions.  Note that the assembler will use an indirect call for
19132every cross-file call, not just those that really will be out of range.
19133@end table
19134
19135@node zSeries Options
19136@subsection zSeries Options
19137@cindex zSeries options
19138
19139These are listed under @xref{S/390 and zSeries Options}.
19140
19141@node Code Gen Options
19142@section Options for Code Generation Conventions
19143@cindex code generation conventions
19144@cindex options, code generation
19145@cindex run-time options
19146
19147These machine-independent options control the interface conventions
19148used in code generation.
19149
19150Most of them have both positive and negative forms; the negative form
19151of @option{-ffoo} would be @option{-fno-foo}.  In the table below, only
19152one of the forms is listed---the one that is not the default.  You
19153can figure out the other form by either removing @samp{no-} or adding
19154it.
19155
19156@table @gcctabopt
19157@item -fbounds-check
19158@opindex fbounds-check
19159For front ends that support it, generate additional code to check that
19160indices used to access arrays are within the declared range.  This is
19161currently only supported by the Java and Fortran front ends, where
19162this option defaults to true and false respectively.
19163
19164@item -ftrapv
19165@opindex ftrapv
19166This option generates traps for signed overflow on addition, subtraction,
19167multiplication operations.
19168
19169@item -fwrapv
19170@opindex fwrapv
19171This option instructs the compiler to assume that signed arithmetic
19172overflow of addition, subtraction and multiplication wraps around
19173using twos-complement representation.  This flag enables some optimizations
19174and disables others.  This option is enabled by default for the Java
19175front end, as required by the Java language specification.
19176
19177@item -fexceptions
19178@opindex fexceptions
19179Enable exception handling.  Generates extra code needed to propagate
19180exceptions.  For some targets, this implies GCC will generate frame
19181unwind information for all functions, which can produce significant data
19182size overhead, although it does not affect execution.  If you do not
19183specify this option, GCC will enable it by default for languages like
19184C++ that normally require exception handling, and disable it for
19185languages like C that do not normally require it.  However, you may need
19186to enable this option when compiling C code that needs to interoperate
19187properly with exception handlers written in C++.  You may also wish to
19188disable this option if you are compiling older C++ programs that don't
19189use exception handling.
19190
19191@item -fnon-call-exceptions
19192@opindex fnon-call-exceptions
19193Generate code that allows trapping instructions to throw exceptions.
19194Note that this requires platform-specific runtime support that does
19195not exist everywhere.  Moreover, it only allows @emph{trapping}
19196instructions to throw exceptions, i.e.@: memory references or floating-point
19197instructions.  It does not allow exceptions to be thrown from
19198arbitrary signal handlers such as @code{SIGALRM}.
19199
19200@item -funwind-tables
19201@opindex funwind-tables
19202Similar to @option{-fexceptions}, except that it will just generate any needed
19203static data, but will not affect the generated code in any other way.
19204You will normally not enable this option; instead, a language processor
19205that needs this handling would enable it on your behalf.
19206
19207@item -fasynchronous-unwind-tables
19208@opindex fasynchronous-unwind-tables
19209Generate unwind table in dwarf2 format, if supported by target machine.  The
19210table is exact at each instruction boundary, so it can be used for stack
19211unwinding from asynchronous events (such as debugger or garbage collector).
19212
19213@item -fpcc-struct-return
19214@opindex fpcc-struct-return
19215Return ``short'' @code{struct} and @code{union} values in memory like
19216longer ones, rather than in registers.  This convention is less
19217efficient, but it has the advantage of allowing intercallability between
19218GCC-compiled files and files compiled with other compilers, particularly
19219the Portable C Compiler (pcc).
19220
19221The precise convention for returning structures in memory depends
19222on the target configuration macros.
19223
19224Short structures and unions are those whose size and alignment match
19225that of some integer type.
19226
19227@strong{Warning:} code compiled with the @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
19228switch is not binary compatible with code compiled with the
19229@option{-freg-struct-return} switch.
19230Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19231
19232@item -freg-struct-return
19233@opindex freg-struct-return
19234Return @code{struct} and @code{union} values in registers when possible.
19235This is more efficient for small structures than
19236@option{-fpcc-struct-return}.
19237
19238If you specify neither @option{-fpcc-struct-return} nor
19239@option{-freg-struct-return}, GCC defaults to whichever convention is
19240standard for the target.  If there is no standard convention, GCC
19241defaults to @option{-fpcc-struct-return}, except on targets where GCC is
19242the principal compiler.  In those cases, we can choose the standard, and
19243we chose the more efficient register return alternative.
19244
19245@strong{Warning:} code compiled with the @option{-freg-struct-return}
19246switch is not binary compatible with code compiled with the
19247@option{-fpcc-struct-return} switch.
19248Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19249
19250@item -fshort-enums
19251@opindex fshort-enums
19252Allocate to an @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it needs for the
19253declared range of possible values.  Specifically, the @code{enum} type
19254will be equivalent to the smallest integer type that has enough room.
19255
19256@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-enums} switch causes GCC to generate
19257code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
19258Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19259
19260@item -fshort-double
19261@opindex fshort-double
19262Use the same size for @code{double} as for @code{float}.
19263
19264@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-double} switch causes GCC to generate
19265code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
19266Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19267
19268@item -fshort-wchar
19269@opindex fshort-wchar
19270Override the underlying type for @samp{wchar_t} to be @samp{short
19271unsigned int} instead of the default for the target.  This option is
19272useful for building programs to run under WINE@.
19273
19274@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fshort-wchar} switch causes GCC to generate
19275code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
19276Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19277
19278@item -fno-common
19279@opindex fno-common
19280In C code, controls the placement of uninitialized global variables.
19281Unix C compilers have traditionally permitted multiple definitions of
19282such variables in different compilation units by placing the variables
19283in a common block.
19284This is the behavior specified by @option{-fcommon}, and is the default
19285for GCC on most targets.
19286On the other hand, this behavior is not required by ISO C, and on some
19287targets may carry a speed or code size penalty on variable references.
19288The @option{-fno-common} option specifies that the compiler should place
19289uninitialized global variables in the data section of the object file,
19290rather than generating them as common blocks.
19291This has the effect that if the same variable is declared
19292(without @code{extern}) in two different compilations,
19293you will get a multiple-definition error when you link them.
19294In this case, you must compile with @option{-fcommon} instead.
19295Compiling with @option{-fno-common} is useful on targets for which
19296it provides better performance, or if you wish to verify that the
19297program will work on other systems that always treat uninitialized
19298variable declarations this way.
19299
19300@item -fno-ident
19301@opindex fno-ident
19302Ignore the @samp{#ident} directive.
19303
19304@item -finhibit-size-directive
19305@opindex finhibit-size-directive
19306Don't output a @code{.size} assembler directive, or anything else that
19307would cause trouble if the function is split in the middle, and the
19308two halves are placed at locations far apart in memory.  This option is
19309used when compiling @file{crtstuff.c}; you should not need to use it
19310for anything else.
19311
19312@item -fverbose-asm
19313@opindex fverbose-asm
19314Put extra commentary information in the generated assembly code to
19315make it more readable.  This option is generally only of use to those
19316who actually need to read the generated assembly code (perhaps while
19317debugging the compiler itself).
19318
19319@option{-fno-verbose-asm}, the default, causes the
19320extra information to be omitted and is useful when comparing two assembler
19321files.
19322
19323@item -frecord-gcc-switches
19324@opindex frecord-gcc-switches
19325This switch causes the command line that was used to invoke the
19326compiler to be recorded into the object file that is being created.
19327This switch is only implemented on some targets and the exact format
19328of the recording is target and binary file format dependent, but it
19329usually takes the form of a section containing ASCII text.  This
19330switch is related to the @option{-fverbose-asm} switch, but that
19331switch only records information in the assembler output file as
19332comments, so it never reaches the object file.
19333See also @option{-grecord-gcc-switches} for another
19334way of storing compiler options into the object file.
19335
19336@item -fpic
19337@opindex fpic
19338@cindex global offset table
19339@cindex PIC
19340Generate position-independent code (PIC) suitable for use in a shared
19341library, if supported for the target machine.  Such code accesses all
19342constant addresses through a global offset table (GOT)@.  The dynamic
19343loader resolves the GOT entries when the program starts (the dynamic
19344loader is not part of GCC; it is part of the operating system).  If
19345the GOT size for the linked executable exceeds a machine-specific
19346maximum size, you get an error message from the linker indicating that
19347@option{-fpic} does not work; in that case, recompile with @option{-fPIC}
19348instead.  (These maximums are 8k on the SPARC and 32k
19349on the m68k and RS/6000.  The 386 has no such limit.)
19350
19351Position-independent code requires special support, and therefore works
19352only on certain machines.  For the 386, GCC supports PIC for System V
19353but not for the Sun 386i.  Code generated for the IBM RS/6000 is always
19354position-independent.
19355
19356When this flag is set, the macros @code{__pic__} and @code{__PIC__}
19357are defined to 1.
19358
19359@item -fPIC
19360@opindex fPIC
19361If supported for the target machine, emit position-independent code,
19362suitable for dynamic linking and avoiding any limit on the size of the
19363global offset table.  This option makes a difference on the m68k,
19364PowerPC and SPARC@.
19365
19366Position-independent code requires special support, and therefore works
19367only on certain machines.
19368
19369When this flag is set, the macros @code{__pic__} and @code{__PIC__}
19370are defined to 2.
19371
19372@item -fpie
19373@itemx -fPIE
19374@opindex fpie
19375@opindex fPIE
19376These options are similar to @option{-fpic} and @option{-fPIC}, but
19377generated position independent code can be only linked into executables.
19378Usually these options are used when @option{-pie} GCC option will be
19379used during linking.
19380
19381@option{-fpie} and @option{-fPIE} both define the macros
19382@code{__pie__} and @code{__PIE__}.  The macros have the value 1
19383for @option{-fpie} and 2 for @option{-fPIE}.
19384
19385@item -fno-jump-tables
19386@opindex fno-jump-tables
19387Do not use jump tables for switch statements even where it would be
19388more efficient than other code generation strategies.  This option is
19389of use in conjunction with @option{-fpic} or @option{-fPIC} for
19390building code that forms part of a dynamic linker and cannot
19391reference the address of a jump table.  On some targets, jump tables
19392do not require a GOT and this option is not needed.
19393
19394@item -ffixed-@var{reg}
19395@opindex ffixed
19396Treat the register named @var{reg} as a fixed register; generated code
19397should never refer to it (except perhaps as a stack pointer, frame
19398pointer or in some other fixed role).
19399
19400@var{reg} must be the name of a register.  The register names accepted
19401are machine-specific and are defined in the @code{REGISTER_NAMES}
19402macro in the machine description macro file.
19403
19404This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
19405three-way choice.
19406
19407@item -fcall-used-@var{reg}
19408@opindex fcall-used
19409Treat the register named @var{reg} as an allocable register that is
19410clobbered by function calls.  It may be allocated for temporaries or
19411variables that do not live across a call.  Functions compiled this way
19412will not save and restore the register @var{reg}.
19413
19414It is an error to used this flag with the frame pointer or stack pointer.
19415Use of this flag for other registers that have fixed pervasive roles in
19416the machine's execution model will produce disastrous results.
19417
19418This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
19419three-way choice.
19420
19421@item -fcall-saved-@var{reg}
19422@opindex fcall-saved
19423Treat the register named @var{reg} as an allocable register saved by
19424functions.  It may be allocated even for temporaries or variables that
19425live across a call.  Functions compiled this way will save and restore
19426the register @var{reg} if they use it.
19427
19428It is an error to used this flag with the frame pointer or stack pointer.
19429Use of this flag for other registers that have fixed pervasive roles in
19430the machine's execution model will produce disastrous results.
19431
19432A different sort of disaster will result from the use of this flag for
19433a register in which function values may be returned.
19434
19435This flag does not have a negative form, because it specifies a
19436three-way choice.
19437
19438@item -fpack-struct[=@var{n}]
19439@opindex fpack-struct
19440Without a value specified, pack all structure members together without
19441holes.  When a value is specified (which must be a small power of two), pack
19442structure members according to this value, representing the maximum
19443alignment (that is, objects with default alignment requirements larger than
19444this will be output potentially unaligned at the next fitting location.
19445
19446@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fpack-struct} switch causes GCC to generate
19447code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that switch.
19448Additionally, it makes the code suboptimal.
19449Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19450
19451@item -finstrument-functions
19452@opindex finstrument-functions
19453Generate instrumentation calls for entry and exit to functions.  Just
19454after function entry and just before function exit, the following
19455profiling functions will be called with the address of the current
19456function and its call site.  (On some platforms,
19457@code{__builtin_return_address} does not work beyond the current
19458function, so the call site information may not be available to the
19459profiling functions otherwise.)
19460
19461@smallexample
19462void __cyg_profile_func_enter (void *this_fn,
19463                               void *call_site);
19464void __cyg_profile_func_exit  (void *this_fn,
19465                               void *call_site);
19466@end smallexample
19467
19468The first argument is the address of the start of the current function,
19469which may be looked up exactly in the symbol table.
19470
19471This instrumentation is also done for functions expanded inline in other
19472functions.  The profiling calls will indicate where, conceptually, the
19473inline function is entered and exited.  This means that addressable
19474versions of such functions must be available.  If all your uses of a
19475function are expanded inline, this may mean an additional expansion of
19476code size.  If you use @samp{extern inline} in your C code, an
19477addressable version of such functions must be provided.  (This is
19478normally the case anyways, but if you get lucky and the optimizer always
19479expands the functions inline, you might have gotten away without
19480providing static copies.)
19481
19482A function may be given the attribute @code{no_instrument_function}, in
19483which case this instrumentation will not be done.  This can be used, for
19484example, for the profiling functions listed above, high-priority
19485interrupt routines, and any functions from which the profiling functions
19486cannot safely be called (perhaps signal handlers, if the profiling
19487routines generate output or allocate memory).
19488
19489@item -finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=@var{file},@var{file},@dots{}
19490@opindex finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list
19491
19492Set the list of functions that are excluded from instrumentation (see
19493the description of @code{-finstrument-functions}).  If the file that
19494contains a function definition matches with one of @var{file}, then
19495that function is not instrumented.  The match is done on substrings:
19496if the @var{file} parameter is a substring of the file name, it is
19497considered to be a match.
19498
19499For example:
19500
19501@smallexample
19502-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list=/bits/stl,include/sys
19503@end smallexample
19504
19505@noindent
19506will exclude any inline function defined in files whose pathnames
19507contain @code{/bits/stl} or @code{include/sys}.
19508
19509If, for some reason, you want to include letter @code{','} in one of
19510@var{sym}, write @code{'\,'}. For example,
19511@code{-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list='\,\,tmp'}
19512(note the single quote surrounding the option).
19513
19514@item -finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list=@var{sym},@var{sym},@dots{}
19515@opindex finstrument-functions-exclude-function-list
19516
19517This is similar to @code{-finstrument-functions-exclude-file-list},
19518but this option sets the list of function names to be excluded from
19519instrumentation.  The function name to be matched is its user-visible
19520name, such as @code{vector<int> blah(const vector<int> &)}, not the
19521internal mangled name (e.g., @code{_Z4blahRSt6vectorIiSaIiEE}).  The
19522match is done on substrings: if the @var{sym} parameter is a substring
19523of the function name, it is considered to be a match.  For C99 and C++
19524extended identifiers, the function name must be given in UTF-8, not
19525using universal character names.
19526
19527@item -fstack-check
19528@opindex fstack-check
19529Generate code to verify that you do not go beyond the boundary of the
19530stack.  You should specify this flag if you are running in an
19531environment with multiple threads, but only rarely need to specify it in
19532a single-threaded environment since stack overflow is automatically
19533detected on nearly all systems if there is only one stack.
19534
19535Note that this switch does not actually cause checking to be done; the
19536operating system or the language runtime must do that.  The switch causes
19537generation of code to ensure that they see the stack being extended.
19538
19539You can additionally specify a string parameter: @code{no} means no
19540checking, @code{generic} means force the use of old-style checking,
19541@code{specific} means use the best checking method and is equivalent
19542to bare @option{-fstack-check}.
19543
19544Old-style checking is a generic mechanism that requires no specific
19545target support in the compiler but comes with the following drawbacks:
19546
19547@enumerate
19548@item
19549Modified allocation strategy for large objects: they will always be
19550allocated dynamically if their size exceeds a fixed threshold.
19551
19552@item
19553Fixed limit on the size of the static frame of functions: when it is
19554topped by a particular function, stack checking is not reliable and
19555a warning is issued by the compiler.
19556
19557@item
19558Inefficiency: because of both the modified allocation strategy and the
19559generic implementation, the performances of the code are hampered.
19560@end enumerate
19561
19562Note that old-style stack checking is also the fallback method for
19563@code{specific} if no target support has been added in the compiler.
19564
19565@item -fstack-limit-register=@var{reg}
19566@itemx -fstack-limit-symbol=@var{sym}
19567@itemx -fno-stack-limit
19568@opindex fstack-limit-register
19569@opindex fstack-limit-symbol
19570@opindex fno-stack-limit
19571Generate code to ensure that the stack does not grow beyond a certain value,
19572either the value of a register or the address of a symbol.  If the stack
19573would grow beyond the value, a signal is raised.  For most targets,
19574the signal is raised before the stack overruns the boundary, so
19575it is possible to catch the signal without taking special precautions.
19576
19577For instance, if the stack starts at absolute address @samp{0x80000000}
19578and grows downwards, you can use the flags
19579@option{-fstack-limit-symbol=__stack_limit} and
19580@option{-Wl,--defsym,__stack_limit=0x7ffe0000} to enforce a stack limit
19581of 128KB@.  Note that this may only work with the GNU linker.
19582
19583@item -fsplit-stack
19584@opindex fsplit-stack
19585Generate code to automatically split the stack before it overflows.
19586The resulting program has a discontiguous stack which can only
19587overflow if the program is unable to allocate any more memory.  This
19588is most useful when running threaded programs, as it is no longer
19589necessary to calculate a good stack size to use for each thread.  This
19590is currently only implemented for the i386 and x86_64 back ends running
19591GNU/Linux.
19592
19593When code compiled with @option{-fsplit-stack} calls code compiled
19594without @option{-fsplit-stack}, there may not be much stack space
19595available for the latter code to run.  If compiling all code,
19596including library code, with @option{-fsplit-stack} is not an option,
19597then the linker can fix up these calls so that the code compiled
19598without @option{-fsplit-stack} always has a large stack.  Support for
19599this is implemented in the gold linker in GNU binutils release 2.21
19600and later.
19601
19602@item -fleading-underscore
19603@opindex fleading-underscore
19604This option and its counterpart, @option{-fno-leading-underscore}, forcibly
19605change the way C symbols are represented in the object file.  One use
19606is to help link with legacy assembly code.
19607
19608@strong{Warning:} the @option{-fleading-underscore} switch causes GCC to
19609generate code that is not binary compatible with code generated without that
19610switch.  Use it to conform to a non-default application binary interface.
19611Not all targets provide complete support for this switch.
19612
19613@item -ftls-model=@var{model}
19614@opindex ftls-model
19615Alter the thread-local storage model to be used (@pxref{Thread-Local}).
19616The @var{model} argument should be one of @code{global-dynamic},
19617@code{local-dynamic}, @code{initial-exec} or @code{local-exec}.
19618
19619The default without @option{-fpic} is @code{initial-exec}; with
19620@option{-fpic} the default is @code{global-dynamic}.
19621
19622@item -fvisibility=@var{default|internal|hidden|protected}
19623@opindex fvisibility
19624Set the default ELF image symbol visibility to the specified option---all
19625symbols will be marked with this unless overridden within the code.
19626Using this feature can very substantially improve linking and
19627load times of shared object libraries, produce more optimized
19628code, provide near-perfect API export and prevent symbol clashes.
19629It is @strong{strongly} recommended that you use this in any shared objects
19630you distribute.
19631
19632Despite the nomenclature, @code{default} always means public; i.e.,
19633available to be linked against from outside the shared object.
19634@code{protected} and @code{internal} are pretty useless in real-world
19635usage so the only other commonly used option will be @code{hidden}.
19636The default if @option{-fvisibility} isn't specified is
19637@code{default}, i.e., make every
19638symbol public---this causes the same behavior as previous versions of
19639GCC@.
19640
19641A good explanation of the benefits offered by ensuring ELF
19642symbols have the correct visibility is given by ``How To Write
19643Shared Libraries'' by Ulrich Drepper (which can be found at
19644@w{@uref{http://people.redhat.com/~drepper/}})---however a superior
19645solution made possible by this option to marking things hidden when
19646the default is public is to make the default hidden and mark things
19647public.  This is the norm with DLL's on Windows and with @option{-fvisibility=hidden}
19648and @code{__attribute__ ((visibility("default")))} instead of
19649@code{__declspec(dllexport)} you get almost identical semantics with
19650identical syntax.  This is a great boon to those working with
19651cross-platform projects.
19652
19653For those adding visibility support to existing code, you may find
19654@samp{#pragma GCC visibility} of use.  This works by you enclosing
19655the declarations you wish to set visibility for with (for example)
19656@samp{#pragma GCC visibility push(hidden)} and
19657@samp{#pragma GCC visibility pop}.
19658Bear in mind that symbol visibility should be viewed @strong{as
19659part of the API interface contract} and thus all new code should
19660always specify visibility when it is not the default; i.e., declarations
19661only for use within the local DSO should @strong{always} be marked explicitly
19662as hidden as so to avoid PLT indirection overheads---making this
19663abundantly clear also aids readability and self-documentation of the code.
19664Note that due to ISO C++ specification requirements, operator new and
19665operator delete must always be of default visibility.
19666
19667Be aware that headers from outside your project, in particular system
19668headers and headers from any other library you use, may not be
19669expecting to be compiled with visibility other than the default.  You
19670may need to explicitly say @samp{#pragma GCC visibility push(default)}
19671before including any such headers.
19672
19673@samp{extern} declarations are not affected by @samp{-fvisibility}, so
19674a lot of code can be recompiled with @samp{-fvisibility=hidden} with
19675no modifications.  However, this means that calls to @samp{extern}
19676functions with no explicit visibility will use the PLT, so it is more
19677effective to use @samp{__attribute ((visibility))} and/or
19678@samp{#pragma GCC visibility} to tell the compiler which @samp{extern}
19679declarations should be treated as hidden.
19680
19681Note that @samp{-fvisibility} does affect C++ vague linkage
19682entities. This means that, for instance, an exception class that will
19683be thrown between DSOs must be explicitly marked with default
19684visibility so that the @samp{type_info} nodes will be unified between
19685the DSOs.
19686
19687An overview of these techniques, their benefits and how to use them
19688is at @uref{http://gcc.gnu.org/@/wiki/@/Visibility}.
19689
19690@item -fstrict-volatile-bitfields
19691@opindex fstrict-volatile-bitfields
19692This option should be used if accesses to volatile bit-fields (or other
19693structure fields, although the compiler usually honors those types
19694anyway) should use a single access of the width of the
19695field's type, aligned to a natural alignment if possible.  For
19696example, targets with memory-mapped peripheral registers might require
19697all such accesses to be 16 bits wide; with this flag the user could
19698declare all peripheral bit-fields as ``unsigned short'' (assuming short
19699is 16 bits on these targets) to force GCC to use 16-bit accesses
19700instead of, perhaps, a more efficient 32-bit access.
19701
19702If this option is disabled, the compiler will use the most efficient
19703instruction.  In the previous example, that might be a 32-bit load
19704instruction, even though that will access bytes that do not contain
19705any portion of the bit-field, or memory-mapped registers unrelated to
19706the one being updated.
19707
19708If the target requires strict alignment, and honoring the field
19709type would require violating this alignment, a warning is issued.
19710If the field has @code{packed} attribute, the access is done without
19711honoring the field type.  If the field doesn't have @code{packed}
19712attribute, the access is done honoring the field type.  In both cases,
19713GCC assumes that the user knows something about the target hardware
19714that it is unaware of.
19715
19716The default value of this option is determined by the application binary
19717interface for the target processor.
19718
19719@end table
19720
19721@c man end
19722
19723@node Environment Variables
19724@section Environment Variables Affecting GCC
19725@cindex environment variables
19726
19727@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
19728This section describes several environment variables that affect how GCC
19729operates.  Some of them work by specifying directories or prefixes to use
19730when searching for various kinds of files.  Some are used to specify other
19731aspects of the compilation environment.
19732
19733Note that you can also specify places to search using options such as
19734@option{-B}, @option{-I} and @option{-L} (@pxref{Directory Options}).  These
19735take precedence over places specified using environment variables, which
19736in turn take precedence over those specified by the configuration of GCC@.
19737@xref{Driver,, Controlling the Compilation Driver @file{gcc}, gccint,
19738GNU Compiler Collection (GCC) Internals}.
19739
19740@table @env
19741@item LANG
19742@itemx LC_CTYPE
19743@c @itemx LC_COLLATE
19744@itemx LC_MESSAGES
19745@c @itemx LC_MONETARY
19746@c @itemx LC_NUMERIC
19747@c @itemx LC_TIME
19748@itemx LC_ALL
19749@findex LANG
19750@findex LC_CTYPE
19751@c @findex LC_COLLATE
19752@findex LC_MESSAGES
19753@c @findex LC_MONETARY
19754@c @findex LC_NUMERIC
19755@c @findex LC_TIME
19756@findex LC_ALL
19757@cindex locale
19758These environment variables control the way that GCC uses
19759localization information which allows GCC to work with different
19760national conventions.  GCC inspects the locale categories
19761@env{LC_CTYPE} and @env{LC_MESSAGES} if it has been configured to do
19762so.  These locale categories can be set to any value supported by your
19763installation.  A typical value is @samp{en_GB.UTF-8} for English in the United
19764Kingdom encoded in UTF-8.
19765
19766The @env{LC_CTYPE} environment variable specifies character
19767classification.  GCC uses it to determine the character boundaries in
19768a string; this is needed for some multibyte encodings that contain quote
19769and escape characters that would otherwise be interpreted as a string
19770end or escape.
19771
19772The @env{LC_MESSAGES} environment variable specifies the language to
19773use in diagnostic messages.
19774
19775If the @env{LC_ALL} environment variable is set, it overrides the value
19776of @env{LC_CTYPE} and @env{LC_MESSAGES}; otherwise, @env{LC_CTYPE}
19777and @env{LC_MESSAGES} default to the value of the @env{LANG}
19778environment variable.  If none of these variables are set, GCC
19779defaults to traditional C English behavior.
19780
19781@item TMPDIR
19782@findex TMPDIR
19783If @env{TMPDIR} is set, it specifies the directory to use for temporary
19784files.  GCC uses temporary files to hold the output of one stage of
19785compilation which is to be used as input to the next stage: for example,
19786the output of the preprocessor, which is the input to the compiler
19787proper.
19788
19789@item GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG
19790@findex GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG
19791Setting @env{GCC_COMPARE_DEBUG} is nearly equivalent to passing
19792@option{-fcompare-debug} to the compiler driver.  See the documentation
19793of this option for more details.
19794
19795@item GCC_EXEC_PREFIX
19796@findex GCC_EXEC_PREFIX
19797If @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is set, it specifies a prefix to use in the
19798names of the subprograms executed by the compiler.  No slash is added
19799when this prefix is combined with the name of a subprogram, but you can
19800specify a prefix that ends with a slash if you wish.
19801
19802If @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is not set, GCC will attempt to figure out
19803an appropriate prefix to use based on the pathname it was invoked with.
19804
19805If GCC cannot find the subprogram using the specified prefix, it
19806tries looking in the usual places for the subprogram.
19807
19808The default value of @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} is
19809@file{@var{prefix}/lib/gcc/} where @var{prefix} is the prefix to
19810the installed compiler. In many cases @var{prefix} is the value
19811of @code{prefix} when you ran the @file{configure} script.
19812
19813Other prefixes specified with @option{-B} take precedence over this prefix.
19814
19815This prefix is also used for finding files such as @file{crt0.o} that are
19816used for linking.
19817
19818In addition, the prefix is used in an unusual way in finding the
19819directories to search for header files.  For each of the standard
19820directories whose name normally begins with @samp{/usr/local/lib/gcc}
19821(more precisely, with the value of @env{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}), GCC tries
19822replacing that beginning with the specified prefix to produce an
19823alternate directory name.  Thus, with @option{-Bfoo/}, GCC will search
19824@file{foo/bar} where it would normally search @file{/usr/local/lib/bar}.
19825These alternate directories are searched first; the standard directories
19826come next. If a standard directory begins with the configured
19827@var{prefix} then the value of @var{prefix} is replaced by
19828@env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} when looking for header files.
19829
19830@item COMPILER_PATH
19831@findex COMPILER_PATH
19832The value of @env{COMPILER_PATH} is a colon-separated list of
19833directories, much like @env{PATH}.  GCC tries the directories thus
19834specified when searching for subprograms, if it can't find the
19835subprograms using @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.
19836
19837@item LIBRARY_PATH
19838@findex LIBRARY_PATH
19839The value of @env{LIBRARY_PATH} is a colon-separated list of
19840directories, much like @env{PATH}.  When configured as a native compiler,
19841GCC tries the directories thus specified when searching for special
19842linker files, if it can't find them using @env{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}.  Linking
19843using GCC also uses these directories when searching for ordinary
19844libraries for the @option{-l} option (but directories specified with
19845@option{-L} come first).
19846
19847@item LANG
19848@findex LANG
19849@cindex locale definition
19850This variable is used to pass locale information to the compiler.  One way in
19851which this information is used is to determine the character set to be used
19852when character literals, string literals and comments are parsed in C and C++.
19853When the compiler is configured to allow multibyte characters,
19854the following values for @env{LANG} are recognized:
19855
19856@table @samp
19857@item C-JIS
19858Recognize JIS characters.
19859@item C-SJIS
19860Recognize SJIS characters.
19861@item C-EUCJP
19862Recognize EUCJP characters.
19863@end table
19864
19865If @env{LANG} is not defined, or if it has some other value, then the
19866compiler will use mblen and mbtowc as defined by the default locale to
19867recognize and translate multibyte characters.
19868@end table
19869
19870@noindent
19871Some additional environments variables affect the behavior of the
19872preprocessor.
19873
19874@include cppenv.texi
19875
19876@c man end
19877
19878@node Precompiled Headers
19879@section Using Precompiled Headers
19880@cindex precompiled headers
19881@cindex speed of compilation
19882
19883Often large projects have many header files that are included in every
19884source file.  The time the compiler takes to process these header files
19885over and over again can account for nearly all of the time required to
19886build the project.  To make builds faster, GCC allows users to
19887`precompile' a header file; then, if builds can use the precompiled
19888header file they will be much faster.
19889
19890To create a precompiled header file, simply compile it as you would any
19891other file, if necessary using the @option{-x} option to make the driver
19892treat it as a C or C++ header file.  You will probably want to use a
19893tool like @command{make} to keep the precompiled header up-to-date when
19894the headers it contains change.
19895
19896A precompiled header file will be searched for when @code{#include} is
19897seen in the compilation.  As it searches for the included file
19898(@pxref{Search Path,,Search Path,cpp,The C Preprocessor}) the
19899compiler looks for a precompiled header in each directory just before it
19900looks for the include file in that directory.  The name searched for is
19901the name specified in the @code{#include} with @samp{.gch} appended.  If
19902the precompiled header file can't be used, it is ignored.
19903
19904For instance, if you have @code{#include "all.h"}, and you have
19905@file{all.h.gch} in the same directory as @file{all.h}, then the
19906precompiled header file will be used if possible, and the original
19907header will be used otherwise.
19908
19909Alternatively, you might decide to put the precompiled header file in a
19910directory and use @option{-I} to ensure that directory is searched
19911before (or instead of) the directory containing the original header.
19912Then, if you want to check that the precompiled header file is always
19913used, you can put a file of the same name as the original header in this
19914directory containing an @code{#error} command.
19915
19916This also works with @option{-include}.  So yet another way to use
19917precompiled headers, good for projects not designed with precompiled
19918header files in mind, is to simply take most of the header files used by
19919a project, include them from another header file, precompile that header
19920file, and @option{-include} the precompiled header.  If the header files
19921have guards against multiple inclusion, they will be skipped because
19922they've already been included (in the precompiled header).
19923
19924If you need to precompile the same header file for different
19925languages, targets, or compiler options, you can instead make a
19926@emph{directory} named like @file{all.h.gch}, and put each precompiled
19927header in the directory, perhaps using @option{-o}.  It doesn't matter
19928what you call the files in the directory, every precompiled header in
19929the directory will be considered.  The first precompiled header
19930encountered in the directory that is valid for this compilation will
19931be used; they're searched in no particular order.
19932
19933There are many other possibilities, limited only by your imagination,
19934good sense, and the constraints of your build system.
19935
19936A precompiled header file can be used only when these conditions apply:
19937
19938@itemize
19939@item
19940Only one precompiled header can be used in a particular compilation.
19941
19942@item
19943A precompiled header can't be used once the first C token is seen.  You
19944can have preprocessor directives before a precompiled header; you can
19945even include a precompiled header from inside another header, so long as
19946there are no C tokens before the @code{#include}.
19947
19948@item
19949The precompiled header file must be produced for the same language as
19950the current compilation.  You can't use a C precompiled header for a C++
19951compilation.
19952
19953@item
19954The precompiled header file must have been produced by the same compiler
19955binary as the current compilation is using.
19956
19957@item
19958Any macros defined before the precompiled header is included must
19959either be defined in the same way as when the precompiled header was
19960generated, or must not affect the precompiled header, which usually
19961means that they don't appear in the precompiled header at all.
19962
19963The @option{-D} option is one way to define a macro before a
19964precompiled header is included; using a @code{#define} can also do it.
19965There are also some options that define macros implicitly, like
19966@option{-O} and @option{-Wdeprecated}; the same rule applies to macros
19967defined this way.
19968
19969@item If debugging information is output when using the precompiled
19970header, using @option{-g} or similar, the same kind of debugging information
19971must have been output when building the precompiled header.  However,
19972a precompiled header built using @option{-g} can be used in a compilation
19973when no debugging information is being output.
19974
19975@item The same @option{-m} options must generally be used when building
19976and using the precompiled header.  @xref{Submodel Options},
19977for any cases where this rule is relaxed.
19978
19979@item Each of the following options must be the same when building and using
19980the precompiled header:
19981
19982@gccoptlist{-fexceptions}
19983
19984@item
19985Some other command-line options starting with @option{-f},
19986@option{-p}, or @option{-O} must be defined in the same way as when
19987the precompiled header was generated.  At present, it's not clear
19988which options are safe to change and which are not; the safest choice
19989is to use exactly the same options when generating and using the
19990precompiled header.  The following are known to be safe:
19991
19992@gccoptlist{-fmessage-length=  -fpreprocessed  -fsched-interblock @gol
19993-fsched-spec  -fsched-spec-load  -fsched-spec-load-dangerous @gol
19994-fsched-verbose=@var{number}  -fschedule-insns  -fvisibility= @gol
19995-pedantic-errors}
19996
19997@end itemize
19998
19999For all of these except the last, the compiler will automatically
20000ignore the precompiled header if the conditions aren't met.  If you
20001find an option combination that doesn't work and doesn't cause the
20002precompiled header to be ignored, please consider filing a bug report,
20003see @ref{Bugs}.
20004
20005If you do use differing options when generating and using the
20006precompiled header, the actual behavior will be a mixture of the
20007behavior for the options.  For instance, if you use @option{-g} to
20008generate the precompiled header but not when using it, you may or may
20009not get debugging information for routines in the precompiled header.
20010